Provided by: gcc-4.9_4.9.3-13ubuntu2_amd64 bug

NAME

       gcc - GNU project C and C++ compiler

SYNOPSIS

       gcc [-c|-S|-E] [-std=standard]
           [-g] [-pg] [-Olevel]
           [-Wwarn...] [-Wpedantic]
           [-Idir...] [-Ldir...]
           [-Dmacro[=defn]...] [-Umacro]
           [-foption...] [-mmachine-option...]
           [-o outfile] [@file] infile...

       Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the remainder.  g++ accepts mostly the same
       options as gcc.

DESCRIPTION

       When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation, assembly and linking.  The "overall
       options" allow you to stop this process at an intermediate stage.  For example, the -c option says not to
       run the linker.  Then the output consists of object files output by the assembler.

       Other options are passed on to one stage of processing.  Some options control the preprocessor and others
       the compiler itself.  Yet other options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
       documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.

       Most of the command-line options that you can use with GCC are useful for C programs; when an option is
       only useful with another language (usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly.  If the description
       for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use that option with all supported
       languages.

       The gcc program accepts options and file names as operands.  Many options have multi-letter names;
       therefore multiple single-letter options may not be grouped: -dv is very different from -d -v.

       You can mix options and other arguments.  For the most part, the order you use doesn't matter.  Order
       does matter when you use several options of the same kind; for example, if you specify -L more than once,
       the directories are searched in the order specified.  Also, the placement of the -l option is
       significant.

       Many options have long names starting with -f or with -W---for example, -fmove-loop-invariants, -Wformat
       and so on.  Most of these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of -ffoo is -fno-foo.
       This manual documents only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.

OPTIONS

   Option Summary
       Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type.  Explanations are in the following sections.

       Overall Options
           -c    -S   -E   -o  file   -no-canonical-prefixes  -pipe   -pass-exit-codes  -x  language   -v   -###
           --help[=class[,...]]  --target-help  --version  -wrapper  @file  -fplugin=file  -fplugin-arg-name=arg
           -fdump-ada-spec[-slim] -fada-spec-parent=unit -fdump-go-spec=file

       C Language Options
           -ansi   -std=standard   -fgnu89-inline  -aux-info  filename  -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
           -fno-asm   -fno-builtin   -fno-builtin-function  -fhosted   -ffreestanding   -fopenmp   -fopenmp-simd
           -fms-extensions       -fplan9-extensions       -trigraphs        -traditional        -traditional-cpp
           -fallow-single-precision  -fcond-mismatch -flax-vector-conversions -fsigned-bitfields   -fsigned-char
           -funsigned-bitfields  -funsigned-char

       C++ Language Options
           -fabi-version=n     -fno-access-control     -fcheck-new    -fconstexpr-depth=n     -ffriend-injection
           -fno-elide-constructors   -fno-enforce-eh-specs   -ffor-scope    -fno-for-scope     -fno-gnu-keywords
           -fno-implicit-templates    -fno-implicit-inline-templates   -fno-implement-inlines    -fms-extensions
           -fno-nonansi-builtins    -fnothrow-opt    -fno-operator-names    -fno-optional-diags     -fpermissive
           -fno-pretty-templates  -frepo   -fno-rtti   -fstats   -ftemplate-backtrace-limit=n -ftemplate-depth=n
           -fno-threadsafe-statics   -fuse-cxa-atexit    -fno-weak    -nostdinc++    -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
           -fvtable-verify=std|preinit|none        -fvtv-counts        -fvtv-debug        -fvisibility-ms-compat
           -fext-numeric-literals  -Wabi    -Wconversion-null    -Wctor-dtor-privacy   -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor
           -Wliteral-suffix      -Wnarrowing      -Wnoexcept      -Wnon-virtual-dtor      -Wreorder     -Weffc++
           -Wstrict-null-sentinel      -Wno-non-template-friend       -Wold-style-cast      -Woverloaded-virtual
           -Wno-pmf-conversions -Wsign-promo

       Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
           -fconstant-string-class=class-name       -fgnu-runtime        -fnext-runtime       -fno-nil-receivers
           -fobjc-abi-version=n  -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors   -fobjc-direct-dispatch   -fobjc-exceptions   -fobjc-gc
           -fobjc-nilcheck  -fobjc-std=objc1  -freplace-objc-classes  -fzero-link  -gen-decls -Wassign-intercept
           -Wno-protocol  -Wselector -Wstrict-selector-match -Wundeclared-selector

       Language Independent Options
           -fmessage-length=n                                      -fdiagnostics-show-location=[once|every-line]
           -fdiagnostics-color=[auto|never|always] -fno-diagnostics-show-option -fno-diagnostics-show-caret

       Warning Options
           -fsyntax-only    -fmax-errors=n    -Wpedantic   -pedantic-errors   -w    -Wextra    -Wall   -Waddress
           -Waggregate-return       -Waggressive-loop-optimizations        -Warray-bounds        -Wno-attributes
           -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined  -Wc++-compat -Wc++11-compat -Wcast-align  -Wcast-qual -Wchar-subscripts
           -Wclobbered   -Wcomment  -Wconditionally-supported   -Wconversion   -Wcoverage-mismatch   -Wdate-time
           -Wdelete-incomplete  -Wno-cpp  -Wno-deprecated  -Wno-deprecated-declarations  -Wdisabled-optimization
           -Wno-div-by-zero -Wdouble-promotion -Wempty-body  -Wenum-compare -Wno-endif-labels -Werror  -Werror=*
           -Wfatal-errors  -Wfloat-equal  -Wformat  -Wformat=2  -Wno-format-contains-nul  -Wno-format-extra-args
           -Wformat-nonliteral  -Wformat-security  -Wformat-y2k -Wframe-larger-than=len -Wno-free-nonheap-object
           -Wjump-misses-init -Wignored-qualifiers -Wimplicit   -Wimplicit-function-declaration   -Wimplicit-int
           -Winit-self     -Winline    -Wmaybe-uninitialized    -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast   -Wno-invalid-offsetof
           -Winvalid-pch  -Wlarger-than=len    -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations   -Wlogical-op   -Wlong-long   -Wmain
           -Wmaybe-uninitialized    -Wmemset-transposed-args    -Wmissing-braces    -Wmissing-field-initializers
           -Wmissing-include-dirs -Wno-multichar  -Wnonnull   -Wno-overflow  -Wopenmp-simd  -Woverlength-strings
           -Wpacked        -Wpacked-bitfield-compat       -Wpadded      -Wparentheses       -Wpedantic-ms-format
           -Wno-pedantic-ms-format       -Wpointer-arith        -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast       -Wredundant-decls
           -Wno-return-local-addr  -Wreturn-type   -Wsequence-point   -Wshadow -Wsign-compare  -Wsign-conversion
           -Wfloat-conversion -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess -Wstack-protector  -Wstack-usage=len  -Wstrict-aliasing
           -Wstrict-aliasing=n                        -Wstrict-overflow                      -Wstrict-overflow=n
           -Wsuggest-attribute=[pure|const|noreturn|format]         -Wmissing-format-attribute          -Wswitch
           -Wswitch-default     -Wswitch-enum    -Wsync-nand    -Wsystem-headers    -Wtrampolines    -Wtrigraphs
           -Wtype-limits  -Wundef -Wuninitialized  -Wunknown-pragmas  -Wno-pragmas  -Wunsuffixed-float-constants
           -Wunused      -Wunused-function     -Wunused-label      -Wunused-local-typedefs    -Wunused-parameter
           -Wno-unused-result        -Wunused-value         -Wunused-variable         -Wunused-but-set-parameter
           -Wunused-but-set-variable   -Wuseless-cast   -Wvariadic-macros  -Wvector-operation-performance  -Wvla
           -Wvolatile-register-var  -Wwrite-strings -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant

       C and Objective-C-only Warning Options
           -Wbad-function-cast     -Wmissing-declarations     -Wmissing-parameter-type      -Wmissing-prototypes
           -Wnested-externs  -Wold-style-declaration   -Wold-style-definition -Wstrict-prototypes  -Wtraditional
           -Wtraditional-conversion -Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign

       Debugging Options
           -dletters  -dumpspecs  -dumpmachine  -dumpversion -fsanitize=style -fdbg-cnt-list  -fdbg-cnt=counter-
           value-list    -fdisable-ipa-pass_name    -fdisable-rtl-pass_name   -fdisable-rtl-pass-name=range-list
           -fdisable-tree-pass_name    -fdisable-tree-pass-name=range-list    -fdump-noaddr    -fdump-unnumbered
           -fdump-unnumbered-links    -fdump-translation-unit[-n]    -fdump-class-hierarchy[-n]   -fdump-ipa-all
           -fdump-ipa-cgraph     -fdump-ipa-inline     -fdump-passes      -fdump-statistics      -fdump-tree-all
           -fdump-tree-original[-n]  -fdump-tree-optimized[-n]  -fdump-tree-cfg -fdump-tree-alias -fdump-tree-ch
           -fdump-tree-ssa[-n]        -fdump-tree-pre[-n]        -fdump-tree-ccp[-n]         -fdump-tree-dce[-n]
           -fdump-tree-gimple[-raw]      -fdump-tree-dom[-n]     -fdump-tree-dse[-n]     -fdump-tree-phiprop[-n]
           -fdump-tree-phiopt[-n]    -fdump-tree-forwprop[-n]     -fdump-tree-copyrename[-n]     -fdump-tree-nrv
           -fdump-tree-vect  -fdump-tree-sink  -fdump-tree-sra[-n]  -fdump-tree-forwprop[-n] -fdump-tree-fre[-n]
           -fdump-tree-vtable-verify   -fdump-tree-vrp[-n]   -fdump-tree-storeccp[-n]    -fdump-final-insns=file
           -fcompare-debug[=opts]                  -fcompare-debug-second                -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
           -fno-eliminate-unused-debug-types     -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols      -femit-class-debug-always
           -fenable-kind-pass  -fenable-kind-pass=range-list -fdebug-types-section -fmem-report-wpa -fmem-report
           -fpre-ipa-mem-report  -fpost-ipa-mem-report   -fprofile-arcs   -fopt-info   -fopt-info-options[=file]
           -frandom-seed=string         -fsched-verbose=n        -fsel-sched-verbose        -fsel-sched-dump-cfg
           -fsel-sched-pipelining-verbose   -fstack-usage    -ftest-coverage     -ftime-report    -fvar-tracking
           -fvar-tracking-assignments    -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle   -g    -glevel    -gtoggle    -gcoff
           -gdwarf-version   -ggdb    -grecord-gcc-switches     -gno-record-gcc-switches    -gstabs     -gstabs+
           -gstrict-dwarf      -gno-strict-dwarf     -gvms      -gxcoff     -gxcoff+    -fno-merge-debug-strings
           -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm              -fdebug-prefix-map=old=new              -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
           -femit-struct-debug-reduced          -femit-struct-debug-detailed[=spec-list]         -p          -pg
           -print-file-name=library     -print-libgcc-file-name     -print-multi-directory      -print-multi-lib
           -print-multi-os-directory    -print-prog-name=program     -print-search-dirs     -Q    -print-sysroot
           -print-sysroot-headers-suffix -save-temps -save-temps=cwd -save-temps=obj -time[=file]

       Optimization Options
           -faggressive-loop-optimizations    -falign-functions[=n]     -falign-jumps[=n]     -falign-labels[=n]
           -falign-loops[=n]          -fassociative-math          -fauto-inc-dec          -fbranch-probabilities
           -fbranch-target-load-optimize   -fbranch-target-load-optimize2   -fbtr-bb-exclusive    -fcaller-saves
           -fcheck-data-deps   -fcombine-stack-adjustments   -fconserve-stack  -fcompare-elim  -fcprop-registers
           -fcrossjumping    -fcse-follow-jumps    -fcse-skip-blocks    -fcx-fortran-rules    -fcx-limited-range
           -fdata-sections      -fdce      -fdelayed-branch      -fdelete-null-pointer-checks     -fdevirtualize
           -fdevirtualize-speculatively    -fdse    -fearly-inlining     -fipa-sra     -fexpensive-optimizations
           -ffat-lto-objects     -ffast-math     -ffinite-math-only    -ffloat-store    -fexcess-precision=style
           -fforward-propagate -ffp-contract=style  -ffunction-sections  -fgcse  -fgcse-after-reload  -fgcse-las
           -fgcse-lm   -fgraphite-identity  -fgcse-sm  -fhoist-adjacent-loads  -fif-conversion  -fif-conversion2
           -findirect-inlining      -finline-functions      -finline-functions-called-once      -finline-limit=n
           -finline-small-functions    -fipa-cp    -fipa-cp-clone   -fipa-pta   -fipa-profile   -fipa-pure-const
           -fipa-reference       -fira-algorithm=algorithm       -fira-region=region        -fira-hoist-pressure
           -fira-loop-pressure      -fno-ira-share-save-slots     -fno-ira-share-spill-slots     -fira-verbose=n
           -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference          -fisolate-erroneous-paths-attribute           -fivopts
           -fkeep-inline-functions  -fkeep-static-consts  -flive-range-shrinkage -floop-block -floop-interchange
           -floop-strip-mine   -floop-nest-optimize   -floop-parallelize-all    -flto    -flto-compression-level
           -flto-partition=alg    -flto-report    -flto-report-wpa    -fmerge-all-constants    -fmerge-constants
           -fmodulo-sched     -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves     -fmove-loop-invariants     -fno-branch-count-reg
           -fno-defer-pop    -fno-function-cse    -fno-guess-branch-probability    -fno-inline   -fno-math-errno
           -fno-peephole     -fno-peephole2     -fno-sched-interblock     -fno-sched-spec      -fno-signed-zeros
           -fno-toplevel-reorder     -fno-trapping-math     -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss    -fomit-frame-pointer
           -foptimize-sibling-calls        -fpartial-inlining        -fpeel-loops         -fpredictive-commoning
           -fprefetch-loop-arrays  -fprofile-report  -fprofile-correction  -fprofile-dir=path -fprofile-generate
           -fprofile-generate=path -fprofile-use -fprofile-use=path -fprofile-values -fprofile-reorder-functions
           -freciprocal-math   -free    -frename-registers    -freorder-blocks    -freorder-blocks-and-partition
           -freorder-functions    -frerun-cse-after-loop   -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops   -frounding-math
           -fsched2-use-superblocks     -fsched-pressure      -fsched-spec-load      -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
           -fsched-stalled-insns-dep[=n]            -fsched-stalled-insns[=n]            -fsched-group-heuristic
           -fsched-critical-path-heuristic          -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic           -fsched-rank-heuristic
           -fsched-last-insn-heuristic     -fsched-dep-count-heuristic     -fschedule-insns    -fschedule-insns2
           -fsection-anchors     -fselective-scheduling      -fselective-scheduling2      -fsel-sched-pipelining
           -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops    -fshrink-wrap    -fsignaling-nans   -fsingle-precision-constant
           -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller       -fsplit-wide-types       -fstack-protector        -fstack-protector-all
           -fstack-protector-strong  -fstrict-aliasing  -fstrict-overflow -fthread-jumps -ftracer -ftree-bit-ccp
           -ftree-builtin-call-dce   -ftree-ccp   -ftree-ch   -ftree-coalesce-inline-vars   -ftree-coalesce-vars
           -ftree-copy-prop   -ftree-copyrename   -ftree-dce  -ftree-dominator-opts  -ftree-dse  -ftree-forwprop
           -ftree-fre   -ftree-loop-if-convert   -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores   -ftree-loop-im   -ftree-phiprop
           -ftree-loop-distribution   -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns   -ftree-loop-ivcanon   -ftree-loop-linear
           -ftree-loop-optimize -ftree-loop-vectorize -ftree-parallelize-loops=n  -ftree-pre  -ftree-partial-pre
           -ftree-pta     -ftree-reassoc    -ftree-sink    -ftree-slsr    -ftree-sra    -ftree-switch-conversion
           -ftree-tail-merge  -ftree-ter   -ftree-vectorize   -ftree-vrp   -funit-at-a-time   -funroll-all-loops
           -funroll-loops      -funsafe-loop-optimizations      -funsafe-math-optimizations     -funswitch-loops
           -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller -fvect-cost-model -fvpt -fweb -fwhole-program -fwpa  -fuse-ld=linker
           -fuse-linker-plugin --param name=value -O  -O0  -O1  -O2  -O3  -Os -Ofast -Og

       Preprocessor Options
           -Aquestion=answer  -A-question[=answer]  -C  -dD  -dI  -dM  -dN -Dmacro[=defn]  -E  -H -idirafter dir
           -include file  -imacros file -iprefix file  -iwithprefix dir  -iwithprefixbefore  dir   -isystem  dir
           -imultilib  dir  -isysroot  dir  -M   -MM   -MF   -MG   -MP   -MQ   -MT   -nostdinc  -P   -fdebug-cpp
           -ftrack-macro-expansion   -fworking-directory   -remap   -trigraphs    -undef    -Umacro   -Wp,option
           -Xpreprocessor option -no-integrated-cpp

       Assembler Option
           -Wa,option  -Xassembler option

       Linker Options
           object-file-name   -llibrary  -nostartfiles   -nodefaultlibs   -nostdlib  -pie  -rdynamic -s  -static
           -static-libgcc -static-libstdc++  -static-libasan  -static-libtsan  -static-liblsan  -static-libubsan
           -shared -shared-libgcc  -symbolic -T script  -Wl,option  -Xlinker option -u symbol

       Directory Options
           -Bprefix -Idir -iplugindir=dir -iquotedir -Ldir -specs=file -I- --sysroot=dir --no-sysroot-suffix

       Machine Dependent Options
           AArch64   Options   -mabi=name    -mbig-endian    -mlittle-endian  -mgeneral-regs-only  -mcmodel=tiny
           -mcmodel=small  -mcmodel=large -mstrict-align -momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
           -mtls-dialect=desc   -mtls-dialect=traditional  -mfix-cortex-a53-835769    -mno-fix-cortex-a53-835769
           -mfix-cortex-a53-843419  -mno-fix-cortex-a53-843419 -march=name  -mcpu=name  -mtune=name

           Adapteva   Epiphany   Options   -mhalf-reg-file  -mprefer-short-insn-regs  -mbranch-cost=num  -mcmove
           -mnops=num -msoft-cmpsf  -msplit-lohi  -mpost-inc  -mpost-modify  -mstack-offset=num  -mround-nearest
           -mlong-calls     -mshort-calls    -msmall16    -mfp-mode=mode    -mvect-double    -max-vect-align=num
           -msplit-vecmove-early -m1reg-reg

           ARC Options -mbarrel-shifter -mcpu=cpu -mA6 -mARC600 -mA7 -mARC700 -mdpfp -mdpfp-compact  -mdpfp-fast
           -mno-dpfp-lrsr  -mea  -mno-mpy  -mmul32x16  -mmul64  -mnorm  -mspfp -mspfp-compact -mspfp-fast -msimd
           -msoft-float -mswap -mcrc -mdsp-packa -mdvbf -mlock -mmac-d16  -mmac-24  -mrtsc  -mswape  -mtelephony
           -mxy  -misize  -mannotate-align -marclinux -marclinux_prof -mepilogue-cfi -mlong-calls -mmedium-calls
           -msdata  -mucb-mcount  -mvolatile-cache  -malign-call  -mauto-modify-reg  -mbbit-peephole   -mno-brcc
           -mcase-vector-pcrel  -mcompact-casesi -mno-cond-exec -mearly-cbranchsi -mexpand-adddi -mindexed-loads
           -mlra -mlra-priority-none -mlra-priority-compact mlra-priority-noncompact -mno-millicode -mmixed-code
           -mq-class        -mRcq        -mRcw        -msize-level=level        -mtune=cpu        -mmultcost=num
           -munalign-prob-threshold=probability

           ARM   Options  -mapcs-frame   -mno-apcs-frame  -mabi=name  -mapcs-stack-check   -mno-apcs-stack-check
           -mapcs-float  -mno-apcs-float -mapcs-reentrant  -mno-apcs-reentrant -msched-prolog  -mno-sched-prolog
           -mlittle-endian     -mbig-endian     -mwords-little-endian    -mfloat-abi=name     -mfp16-format=name
           -mthumb-interwork         -mno-thumb-interwork        -mcpu=name        -march=name        -mfpu=name
           -mstructure-size-boundary=n  -mabort-on-noreturn  -mlong-calls    -mno-long-calls   -msingle-pic-base
           -mno-single-pic-base   -mpic-register=reg  -mnop-fun-dllimport  -mpoke-function-name  -mthumb   -marm
           -mtpcs-frame  -mtpcs-leaf-frame  -mcaller-super-interworking   -mcallee-super-interworking  -mtp=name
           -mtls-dialect=dialect  -mword-relocations  -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd  -munaligned-access -mneon-for-64bits
           -mslow-flash-data -mrestrict-it

           AVR Options -mmcu=mcu -maccumulate-args -mbranch-cost=cost  -mcall-prologues  -mint8  -mno-interrupts
           -mrelax -mstrict-X -mtiny-stack -Waddr-space-convert

           Blackfin Options -mcpu=cpu[-sirevision] -msim -momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
           -mspecld-anomaly   -mno-specld-anomaly   -mcsync-anomaly   -mno-csync-anomaly  -mlow-64k  -mno-low64k
           -mstack-check-l1        -mid-shared-library       -mno-id-shared-library        -mshared-library-id=n
           -mleaf-id-shared-library    -mno-leaf-id-shared-library   -msep-data    -mno-sep-data    -mlong-calls
           -mno-long-calls -mfast-fp -minline-plt -mmulticore  -mcorea  -mcoreb  -msdram -micplb

           C6X Options -mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian -march=cpu -msim -msdata=sdata-type

           CRIS Options -mcpu=cpu  -march=cpu   -mtune=cpu  -mmax-stack-frame=n   -melinux-stacksize=n  -metrax4
           -metrax100    -mpdebug    -mcc-init   -mno-side-effects  -mstack-align   -mdata-align   -mconst-align
           -m32-bit  -m16-bit  -m8-bit  -mno-prologue-epilogue  -mno-gotplt  -melf   -maout   -melinux   -mlinux
           -sim  -sim2 -mmul-bug-workaround  -mno-mul-bug-workaround

           CR16 Options -mmac -mcr16cplus -mcr16c -msim -mint32 -mbit-ops -mdata-model=model

           Darwin  Options  -all_load   -allowable_client   -arch   -arch_errors_fatal -arch_only  -bind_at_load
           -bundle    -bundle_loader   -client_name    -compatibility_version    -current_version    -dead_strip
           -dependency-file   -dylib_file   -dylinker_install_name -dynamic  -dynamiclib  -exported_symbols_list
           -filelist  -flat_namespace  -force_cpusubtype_ALL -force_flat_namespace  -headerpad_max_install_names
           -iframework -image_base  -init  -install_name  -keep_private_externs -multi_module  -multiply_defined
           -multiply_defined_unused -noall_load   -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms  -nofixprebinding  -nomultidefs
           -noprebind   -noseglinkedit  -pagezero_size   -prebind  -prebind_all_twolevel_modules -private_bundle
           -read_only_relocs  -sectalign -sectobjectsymbols  -whyload  -seg1addr -sectcreate  -sectobjectsymbols
           -sectorder      -segaddr       -segs_read_only_addr       -segs_read_write_addr       -seg_addr_table
           -seg_addr_table_filename     -seglinkedit   -segprot    -segs_read_only_addr    -segs_read_write_addr
           -single_module   -static   -sub_library   -sub_umbrella  -twolevel_namespace   -umbrella   -undefined
           -unexported_symbols_list      -weak_reference_mismatches     -whatsloaded     -F     -gused    -gfull
           -mmacosx-version-min=version -mkernel -mone-byte-bool

           DEC  Alpha  Options  -mno-fp-regs   -msoft-float   -mieee    -mieee-with-inexact    -mieee-conformant
           -mfp-trap-mode=mode   -mfp-rounding-mode=mode -mtrap-precision=mode  -mbuild-constants -mcpu=cpu-type
           -mtune=cpu-type -mbwx  -mmax  -mfix  -mcix -mfloat-vax  -mfloat-ieee -mexplicit-relocs   -msmall-data
           -mlarge-data -msmall-text  -mlarge-text -mmemory-latency=time

           FR30 Options -msmall-model -mno-lsim

           FRV  Options -mgpr-32  -mgpr-64  -mfpr-32  -mfpr-64 -mhard-float  -msoft-float -malloc-cc  -mfixed-cc
           -mdword   -mno-dword  -mdouble   -mno-double  -mmedia   -mno-media   -mmuladd   -mno-muladd   -mfdpic
           -minline-plt    -mgprel-ro     -multilib-library-pic    -mlinked-fp    -mlong-calls    -malign-labels
           -mlibrary-pic   -macc-4   -macc-8  -mpack   -mno-pack    -mno-eflags    -mcond-move    -mno-cond-move
           -moptimize-membar  -mno-optimize-membar  -mscc   -mno-scc   -mcond-exec  -mno-cond-exec -mvliw-branch
           -mno-vliw-branch -mmulti-cond-exec   -mno-multi-cond-exec   -mnested-cond-exec  -mno-nested-cond-exec
           -mtomcat-stats -mTLS -mtls -mcpu=cpu

           GNU/Linux Options -mglibc -muclibc -mbionic -mandroid -tno-android-cc -tno-android-ld

           H8/300 Options -mrelax  -mh  -ms  -mn  -mexr -mno-exr  -mint32  -malign-300

           HPPA  Options  -march=architecture-type  -mdisable-fpregs   -mdisable-indexing  -mfast-indirect-calls
           -mgas  -mgnu-ld    -mhp-ld  -mfixed-range=register-range  -mjump-in-delay  -mlinker-opt  -mlong-calls
           -mlong-load-store    -mno-disable-fpregs  -mno-disable-indexing   -mno-fast-indirect-calls   -mno-gas
           -mno-jump-in-delay   -mno-long-load-store  -mno-portable-runtime    -mno-soft-float   -mno-space-regs
           -msoft-float   -mpa-risc-1-0  -mpa-risc-1-1   -mpa-risc-2-0   -mportable-runtime  -mschedule=cpu-type
           -mspace-regs  -msio  -mwsio -munix=unix-std  -nolibdld  -static  -threads

           i386    and    x86-64    Options    -mtune=cpu-type      -march=cpu-type     -mtune-ctrl=feature-list
           -mdump-tune-features -mno-default -mfpmath=unit -masm=dialect  -mno-fancy-math-387 -mno-fp-ret-in-387
           -msoft-float     -mno-wide-multiply      -mrtd      -malign-double     -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num
           -mincoming-stack-boundary=num -mcld -mcx16 -msahf -mmovbe -mcrc32  -mrecip  -mrecip=opt  -mvzeroupper
           -mprefer-avx128  -mmmx   -msse  -msse2 -msse3 -mssse3 -msse4.1 -msse4.2 -msse4 -mavx -mavx2 -mavx512f
           -mavx512pf -mavx512er -mavx512cd -msha -maes -mpclmul -mfsgsbase -mrdrnd -mf16c  -mfma  -mprefetchwt1
           -msse4a  -m3dnow  -mpopcnt  -mabm  -mbmi  -mtbm -mfma4 -mxop -mlzcnt -mbmi2 -mfxsr -mxsave -mxsaveopt
           -mrtm -mlwp  -mthreads  -mno-align-stringops   -minline-all-stringops  -minline-stringops-dynamically
           -mstringop-strategy=alg     -mmemcpy-strategy=strategy     -mmemset-strategy=strategy     -mpush-args
           -maccumulate-outgoing-args       -m128bit-long-double      -m96bit-long-double       -mlong-double-64
           -mlong-double-80  -mlong-double-128  -mregparm=num   -msseregparm -mveclibabi=type -mvect8-ret-in-mem
           -mpc32 -mpc64 -mpc80 -mstackrealign -momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-red-zone -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
           -mcmodel=code-model -mabi=name -maddress-mode=mode -m32 -m64  -mx32  -m16  -mlarge-data-threshold=num
           -msse2avx    -mfentry    -m8bit-idiv   -mavx256-split-unaligned-load   -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
           -mstack-protector-guard=guard

           i386 and x86-64 Windows Options -mconsole -mcygwin  -mno-cygwin  -mdll  -mnop-fun-dllimport  -mthread
           -municode -mwin32 -mwindows -fno-set-stack-executable

           IA-64   Options  -mbig-endian   -mlittle-endian   -mgnu-as   -mgnu-ld   -mno-pic  -mvolatile-asm-stop
           -mregister-names       -msdata      -mno-sdata      -mconstant-gp       -mauto-pic       -mfused-madd
           -minline-float-divide-min-latency    -minline-float-divide-max-throughput    -mno-inline-float-divide
           -minline-int-divide-min-latency       -minline-int-divide-max-throughput       -mno-inline-int-divide
           -minline-sqrt-min-latency       -minline-sqrt-max-throughput       -mno-inline-sqrt      -mdwarf2-asm
           -mearly-stop-bits -mfixed-range=register-range  -mtls-size=tls-size  -mtune=cpu-type  -milp32  -mlp64
           -msched-br-data-spec      -msched-ar-data-spec      -msched-control-spec      -msched-br-in-data-spec
           -msched-ar-in-data-spec     -msched-in-control-spec     -msched-spec-ldc     -msched-spec-control-ldc
           -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns                              -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
           -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle                               -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
           -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
           -msched-max-memory-insns=max-insns

           LM32   Options   -mbarrel-shift-enabled   -mdivide-enabled  -mmultiply-enabled  -msign-extend-enabled
           -muser-enabled

           M32R/D  Options  -m32r2  -m32rx  -m32r  -mdebug  -malign-loops  -mno-align-loops  -missue-rate=number
           -mbranch-cost=number       -mmodel=code-size-model-type       -msdata=sdata-type      -mno-flush-func
           -mflush-func=name -mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=number -G num

           M32C Options -mcpu=cpu -msim -memregs=number

           M680x0 Options -march=arch  -mcpu=cpu  -mtune=tune -m68000  -m68020  -m68020-40  -m68020-60   -m68030
           -m68040  -m68060  -mcpu32  -m5200  -m5206e  -m528x  -m5307  -m5407 -mcfv4e  -mbitfield  -mno-bitfield
           -mc68000  -mc68020 -mnobitfield  -mrtd  -mno-rtd  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mshort  -mno-short   -mhard-float
           -m68881     -msoft-float     -mpcrel    -malign-int     -mstrict-align    -msep-data    -mno-sep-data
           -mshared-library-id=n  -mid-shared-library  -mno-id-shared-library -mxgot -mno-xgot

           MCore Options -mhardlit   -mno-hardlit   -mdiv   -mno-div   -mrelax-immediates  -mno-relax-immediates
           -mwide-bitfields    -mno-wide-bitfields   -m4byte-functions   -mno-4byte-functions   -mcallgraph-data
           -mno-callgraph-data  -mslow-bytes  -mno-slow-bytes  -mno-lsim  -mlittle-endian   -mbig-endian   -m210
           -m340  -mstack-increment

           MeP  Options  -mabsdiff  -mall-opts  -maverage  -mbased=n  -mbitops  -mc=n -mclip -mconfig=name -mcop
           -mcop32 -mcop64 -mivc2 -mdc -mdiv -meb -mel -mio-volatile -ml -mleadz -mm -mminmax  -mmult  -mno-opts
           -mrepeat -ms -msatur -msdram -msim -msimnovec -mtf -mtiny=n

           MicroBlaze   Options  -msoft-float  -mhard-float  -msmall-divides  -mcpu=cpu  -mmemcpy  -mxl-soft-mul
           -mxl-soft-div  -mxl-barrel-shift  -mxl-pattern-compare  -mxl-stack-check  -mxl-gp-opt   -mno-clearbss
           -mxl-multiply-high   -mxl-float-convert  -mxl-float-sqrt  -mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian  -mxl-reorder
           -mxl-mode-app-model

           MIPS Options -EL  -EB  -march=arch  -mtune=arch -mips1  -mips2  -mips3   -mips4   -mips32   -mips32r2
           -mips64       -mips64r2      -mips16       -mno-mips16       -mflip-mips16     -minterlink-compressed
           -mno-interlink-compressed    -minterlink-mips16     -mno-interlink-mips16    -mabi=abi     -mabicalls
           -mno-abicalls  -mshared   -mno-shared   -mplt   -mno-plt   -mxgot   -mno-xgot  -mgp32  -mgp64  -mfp32
           -mfp64    -mhard-float    -msoft-float   -mno-float    -msingle-float    -mdouble-float    -mabs=mode
           -mnan=encoding  -mdsp   -mno-dsp  -mdspr2  -mno-dspr2 -mmcu -mmno-mcu -meva -mno-eva -mvirt -mno-virt
           -mmicromips    -mno-micromips    -mfpu=fpu-type    -msmartmips     -mno-smartmips     -mpaired-single
           -mno-paired-single   -mdmx  -mno-mdmx -mips3d  -mno-mips3d  -mmt  -mno-mt  -mllsc  -mno-llsc -mlong64
           -mlong32     -msym32     -mno-sym32    -Gnum     -mlocal-sdata     -mno-local-sdata    -mextern-sdata
           -mno-extern-sdata   -mgpopt   -mno-gopt  -membedded-data  -mno-embedded-data -muninit-const-in-rodata
           -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata    -mcode-readable=setting    -msplit-addresses      -mno-split-addresses
           -mexplicit-relocs       -mno-explicit-relocs      -mcheck-zero-division      -mno-check-zero-division
           -mdivide-traps  -mdivide-breaks -mmemcpy  -mno-memcpy  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls  -mmad  -mno-mad
           -mimadd   -mno-imadd   -mfused-madd    -mno-fused-madd   -nocpp  -mfix-24k  -mno-fix-24k  -mfix-r4000
           -mno-fix-r4000     -mfix-r4400     -mno-fix-r4400    -mfix-r10000    -mno-fix-r10000     -mfix-rm7000
           -mno-fix-rm7000  -mfix-vr4120  -mno-fix-vr4120 -mfix-vr4130  -mno-fix-vr4130  -mfix-sb1  -mno-fix-sb1
           -mflush-func=func     -mno-flush-func    -mbranch-cost=num     -mbranch-likely     -mno-branch-likely
           -mfp-exceptions    -mno-fp-exceptions    -mvr4130-align    -mno-vr4130-align    -msynci    -mno-synci
           -mrelax-pic-calls -mno-relax-pic-calls -mmcount-ra-address

           MMIX  Options  -mlibfuncs    -mno-libfuncs    -mepsilon    -mno-epsilon    -mabi=gnu   -mabi=mmixware
           -mzero-extend     -mknuthdiv    -mtoplevel-symbols   -melf    -mbranch-predict    -mno-branch-predict
           -mbase-addresses -mno-base-addresses  -msingle-exit  -mno-single-exit

           MN10300  Options  -mmult-bug   -mno-mult-bug  -mno-am33  -mam33   -mam33-2   -mam34   -mtune=cpu-type
           -mreturn-pointer-on-d0 -mno-crt0  -mrelax -mliw -msetlb

           Moxie Options -meb -mel -mno-crt0

           MSP430 Options -msim -masm-hex -mmcu= -mcpu= -mlarge -msmall -mrelax -mhwmult= -minrt

           NDS32  Options  -mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian  -mreduced-regs -mfull-regs -mcmov -mno-cmov -mperf-ext
           -mno-perf-ext    -mv3push    -mno-v3push    -m16bit     -mno-16bit     -mgp-direct     -mno-gp-direct
           -misr-vector-size=num  -mcache-block-size=num  -march=arch  -mforce-fp-as-gp  -mforbid-fp-as-gp -mex9
           -mctor-dtor -mrelax

           Nios  II  Options  -G   num   -mgpopt   -mno-gpopt   -mel   -meb   -mno-bypass-cache   -mbypass-cache
           -mno-cache-volatile  -mcache-volatile  -mno-fast-sw-div  -mfast-sw-div -mhw-mul -mno-hw-mul -mhw-mulx
           -mno-hw-mulx  -mno-hw-div  -mhw-div  -mcustom-insn=N  -mno-custom-insn  -mcustom-fpu-cfg=name   -mhal
           -msmallc -msys-crt0=name -msys-lib=name

           PDP-11  Options  -mfpu   -msoft-float   -mac0   -mno-ac0   -m40   -m45  -m10 -mbcopy  -mbcopy-builtin
           -mint32  -mno-int16 -mint16  -mno-int32  -mfloat32   -mno-float64  -mfloat64   -mno-float32   -mabshi
           -mno-abshi -mbranch-expensive  -mbranch-cheap -munix-asm  -mdec-asm

           picoChip Options -mae=ae_type -mvliw-lookahead=N -msymbol-as-address -mno-inefficient-warnings

           PowerPC Options See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.

           RL78 Options -msim -mmul=none -mmul=g13 -mmul=rl78

           RS/6000  and PowerPC Options -mcpu=cpu-type -mtune=cpu-type -mcmodel=code-model -mpowerpc64 -maltivec
           -mno-altivec  -mpowerpc-gpopt   -mno-powerpc-gpopt  -mpowerpc-gfxopt    -mno-powerpc-gfxopt   -mmfcrf
           -mno-mfcrf   -mpopcntb   -mno-popcntb  -mpopcntd  -mno-popcntd  -mfprnd   -mno-fprnd -mcmpb -mno-cmpb
           -mmfpgpr   -mno-mfpgpr   -mhard-dfp   -mno-hard-dfp   -mfull-toc     -mminimal-toc     -mno-fp-in-toc
           -mno-sum-in-toc   -m64    -m32   -mxl-compat   -mno-xl-compat   -mpe  -malign-power   -malign-natural
           -msoft-float  -mhard-float   -mmultiple   -mno-multiple  -msingle-float  -mdouble-float  -msimple-fpu
           -mstring   -mno-string  -mupdate  -mno-update -mavoid-indexed-addresses  -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
           -mfused-madd   -mno-fused-madd    -mbit-align    -mno-bit-align   -mstrict-align    -mno-strict-align
           -mrelocatable  -mno-relocatable   -mrelocatable-lib   -mno-relocatable-lib  -mtoc  -mno-toc  -mlittle
           -mlittle-endian   -mbig   -mbig-endian   -mdynamic-no-pic    -maltivec   -mswdiv    -msingle-pic-base
           -mprioritize-restricted-insns=priority  -msched-costly-dep=dependence_type -minsert-sched-nops=scheme
           -mcall-sysv   -mcall-netbsd  -maix-struct-return   -msvr4-struct-return  -mabi=abi-type  -msecure-plt
           -mbss-plt   -mblock-move-inline-limit=num  -misel  -mno-isel  -misel=yes   -misel=no  -mspe  -mno-spe
           -mspe=yes  -mspe=no -mpaired -mgen-cell-microcode -mwarn-cell-microcode -mvrsave -mno-vrsave  -mmulhw
           -mno-mulhw     -mdlmzb     -mno-dlmzb     -mfloat-gprs=yes     -mfloat-gprs=no    -mfloat-gprs=single
           -mfloat-gprs=double -mprototype  -mno-prototype -msim  -mmvme  -mads  -myellowknife   -memb   -msdata
           -msdata=opt    -mvxworks    -G   num    -pthread  -mrecip  -mrecip=opt  -mno-recip  -mrecip-precision
           -mno-recip-precision     -mveclibabi=type     -mfriz     -mno-friz     -mpointers-to-nested-functions
           -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions    -msave-toc-indirect    -mno-save-toc-indirect    -mpower8-fusion
           -mno-mpower8-fusion   -mpower8-vector   -mno-power8-vector   -mcrypto    -mno-crypto    -mdirect-move
           -mno-direct-move    -mquad-memory   -mno-quad-memory   -mquad-memory-atomic   -mno-quad-memory-atomic
           -mcompat-align-parm -mno-compat-align-parm

           RX   Options   -m64bit-doubles     -m32bit-doubles     -fpu     -nofpu    -mcpu=    -mbig-endian-data
           -mlittle-endian-data   -msmall-data   -msim    -mno-sim   -mas100-syntax   -mno-as100-syntax  -mrelax
           -mmax-constant-size=         -mint-register=         -mpid         -mno-warn-multiple-fast-interrupts
           -msave-acc-in-interrupts

           S/390  and  zSeries  Options  -mtune=cpu-type  -march=cpu-type -mhard-float  -msoft-float  -mhard-dfp
           -mno-hard-dfp   -mlong-double-64   -mlong-double-128   -mbackchain    -mno-backchain   -mpacked-stack
           -mno-packed-stack  -msmall-exec   -mno-small-exec  -mmvcle -mno-mvcle -m64  -m31  -mdebug  -mno-debug
           -mesa    -mzarch   -mtpf-trace   -mno-tpf-trace    -mfused-madd    -mno-fused-madd   -mwarn-framesize
           -mwarn-dynamicstack  -mstack-size -mstack-guard -mhotpatch=halfwords,halfwords

           Score Options -meb -mel -mnhwloop -muls -mmac -mscore5 -mscore5u -mscore7 -mscore7d

           SH  Options  -m1   -m2   -m2e  -m2a-nofpu  -m2a-single-only  -m2a-single  -m2a  -m3   -m3e  -m4-nofpu
           -m4-single-only  -m4-single  -m4  -m4a-nofpu  -m4a-single-only  -m4a-single  -m4a  -m4al  -m5-64media
           -m5-64media-nofpu  -m5-32media   -m5-32media-nofpu  -m5-compact  -m5-compact-nofpu -mb  -ml  -mdalign
           -mrelax -mbigtable -mfmovd -mhitachi -mrenesas -mno-renesas  -mnomacsave  -mieee  -mno-ieee  -mbitops
           -misize    -minline-ic_invalidate   -mpadstruct   -mspace  -mprefergot   -musermode  -multcost=number
           -mdiv=strategy      -mdivsi3_libfunc=name      -mfixed-range=register-range      -mindexed-addressing
           -mgettrcost=number  -mpt-fixed  -maccumulate-outgoing-args  -minvalid-symbols  -matomic-model=atomic-
           model -mbranch-cost=num -mzdcbranch  -mno-zdcbranch  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -mfsca  -mno-fsca
           -mfsrra -mno-fsrra -mpretend-cmove -mtas

           Solaris 2 Options -mclear-hwcap -mno-clear-hwcap -mimpure-text  -mno-impure-text -pthreads -pthread

           SPARC  Options -mcpu=cpu-type -mtune=cpu-type -mcmodel=code-model -mmemory-model=mem-model -m32  -m64
           -mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs -mfaster-structs  -mno-faster-structs  -mflat   -mno-flat  -mfpu   -mno-fpu
           -mhard-float    -msoft-float   -mhard-quad-float    -msoft-quad-float  -mstack-bias   -mno-stack-bias
           -munaligned-doubles  -mno-unaligned-doubles -muser-mode  -mno-user-mode -mv8plus  -mno-v8plus   -mvis
           -mno-vis  -mvis2   -mno-vis2   -mvis3   -mno-vis3  -mcbcond  -mno-cbcond  -mfmaf   -mno-fmaf   -mpopc
           -mno-popc -mfix-at697f -mfix-ut699

           SPU Options -mwarn-reloc -merror-reloc -msafe-dma -munsafe-dma -mbranch-hints -msmall-mem -mlarge-mem
           -mstdmain      -mfixed-range=register-range      -mea32       -mea64       -maddress-space-conversion
           -mno-address-space-conversion -mcache-size=cache-size -matomic-updates -mno-atomic-updates

           System V Options -Qy  -Qn  -YP,paths  -Ym,dir

           TILE-Gx Options -mcpu=CPU -m32 -m64 -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -mcmodel=code-model

           TILEPro Options -mcpu=cpu -m32

           V850  Options  -mlong-calls   -mno-long-calls   -mep  -mno-ep -mprolog-function  -mno-prolog-function
           -mspace -mtda=n   -msda=n   -mzda=n  -mapp-regs   -mno-app-regs  -mdisable-callt   -mno-disable-callt
           -mv850e2v3   -mv850e2  -mv850e1  -mv850es  -mv850e  -mv850  -mv850e3v5  -mloop  -mrelax  -mlong-jumps
           -msoft-float -mhard-float -mgcc-abi -mrh850-abi -mbig-switch

           VAX Options -mg  -mgnu  -munix

           VMS Options -mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=prefix -mmalloc64 -mpointer-size=size

           VxWorks Options -mrtp  -non-static  -Bstatic  -Bdynamic -Xbind-lazy  -Xbind-now

           x86-64 Options See i386 and x86-64 Options.

           Xstormy16 Options -msim

           Xtensa    Options    -mconst16    -mno-const16    -mfused-madd     -mno-fused-madd     -mforce-no-pic
           -mserialize-volatile    -mno-serialize-volatile  -mtext-section-literals   -mno-text-section-literals
           -mtarget-align  -mno-target-align -mlongcalls  -mno-longcalls

           zSeries Options See S/390 and zSeries Options.

       Code Generation Options
           -fcall-saved-reg       -fcall-used-reg      -ffixed-reg       -fexceptions      -fnon-call-exceptions
           -fdelete-dead-exceptions       -funwind-tables      -fasynchronous-unwind-tables      -fno-gnu-unique
           -finhibit-size-directive                                                       -finstrument-functions
           -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=sym,sym,...
           -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=file,file,...   -fno-common   -fno-ident -fpcc-struct-return
           -fpic  -fPIC -fpie -fPIE -fno-jump-tables  -frecord-gcc-switches  -freg-struct-return   -fshort-enums
           -fshort-double        -fshort-wchar       -fverbose-asm        -fpack-struct[=n]        -fstack-check
           -fstack-limit-register=reg        -fstack-limit-symbol=sym       -fno-stack-limit       -fsplit-stack
           -fleading-underscore   -ftls-model=model  -fstack-reuse=reuse_level  -ftrapv  -fwrapv  -fbounds-check
           -fvisibility -fstrict-volatile-bitfields -fsync-libcalls

   Options Controlling the Kind of Output
       Compilation can involve up to four stages:  preprocessing,  compilation  proper,  assembly  and  linking,
       always  in  that  order.  GCC is capable of preprocessing and compiling several files either into several
       assembler input files, or into one assembler input file; then  each  assembler  input  file  produces  an
       object  file,  and  linking  combines  all the object files (those newly compiled, and those specified as
       input) into an executable file.

       For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of compilation is done:

       file.c
           C source code that must be preprocessed.

       file.i
           C source code that should not be preprocessed.

       file.ii
           C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.

       file.m
           Objective-C source code.  Note that you must link with the libobjc library  to  make  an  Objective-C
           program work.

       file.mi
           Objective-C source code that should not be preprocessed.

       file.mm
       file.M
           Objective-C++ source code.  Note that you must link with the libobjc library to make an Objective-C++
           program work.  Note that .M refers to a literal capital M.

       file.mii
           Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.

       file.h
           C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header (default), or
           C, C++ header file to be turned into an Ada spec (via the -fdump-ada-spec switch).

       file.cc
       file.cp
       file.cxx
       file.cpp
       file.CPP
       file.c++
       file.C
           C++  source  code  that  must  be preprocessed.  Note that in .cxx, the last two letters must both be
           literally x.  Likewise, .C refers to a literal capital C.

       file.mm
       file.M
           Objective-C++ source code that must be preprocessed.

       file.mii
           Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.

       file.hh
       file.H
       file.hp
       file.hxx
       file.hpp
       file.HPP
       file.h++
       file.tcc
           C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header or Ada spec.

       file.f
       file.for
       file.ftn
           Fixed form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.

       file.F
       file.FOR
       file.fpp
       file.FPP
       file.FTN
           Fixed form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the traditional preprocessor).

       file.f90
       file.f95
       file.f03
       file.f08
           Free form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.

       file.F90
       file.F95
       file.F03
       file.F08
           Free form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the traditional preprocessor).

       file.go
           Go source code.

       file.ads
           Ada source code file  that  contains  a  library  unit  declaration  (a  declaration  of  a  package,
           subprogram,  or  generic,  or  a  generic  instantiation),  or a library unit renaming declaration (a
           package, generic, or subprogram renaming declaration).  Such files are also called specs.

       file.adb
           Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or package body).  Such  files  are
           also called bodies.

       file.d
           D source code file.

       file.di
           D interface code file.

       file.dd
           D documentation code file.

       file.s
           Assembler code.

       file.S
       file.sx
           Assembler code that must be preprocessed.

       other
           An  object  file to be fed straight into linking.  Any file name with no recognized suffix is treated
           this way.

       You can specify the input language explicitly with the -x option:

       -x language
           Specify explicitly the language for the following input  files  (rather  than  letting  the  compiler
           choose  a  default  based on the file name suffix).  This option applies to all following input files
           until the next -x option.  Possible values for language are:

                   c  c-header  cpp-output
                   c++  c++-header  c++-cpp-output
                   objective-c  objective-c-header  objective-c-cpp-output
                   objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
                   assembler  assembler-with-cpp
                   ada
                   d
                   f77  f77-cpp-input f95  f95-cpp-input
                   go
                   java

       -x none
           Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files are  handled  according  to  their
           file name suffixes (as they are if -x has not been used at all).

       -pass-exit-codes
           Normally  the gcc program exits with the code of 1 if any phase of the compiler returns a non-success
           return code.  If you specify -pass-exit-codes, the gcc program instead returns with  the  numerically
           highest  error  produced  by  any phase returning an error indication.  The C, C++, and Fortran front
           ends return 4 if an internal compiler error is encountered.

       If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use -x (or filename  suffixes)  to  tell  gcc
       where  to  start,  and  one  of  the  options  -c, -S, or -E to say where gcc is to stop.  Note that some
       combinations (for example, -x cpp-output -E) instruct gcc to do nothing at all.

       -c  Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link.  The linking stage simply is  not  done.   The
           ultimate output is in the form of an object file for each source file.

           By  default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing the suffix .c, .i, .s, etc.,
           with .o.

           Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are ignored.

       -S  Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble.   The  output  is  in  the  form  of  an
           assembler code file for each non-assembler input file specified.

           By  default,  the assembler file name for a source file is made by replacing the suffix .c, .i, etc.,
           with .s.

           Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.

       -E  Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper.  The output is  in  the  form  of
           preprocessed source code, which is sent to the standard output.

           Input files that don't require preprocessing are ignored.

       -o file
           Place  output in file file.  This applies to whatever sort of output is being produced, whether it be
           an executable file, an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.

           If -o is not specified, the default is to put an executable  file  in  a.out,  the  object  file  for
           source.suffix   in   source.o,  its  assembler  file  in  source.s,  a  precompiled  header  file  in
           source.suffix.gch, and all preprocessed C source on standard output.

       -v  Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages of compilation.  Also  print
           the version number of the compiler driver program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.

       -###
           Like  -v  except  the  commands  are  not  executed and arguments are quoted unless they contain only
           alphanumeric characters or "./-_".  This is useful for shell scripts to capture the  driver-generated
           command lines.

       -pipe
           Use  pipes  rather  than temporary files for communication between the various stages of compilation.
           This fails to work on some systems where the assembler is unable to read from a  pipe;  but  the  GNU
           assembler has no trouble.

       --help
           Print  (on  the standard output) a description of the command-line options understood by gcc.  If the
           -v option is also specified then --help is also passed on to the various processes invoked by gcc, so
           that they can display the command-line options they accept.  If the  -Wextra  option  has  also  been
           specified  (prior  to  the  --help  option),  then  command-line  options  that have no documentation
           associated with them are also displayed.

       --target-help
           Print (on the standard output) a description of target-specific command-line options for  each  tool.
           For some targets extra target-specific information may also be printed.

       --help={class|[^]qualifier}[,...]
           Print  (on  the standard output) a description of the command-line options understood by the compiler
           that fit into all specified classes and qualifiers.  These are the supported classes:

           optimizers
               Display all of the optimization options supported by the compiler.

           warnings
               Display all of the options controlling warning messages produced by the compiler.

           target
               Display target-specific  options.   Unlike  the  --target-help  option  however,  target-specific
               options  of  the  linker  and  assembler  are  not displayed.  This is because those tools do not
               currently support the extended --help= syntax.

           params
               Display the values recognized by the --param option.

           language
               Display the options supported for language, where language is the name of one  of  the  languages
               supported in this version of GCC.

           common
               Display the options that are common to all languages.

           These are the supported qualifiers:

           undocumented
               Display only those options that are undocumented.

           joined
               Display  options taking an argument that appears after an equal sign in the same continuous piece
               of text, such as: --help=target.

           separate
               Display options taking an argument that appears as a separate word following the original option,
               such as: -o output-file.

           Thus for example to display all the undocumented target-specific switches supported by the  compiler,
           use:

                   --help=target,undocumented

           The  sense  of  a  qualifier  can be inverted by prefixing it with the ^ character, so for example to
           display all binary warning options (i.e., ones that are either on or off and  that  do  not  take  an
           argument) that have a description, use:

                   --help=warnings,^joined,^undocumented

           The argument to --help= should not consist solely of inverted qualifiers.

           Combining  several classes is possible, although this usually restricts the output so much that there
           is nothing to display.  One case where it does work, however, is when one of the classes  is  target.
           For example, to display all the target-specific optimization options, use:

                   --help=target,optimizers

           The  --help=  option can be repeated on the command line.  Each successive use displays its requested
           class of options, skipping those that have already been displayed.

           If the -Q option appears on the command line before the --help= option,  then  the  descriptive  text
           displayed by --help= is changed.  Instead of describing the displayed options, an indication is given
           as  to whether the option is enabled, disabled or set to a specific value (assuming that the compiler
           knows this at the point where the --help= option is used).

           Here is a truncated example from the ARM port of gcc:

                     % gcc -Q -mabi=2 --help=target -c
                     The following options are target specific:
                     -mabi=                                2
                     -mabort-on-noreturn                   [disabled]
                     -mapcs                                [disabled]

           The output is sensitive to the effects of  previous  command-line  options,  so  for  example  it  is
           possible to find out which optimizations are enabled at -O2 by using:

                   -Q -O2 --help=optimizers

           Alternatively you can discover which binary optimizations are enabled by -O3 by using:

                   gcc -c -Q -O3 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O3-opts
                   gcc -c -Q -O2 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O2-opts
                   diff /tmp/O2-opts /tmp/O3-opts | grep enabled

       -no-canonical-prefixes
           Do  not  expand any symbolic links, resolve references to /../ or /./, or make the path absolute when
           generating a relative prefix.

       --version
           Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC.

       -wrapper
           Invoke all subcommands under a wrapper program.  The name of the wrapper program and  its  parameters
           are passed as a comma separated list.

                   gcc -c t.c -wrapper gdb,--args

           This  invokes  all  subprograms of gcc under gdb --args, thus the invocation of cc1 is gdb --args cc1
           ....

       -fplugin=name.so
           Load the plugin code in file name.so, assumed to be a shared object to be dlopen'd by  the  compiler.
           The  base  name of the shared object file is used to identify the plugin for the purposes of argument
           parsing (See -fplugin-arg-name-key=value below).  Each plugin should define  the  callback  functions
           specified in the Plugins API.

       -fplugin-arg-name-key=value
           Define an argument called key with a value of value for the plugin called name.

       -fdump-ada-spec[-slim]
           For C and C++ source and include files, generate corresponding Ada specs.

       -fada-spec-parent=unit
           In conjunction with -fdump-ada-spec[-slim] above, generate Ada specs as child units of parent unit.

       -fdump-go-spec=file
           For  input  files in any language, generate corresponding Go declarations in file.  This generates Go
           "const", "type", "var", and "func" declarations which may be a useful  way  to  start  writing  a  Go
           interface to code written in some other language.

       @file
           Read  command-line  options  from file.  The options read are inserted in place of the original @file
           option.  If file does not exist, or cannot be read, then the option will be  treated  literally,  and
           not removed.

           Options  in file are separated by whitespace.  A whitespace character may be included in an option by
           surrounding the entire option in  either  single  or  double  quotes.   Any  character  (including  a
           backslash)  may be included by prefixing the character to be included with a backslash.  The file may
           itself contain additional @file options; any such options will be processed recursively.

   Compiling C++ Programs
       C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes .C, .cc, .cpp, .CPP,  .c++,  .cp,  or  .cxx;  C++
       header  files often use .hh, .hpp, .H, or (for shared template code) .tcc; and preprocessed C++ files use
       the suffix .ii.  GCC recognizes files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you call
       the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually with the name gcc).

       However, the use of gcc does not add the C++ library.  g++ is a program that calls GCC and  automatically
       specifies  linking against the C++ library.  It treats .c, .h and .i files as C++ source files instead of
       C source files unless -x is used.  This program is also useful when precompiling a C header file  with  a
       .h extension for use in C++ compilations.  On many systems, g++ is also installed with the name c++.

       When  you  compile  C++  programs, you may specify many of the same command-line options that you use for
       compiling programs in any language; or command-line options meaningful for C and  related  languages;  or
       options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.

   Options Controlling C Dialect
       The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived from C, such as C++, Objective-C and
       Objective-C++) that the compiler accepts:

       -ansi
           In C mode, this is equivalent to -std=c90. In C++ mode, it is equivalent to -std=c++98.

           This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO C90 (when compiling C code), or
           of  standard  C++  (when compiling C++ code), such as the "asm" and "typeof" keywords, and predefined
           macros such as "unix" and "vax" that identify the type of system you are using.  It also enables  the
           undesirable and rarely used ISO trigraph feature.  For the C compiler, it disables recognition of C++
           style // comments as well as the "inline" keyword.

           The  alternate  keywords  "__asm__",  "__extension__", "__inline__" and "__typeof__" continue to work
           despite -ansi.  You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of course, but it  is  useful  to
           put  them  in  header  files  that  might  be  included  in  compilations done with -ansi.  Alternate
           predefined macros such as "__unix__" and "__vax__" are also available, with or without -ansi.

           The -ansi option does not cause non-ISO programs to be rejected gratuitously.  For  that,  -Wpedantic
           is required in addition to -ansi.

           The  macro  "__STRICT_ANSI__"  is  predefined  when  the -ansi option is used.  Some header files may
           notice this macro and refrain from declaring certain functions or defining certain  macros  that  the
           ISO  standard  doesn't  call for; this is to avoid interfering with any programs that might use these
           names for other things.

           Functions that are normally built in but do not have semantics defined by ISO C (such as "alloca" and
           "ffs") are not built-in functions when -ansi is used.

       -std=
           Determine the language standard.   This option is currently only supported when compiling C or C++.

           The compiler can accept several base standards, such as c90 or  c++98,  and  GNU  dialects  of  those
           standards,  such  as  gnu90  or gnu++98.  When a base standard is specified, the compiler accepts all
           programs following that standard plus those using GNU extensions that  do  not  contradict  it.   For
           example,  -std=c90  turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO C90, such as the
           "asm" and "typeof" keywords, but not other GNU extensions that do not have a meaning in ISO C90, such
           as omitting the middle term of a "?:" expression. On the other hand, when a GNU dialect of a standard
           is specified, all features supported by the compiler are enabled, even when those features change the
           meaning of the base standard.  As a result, some strict-conforming programs  may  be  rejected.   The
           particular  standard  is  used by -Wpedantic to identify which features are GNU extensions given that
           version of the standard. For example -std=gnu90 -Wpedantic warns about C++ style //  comments,  while
           -std=gnu99 -Wpedantic does not.

           A value for this option must be provided; possible values are

           c90
           c89
           iso9899:1990
               Support  all  ISO  C90 programs (certain GNU extensions that conflict with ISO C90 are disabled).
               Same as -ansi for C code.

           iso9899:199409
               ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.

           c99
           c9x
           iso9899:1999
           iso9899:199x
               ISO C99.  This standard is substantially completely supported, modulo bugs, extended  identifiers
               (supported except for corner cases when -fextended-identifiers is used) and floating-point issues
               (mainly  but  not  entirely  relating  to  optional  C99  features  from  Annexes  F and G).  See
               <http://gcc.gnu.org/c99status.html> for more information.  The names  c9x  and  iso9899:199x  are
               deprecated.

           c11
           c1x
           iso9899:2011
               ISO  C11,  the  2011  revision  of the ISO C standard.  This standard is substantially completely
               supported,  modulo  bugs,  extended  identifiers  (supported  except  for   corner   cases   when
               -fextended-identifiers  is  used),  floating-point  issues  (mainly  but not entirely relating to
               optional C11 features from  Annexes  F  and  G)  and  the  optional  Annexes  K  (Bounds-checking
               interfaces) and L (Analyzability).  The name c1x is deprecated.

           gnu90
           gnu89
               GNU dialect of ISO C90 (including some C99 features). This is the default for C code.

           gnu99
           gnu9x
               GNU dialect of ISO C99.  The name gnu9x is deprecated.

           gnu11
           gnu1x
               GNU  dialect of ISO C11.  This is intended to become the default in a future release of GCC.  The
               name gnu1x is deprecated.

           c++98
           c++03
               The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus the 2003 technical corrigendum and some additional defect reports.
               Same as -ansi for C++ code.

           gnu++98
           gnu++03
               GNU dialect of -std=c++98.  This is the default for C++ code.

           c++11
           c++0x
               The 2011 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.  The name c++0x is deprecated.

           gnu++11
           gnu++0x
               GNU dialect of -std=c++11.  The name gnu++0x is deprecated.

           c++1y
               The next revision of the ISO C++ standard, tentatively  planned  for  2014.   Support  is  highly
               experimental, and will almost certainly change in incompatible ways in future releases.

           gnu++1y
               GNU  dialect  of -std=c++1y.  Support is highly experimental, and will almost certainly change in
               incompatible ways in future releases.

       -fgnu89-inline
           The option -fgnu89-inline tells GCC to use the traditional GNU semantics for "inline" functions  when
           in C99 mode.
             This  option  is  accepted  and  ignored by GCC versions 4.1.3 up to but not including 4.3.  In GCC
           versions 4.3 and later it changes the behavior of GCC in C99 mode.   Using  this  option  is  roughly
           equivalent to adding the "gnu_inline" function attribute to all inline functions.

           The  option  -fno-gnu89-inline explicitly tells GCC to use the C99 semantics for "inline" when in C99
           or gnu99 mode (i.e., it specifies the default behavior).  This option was first supported in GCC 4.3.
           This option is not supported in -std=c90 or -std=gnu90 mode.

           The preprocessor macros "__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__" and "__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__" may be used to  check  which
           semantics are in effect for "inline" functions.

       -aux-info filename
           Output  to  the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions declared and/or defined in a
           translation unit, including those in header files.  This option is silently ignored in  any  language
           other than C.

           Besides  declarations,  the  file indicates, in comments, the origin of each declaration (source file
           and line), whether the declaration was implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (I, N for new  or  O  for
           old,  respectively,  in the first character after the line number and the colon), and whether it came
           from a declaration or a definition (C or F, respectively, in the following character).  In  the  case
           of  function  definitions,  a  K&R-style  list  of  arguments  followed by their declarations is also
           provided, inside comments, after the declaration.

       -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
           Accept variadic functions without named parameters.

           Although it is possible to define such a function, this is not very useful as it is not  possible  to
           read the arguments.  This is only supported for C as this construct is allowed by C++.

       -fno-asm
           Do  not  recognize  "asm",  "inline"  or  "typeof"  as a keyword, so that code can use these words as
           identifiers.  You can use the keywords  "__asm__",  "__inline__"  and  "__typeof__"  instead.   -ansi
           implies -fno-asm.

           In  C++,  this  switch  only  affects  the  "typeof"  keyword,  since "asm" and "inline" are standard
           keywords.  You may want to use the -fno-gnu-keywords flag instead, which has the same effect.  In C99
           mode (-std=c99 or -std=gnu99), this switch only  affects  the  "asm"  and  "typeof"  keywords,  since
           "inline" is a standard keyword in ISO C99.

       -fno-builtin
       -fno-builtin-function
           Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with __builtin_ as prefix.

           GCC  normally  generates  special  code  to  handle  certain built-in functions more efficiently; for
           instance, calls to "alloca" may become single instructions which adjust the stack directly, and calls
           to "memcpy" may become inline copy loops.  The resulting code is often both smaller and  faster,  but
           since  the  function  calls no longer appear as such, you cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor
           can you change the behavior of the functions by linking with a different library.  In addition,  when
           a  function is recognized as a built-in function, GCC may use information about that function to warn
           about problems with calls to that function, or to generate more efficient code, even if the resulting
           code still contains calls to that function.  For example, warnings are given with  -Wformat  for  bad
           calls to "printf" when "printf" is built in and "strlen" is known not to modify global memory.

           With the -fno-builtin-function option only the built-in function function is disabled.  function must
           not  begin with __builtin_.  If a function is named that is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
           option is ignored.  There is no corresponding -fbuiltin-function option; if you wish to enable built-
           in functions selectively when using -fno-builtin or -ffreestanding, you may define macros such as:

                   #define abs(n)          __builtin_abs ((n))
                   #define strcpy(d, s)    __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))

       -fhosted
           Assert that compilation targets a hosted environment.  This implies -fbuiltin.  A hosted  environment
           is  one  in  which the entire standard library is available, and in which "main" has a return type of
           "int".  Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.  This is equivalent to -fno-freestanding.

       -ffreestanding
           Assert  that  compilation  targets  a  freestanding  environment.   This  implies  -fno-builtin.    A
           freestanding  environment is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup may
           not necessarily be at "main".  The most obvious example is an  OS  kernel.   This  is  equivalent  to
           -fno-hosted.

       -fopenmp
           Enable handling of OpenMP directives "#pragma omp" in C/C++ and "!$omp" in Fortran.  When -fopenmp is
           specified, the compiler generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application Program Interface
           v4.0  <http://www.openmp.org/>.   This option implies -pthread, and thus is only supported on targets
           that have support for -pthread. -fopenmp implies -fopenmp-simd.

       -fopenmp-simd
           Enable handling of OpenMP's SIMD directives with "#pragma omp" in C/C++ and "!$omp" in Fortran. Other
           OpenMP directives are ignored.

       -fcilkplus
           Enable the usage of Cilk Plus language extension features for C/C++.  When the option  -fcilkplus  is
           specified,  enable  the  usage  of  the Cilk Plus Language extension features for C/C++.  The present
           implementation follows ABI version 1.2.  This is an  experimental  feature  that  is  only  partially
           complete,  and  whose  interface  may  change in future versions of GCC as the official specification
           changes.  Currently, all features but "_Cilk_for" have been implemented.

       -fgnu-tm
           When the option -fgnu-tm is specified, the compiler generates code for the Linux variant  of  Intel's
           current  Transactional  Memory  ABI  specification  document  (Revision 1.1, May 6 2009).  This is an
           experimental feature whose  interface  may  change  in  future  versions  of  GCC,  as  the  official
           specification changes.  Please note that not all architectures are supported for this feature.

           For more information on GCC's support for transactional memory,

           Note   that   the   transactional   memory   feature   is  not  supported  with  non-call  exceptions
           (-fnon-call-exceptions).

       -fms-extensions
           Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.

           In C++ code, this allows member names in structures to be similar to previous types declarations.

                   typedef int UOW;
                   struct ABC {
                     UOW UOW;
                   };

           Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only accepted with this option.

           Note that this option is off for all targets but i?86 and x86_64 targets using ms-abi.

       -fplan9-extensions
           Accept some non-standard constructs used in Plan 9 code.

           This enables -fms-extensions, permits  passing  pointers  to  structures  with  anonymous  fields  to
           functions  that  expect  pointers  to  elements  of  the  type of the field, and permits referring to
           anonymous fields declared using a typedef.    This is only supported for C, not C++.

       -trigraphs
           Support ISO C trigraphs.  The -ansi option (and -std options for strict ISO  C  conformance)  implies
           -trigraphs.

       -traditional
       -traditional-cpp
           Formerly,  these  options  caused  GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard C compiler.  They are now
           only supported with the -E switch.  The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard  mode.   See
           the GNU CPP manual for details.

       -fcond-mismatch
           Allow  conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and third arguments.  The value of
           such an expression is void.  This option is not supported for C++.

       -flax-vector-conversions
           Allow implicit conversions between vectors with differing numbers  of  elements  and/or  incompatible
           element types.  This option should not be used for new code.

       -funsigned-char
           Let the type "char" be unsigned, like "unsigned char".

           Each  kind  of machine has a default for what "char" should be.  It is either like "unsigned char" by
           default or like "signed char" by default.

           Ideally, a portable program should always use "signed char" or "unsigned char" when it depends on the
           signedness of an object.  But many programs have been written to use plain "char" and expect it to be
           signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the machines they were written for.   This  option,
           and its inverse, let you make such a program work with the opposite default.

           The  type "char" is always a distinct type from each of "signed char" or "unsigned char", even though
           its behavior is always just like one of those two.

       -fsigned-char
           Let the type "char" be signed, like "signed char".

           Note that this is equivalent to -fno-unsigned-char, which is the negative  form  of  -funsigned-char.
           Likewise, the option -fno-signed-char is equivalent to -funsigned-char.

       -fsigned-bitfields
       -funsigned-bitfields
       -fno-signed-bitfields
       -fno-unsigned-bitfields
           These  options  control  whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the declaration does not use
           either "signed" or "unsigned".  By default, such a bit-field is signed, because this  is  consistent:
           the basic integer types such as "int" are signed types.

   Options Controlling C++ Dialect
       This  section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful for C++ programs.  You can also
       use most of the GNU compiler options regardless of what language your program is in.   For  example,  you
       might compile a file "firstClass.C" like this:

               g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C

       In this example, only -frepo is an option meant only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with
       any language supported by GCC.

       Here is a list of options that are only for compiling C++ programs:

       -fabi-version=n
           Use version n of the C++ ABI.  The default is version 2.

           Version 0 refers to the version conforming most closely to the C++ ABI specification.  Therefore, the
           ABI obtained using version 0 will change in different versions of G++ as ABI bugs are fixed.

           Version 1 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2.

           Version 2 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.4.

           Version 3 corrects an error in mangling a constant address as a template argument.

           Version 4, which first appeared in G++ 4.5, implements a standard mangling for vector types.

           Version  5,  which  first  appeared  in G++ 4.6, corrects the mangling of attribute const/volatile on
           function pointer types, decltype of a plain decl, and use of a function parameter in the  declaration
           of another parameter.

           Version 6, which first appeared in G++ 4.7, corrects the promotion behavior of C++11 scoped enums and
           the  mangling  of  template  argument  packs,  const/static_cast, prefix ++ and --, and a class scope
           function used as a template argument.

           See also -Wabi.

       -fno-access-control
           Turn off all access checking.  This switch is mainly useful for working around  bugs  in  the  access
           control code.

       -fcheck-new
           Check that the pointer returned by "operator new" is non-null before attempting to modify the storage
           allocated.  This check is normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that "operator new"
           only  returns  0 if it is declared throw(), in which case the compiler always checks the return value
           even without this option.  In all  other  cases,  when  "operator  new"  has  a  non-empty  exception
           specification, memory exhaustion is signalled by throwing "std::bad_alloc".  See also new (nothrow).

       -fconstexpr-depth=n
           Set  the  maximum  nested  evaluation depth for C++11 constexpr functions to n.  A limit is needed to
           detect endless recursion during  constant  expression  evaluation.   The  minimum  specified  by  the
           standard is 512.

       -fdeduce-init-list
           Enable  deduction  of  a  template  type  parameter  as "std::initializer_list" from a brace-enclosed
           initializer list, i.e.

                   template <class T> auto forward(T t) -> decltype (realfn (t))
                   {
                     return realfn (t);
                   }

                   void f()
                   {
                     forward({1,2}); // call forward<std::initializer_list<int>>
                   }

           This deduction was implemented as a possible extension to the originally proposed semantics  for  the
           C++11 standard, but was not part of the final standard, so it is disabled by default.  This option is
           deprecated, and may be removed in a future version of G++.

       -ffriend-injection
           Inject  friend  functions into the enclosing namespace, so that they are visible outside the scope of
           the class in which they are declared.  Friend functions were documented to work this way in  the  old
           Annotated  C++  Reference Manual, and versions of G++ before 4.1 always worked that way.  However, in
           ISO C++ a friend function that is not declared in an enclosing scope can only be found using argument
           dependent lookup.  This option causes friends to be injected as they were in earlier releases.

           This option is for compatibility, and may be removed in a future release of G++.

       -fno-elide-constructors
           The C++ standard allows an implementation  to  omit  creating  a  temporary  that  is  only  used  to
           initialize  another  object of the same type.  Specifying this option disables that optimization, and
           forces G++ to call the copy constructor in all cases.

       -fno-enforce-eh-specs
           Don't generate code to check for violation of exception specifications  at  run  time.   This  option
           violates  the  C++ standard, but may be useful for reducing code size in production builds, much like
           defining NDEBUG.  This does not give user code permission to throw exceptions  in  violation  of  the
           exception  specifications;  the  compiler still optimizes based on the specifications, so throwing an
           unexpected exception results in undefined behavior at run time.

       -fextern-tls-init
       -fno-extern-tls-init
           The C++11 and OpenMP standards  allow  thread_local  and  threadprivate  variables  to  have  dynamic
           (runtime)  initialization.   To  support  this,  any  use  of  such a variable goes through a wrapper
           function that performs any necessary initialization.  When the use and definition of the variable are
           in the same translation unit, this overhead can be optimized away, but when the use is in a different
           translation unit there is significant overhead even if the variable  doesn't  actually  need  dynamic
           initialization.  If the programmer can be sure that no use of the variable in a non-defining TU needs
           to trigger dynamic initialization (either because the variable is statically initialized, or a use of
           the  variable in the defining TU will be executed before any uses in another TU), they can avoid this
           overhead with the -fno-extern-tls-init option.

           On targets that support symbol aliases, the default is -fextern-tls-init.  On  targets  that  do  not
           support symbol aliases, the default is -fno-extern-tls-init.

       -ffor-scope
       -fno-for-scope
           If  -ffor-scope  is  specified, the scope of variables declared in a for-init-statement is limited to
           the for loop itself, as specified by the C++ standard.  If -fno-for-scope is specified, the scope  of
           variables declared in a for-init-statement extends to the end of the enclosing scope, as was the case
           in old versions of G++, and other (traditional) implementations of C++.

           If  neither flag is given, the default is to follow the standard, but to allow and give a warning for
           old-style code that would otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.

       -fno-gnu-keywords
           Do not recognize "typeof" as a keyword, so that code can use this word as an identifier.  You can use
           the keyword "__typeof__" instead.  -ansi implies -fno-gnu-keywords.

       -fno-implicit-templates
           Never emit code for non-inline templates that are instantiated implicitly (i.e. by  use);  only  emit
           code for explicit instantiations.

       -fno-implicit-inline-templates
           Don't  emit  code  for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.  The default is to handle
           inlines differently so that compiles with and without optimization need  the  same  set  of  explicit
           instantiations.

       -fno-implement-inlines
           To   save  space,  do  not  emit  out-of-line  copies  of  inline  functions  controlled  by  #pragma
           implementation.  This causes linker errors if these functions are not  inlined  everywhere  they  are
           called.

       -fms-extensions
           Disable  Wpedantic  warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit int and getting a pointer
           to member function via non-standard syntax.

       -fno-nonansi-builtins
           Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by ANSI/ISO C.  These include "ffs",
           "alloca", "_exit", "index", "bzero", "conjf", and other related functions.

       -fnothrow-opt
           Treat a "throw()" exception specification as if it were  a  "noexcept"  specification  to  reduce  or
           eliminate  the  text  size  overhead  relative to a function with no exception specification.  If the
           function has local variables of types  with  non-trivial  destructors,  the  exception  specification
           actually  makes  the  function  smaller  because the EH cleanups for those variables can be optimized
           away.  The semantic effect is that an exception thrown out of  a  function  with  such  an  exception
           specification results in a call to "terminate" rather than "unexpected".

       -fno-operator-names
           Do  not  treat the operator name keywords "and", "bitand", "bitor", "compl", "not", "or" and "xor" as
           synonyms as keywords.

       -fno-optional-diags
           Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to issue.   Currently,  the  only
           such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for a name having multiple meanings within a class.

       -fpermissive
           Downgrade   some  diagnostics  about  nonconformant  code  from  errors  to  warnings.   Thus,  using
           -fpermissive allows some nonconforming code to compile.

       -fno-pretty-templates
           When an error message refers to a specialization of a function template, the compiler normally prints
           the signature of the template followed by the template arguments and any typedefs or typenames in the
           signature (e.g. "void f(T) [with T = int]" rather than  "void  f(int)")  so  that  it's  clear  which
           template  is  involved.   When  an  error message refers to a specialization of a class template, the
           compiler omits any template arguments that match the default template arguments  for  that  template.
           If  either  of these behaviors make it harder to understand the error message rather than easier, you
           can use -fno-pretty-templates to disable them.

       -frepo
           Enable   automatic   template   instantiation   at   link   time.    This   option    also    implies
           -fno-implicit-templates.

       -fno-rtti
           Disable  generation  of  information about every class with virtual functions for use by the C++ run-
           time type identification features (dynamic_cast and typeid).  If you don't use  those  parts  of  the
           language,  you  can  save  some space by using this flag.  Note that exception handling uses the same
           information, but G++ generates it as needed. The dynamic_cast operator can still be  used  for  casts
           that do not require run-time type information, i.e. casts to "void *" or to unambiguous base classes.

       -fstats
           Emit  statistics  about  front-end  processing  at  the  end of the compilation.  This information is
           generally only useful to the G++ development team.

       -fstrict-enums
           Allow the compiler to optimize using the assumption that a value of enumerated type can only  be  one
           of  the  values  of  the  enumeration (as defined in the C++ standard; basically, a value that can be
           represented in the minimum number of bits needed to represent all the enumerators).  This  assumption
           may  not  be valid if the program uses a cast to convert an arbitrary integer value to the enumerated
           type.

       -ftemplate-backtrace-limit=n
           Set the maximum number of template instantiation notes for a single  warning  or  error  to  n.   The
           default value is 10.

       -ftemplate-depth=n
           Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to n.  A limit on the template instantiation
           depth  is  needed  to  detect  endless  recursions during template class instantiation.  ANSI/ISO C++
           conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17 (changed to 1024 in C++11).  The
           default value is 900, as the compiler can run  out  of  stack  space  before  hitting  1024  in  some
           situations.

       -fno-threadsafe-statics
           Do  not  emit  the  extra  code  to  use  the  routines  specified  in  the  C++  ABI for thread-safe
           initialization of local statics.  You can use this option to reduce code size slightly in  code  that
           doesn't need to be thread-safe.

       -fuse-cxa-atexit
           Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the "__cxa_atexit" function rather
           than the "atexit" function.  This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
           destructors, but only works if your C library supports "__cxa_atexit".

       -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
           Don't use the "__cxa_get_exception_ptr" runtime routine.  This causes "std::uncaught_exception" to be
           incorrect, but is necessary if the runtime routine is not available.

       -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
           This  switch  declares  that  the  user  does  not attempt to compare pointers to inline functions or
           methods where the addresses of the two functions are taken in different shared objects.

           The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline methods with "__attribute__ ((visibility
           ("hidden")))" so that they do not appear in the export table of a  DSO  and  do  not  require  a  PLT
           indirection  when  used  within the DSO.  Enabling this option can have a dramatic effect on load and
           link times of a DSO as it massively reduces the size of the dynamic export  table  when  the  library
           makes heavy use of templates.

           The  behavior of this switch is not quite the same as marking the methods as hidden directly, because
           it does not affect static variables local to the function or cause the compiler to  deduce  that  the
           function is defined in only one shared object.

           You  may  mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate the effect of the switch for that
           method.  For example, if you do want to compare pointers to a particular  inline  method,  you  might
           mark  it  as  having default visibility.  Marking the enclosing class with explicit visibility has no
           effect.

           Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this option as their linkage might otherwise
           cross a shared library boundary.

       -fvisibility-ms-compat
           This flag attempts to use visibility settings to make GCC's C++ linkage model compatible with that of
           Microsoft Visual Studio.

           The flag makes these changes to GCC's linkage model:

           1.  It sets the default visibility to "hidden", like -fvisibility=hidden.

           2.  Types, but not their members, are not hidden by default.

           3.  The One Definition Rule is relaxed for types without explicit visibility specifications that  are
               defined  in  more  than one shared object: those declarations are permitted if they are permitted
               when this option is not used.

           In new code it is better to use -fvisibility=hidden and export those classes that are intended to  be
           externally  visible.   Unfortunately  it  is  possible for code to rely, perhaps accidentally, on the
           Visual Studio behavior.

           Among the consequences of these changes are that static data members of the same type with  the  same
           name  but  defined  in  different  shared  objects are different, so changing one does not change the
           other; and that pointers to function members defined in different  shared  objects  may  not  compare
           equal.   When  this  flag  is  given, it is a violation of the ODR to define types with the same name
           differently.

       -fvtable-verify=std|preinit|none
           Turn on (or off, if using -fvtable-verify=none) the security feature that verifies  at  runtime,  for
           every  virtual call that is made, that the vtable pointer through which the call is made is valid for
           the type of the object, and has not been corrupted or overwritten.  If an invalid vtable  pointer  is
           detected (at runtime), an error is reported and execution of the program is immediately halted.

           This option causes runtime data structures to be built, at program start up, for verifying the vtable
           pointers.   The  options  "std"  and  "preinit"  control the timing of when these data structures are
           built.  In  both  cases  the  data  structures  are  built  before  execution  reaches  'main'.   The
           -fvtable-verify=std  causes  these  data  structure  to be built after the shared libraries have been
           loaded and initialized.  -fvtable-verify=preinit causes them to be built before the shared  libraries
           have been loaded and initialized.

           If  this  option appears multiple times in the compiler line, with different values specified, 'none'
           will take highest priority over both 'std' and 'preinit'; 'preinit' will take priority over 'std'.

       -fvtv-debug
           Causes debug versions of the runtime functions for the vtable  verification  feature  to  be  called.
           This  assumes  the -fvtable-verify=std or -fvtable-verify=preinit has been used.  This flag will also
           cause the compiler to keep track of which vtable pointers it found for each class,  and  record  that
           information in the file "vtv_set_ptr_data.log", in the dump file directory on the user's machine.

           Note:  This feature APPENDS data to the log file. If you want a fresh log file, be sure to delete any
           existing one.

       -fvtv-counts
           This   is   a   debugging   flag.    When   used   in   conjunction   with   -fvtable-verify=std   or
           -fvtable-verify=preinit, this causes the compiler to keep track of the total number of virtual  calls
           it  encountered  and  the number of verifications it inserted.  It also counts the number of calls to
           certain runtime library functions that it inserts.  This information, for each compilation  unit,  is
           written  to a file named "vtv_count_data.log", in the dump_file directory on the user's machine.   It
           also counts the size of the vtable pointer sets for  each  class,  and  writes  this  information  to
           "vtv_class_set_sizes.log" in the same directory.

           Note:   This  feature APPENDS data to the log files.  To get a fresh log files, be sure to delete any
           existing ones.

       -fno-weak
           Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.   By  default,  G++  uses  weak
           symbols  if  they are available.  This option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-
           users; it results in inferior code and has no benefits.  This option  may  be  removed  in  a  future
           release of G++.

       -nostdinc++
           Do  not  search for header files in the standard directories specific to C++, but do still search the
           other standard directories.  (This option is used when building the C++ library.)

       In addition, these optimization, warning,  and  code  generation  options  have  meanings  only  for  C++
       programs:

       -Wabi (C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  when  G++  generates  code  that  is  probably  not compatible with the vendor-neutral C++ ABI.
           Although an effort has been made to warn about all such cases, there are probably some cases that are
           not warned about, even though G++ is generating incompatible code.  There may  also  be  cases  where
           warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated is compatible.

           You  should  rewrite  your code to avoid these warnings if you are concerned about the fact that code
           generated by G++ may not be binary compatible with code generated by other compilers.

           The known incompatibilities in -fabi-version=2 (the default) include:

           •   A template with a non-type template parameter of reference type is mangled incorrectly:

                       extern int N;
                       template <int &> struct S {};
                       void n (S<N>) {2}

               This is fixed in -fabi-version=3.

           •   SIMD vector types declared using "__attribute ((vector_size))" are mangled in a non-standard  way
               that does not allow for overloading of functions taking vectors of different sizes.

               The mangling is changed in -fabi-version=4.

           The known incompatibilities in -fabi-version=1 include:

           •   Incorrect  handling  of  tail-padding for bit-fields.  G++ may attempt to pack data into the same
               byte as a base class.  For example:

                       struct A { virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; };
                       struct B : public A { int f2 : 1; };

               In this case, G++ places "B::f2" into the same byte as "A::f1"; other compilers do not.  You  can
               avoid  this  problem by explicitly padding "A" so that its size is a multiple of the byte size on
               your platform; that causes G++ and other compilers to lay out "B" identically.

           •   Incorrect handling of tail-padding for virtual bases.  G++ does not use tail padding when  laying
               out virtual bases.  For example:

                       struct A { virtual void f(); char c1; };
                       struct B { B(); char c2; };
                       struct C : public A, public virtual B {};

               In  this case, G++ does not place "B" into the tail-padding for "A"; other compilers do.  You can
               avoid this problem by explicitly padding "A" so that its size is  a  multiple  of  its  alignment
               (ignoring virtual base classes); that causes G++ and other compilers to lay out "C" identically.

           •   Incorrect  handling  of  bit-fields  with  declared  widths greater than that of their underlying
               types, when the bit-fields appear in a union.  For example:

                       union U { int i : 4096; };

               Assuming that an "int" does not have 4096 bits, G++ makes the union too small by  the  number  of
               bits in an "int".

           •   Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets.  For example:

                       struct A {};

                       struct B {
                         A a;
                         virtual void f ();
                       };

                       struct C : public B, public A {};

               G++  places  the  "A"  base class of "C" at a nonzero offset; it should be placed at offset zero.
               G++ mistakenly believes that the "A" data member of "B" is already at offset zero.

           •   Names of template functions whose types involve "typename" or template template parameters can be
               mangled incorrectly.

                       template <typename Q>
                       void f(typename Q::X) {}

                       template <template <typename> class Q>
                       void f(typename Q<int>::X) {}

               Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.

           It also warns about psABI-related changes.  The known psABI changes at this point include:

           •   For SysV/x86-64, unions with "long double" members are passed in memory as  specified  in  psABI.
               For example:

                       union U {
                         long double ld;
                         int i;
                       };

               "union U" is always passed in memory.

       -Wctor-dtor-privacy (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  when  a  class  seems  unusable  because  all the constructors or destructors in that class are
           private, and it has neither friends nor public static member functions.  Also warn if  there  are  no
           non-private  methods,  and  there's  at least one private member function that isn't a constructor or
           destructor.

       -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when delete is used to destroy an instance of a class that has virtual functions and non-virtual
           destructor. It is unsafe to delete an instance of a derived class through a pointer to a  base  class
           if the base class does not have a virtual destructor.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wliteral-suffix (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  when  a  string  or  character  literal is followed by a ud-suffix which does not begin with an
           underscore.  As a conforming extension, GCC treats such suffixes as separate preprocessing tokens  in
           order  to maintain backwards compatibility with code that uses formatting macros from "<inttypes.h>".
           For example:

                   #define __STDC_FORMAT_MACROS
                   #include <inttypes.h>
                   #include <stdio.h>

                   int main() {
                     int64_t i64 = 123;
                     printf("My int64: %"PRId64"\n", i64);
                   }

           In this case, "PRId64" is treated as a separate preprocessing token.

           This warning is enabled by default.

       -Wnarrowing (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a narrowing conversion prohibited by C++11 occurs within { }, e.g.

                   int i = { 2.2 }; // error: narrowing from double to int

           This flag is included in -Wall and -Wc++11-compat.

           With -std=c++11, -Wno-narrowing suppresses the diagnostic required by the standard.  Note  that  this
           does  not  affect  the  meaning  of well-formed code; narrowing conversions are still considered ill-
           formed in SFINAE context.

       -Wnoexcept (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a noexcept-expression evaluates to false because of a call to a function that does not have
           a non-throwing exception specification (i.e. throw() or noexcept) but is known  by  the  compiler  to
           never throw an exception.

       -Wnon-virtual-dtor (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  when  a  class  has  virtual functions and an accessible non-virtual destructor itself or in an
           accessible polymorphic base class, in which case it is possible but unsafe to delete an instance of a
           derived class through a pointer to the class itself or base class.   This  warning  is  automatically
           enabled if -Weffc++ is specified.

       -Wreorder (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  when  the order of member initializers given in the code does not match the order in which they
           must be executed.  For instance:

                   struct A {
                     int i;
                     int j;
                     A(): j (0), i (1) { }
                   };

           The compiler rearranges the member initializers for i and j to match the  declaration  order  of  the
           members, emitting a warning to that effect.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -fext-numeric-literals (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Accept  imaginary,  fixed-point,  or machine-defined literal number suffixes as GNU extensions.  When
           this option is turned off these suffixes are treated as C++11 user-defined literal numeric  suffixes.
           This  is  on  by  default  for all pre-C++11 dialects and all GNU dialects: -std=c++98, -std=gnu++98,
           -std=gnu++11, -std=gnu++1y.  This option is off by default for ISO C++11 onwards (-std=c++11, ...).

       The following -W... options are not affected by -Wall.

       -Weffc++ (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers' Effective  C++  series  of
           books:

           •   Define  a  copy  constructor  and  an  assignment operator for classes with dynamically-allocated
               memory.

           •   Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.

           •   Have "operator=" return a reference to *this.

           •   Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.

           •   Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and decrement operators.

           •   Never overload "&&", "||", or ",".

           This option also enables -Wnon-virtual-dtor, which is also one of the effective C++  recommendations.
           However,  the  check  is  extended  to  warn  about the lack of virtual destructor in accessible non-
           polymorphic bases classes too.

           When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library headers  do  not  obey  all  of  these
           guidelines; use grep -v to filter out those warnings.

       -Wstrict-null-sentinel (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  about  the use of an uncasted "NULL" as sentinel.  When compiling only with GCC this is a valid
           sentinel, as "NULL" is defined to "__null".  Although it is a null pointer  constant  rather  than  a
           null  pointer,  it  is  guaranteed to be of the same size as a pointer.  But this use is not portable
           across different compilers.

       -Wno-non-template-friend (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared within  a  template.   Since  the
           advent  of  explicit  template  specification  support  in  G++,  if  the  name  of  the friend is an
           unqualified-id (i.e., friend foo(int)), the  C++  language  specification  demands  that  the  friend
           declare  or  define  an  ordinary,  nontemplate  function.  (Section 14.5.3).  Before G++ implemented
           explicit specification, unqualified-ids could be interpreted as  a  particular  specialization  of  a
           templatized  function.   Because  this  non-conforming behavior is no longer the default behavior for
           G++, -Wnon-template-friend allows the compiler to check existing code for potential trouble spots and
           is on by default.  This new compiler behavior can be turned off with -Wno-non-template-friend,  which
           keeps the conformant compiler code but disables the helpful warning.

       -Wold-style-cast (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  if  an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within a C++ program.  The new-style
           casts (dynamic_cast, static_cast, reinterpret_cast, and const_cast) are less vulnerable to unintended
           effects and much easier to search for.

       -Woverloaded-virtual (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a base class.  For example, in:

                   struct A {
                     virtual void f();
                   };

                   struct B: public A {
                     void f(int);
                   };

           the "A" class version of "f" is hidden in "B", and code like:

                   B* b;
                   b->f();

           fails to compile.

       -Wno-pmf-conversions (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function to a plain pointer.

       -Wsign-promo (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or enumerated type to a signed  type,
           over  a  conversion to an unsigned type of the same size.  Previous versions of G++ tried to preserve
           unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.

   Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
       (NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++ languages themselves.

       This  section  describes  the  command-line  options  that  are  only  meaningful  for  Objective-C   and
       Objective-C++  programs.   You  can  also use most of the language-independent GNU compiler options.  For
       example, you might compile a file "some_class.m" like this:

               gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m

       In this example, -fgnu-runtime is an option meant only for Objective-C and  Objective-C++  programs;  you
       can use the other options with any language supported by GCC.

       Note  that  since  Objective-C  is  an extension of the C language, Objective-C compilations may also use
       options specific to the C front-end (e.g., -Wtraditional).  Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may use
       C++-specific options (e.g., -Wabi).

       Here is a list of options that are only for compiling Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs:

       -fconstant-string-class=class-name
           Use class-name as the name of the class to instantiate for each literal  string  specified  with  the
           syntax  "@"..."".  The default class name is "NXConstantString" if the GNU runtime is being used, and
           "NSConstantString" if the NeXT runtime is being used (see below).  The  -fconstant-cfstrings  option,
           if also present, overrides the -fconstant-string-class setting and cause "@"..."" literals to be laid
           out as constant CoreFoundation strings.

       -fgnu-runtime
           Generate  object  code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C runtime.  This is the default for
           most types of systems.

       -fnext-runtime
           Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime.   This  is  the  default  for  NeXT-based  systems,
           including  Darwin  and  Mac  OS  X.  The macro "__NEXT_RUNTIME__" is predefined if (and only if) this
           option is used.

       -fno-nil-receivers
           Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches ("[receiver message:arg]") in  this  translation  unit
           ensure that the receiver is not "nil".  This allows for more efficient entry points in the runtime to
           be used.  This option is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime and ABI version 0 or 1.

       -fobjc-abi-version=n
           Use  version  n  of the Objective-C ABI for the selected runtime.  This option is currently supported
           only for the NeXT runtime.  In that case, Version 0 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI  without  support
           for  properties  and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 1 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI with
           support for properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 2 is the  modern  (64-bit)  ABI.
           If  nothing is specified, the default is Version 0 on 32-bit target machines, and Version 2 on 64-bit
           target machines.

       -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
           For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables is a C++ object with a non-trivial
           default constructor.  If so, synthesize a special "- (id) .cxx_construct" instance method which  runs
           non-trivial  default  constructors  on any such instance variables, in order, and then return "self".
           Similarly, check if any instance variable is a C++ object with a non-trivial destructor, and  if  so,
           synthesize  a  special  "-  (void)  .cxx_destruct" method which runs all such default destructors, in
           reverse order.

           The "- (id) .cxx_construct" and "- (void) .cxx_destruct" methods thusly  generated  only  operate  on
           instance  variables  declared  in  the  current  Objective-C  class,  and  not  those  inherited from
           superclasses.  It is the responsibility of the Objective-C runtime to invoke all such methods  in  an
           object's  inheritance  hierarchy.   The  "-  (id)  .cxx_construct" methods are invoked by the runtime
           immediately after a new object instance is  allocated;  the  "-  (void)  .cxx_destruct"  methods  are
           invoked immediately before the runtime deallocates an object instance.

           As  of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and later has support for invoking the "-
           (id) .cxx_construct" and "- (void) .cxx_destruct" methods.

       -fobjc-direct-dispatch
           Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher.  On Darwin this is accomplished via the comm page.

       -fobjc-exceptions
           Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in Objective-C, similar to what is offered
           by C++ and Java.  This option is required to use  the  Objective-C  keywords  @try,  @throw,  @catch,
           @finally  and @synchronized.  This option is available with both the GNU runtime and the NeXT runtime
           (but not available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and earlier).

       -fobjc-gc
           Enable garbage collection (GC) in Objective-C  and  Objective-C++  programs.   This  option  is  only
           available  with  the  NeXT runtime; the GNU runtime has a different garbage collection implementation
           that does not require special compiler flags.

       -fobjc-nilcheck
           For the NeXT runtime with version 2 of the ABI, check for a nil receiver in method invocations before
           doing the actual method call.  This is the default and  can  be  disabled  using  -fno-objc-nilcheck.
           Class  methods  and super calls are never checked for nil in this way no matter what this flag is set
           to.  Currently this flag does nothing when the GNU runtime, or an older version of the  NeXT  runtime
           ABI, is used.

       -fobjc-std=objc1
           Conform  to  the  language  syntax of Objective-C 1.0, the language recognized by GCC 4.0.  This only
           affects the Objective-C additions to the C/C++ language; it does  not  affect  conformance  to  C/C++
           standards,  which is controlled by the separate C/C++ dialect option flags.  When this option is used
           with the Objective-C or Objective-C++ compiler, any Objective-C syntax that is not recognized by  GCC
           4.0  is rejected.  This is useful if you need to make sure that your Objective-C code can be compiled
           with older versions of GCC.

       -freplace-objc-classes
           Emit a special marker instructing ld(1) not to statically link in  the  resulting  object  file,  and
           allow  dyld(1)  to  load  it  in  at run time instead.  This is used in conjunction with the Fix-and-
           Continue debugging mode, where the object file in question may be recompiled and dynamically reloaded
           in the course of program execution, without the need to restart the program itself.  Currently,  Fix-
           and-Continue  functionality  is  only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3
           and later.

       -fzero-link
           When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily replaces calls to "objc_getClass("...")"
           (when the name of the class is  known  at  compile  time)  with  static  class  references  that  get
           initialized  at  load  time,  which  improves  run-time performance.  Specifying the -fzero-link flag
           suppresses this behavior and causes calls to "objc_getClass("...")"  to be retained.  This is  useful
           in  Zero-Link  debugging  mode,  since  it allows for individual class implementations to be modified
           during program execution.  The GNU runtime currently always retains calls to  "objc_get_class("...")"
           regardless of command-line options.

       -gen-decls
           Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a file named sourcename.decl.

       -Wassign-intercept (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the garbage collector.

       -Wno-protocol (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           If  a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for every method in the protocol
           that is not implemented by the class.  The default behavior is to issue a warning  for  every  method
           not  explicitly  implemented  in  the  class,  even  if a method implementation is inherited from the
           superclass.  If you use the -Wno-protocol option, then methods  inherited  from  the  superclass  are
           considered to be implemented, and no warning is issued for them.

       -Wselector (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are found during compilation.  The
           check is performed on the list of methods in the final stage of compilation.  Additionally,  a  check
           is  performed  for  each  selector  appearing  in a "@selector(...)"  expression, and a corresponding
           method for that selector has been found during compilation.  Because these  checks  scan  the  method
           table  only  at  the  end  of  compilation,  these  warnings  are  not produced if the final stage of
           compilation is not reached, for example because an error is found during compilation, or because  the
           -fsyntax-only option is being used.

       -Wstrict-selector-match (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  if  multiple methods with differing argument and/or return types are found for a given selector
           when attempting to send a message using this selector to a receiver of type "id"  or  "Class".   When
           this flag is off (which is the default behavior), the compiler omits such warnings if any differences
           found are confined to types that share the same size and alignment.

       -Wundeclared-selector (Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  if  a  "@selector(...)" expression referring to an undeclared selector is found.  A selector is
           considered undeclared if no method with that name  has  been  declared  before  the  "@selector(...)"
           expression,  either  explicitly  in  an  @interface  or  @protocol  declaration,  or implicitly in an
           @implementation section.  This option always performs  its  checks  as  soon  as  a  "@selector(...)"
           expression  is  found,  while  -Wselector only performs its checks in the final stage of compilation.
           This also enforces the coding style convention that methods and selectors  must  be  declared  before
           being used.

       -print-objc-runtime-info
           Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed by value, if any.

   Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
       Traditionally,  diagnostic  messages have been formatted irrespective of the output device's aspect (e.g.
       its width, ...).  You can use the options  described  below  to  control  the  formatting  algorithm  for
       diagnostic  messages,  e.g. how many characters per line, how often source location information should be
       reported.  Note that some language front ends may not honor these options.

       -fmessage-length=n
           Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about n  characters.   The  default  is  72
           characters  for  g++  and  0  for the rest of the front ends supported by GCC.  If n is zero, then no
           line-wrapping is done; each error message appears on a single line.

       -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
           Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic messages  reporter  to  emit  source
           location  information once; that is, in case the message is too long to fit on a single physical line
           and has to be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix)  again,  over  and  over,  in
           subsequent continuation lines.  This is the default behavior.

       -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
           Only  meaningful  in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic messages reporter to emit the same
           source location information (as prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking a
           message which is too long to fit on a single line.

       -fdiagnostics-color[=WHEN]
       -fno-diagnostics-color
           Use color in diagnostics.  WHEN is never, always, or  auto.   The  default  is  never  if  GCC_COLORS
           environment  variable  isn't present in the environment, and auto otherwise.  auto means to use color
           only when the standard error is a terminal.  The forms -fdiagnostics-color and -fno-diagnostics-color
           are aliases for -fdiagnostics-color=always and -fdiagnostics-color=never, respectively.

           The colors are defined by the environment variable GCC_COLORS.  Its value is a  colon-separated  list
           of  capabilities  and  Select Graphic Rendition (SGR) substrings. SGR commands are interpreted by the
           terminal or terminal emulator.  (See the section in the  documentation  of  your  text  terminal  for
           permitted values and their meanings as character attributes.)  These substring values are integers in
           decimal representation and can be concatenated with semicolons.  Common values to concatenate include
           1  for  bold,  4 for underline, 5 for blink, 7 for inverse, 39 for default foreground color, 30 to 37
           for foreground colors, 90 to 97 for 16-color mode foreground colors, 38;5;0 to 38;5;255 for  88-color
           and  256-color  modes  foreground  colors,  49  for default background color, 40 to 47 for background
           colors, 100 to 107 for 16-color mode background colors, and  48;5;0  to  48;5;255  for  88-color  and
           256-color modes background colors.

           The  default  GCC_COLORS  is error=01;31:warning=01;35:note=01;36:caret=01;32:locus=01:quote=01 where
           01;31 is bold red, 01;35 is bold magenta, 01;36 is bold cyan, 01;32 is bold green  and  01  is  bold.
           Setting GCC_COLORS to the empty string disables colors.  Supported capabilities are as follows.

           "error="
               SGR substring for error: markers.

           "warning="
               SGR substring for warning: markers.

           "note="
               SGR substring for note: markers.

           "caret="
               SGR substring for caret line.

           "locus="
               SGR substring for location information, file:line or file:line:column etc.

           "quote="
               SGR substring for information printed within quotes.

       -fno-diagnostics-show-option
           By  default,  each  diagnostic emitted includes text indicating the command-line option that directly
           controls the diagnostic (if such an option is known to the  diagnostic  machinery).   Specifying  the
           -fno-diagnostics-show-option flag suppresses that behavior.

       -fno-diagnostics-show-caret
           By  default, each diagnostic emitted includes the original source line and a caret '^' indicating the
           column.  This option suppresses this information.

   Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
       Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions that are not inherently erroneous but that are
       risky or suggest there may have been an error.

       The following language-independent options do not enable specific  warnings  but  control  the  kinds  of
       diagnostics produced by GCC.

       -fsyntax-only
           Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.

       -fmax-errors=n
           Limits the maximum number of error messages to n, at which point GCC bails out rather than attempting
           to  continue processing the source code.  If n is 0 (the default), there is no limit on the number of
           error messages produced.  If -Wfatal-errors is also specified, then -Wfatal-errors  takes  precedence
           over this option.

       -w  Inhibit all warning messages.

       -Werror
           Make all warnings into errors.

       -Werror=
           Make  the  specified  warning  into  an  error.  The specifier for a warning is appended; for example
           -Werror=switch turns the warnings controlled by -Wswitch into errors.  This switch takes  a  negative
           form,  to  be  used  to  negate  -Werror  for  specific warnings; for example -Wno-error=switch makes
           -Wswitch warnings not be errors, even when -Werror is in effect.

           The warning message for each controllable warning includes the  option  that  controls  the  warning.
           That  option  can  then  be  used with -Werror= and -Wno-error= as described above.  (Printing of the
           option in the warning message can be disabled using the -fno-diagnostics-show-option flag.)

           Note that specifying -Werror=foo automatically implies -Wfoo.  However, -Wno-error=foo does not imply
           anything.

       -Wfatal-errors
           This option causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first error occurred rather  than  trying
           to keep going and printing further error messages.

       You  can request many specific warnings with options beginning with -W, for example -Wimplicit to request
       warnings on implicit declarations.  Each of these specific warning  options  also  has  a  negative  form
       beginning  -Wno- to turn off warnings; for example, -Wno-implicit.  This manual lists only one of the two
       forms, whichever is not the default.  For further language-specific options also  refer  to  C++  Dialect
       Options and Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options.

       When  an  unrecognized  warning  option  is  requested  (e.g., -Wunknown-warning), GCC emits a diagnostic
       stating that the option is not recognized.  However, if the -Wno- form is used, the behavior is  slightly
       different:  no  diagnostic  is  produced  for  -Wno-unknown-warning  unless  other  diagnostics are being
       produced.  This allows the use of new -Wno- options with old compilers, but if something goes wrong,  the
       compiler warns that an unrecognized option is present.

       -Wpedantic
       -pedantic
           Issue  all  the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++; reject all programs that use forbidden
           extensions, and some other programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++.  For  ISO  C,  follows  the
           version of the ISO C standard specified by any -std option used.

           Valid  ISO  C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without this option (though a rare
           few require -ansi or a -std option specifying the required version of ISO C).  However, without  this
           option,  certain  GNU extensions and traditional C and C++ features are supported as well.  With this
           option, they are rejected.

           -Wpedantic does not cause warning messages for use of the alternate keywords whose  names  begin  and
           end  with  __.   Pedantic  warnings are also disabled in the expression that follows "__extension__".
           However, only system header files should use these escape routes; application programs  should  avoid
           them.

           Some users try to use -Wpedantic to check programs for strict ISO C conformance.  They soon find that
           it  does  not  do quite what they want: it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for
           which ISO C requires a diagnostic, and some others for which diagnostics have been added.

           A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful  in  some  instances,  but  would
           require  considerable  additional  work  and would be quite different from -Wpedantic.  We don't have
           plans to support such a feature in the near future.

           Where the standard specified with -std represents a GNU extended dialect  of  C,  such  as  gnu90  or
           gnu99, there is a corresponding base standard, the version of ISO C on which the GNU extended dialect
           is based.  Warnings from -Wpedantic are given where they are required by the base standard.  (It does
           not  make  sense  for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified GNU C dialect,
           since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all features the compiler supports with  the  given
           option, and there would be nothing to warn about.)

       -pedantic-errors
           Like -Wpedantic, except that errors are produced rather than warnings.

       -Wall
           This enables all the warnings about constructions that some users consider questionable, and that are
           easy to avoid (or modify to prevent the warning), even in conjunction with macros.  This also enables
           some  language-specific  warnings  described in C++ Dialect Options and Objective-C and Objective-C++
           Dialect Options.

           -Wall turns on the following warning flags:

           -Waddress -Warray-bounds (only with -O2) -Wc++11-compat -Wchar-subscripts -Wenum-compare (in  C/ObjC;
           this is on by default in C++) -Wimplicit-int (C and Objective-C only) -Wimplicit-function-declaration
           (C  and  Objective-C  only)  -Wcomment  -Wformat  -Wmain  (only for C/ObjC and unless -ffreestanding)
           -Wmaybe-uninitialized  -Wmissing-braces  (only  for  C/ObjC)  -Wnonnull  -Wopenmp-simd  -Wparentheses
           -Wpointer-sign    -Wreorder    -Wreturn-type    -Wsequence-point   -Wsign-compare   (only   in   C++)
           -Wstrict-aliasing  -Wstrict-overflow=1   -Wswitch   -Wtrigraphs   -Wuninitialized   -Wunknown-pragmas
           -Wunused-function -Wunused-label -Wunused-value -Wunused-variable -Wvolatile-register-var

           Note  that  some  warning flags are not implied by -Wall.  Some of them warn about constructions that
           users generally do not consider questionable, but which occasionally you might  wish  to  check  for;
           others  warn  about  constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid in some cases, and there is no
           simple way to modify the code to suppress the warning. Some of them are enabled by -Wextra  but  many
           of them must be enabled individually.

       -Wextra
           This  enables  some extra warning flags that are not enabled by -Wall. (This option used to be called
           -W.  The older name is still supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)

           -Wclobbered -Wempty-body -Wignored-qualifiers  -Wmissing-field-initializers  -Wmissing-parameter-type
           (C    only)   -Wold-style-declaration   (C   only)   -Woverride-init   -Wsign-compare   -Wtype-limits
           -Wuninitialized -Wunused-parameter (only with -Wunused  or  -Wall)  -Wunused-but-set-parameter  (only
           with -Wunused or -Wall)

           The option -Wextra also prints warning messages for the following cases:

           •   A pointer is compared against integer zero with <, <=, >, or >=.

           •   (C++ only) An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a conditional expression.

           •   (C++ only) Ambiguous virtual bases.

           •   (C++ only) Subscripting an array that has been declared register.

           •   (C++ only) Taking the address of a variable that has been declared register.

           •   (C++ only) A base class is not initialized in a derived class's copy constructor.

       -Wchar-subscripts
           Warn  if  an  array subscript has type "char".  This is a common cause of error, as programmers often
           forget that this type is signed on some machines.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wcomment
           Warn whenever a comment-start sequence /* appears in a /* comment, or  whenever  a  Backslash-Newline
           appears in a // comment.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wno-coverage-mismatch
           Warn  if  feedback  profiles  do  not match when using the -fprofile-use option.  If a source file is
           changed between compiling with -fprofile-gen and with  -fprofile-use,  the  files  with  the  profile
           feedback  can  fail to match the source file and GCC cannot use the profile feedback information.  By
           default, this warning is enabled and is treated as an error.  -Wno-coverage-mismatch can be  used  to
           disable  the warning or -Wno-error=coverage-mismatch can be used to disable the error.  Disabling the
           error for this warning can result in poorly optimized code and is useful only in  the  case  of  very
           minor  changes  such  as bug fixes to an existing code-base.  Completely disabling the warning is not
           recommended.

       -Wno-cpp
           (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++ and Fortran only)

           Suppress warning messages emitted by "#warning" directives.

       -Wdouble-promotion (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Give a warning when a value of type "float" is implicitly promoted to "double".  CPUs with  a  32-bit
           "single-precision"  floating-point  unit  implement  "float"  in  hardware,  but  emulate "double" in
           software.  On such a machine, doing computations using "double" values is much more expensive because
           of the overhead required for software emulation.

           It is easy to  accidentally  do  computations  with  "double"  because  floating-point  literals  are
           implicitly of type "double".  For example, in:

                   float area(float radius)
                   {
                      return 3.14159 * radius * radius;
                   }

           the  compiler  performs  the entire computation with "double" because the floating-point literal is a
           "double".

       -Wformat
       -Wformat=n
           Check calls to "printf" and "scanf", etc., to make  sure  that  the  arguments  supplied  have  types
           appropriate  to  the format string specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string
           make sense.  This includes standard functions, and others specified  by  format  attributes,  in  the
           "printf", "scanf", "strftime" and "strfmon" (an X/Open extension, not in the C standard) families (or
           other  target-specific  families).  Which functions are checked without format attributes having been
           specified depends on the standard  version  selected,  and  such  checks  of  functions  without  the
           attribute specified are disabled by -ffreestanding or -fno-builtin.

           The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU libc version 2.2.  These include
           all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and
           GNU  extensions.   Other  library  implementations  may  not support all these features; GCC does not
           support warning about features that go  beyond  a  particular  library's  limitations.   However,  if
           -Wpedantic  is  used  with  -Wformat,  warnings  are  given about format features not in the selected
           standard version (but not for "strfmon" formats, since  those  are  not  in  any  version  of  the  C
           standard).

           -Wformat=1
           -Wformat
               Option  -Wformat is equivalent to -Wformat=1, and -Wno-format is equivalent to -Wformat=0.  Since
               -Wformat also checks for null format arguments  for  several  functions,  -Wformat  also  implies
               -Wnonnull.   Some  aspects  of  this  level  of  format  checking can be disabled by the options:
               -Wno-format-contains-nul,  -Wno-format-extra-args,  and  -Wno-format-zero-length.   -Wformat   is
               enabled by -Wall.

           -Wno-format-contains-nul
               If -Wformat is specified, do not warn about format strings that contain NUL bytes.

           -Wno-format-extra-args
               If  -Wformat  is  specified,  do  not warn about excess arguments to a "printf" or "scanf" format
               function.  The C standard specifies that such arguments are ignored.

               Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are specified with  $  operand  number
               specifications,  normally  warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what
               type to pass to "va_arg" to skip the unused arguments.  However, in the case of "scanf"  formats,
               this  option  suppresses  the  warning if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single
               Unix Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.

           -Wno-format-zero-length
               If -Wformat is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.  The C standard  specifies  that
               zero-length formats are allowed.

           -Wformat=2
               Enable   -Wformat   plus   additional   format   checks.    Currently   equivalent   to  -Wformat
               -Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security -Wformat-y2k.

           -Wformat-nonliteral
               If -Wformat is specified, also warn if the format string is not a string literal and so cannot be
               checked, unless the format function takes its format arguments as a "va_list".

           -Wformat-security
               If -Wformat is specified, also warn about  uses  of  format  functions  that  represent  possible
               security  problems.   At  present, this warns about calls to "printf" and "scanf" functions where
               the format string is not a string literal and there  are  no  format  arguments,  as  in  "printf
               (foo);".  This may be a security hole if the format string came from untrusted input and contains
               %n.   (This is currently a subset of what -Wformat-nonliteral warns about, but in future warnings
               may be added to -Wformat-security that are not included in -Wformat-nonliteral.)

               NOTE: In Ubuntu 8.10 and later versions this option is enabled  by  default  for  C,  C++,  ObjC,
               ObjC++.   To  disable,  use -Wno-format-security, or disable all format warnings with -Wformat=0.
               To make format security warnings fatal, specify -Werror=format-security.

           -Wformat-y2k
               If -Wformat is specified, also warn about "strftime" formats that  may  yield  only  a  two-digit
               year.

       -Wnonnull
           Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as requiring a non-null value by the "nonnull"
           function attribute.

           -Wnonnull is included in -Wall and -Wformat.  It can be disabled with the -Wno-nonnull option.

       -Winit-self (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn  about  uninitialized variables that are initialized with themselves.  Note this option can only
           be used with the -Wuninitialized option.

           For example, GCC warns about "i" being uninitialized in the following snippet only  when  -Winit-self
           has been specified:

                   int f()
                   {
                     int i = i;
                     return i;
                   }

           This warning is enabled by -Wall in C++.

       -Wimplicit-int (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wimplicit-function-declaration (C and Objective-C only)
           Give  a  warning  whenever  a  function  is  used  before  being  declared.  In C99 mode (-std=c99 or
           -std=gnu99), this warning is enabled by default and it is made into  an  error  by  -pedantic-errors.
           This warning is also enabled by -Wall.

       -Wimplicit (C and Objective-C only)
           Same as -Wimplicit-int and -Wimplicit-function-declaration.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wignored-qualifiers (C and C++ only)
           Warn  if  the  return type of a function has a type qualifier such as "const".  For ISO C such a type
           qualifier has no effect, since the value returned by a function is  not  an  lvalue.   For  C++,  the
           warning is only emitted for scalar types or "void".  ISO C prohibits qualified "void" return types on
           function definitions, so such return types always receive a warning even without this option.

           This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wmain
           Warn  if  the type of main is suspicious.  main should be a function with external linkage, returning
           int, taking either zero arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate  types.   This  warning  is
           enabled by default in C++ and is enabled by either -Wall or -Wpedantic.

       -Wmissing-braces
           Warn  if  an  aggregate  or  union initializer is not fully bracketed.  In the following example, the
           initializer for a is not fully bracketed, but that for b is fully bracketed.  This warning is enabled
           by -Wall in C.

                   int a[2][2] = { 0, 1, 2, 3 };
                   int b[2][2] = { { 0, 1 }, { 2, 3 } };

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wmissing-include-dirs (C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.

       -Wparentheses
           Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such as when there is an assignment in a context
           where a truth value is expected, or when operators are  nested  whose  precedence  people  often  get
           confused about.

           Also warn if a comparison like x<=y<=z appears; this is equivalent to (x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z, which is a
           different interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.

           Also  warn  about constructions where there may be confusion to which "if" statement an "else" branch
           belongs.  Here is an example of such a case:

                   {
                     if (a)
                       if (b)
                         foo ();
                     else
                       bar ();
                   }

           In C/C++, every "else" branch belongs to the innermost possible "if" statement, which in this example
           is "if (b)".  This is often not what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above example  by
           indentation  the  programmer  chose.   When  there  is the potential for this confusion, GCC issues a
           warning when this flag is specified.  To eliminate  the  warning,  add  explicit  braces  around  the
           innermost  "if"  statement  so  there  is  no  way  the "else" can belong to the enclosing "if".  The
           resulting code looks like this:

                   {
                     if (a)
                       {
                         if (b)
                           foo ();
                         else
                           bar ();
                       }
                   }

           Also warn for dangerous uses of the GNU extension to "?:"  with  omitted  middle  operand.  When  the
           condition  in  the  "?":  operator  is  a  boolean  expression, the omitted value is always 1.  Often
           programmers expect it to be a value computed inside the conditional expression instead.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wsequence-point
           Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations of sequence  point  rules  in
           the C and C++ standards.

           The  C  and  C++  standards define the order in which expressions in a C/C++ program are evaluated in
           terms of sequence points, which represent a partial ordering between the execution of  parts  of  the
           program:  those  executed  before the sequence point, and those executed after it.  These occur after
           the evaluation of a full expression (one which is  not  part  of  a  larger  expression),  after  the
           evaluation  of the first operand of a "&&", "||", "? :" or "," (comma) operator, before a function is
           called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the expression denoting the  called  function),
           and  in  certain  other  places.   Other  than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
           evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified.  All  these  rules  describe  only  a
           partial  order  rather than a total order, since, for example, if two functions are called within one
           expression with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions are  called  is  not
           specified.  However, the standards committee have ruled that function calls do not overlap.

           It  is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the values of objects take effect.
           Programs whose behavior depends on this have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify that
           "Between the previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored value modified at  most
           once  by  the  evaluation  of  an  expression.   Furthermore,  the  prior value shall be read only to
           determine the value to be stored.".  If a program breaks these rules, the results on  any  particular
           implementation are entirely unpredictable.

           Examples  of  code  with  undefined behavior are "a = a++;", "a[n] = b[n++]" and "a[i++] = i;".  Some
           more complicated cases are not diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
           result, but in general it has been found fairly effective  at  detecting  this  sort  of  problem  in
           programs.

           The  standard  is  worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate over the precise meaning of the
           sequence point rules in subtle cases.  Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
           definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at <http://gcc.gnu.org/readings.html>.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall for C and C++.

       -Wno-return-local-addr
           Do not warn about returning a pointer (or in C++, a reference) to a variable that goes out  of  scope
           after the function returns.

       -Wreturn-type
           Warn  whenever  a function is defined with a return type that defaults to "int".  Also warn about any
           "return" statement with no return value in a function whose return type is not  "void"  (falling  off
           the end of the function body is considered returning without a value), and about a "return" statement
           with an expression in a function whose return type is "void".

           For   C++,  a  function  without  return  type  always  produces  a  diagnostic  message,  even  when
           -Wno-return-type is specified.  The only exceptions are main and functions defined in system headers.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wswitch
           Warn whenever a "switch" statement has an index of enumerated type and lacks a "case" for one or more
           of the named codes of that enumeration.  (The presence of a "default" label prevents  this  warning.)
           "case"  labels  outside the enumeration range also provoke warnings when this option is used (even if
           there is a "default" label).  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wswitch-default
           Warn whenever a "switch" statement does not have a "default" case.

       -Wswitch-enum
           Warn whenever a "switch" statement has an index of enumerated type and lacks a "case" for one or more
           of the named codes of that enumeration.  "case" labels outside the  enumeration  range  also  provoke
           warnings when this option is used.  The only difference between -Wswitch and this option is that this
           option gives a warning about an omitted enumeration code even if there is a "default" label.

       -Wsync-nand (C and C++ only)
           Warn  when  "__sync_fetch_and_nand"  and  "__sync_nand_and_fetch" built-in functions are used.  These
           functions changed semantics in GCC 4.4.

       -Wtrigraphs
           Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of the program (trigraphs  within
           comments are not warned about).  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused-but-set-parameter
           Warn whenever a function parameter is assigned to, but otherwise unused (aside from its declaration).

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

           This warning is also enabled by -Wunused together with -Wextra.

       -Wunused-but-set-variable
           Warn  whenever  a  local  variable is assigned to, but otherwise unused (aside from its declaration).
           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

           This warning is also enabled by -Wunused, which is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused-function
           Warn whenever a static function is declared but not  defined  or  a  non-inline  static  function  is
           unused.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused-label
           Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

       -Wunused-local-typedefs (C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a typedef locally defined in a function is not used.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused-parameter
           Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

       -Wno-unused-result
           Do  not  warn  if  a caller of a function marked with attribute "warn_unused_result" does not use its
           return value. The default is -Wunused-result.

       -Wunused-variable
           Warn whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused aside from its  declaration.
           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

           To suppress this warning use the unused attribute.

       -Wunused-value
           Warn  whenever  a  statement  computes a result that is explicitly not used. To suppress this warning
           cast the unused expression to void. This includes an expression-statement or the left-hand side of  a
           comma  expression  that  contains no side effects. For example, an expression such as x[i,j] causes a
           warning, while x[(void)i,j] does not.

           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wunused
           All the above -Wunused options combined.

           In order to get a warning about an  unused  function  parameter,  you  must  either  specify  -Wextra
           -Wunused (note that -Wall implies -Wunused), or separately specify -Wunused-parameter.

       -Wuninitialized
           Warn  if  an  automatic  variable  is  used  without  first being initialized or if a variable may be
           clobbered by a "setjmp" call. In C++, warn if a  non-static  reference  or  non-static  const  member
           appears in a class without constructors.

           If  you  want  to  warn  about  code  that  uses  the  uninitialized value of the variable in its own
           initializer, use the -Winit-self option.

           These warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered elements of structure, union or  array
           variables as well as for variables that are uninitialized or clobbered as a whole.  They do not occur
           for  variables  or  elements declared "volatile".  Because these warnings depend on optimization, the
           exact variables or elements for which there are warnings depends on the precise optimization  options
           and version of GCC used.

           Note  that  there may be no warning about a variable that is used only to compute a value that itself
           is never used, because such computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings are
           printed.

       -Wmaybe-uninitialized
           For an automatic variable, if there exists a path from the function entry to a use  of  the  variable
           that  is initialized, but there exist some other paths for which the variable is not initialized, the
           compiler emits a warning if it cannot prove the uninitialized paths are not  executed  at  run  time.
           These  warnings are made optional because GCC is not smart enough to see all the reasons why the code
           might be correct in spite of appearing to have an error.  Here is one example of how this can happen:

                   {
                     int x;
                     switch (y)
                       {
                       case 1: x = 1;
                         break;
                       case 2: x = 4;
                         break;
                       case 3: x = 5;
                       }
                     foo (x);
                   }

           If the value of "y" is always 1, 2 or 3, then "x" is always initialized, but GCC doesn't  know  this.
           To suppress the warning, you need to provide a default case with assert(0) or similar code.

           This  option  also  warns  when  a  non-volatile  automatic  variable  might  be changed by a call to
           "longjmp".  These warnings as well are possible only in optimizing compilation.

           The compiler sees only the calls to "setjmp".  It cannot know where  "longjmp"  will  be  called;  in
           fact,  a  signal  handler could call it at any point in the code.  As a result, you may get a warning
           even when there is in fact no problem because "longjmp" cannot in fact be called at  the  place  that
           would cause a problem.

           Some  spurious  warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions you use that never return as
           "noreturn".

           This warning is enabled by -Wall or -Wextra.

       -Wunknown-pragmas
           Warn when a "#pragma" directive is encountered that is not understood by GCC.  If  this  command-line
           option is used, warnings are even issued for unknown pragmas in system header files.  This is not the
           case if the warnings are only enabled by the -Wall command-line option.

       -Wno-pragmas
           Do  not  warn  about  misuses  of pragmas, such as incorrect parameters, invalid syntax, or conflicts
           between pragmas.  See also -Wunknown-pragmas.

       -Wstrict-aliasing
           This option is only active when -fstrict-aliasing is active.  It warns about code  that  might  break
           the  strict  aliasing  rules that the compiler is using for optimization.  The warning does not catch
           all cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls.  It  is  included  in  -Wall.   It  is
           equivalent to -Wstrict-aliasing=3

       -Wstrict-aliasing=n
           This  option  is  only active when -fstrict-aliasing is active.  It warns about code that might break
           the strict aliasing rules that the compiler is using for optimization.  Higher levels  correspond  to
           higher  accuracy  (fewer  false positives).  Higher levels also correspond to more effort, similar to
           the way -O works.  -Wstrict-aliasing is equivalent to -Wstrict-aliasing=3.

           Level 1: Most aggressive, quick, least accurate.  Possibly useful when higher levels do not warn  but
           -fstrict-aliasing  still  breaks  the code, as it has very few false negatives.  However, it has many
           false positives.  Warns for all pointer conversions between  possibly  incompatible  types,  even  if
           never dereferenced.  Runs in the front end only.

           Level  2:  Aggressive,  quick,  not too precise.  May still have many false positives (not as many as
           level 1 though), and few false negatives (but possibly more than level 1).  Unlike level 1,  it  only
           warns when an address is taken.  Warns about incomplete types.  Runs in the front end only.

           Level  3  (default  for  -Wstrict-aliasing):  Should  have  very  few  false  positives and few false
           negatives.  Slightly slower than levels 1 or 2 when optimization  is  enabled.   Takes  care  of  the
           common  pun+dereference  pattern in the front end: "*(int*)&some_float".  If optimization is enabled,
           it also runs in the back end, where it deals  with  multiple  statement  cases  using  flow-sensitive
           points-to  information.   Only warns when the converted pointer is dereferenced.  Does not warn about
           incomplete types.

       -Wstrict-overflow
       -Wstrict-overflow=n
           This option is only active when -fstrict-overflow is active.  It warns about cases where the compiler
           optimizes based on the assumption that signed overflow does not occur.  Note that it  does  not  warn
           about  all  cases  where  the  code  might  overflow:  it  only  warns about cases where the compiler
           implements some optimization.  Thus this warning depends on the optimization level.

           An optimization that assumes that signed overflow does not occur is perfectly safe if the  values  of
           the variables involved are such that overflow never does, in fact, occur.  Therefore this warning can
           easily  give a false positive: a warning about code that is not actually a problem.  To help focus on
           important issues, several warning levels are  defined.   No  warnings  are  issued  for  the  use  of
           undefined  signed  overflow  when  estimating how many iterations a loop requires, in particular when
           determining whether a loop will be executed at all.

           -Wstrict-overflow=1
               Warn  about  cases  that  are  both  questionable  and  easy  to  avoid.   For   example,    with
               -fstrict-overflow,  the compiler simplifies "x + 1 > x" to 1.  This level of -Wstrict-overflow is
               enabled by -Wall; higher levels are not, and must be explicitly requested.

           -Wstrict-overflow=2
               Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified to a constant.   For  example:  "abs
               (x)  >=  0".   This  can  only  be  simplified  when -fstrict-overflow is in effect, because "abs
               (INT_MIN)" overflows to "INT_MIN", which is less than zero.  -Wstrict-overflow (with no level) is
               the same as -Wstrict-overflow=2.

           -Wstrict-overflow=3
               Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified.  For  example:  "x  +  1  >  1"  is
               simplified to "x > 0".

           -Wstrict-overflow=4
               Also  warn  about other simplifications not covered by the above cases.  For example: "(x * 10) /
               5" is simplified to "x * 2".

           -Wstrict-overflow=5
               Also warn about cases where the compiler reduces the  magnitude  of  a  constant  involved  in  a
               comparison.   For  example:  "x + 2 > y" is simplified to "x + 1 >= y".  This is reported only at
               the highest warning level because this  simplification  applies  to  many  comparisons,  so  this
               warning level gives a very large number of false positives.

       -Wsuggest-attribute=[pure|const|noreturn|format]
           Warn  for  cases  where adding an attribute may be beneficial. The attributes currently supported are
           listed below.

           -Wsuggest-attribute=pure
           -Wsuggest-attribute=const
           -Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
               Warn about functions that might be candidates for attributes "pure", "const" or "noreturn".   The
               compiler  only  warns  for functions visible in other compilation units or (in the case of "pure"
               and "const") if it cannot prove that the function returns normally. A function  returns  normally
               if  it  doesn't  contain  an infinite loop or return abnormally by throwing, calling "abort()" or
               trapping.  This analysis requires option -fipa-pure-const, which is enabled by default at -O  and
               higher.  Higher optimization levels improve the accuracy of the analysis.

           -Wsuggest-attribute=format
           -Wmissing-format-attribute
               Warn  about  function  pointers that might be candidates for "format" attributes.  Note these are
               only possible candidates, not absolute ones.  GCC guesses that function  pointers  with  "format"
               attributes  that  are  used in assignment, initialization, parameter passing or return statements
               should have a corresponding "format" attribute in the resulting type.  I.e. the left-hand side of
               the assignment or initialization, the type of the parameter variable, or the return type  of  the
               containing function respectively should also have a "format" attribute to avoid the warning.

               GCC  also  warns  about  function  definitions  that might be candidates for "format" attributes.
               Again, these are only possible  candidates.   GCC  guesses  that  "format"  attributes  might  be
               appropriate for any function that calls a function like "vprintf" or "vscanf", but this might not
               always  be  the case, and some functions for which "format" attributes are appropriate may not be
               detected.

       -Warray-bounds
           This option is only active when -ftree-vrp is active (default for -O2  and  above).  It  warns  about
           subscripts to arrays that are always out of bounds. This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wno-div-by-zero
           Do  not  warn  about  compile-time  integer division by zero.  Floating-point division by zero is not
           warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of obtaining infinities and NaNs.

       -Wsystem-headers
           Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.  Warnings from system headers are
           normally suppressed, on the assumption that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only
           make the compiler output harder to read.  Using this command-line option tells GCC to  emit  warnings
           from  system headers as if they occurred in user code.  However, note that using -Wall in conjunction
           with this option does not warn about unknown pragmas in system headers---for that,  -Wunknown-pragmas
           must also be used.

       -Wtrampolines
            Warn about trampolines generated for pointers to nested functions.

            A trampoline is a small piece of data or code that is created at run
            time on the stack when the address of a nested function is taken, and
            is used to call the nested function indirectly.  For some targets, it
            is made up of data only and thus requires no special treatment.  But,
            for most targets, it is made up of code and thus requires the stack
            to be made executable in order for the program to work properly.

       -Wfloat-equal
           Warn if floating-point values are used in equality comparisons.

           The  idea  behind  this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the programmer) to consider floating-
           point values as approximations to infinitely precise real numbers.  If you are doing this,  then  you
           need  to  compute  (by  analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum or likely maximum error
           that the computation introduces, and allow for it when performing  comparisons  (and  when  producing
           output,  but that's a different problem).  In particular, instead of testing for equality, you should
           check to see whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and this is done  with  the  relational
           operators, so equality comparisons are probably mistaken.

       -Wtraditional (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn  about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and ISO C.  Also warn about ISO
           C constructs that have no traditional C equivalent, and/or  problematic  constructs  that  should  be
           avoided.

           •   Macro  parameters  that  appear within string literals in the macro body.  In traditional C macro
               replacement takes place within string literals, but in ISO C it does not.

           •   In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not  exist.   Traditional  preprocessors  only
               considered  a  line  to  be  a  directive  if  the # appeared in column 1 on the line.  Therefore
               -Wtraditional warns about directives that traditional C understands but  ignores  because  the  #
               does  not  appear  as the first character on the line.  It also suggests you hide directives like
               #pragma not understood by traditional C by indenting them.  Some traditional  implementations  do
               not recognize #elif, so this option suggests avoiding it altogether.

           •   A function-like macro that appears without arguments.

           •   The unary plus operator.

           •   The  U  integer  constant suffix, or the F or L floating-point constant suffixes.  (Traditional C
               does support the L suffix on integer constants.)  Note, these suffixes appear in  macros  defined
               in  the system headers of most modern systems, e.g. the _MIN/_MAX macros in "<limits.h>".  Use of
               these macros in user code might normally lead to  spurious  warnings,  however  GCC's  integrated
               preprocessor has enough context to avoid warning in these cases.

           •   A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of the block.

           •   A "switch" statement has an operand of type "long".

           •   A  non-"static"  function  declaration follows a "static" one.  This construct is not accepted by
               some traditional C compilers.

           •   The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width  or  signedness  from  its  traditional
               type.  This warning is only issued if the base of the constant is ten.  I.e. hexadecimal or octal
               values, which typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.

           •   Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.

           •   Initialization of automatic aggregates.

           •   Identifier conflicts with labels.  Traditional C lacks a separate namespace for labels.

           •   Initialization  of  unions.   If  the  initializer is zero, the warning is omitted.  This is done
               under the assumption that  the  zero  initializer  in  user  code  appears  conditioned  on  e.g.
               "__STDC__"  to avoid missing initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero in
               the traditional C case.

           •   Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating-point values and vice  versa.   The  absence  of
               these  prototypes when compiling with traditional C causes serious problems.  This is a subset of
               the possible conversion warnings; for the full set use -Wtraditional-conversion.

           •   Use of ISO C style function definitions.  This warning intentionally is not issued for  prototype
               declarations  or  variadic  functions because these ISO C features appear in your code when using
               libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros, "PARAMS" and "VPARAMS".   This  warning  is  also
               bypassed  for  nested  functions  because  that  feature  is already a GCC extension and thus not
               relevant to traditional C compatibility.

       -Wtraditional-conversion (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from what would  happen  to  the  same
           argument  in  the  absence  of a prototype.  This includes conversions of fixed point to floating and
           vice versa, and conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed-point  argument  except  when
           the same as the default promotion.

       -Wdeclaration-after-statement (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn  when  a declaration is found after a statement in a block.  This construct, known from C++, was
           introduced with ISO C99 and is by default allowed in GCC.  It is not supported by ISO C90 and was not
           supported by GCC versions before GCC 3.0.

       -Wundef
           Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an #if directive.

       -Wno-endif-labels
           Do not warn whenever an #else or an #endif are followed by text.

       -Wshadow
           Warn whenever a local variable or type declaration shadows  another  variable,  parameter,  type,  or
           class  member  (in  C++), or whenever a built-in function is shadowed. Note that in C++, the compiler
           warns if a local variable shadows an explicit typedef, but not if it shadows a struct/class/enum.

       -Wlarger-than=len
           Warn whenever an object of larger than len bytes is defined.

       -Wframe-larger-than=len
           Warn if the size of a function frame is larger than len bytes.  The computation done to determine the
           stack frame size is approximate and not  conservative.   The  actual  requirements  may  be  somewhat
           greater  than  len  even if you do not get a warning.  In addition, any space allocated via "alloca",
           variable-length arrays, or related constructs is  not  included  by  the  compiler  when  determining
           whether or not to issue a warning.

       -Wno-free-nonheap-object
           Do not warn when attempting to free an object that was not allocated on the heap.

       -Wstack-usage=len
           Warn  if  the  stack  usage  of  a  function might be larger than len bytes.  The computation done to
           determine the stack usage is conservative.  Any space allocated via "alloca", variable-length arrays,
           or related constructs is included by the compiler when determining whether or not to issue a warning.

           The message is in keeping with the output of -fstack-usage.

           •   If the stack usage is fully static but exceeds the specified amount, it's:

                         warning: stack usage is 1120 bytes

           •   If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic but bounded, it's:

                         warning: stack usage might be 1648 bytes

           •   If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic and not bounded, it's:

                         warning: stack usage might be unbounded

       -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
           Warn if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler cannot assume anything on the bounds of the
           loop indices.  With -funsafe-loop-optimizations warn if the compiler makes such assumptions.

       -Wno-pedantic-ms-format (MinGW targets only)
           When used in combination with -Wformat and -pedantic without GNU extensions, this option disables the
           warnings about non-ISO "printf" / "scanf" format width specifiers  "I32",  "I64",  and  "I"  used  on
           Windows targets, which depend on the MS runtime.

       -Wpointer-arith
           Warn  about anything that depends on the "size of" a function type or of "void".  GNU C assigns these
           types a size of 1, for convenience in calculations with "void *" pointers and pointers to  functions.
           In  C++,  warn  also  when  an arithmetic operation involves "NULL".  This warning is also enabled by
           -Wpedantic.

       -Wtype-limits
           Warn if a comparison is always true or always false due to the limited range of the data type, but do
           not warn for constant expressions.  For example, warn if an unsigned  variable  is  compared  against
           zero with < or >=.  This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wbad-function-cast (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.  For example, warn if "int malloc()" is
           cast to "anything *".

       -Wc++-compat (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn  about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset of ISO C and ISO C++, e.g. request
           for implicit conversion from "void *" to a pointer to non-"void" type.

       -Wc++11-compat (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs  between  ISO  C++  1998  and  ISO  C++  2011,  e.g.,
           identifiers in ISO C++ 1998 that are keywords in ISO C++ 2011.  This warning turns on -Wnarrowing and
           is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wcast-qual
           Warn  whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from the target type.  For example,
           warn if a "const char *" is cast to an ordinary "char *".

           Also warn when making a cast that introduces a type qualifier in an unsafe way.  For example, casting
           "char **" to "const char **" is unsafe, as in this example:

                     /* p is char ** value.  */
                     const char **q = (const char **) p;
                     /* Assignment of readonly string to const char * is OK.  */
                     *q = "string";
                     /* Now char** pointer points to read-only memory.  */
                     **p = 'b';

       -Wcast-align
           Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of the  target  is  increased.   For
           example,  warn if a "char *" is cast to an "int *" on machines where integers can only be accessed at
           two- or four-byte boundaries.

       -Wwrite-strings
           When compiling C, give string constants the type "const char[length]" so that copying the address  of
           one  into a non-"const" "char *" pointer produces a warning.  These warnings help you find at compile
           time code that can try to write into a string constant, but only if you have been very careful  about
           using  "const"  in declarations and prototypes.  Otherwise, it is just a nuisance. This is why we did
           not make -Wall request these warnings.

           When compiling C++, warn about the deprecated conversion from string  literals  to  "char  *".   This
           warning is enabled by default for C++ programs.

       -Wclobbered
           Warn  for  variables  that  might  be  changed  by longjmp or vfork.  This warning is also enabled by
           -Wextra.

       -Wconditionally-supported (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn for conditionally-supported (C++11 [intro.defs]) constructs.

       -Wconversion
           Warn for implicit conversions that may alter a value. This  includes  conversions  between  real  and
           integer, like "abs (x)" when "x" is "double"; conversions between signed and unsigned, like "unsigned
           ui  = -1"; and conversions to smaller types, like "sqrtf (M_PI)". Do not warn for explicit casts like
           "abs ((int) x)" and "ui = (unsigned) -1", or if the value is not changed by the  conversion  like  in
           "abs  (2.0)".   Warnings  about  conversions  between signed and unsigned integers can be disabled by
           using -Wno-sign-conversion.

           For C++, also warn for confusing overload resolution for user-defined  conversions;  and  conversions
           that  never  use  a type conversion operator: conversions to "void", the same type, a base class or a
           reference to them. Warnings about conversions between signed and unsigned integers  are  disabled  by
           default in C++ unless -Wsign-conversion is explicitly enabled.

       -Wno-conversion-null (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Do  not  warn  for  conversions between "NULL" and non-pointer types. -Wconversion-null is enabled by
           default.

       -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when a literal '0' is used as null pointer constant.  This  can  be  useful  to  facilitate  the
           conversion to "nullptr" in C++11.

       -Wdate-time
           Warn when macros "__TIME__", "__DATE__" or "__TIMESTAMP__" are encountered as they might prevent bit-
           wise-identical reproducible compilations.

       -Wdelete-incomplete (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when deleting a pointer to incomplete type, which may cause undefined behavior at runtime.  This
           warning is enabled by default.

       -Wuseless-cast (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Warn when an expression is casted to its own type.

       -Wempty-body
           Warn  if  an empty body occurs in an if, else or do while statement.  This warning is also enabled by
           -Wextra.

       -Wenum-compare
           Warn about a comparison between values of different enumerated types.  In C++ enumeral mismatches  in
           conditional  expressions are also diagnosed and the warning is enabled by default.  In C this warning
           is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wjump-misses-init (C, Objective-C only)
           Warn if a "goto" statement or a "switch" statement jumps  forward  across  the  initialization  of  a
           variable,  or  jumps  backward  to  a label after the variable has been initialized.  This only warns
           about variables that are initialized when they are declared.  This warning is only  supported  for  C
           and Objective-C; in C++ this sort of branch is an error in any case.

           -Wjump-misses-init  is  included  in -Wc++-compat.  It can be disabled with the -Wno-jump-misses-init
           option.

       -Wsign-compare
           Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce an incorrect result when  the
           signed  value  is  converted  to unsigned.  This warning is also enabled by -Wextra; to get the other
           warnings of -Wextra without this warning, use -Wextra -Wno-sign-compare.

       -Wsign-conversion
           Warn for implicit conversions that may change the sign of an integer value, like assigning  a  signed
           integer expression to an unsigned integer variable. An explicit cast silences the warning. In C, this
           option is enabled also by -Wconversion.

       -Wfloat-conversion
           Warn  for  implicit conversions that reduce the precision of a real value.  This includes conversions
           from real to integer, and from higher precision real to lower precision real values.  This option  is
           also enabled by -Wconversion.

       -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess
           Warn for suspicious length parameters to certain string and memory built-in functions if the argument
           uses  "sizeof".   This  warning warns e.g.  about "memset (ptr, 0, sizeof (ptr));" if "ptr" is not an
           array, but a pointer, and suggests a possible fix, or about "memcpy  (&foo,  ptr,  sizeof  (&foo));".
           This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wmemset-transposed-args
           Warn  for  suspicious calls to the "memset" built-in function, if the second argument is not zero and
           the third argument is zero.  This warns e.g.@ about "memset (buf, sizeof buf, 0)" where most probably
           "memset (buf, 0, sizeof buf)" was meant instead.  The  diagnostics  is  only  emitted  if  the  third
           argument  is literal zero, if it is some expression that is folded to zero, or e.g. a cast of zero to
           some type etc., it is far less likely that user has mistakenly exchanged the arguments and no warning
           is emitted.  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Waddress
           Warn about suspicious uses of memory addresses. These include using the address of a  function  in  a
           conditional  expression,  such  as  "void  func(void); if (func)", and comparisons against the memory
           address of a string literal, such as "if (x == "abc")".  Such uses typically  indicate  a  programmer
           error:  the  address  of  a  function always evaluates to true, so their use in a conditional usually
           indicate that the programmer forgot the parentheses in  a  function  call;  and  comparisons  against
           string  literals  result  in unspecified behavior and are not portable in C, so they usually indicate
           that the programmer intended to use "strcmp".  This warning is enabled by -Wall.

       -Wlogical-op
           Warn about suspicious uses  of  logical  operators  in  expressions.   This  includes  using  logical
           operators in contexts where a bit-wise operator is likely to be expected.

       -Waggregate-return
           Warn  if  any  functions that return structures or unions are defined or called.  (In languages where
           you can return an array, this also elicits a warning.)

       -Wno-aggressive-loop-optimizations
           Warn if in a loop with constant number of iterations the compiler detects undefined behavior in  some
           statement during one or more of the iterations.

       -Wno-attributes
           Do  not  warn  if  an  unexpected  "__attribute__" is used, such as unrecognized attributes, function
           attributes applied to variables, etc.  This does not stop  errors  for  incorrect  use  of  supported
           attributes.

       -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
           Do  not  warn if certain built-in macros are redefined.  This suppresses warnings for redefinition of
           "__TIMESTAMP__", "__TIME__", "__DATE__", "__FILE__", and "__BASE_FILE__".

       -Wstrict-prototypes (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if a function is declared or defined without  specifying  the  argument  types.   (An  old-style
           function  definition  is  permitted without a warning if preceded by a declaration that specifies the
           argument types.)

       -Wold-style-declaration (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn for obsolescent usages, according to the C Standard, in a  declaration.  For  example,  warn  if
           storage-class  specifiers  like  "static" are not the first things in a declaration.  This warning is
           also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wold-style-definition (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if an old-style function definition is used.  A warning is given even if  there  is  a  previous
           prototype.

       -Wmissing-parameter-type (C and Objective-C only)
           A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style functions:

                   void foo(bar) { }

           This warning is also enabled by -Wextra.

       -Wmissing-prototypes (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn  if  a  global  function  is  defined without a previous prototype declaration.  This warning is
           issued even if the definition itself  provides  a  prototype.   Use  this  option  to  detect  global
           functions  that  do  not  have a matching prototype declaration in a header file.  This option is not
           valid for C++ because all function declarations provide prototypes  and  a  non-matching  declaration
           will   declare   an   overload   rather   than   conflict   with   an   earlier   declaration.    Use
           -Wmissing-declarations to detect missing declarations in C++.

       -Wmissing-declarations
           Warn if a global function is defined without a previous declaration.  Do so even  if  the  definition
           itself  provides  a  prototype.   Use this option to detect global functions that are not declared in
           header files.  In C, no warnings are issued for functions with previous  non-prototype  declarations;
           use  -Wmissing-prototype  to  detect missing prototypes.  In C++, no warnings are issued for function
           templates, or for inline functions, or for functions in anonymous namespaces.

       -Wmissing-field-initializers
           Warn if a structure's initializer has some fields missing.  For example, the  following  code  causes
           such a warning, because "x.h" is implicitly zero:

                   struct s { int f, g, h; };
                   struct s x = { 3, 4 };

           This  option  does  not  warn  about  designated initializers, so the following modification does not
           trigger a warning:

                   struct s { int f, g, h; };
                   struct s x = { .f = 3, .g = 4 };

           This warning is included in -Wextra.  To get other -Wextra warnings without  this  one,  use  -Wextra
           -Wno-missing-field-initializers.

       -Wno-multichar
           Do  not  warn  if  a  multicharacter  constant ('FOOF') is used.  Usually they indicate a typo in the
           user's code, as they have implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.

       -Wnormalized=<none|id|nfc|nfkc>
           In ISO C and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are different  sequences  of  characters.
           However,  sometimes  when characters outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can have two
           different character sequences that look the same.  To avoid confusion, the ISO  10646  standard  sets
           out  some  normalization  rules  which  when applied ensure that two sequences that look the same are
           turned into the same sequence.  GCC can warn you if you are using  identifiers  that  have  not  been
           normalized; this option controls that warning.

           There  are  four  levels  of  warning supported by GCC.  The default is -Wnormalized=nfc, which warns
           about any identifier that is not in the ISO 10646 "C" normalized form, NFC.  NFC is  the  recommended
           form for most uses.

           Unfortunately,  there  are  some  characters  allowed  in identifiers by ISO C and ISO C++ that, when
           turned into NFC, are not allowed in identifiers.  That is, there's no way to  use  these  symbols  in
           portable  ISO  C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC.  -Wnormalized=id suppresses the warning
           for these characters.  It is hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct  this,
           which is why this option is not the default.

           You  can  switch the warning off for all characters by writing -Wnormalized=none.  You should only do
           this if you are using some other normalization scheme (like "D"), because otherwise  you  can  easily
           create bugs that are literally impossible to see.

           Some  characters  in  ISO  10646  have  distinct meanings but look identical in some fonts or display
           methodologies, especially once formatting has been  applied.   For  instance  "\u207F",  "SUPERSCRIPT
           LATIN  SMALL  LETTER N", displays just like a regular "n" that has been placed in a superscript.  ISO
           10646 defines the NFKC normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form  as  well,  and
           GCC  warns  if  your code is not in NFKC if you use -Wnormalized=nfkc.  This warning is comparable to
           warning about every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be confused with the digit
           0, and so is not the default, but may be useful as a  local  coding  convention  if  the  programming
           environment cannot be fixed to display these characters distinctly.

       -Wno-deprecated
           Do not warn about usage of deprecated features.

       -Wno-deprecated-declarations
           Do  not  warn  about  uses  of  functions,  variables,  and  types  marked as deprecated by using the
           "deprecated" attribute.

       -Wno-overflow
           Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.

       -Wopenmp-simd
           Warn if the vectorizer cost model overrides the OpenMP or the Cilk Plus simd directive set  by  user.
           The -fsimd-cost-model=unlimited can be used to relax the cost model.

       -Woverride-init (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden when using designated initializers.

           This  warning  is  included  in -Wextra.  To get other -Wextra warnings without this one, use -Wextra
           -Wno-override-init.

       -Wpacked
           Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed attribute  has  no  effect  on  the
           layout  or  size  of  the  structure.   Such  structures  may be mis-aligned for little benefit.  For
           instance, in this code, the variable "f.x" in "struct bar" is misaligned  even  though  "struct  bar"
           does not itself have the packed attribute:

                   struct foo {
                     int x;
                     char a, b, c, d;
                   } __attribute__((packed));
                   struct bar {
                     char z;
                     struct foo f;
                   };

       -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
           The  4.1, 4.2 and 4.3 series of GCC ignore the "packed" attribute on bit-fields of type "char".  This
           has been fixed in GCC 4.4 but the change can lead  to  differences  in  the  structure  layout.   GCC
           informs you when the offset of such a field has changed in GCC 4.4.  For example there is no longer a
           4-bit padding between field "a" and "b" in this structure:

                   struct foo
                   {
                     char a:4;
                     char b:8;
                   } __attribute__ ((packed));

           This warning is enabled by default.  Use -Wno-packed-bitfield-compat to disable this warning.

       -Wpadded
           Warn  if  padding is included in a structure, either to align an element of the structure or to align
           the whole structure.  Sometimes when this happens it is possible  to  rearrange  the  fields  of  the
           structure to reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.

       -Wredundant-decls
           Warn  if  anything  is  declared  more  than  once  in  the  same scope, even in cases where multiple
           declaration is valid and changes nothing.

       -Wnested-externs (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn if an "extern" declaration is encountered within a function.

       -Wno-inherited-variadic-ctor
           Suppress warnings about use of C++11 inheriting constructors when the base class inherited from has a
           C variadic constructor; the warning is on by default because the ellipsis is not inherited.

       -Winline
           Warn if a function that is declared as inline cannot be inlined.  Even with this option, the compiler
           does not warn about failures to inline functions declared in system headers.

           The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or not  to  inline  a  function.   For
           example,  the  compiler  takes  into account the size of the function being inlined and the amount of
           inlining that has already been done in the  current  function.   Therefore,  seemingly  insignificant
           changes in the source program can cause the warnings produced by -Winline to appear or disappear.

       -Wno-invalid-offsetof (C++ and Objective-C++ only)
           Suppress  warnings from applying the offsetof macro to a non-POD type.  According to the 1998 ISO C++
           standard, applying offsetof to a  non-POD  type  is  undefined.   In  existing  C++  implementations,
           however,  offsetof  typically  gives meaningful results even when applied to certain kinds of non-POD
           types (such as a simple struct that fails to be a POD type only by virtue of having  a  constructor).
           This flag is for users who are aware that they are writing nonportable code and who have deliberately
           chosen to ignore the warning about it.

           The restrictions on offsetof may be relaxed in a future version of the C++ standard.

       -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
           Suppress  warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a different size. In C++, casting to a
           pointer type of smaller size is an error. Wint-to-pointer-cast is enabled by default.

       -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast (C and Objective-C only)
           Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a different size.

       -Winvalid-pch
           Warn if a precompiled header is found in the search path but can't be used.

       -Wlong-long
           Warn if long long type is used.  This is enabled by either -Wpedantic or -Wtraditional in ISO C90 and
           C++98 modes.  To inhibit the warning messages, use -Wno-long-long.

       -Wvariadic-macros
           Warn if variadic macros are used in pedantic ISO C90 mode,  or  the  GNU  alternate  syntax  when  in
           pedantic ISO C99 mode.  This is default.  To inhibit the warning messages, use -Wno-variadic-macros.

       -Wvarargs
           Warn  upon questionable usage of the macros used to handle variable arguments like va_start.  This is
           default.  To inhibit the warning messages, use -Wno-varargs.

       -Wvector-operation-performance
           Warn if vector operation is not implemented via SIMD capabilities of the architecture.  Mainly useful
           for the performance tuning.  Vector operation can be implemented "piecewise", which  means  that  the
           scalar  operation  is  performed  on every vector element; "in parallel", which means that the vector
           operation is implemented using scalars of wider type, which normally is more  performance  efficient;
           and "as a single scalar", which means that vector fits into a scalar type.

       -Wno-virtual-move-assign
           Suppress  warnings  about  inheriting  from  a  virtual base with a non-trivial C++11 move assignment
           operator.  This is dangerous because if the virtual base is reachable along more than  one  path,  it
           will  be  moved  multiple  times, which can mean both objects end up in the moved-from state.  If the
           move assignment operator is written to avoid moving from a moved-from object,  this  warning  can  be
           disabled.

       -Wvla
           Warn  if  variable length array is used in the code.  -Wno-vla prevents the -Wpedantic warning of the
           variable length array.

       -Wvolatile-register-var
           Warn if a register variable is declared  volatile.   The  volatile  modifier  does  not  inhibit  all
           optimizations  that may eliminate reads and/or writes to register variables.  This warning is enabled
           by -Wall.

       -Wdisabled-optimization
           Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled.  This warning does  not  generally  indicate  that
           there  is  anything  wrong  with  your  code; it merely indicates that GCC's optimizers are unable to
           handle the code effectively.  Often, the problem is that your code is too big  or  too  complex;  GCC
           refuses  to  optimize  programs  when the optimization itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of
           time.

       -Wpointer-sign (C and Objective-C only)
           Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with  different  signedness.   This  option  is  only
           supported  for  C  and  Objective-C.  It is implied by -Wall and by -Wpedantic, which can be disabled
           with -Wno-pointer-sign.

       -Wstack-protector
           This option is only active when -fstack-protector is active.  It warns about functions that  are  not
           protected against stack smashing.

       -Woverlength-strings
           Warn  about  string  constants  that  are longer than the "minimum maximum" length specified in the C
           standard.  Modern compilers generally allow string constants that are much longer than the standard's
           minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid using longer strings.

           The limit applies after string constant concatenation, and does not count the trailing NUL.  In  C90,
           the  limit  was  509  characters;  in C99, it was raised to 4095.  C++98 does not specify a normative
           minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++.

           This option is implied by -Wpedantic, and can be disabled with -Wno-overlength-strings.

       -Wunsuffixed-float-constants (C and Objective-C only)
           Issue a warning for any floating constant that does not have  a  suffix.   When  used  together  with
           -Wsystem-headers  it  warns  about  such  constants  in system header files.  This can be useful when
           preparing code to use  with  the  "FLOAT_CONST_DECIMAL64"  pragma  from  the  decimal  floating-point
           extension to C99.

   Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
       GCC has various special options that are used for debugging either your program or GCC:

       -g  Produce  debugging  information in the operating system's native format (stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF
           2).  GDB can work with this debugging information.

           On most systems that use stabs format, -g enables use of extra debugging information  that  only  GDB
           can use; this extra information makes debugging work better in GDB but probably makes other debuggers
           crash  or  refuse  to  read  the program.  If you want to control for certain whether to generate the
           extra information, use -gstabs+, -gstabs, -gxcoff+, -gxcoff, or -gvms (see below).

           GCC allows you to use -g with -O.  The shortcuts taken by optimized  code  may  occasionally  produce
           surprising  results:  some  variables  you declared may not exist at all; flow of control may briefly
           move where you did not expect it; some statements may not be executed because they  compute  constant
           results  or their values are already at hand; some statements may execute in different places because
           they have been moved out of loops.

           Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output.  This  makes  it  reasonable  to  use  the
           optimizer for programs that might have bugs.

           The  following  options  are  useful  when  GCC  is  generated  with the capability for more than one
           debugging format.

       -gsplit-dwarf
           Separate as much dwarf debugging information as  possible  into  a  separate  output  file  with  the
           extension  .dwo.   This option allows the build system to avoid linking files with debug information.
           To be useful, this option requires a debugger capable of reading .dwo files.

       -ggdb
           Produce debugging information for use by GDB.  This means to use the most expressive format available
           (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if
           at all possible.

       -gpubnames
           Generate dwarf .debug_pubnames and .debug_pubtypes sections.

       -ggnu-pubnames
           Generate .debug_pubnames and .debug_pubtypes sections in a format suitable for conversion into a  GDB
           index.  This option is only useful with a linker that can produce GDB index version 7.

       -gstabs
           Produce  debugging  information in stabs format (if that is supported), without GDB extensions.  This
           is the format used by DBX on most BSD systems.  On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release  4  systems  this
           option  produces  stabs debugging output that is not understood by DBX or SDB.  On System V Release 4
           systems this option requires the GNU assembler.

       -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
           Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is  supported),  for  only  symbols  that  are
           actually used.

       -femit-class-debug-always
           Instead  of  emitting  debugging  information for a C++ class in only one object file, emit it in all
           object files using the class.  This option should be used only with  debuggers  that  are  unable  to
           handle  the  way  GCC  normally  emits  debugging  information  for classes because using this option
           increases the size of debugging information by as much as a factor of two.

       -fdebug-types-section
           When using DWARF Version 4 or higher, type DIEs can be put  into  their  own  ".debug_types"  section
           instead  of  making  them  part  of the ".debug_info" section.  It is more efficient to put them in a
           separate comdat sections since the linker can then remove duplicates.  But not  all  DWARF  consumers
           support  ".debug_types"  sections  yet  and on some objects ".debug_types" produces larger instead of
           smaller debugging information.

       -gstabs+
           Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported), using GNU extensions understood
           only by the GNU debugger (GDB).  The use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers  crash
           or refuse to read the program.

       -gcoff
           Produce  debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).  This is the format used by SDB
           on most System V systems prior to System V Release 4.

       -gxcoff
           Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).  This is the format used by the
           DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.

       -gxcoff+
           Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported), using GNU extensions understood
           only by the GNU debugger (GDB).  The use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers  crash
           or  refuse  to  read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU assembler (GAS) to fail
           with an error.

       -gdwarf-version
           Produce debugging information in DWARF format (if that is supported).  The value of  version  may  be
           either 2, 3 or 4; the default version for most targets is 4.

           Note  that  with  DWARF  Version  2,  some  ports require and always use some non-conflicting DWARF 3
           extensions in the unwind tables.

           Version 4 may require GDB 7.0 and -fvar-tracking-assignments for maximum benefit.

       -grecord-gcc-switches
           This switch causes the command-line options  used  to  invoke  the  compiler  that  may  affect  code
           generation  to  be  appended  to  the  DW_AT_producer  attribute in DWARF debugging information.  The
           options are concatenated with spaces separating them from each other and from the  compiler  version.
           See  also  -frecord-gcc-switches  for  another  way of storing compiler options into the object file.
           This is the default.

       -gno-record-gcc-switches
           Disallow  appending  command-line  options  to  the  DW_AT_producer  attribute  in  DWARF   debugging
           information.

       -gstrict-dwarf
           Disallow  using  extensions  of  later DWARF standard version than selected with -gdwarf-version.  On
           most targets using non-conflicting DWARF extensions from later standard versions is allowed.

       -gno-strict-dwarf
           Allow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected with -gdwarf-version.

       -gvms
           Produce debugging information in Alpha/VMS debug format (if that is supported).  This is  the  format
           used by DEBUG on Alpha/VMS systems.

       -glevel
       -ggdblevel
       -gstabslevel
       -gcofflevel
       -gxcofflevel
       -gvmslevel
           Request  debugging information and also use level to specify how much information.  The default level
           is 2.

           Level 0 produces no debug information at all.  Thus, -g0 negates -g.

           Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in parts of the program  that  you
           don't plan to debug.  This includes descriptions of functions and external variables, and line number
           tables, but no information about local variables.

           Level  3  includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions present in the program.  Some
           debuggers support macro expansion when you use -g3.

           -gdwarf-2 does not accept a concatenated debug level, because GCC used to support an  option  -gdwarf
           that  meant  to  generate debug information in version 1 of the DWARF format (which is very different
           from version 2), and it would have been too confusing.  That debug format is long obsolete,  but  the
           option cannot be changed now.  Instead use an additional -glevel option to change the debug level for
           DWARF.

       -gtoggle
           Turn  off generation of debug info, if leaving out this option generates it, or turn it on at level 2
           otherwise.  The position of this argument in the command line does not matter; it takes effect  after
           all  other  options  are  processed,  and it does so only once, no matter how many times it is given.
           This is mainly intended to be used with -fcompare-debug.

       -fsanitize=address
           Enable  AddressSanitizer,  a  fast  memory  error  detector.   Memory  access  instructions  will  be
           instrumented      to      detect      out-of-bounds      and      use-after-free      bugs.       See
           <http://code.google.com/p/address-sanitizer/>  for  more  details.   The  run-time  behavior  can  be
           influenced        using        the        ASAN_OPTIONS        environment        variable;        see
           <https://code.google.com/p/address-sanitizer/wiki/Flags#Run-time_flags>  for  a  list  of   supported
           options.

       -fsanitize=kernel-address
           Enable            AddressSanitizer            for            Linux            kernel.             See
           <http://code.google.com/p/address-sanitizer/wiki/AddressSanitizerForKernel> for more details.

       -fsanitize=thread
           Enable ThreadSanitizer, a fast data race detector.  Memory access instructions will  be  instrumented
           to  detect  data  race  bugs.  See <http://code.google.com/p/thread-sanitizer/> for more details. The
           run-time  behavior  can  be   influenced   using   the   TSAN_OPTIONS   environment   variable;   see
           <https://code.google.com/p/thread-sanitizer/wiki/Flags> for a list of supported options.

       -fsanitize=leak
           Enable  LeakSanitizer,  a  memory leak detector.  This option only matters for linking of executables
           and if neither -fsanitize=address nor -fsanitize=thread is used.  In  that  case  it  will  link  the
           executable   against   a  library  that  overrides  "malloc"  and  other  allocator  functions.   See
           <https://code.google.com/p/address-sanitizer/wiki/LeakSanitizer>  for  more  details.   The  run-time
           behavior can be influenced using the LSAN_OPTIONS environment variable.

       -fsanitize=undefined
           Enable  UndefinedBehaviorSanitizer, a fast undefined behavior detector.  Various computations will be
           instrumented to detect undefined behavior at runtime.  Current suboptions are:

           -fsanitize=shift
               This option enables checking that the result of a shift operation is not  undefined.   Note  that
               what  exactly  is considered undefined differs slightly between C and C++, as well as between ISO
               C90 and C99, etc.

           -fsanitize=integer-divide-by-zero
               Detect integer division by zero as well as "INT_MIN / -1" division.

           -fsanitize=unreachable
               With this option, the compiler will turn the  "__builtin_unreachable"  call  into  a  diagnostics
               message call instead.  When reaching the "__builtin_unreachable" call, the behavior is undefined.

           -fsanitize=vla-bound
               This option instructs the compiler to check that the size of a variable length array is positive.
               This  option  does not have any effect in -std=c++1y mode, as the standard requires the exception
               be thrown instead.

           -fsanitize=null
               This option enables pointer checking.  Particularly,  the  application  built  with  this  option
               turned  on  will  issue  an  error  message  when it tries to dereference a NULL pointer, or if a
               reference (possibly an rvalue reference) is bound to a NULL pointer.

           -fsanitize=return
               This option enables return statement checking.  Programs built with this option  turned  on  will
               issue  an error message when the end of a non-void function is reached without actually returning
               a value.  This option works in C++ only.

           -fsanitize=signed-integer-overflow
               This option enables signed integer overflow checking.  We check that the result of "+", "*",  and
               both  unary  and binary "-" does not overflow in the signed arithmetics.  Note, integer promotion
               rules must be taken into account.  That is, the following is not an overflow:

                       signed char a = SCHAR_MAX;
                       a++;

           While -ftrapv causes  traps  for  signed  overflows  to  be  emitted,  -fsanitize=undefined  gives  a
           diagnostic message.  This currently works only for the C family of languages.

       -fdump-final-insns[=file]
           Dump  the  final  internal  representation (RTL) to file.  If the optional argument is omitted (or if
           file is "."), the name of the dump file is determined by appending ".gkd" to the  compilation  output
           file name.

       -fcompare-debug[=opts]
           If   no  error  occurs  during  compilation,  run  the  compiler  a  second  time,  adding  opts  and
           -fcompare-debug-second to the arguments passed to the second compilation.  Dump  the  final  internal
           representation in both compilations, and print an error if they differ.

           If the equal sign is omitted, the default -gtoggle is used.

           The  environment  variable  GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG,  if defined, non-empty and nonzero, implicitly enables
           -fcompare-debug.  If GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG is defined to a string starting with a dash, then it  is  used
           for opts, otherwise the default -gtoggle is used.

           -fcompare-debug=,  with  the  equal sign but without opts, is equivalent to -fno-compare-debug, which
           disables the dumping of  the  final  representation  and  the  second  compilation,  preventing  even
           GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG from taking effect.

           To   verify   full   coverage   during   -fcompare-debug   testing,   set  GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG  to  say
           -fcompare-debug-not-overridden, which GCC rejects as an invalid  option  in  any  actual  compilation
           (rather  than  preprocessing, assembly or linking).  To get just a warning, setting GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
           to -w%n-fcompare-debug not overridden will do.

       -fcompare-debug-second
           This  option  is  implicitly  passed  to  the  compiler  for  the  second  compilation  requested  by
           -fcompare-debug,  along with options to silence warnings, and omitting other options that would cause
           side-effect compiler outputs to files or to the standard output.  Dump files and preserved  temporary
           files  are  renamed so as to contain the ".gk" additional extension during the second compilation, to
           avoid overwriting those generated by the first.

           When this option is passed to the compiler driver, it causes the first  compilation  to  be  skipped,
           which makes it useful for little other than debugging the compiler proper.

       -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
           Compress DWARF 2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated information about each symbol.  This
           option only makes sense when generating DWARF 2 debugging information with -gdwarf-2.

       -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
           Emit  debug  information for struct-like types only when the base name of the compilation source file
           matches the base name of file in which the struct is defined.

           This option substantially reduces the size of debugging information,  but  at  significant  potential
           loss  in  type  information  to  the debugger.  See -femit-struct-debug-reduced for a less aggressive
           option.  See -femit-struct-debug-detailed for more detailed control.

           This option works only with DWARF 2.

       -femit-struct-debug-reduced
           Emit debug information for struct-like types only when the base name of the compilation  source  file
           matches  the  base  name  of  file  in  which the type is defined, unless the struct is a template or
           defined in a system header.

           This option significantly reduces the size of debugging information, with some potential loss in type
           information to the debugger.  See -femit-struct-debug-baseonly for a  more  aggressive  option.   See
           -femit-struct-debug-detailed for more detailed control.

           This option works only with DWARF 2.

       -femit-struct-debug-detailed[=spec-list]
           Specify  the  struct-like types for which the compiler generates debug information.  The intent is to
           reduce duplicate struct debug information between different object files within the same program.

           This option is a detailed version of  -femit-struct-debug-reduced  and  -femit-struct-debug-baseonly,
           which serves for most needs.

           A specification has the syntax[dir:|ind:][ord:|gen:](any|sys|base|none)

           The  optional  first  word  limits the specification to structs that are used directly (dir:) or used
           indirectly (ind:).  A struct type is used directly when  it  is  the  type  of  a  variable,  member.
           Indirect uses arise through pointers to structs.  That is, when use of an incomplete struct is valid,
           the use is indirect.  An example is struct one direct; struct two * indirect;.

           The  optional  second  word  limits  the  specification to ordinary structs (ord:) or generic structs
           (gen:).  Generic structs are  a  bit  complicated  to  explain.   For  C++,  these  are  non-explicit
           specializations  of  template  classes,  or non-template classes within the above.  Other programming
           languages have generics, but -femit-struct-debug-detailed does not yet implement them.

           The third word specifies the source files for those structs for which the compiler should emit  debug
           information.  The values none and any have the normal meaning.  The value base means that the base of
           name  of  the  file in which the type declaration appears must match the base of the name of the main
           compilation file.  In practice, this means that when compiling foo.c, debug information is  generated
           for  types  declared  in  that file and foo.h, but not other header files.  The value sys means those
           types satisfying base or declared in system or compiler headers.

           You may need to experiment to determine the best settings for your application.

           The default is -femit-struct-debug-detailed=all.

           This option works only with DWARF 2.

       -fno-merge-debug-strings
           Direct the linker to not merge together strings in the debugging information that  are  identical  in
           different  object  files.   Merging is not supported by all assemblers or linkers.  Merging decreases
           the size of the debug information in the output file at the cost of increasing link processing  time.
           Merging is enabled by default.

       -fdebug-prefix-map=old=new
           When  compiling  files  in  directory  old,  record  debugging  information describing them as in new
           instead.

       -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
           Emit DWARF 2 unwind info as compiler generated ".eh_frame" section  instead  of  using  GAS  ".cfi_*"
           directives.

       -p  Generate  extra  code  to write profile information suitable for the analysis program prof.  You must
           use this option when compiling the source files you want data about, and you must also  use  it  when
           linking.

       -pg Generate  extra  code to write profile information suitable for the analysis program gprof.  You must
           use this option when compiling the source files you want data about, and you must also  use  it  when
           linking.

       -Q  Makes  the  compiler  print out each function name as it is compiled, and print some statistics about
           each pass when it finishes.

       -ftime-report
           Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each pass when it finishes.

       -fmem-report
           Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory allocation when it finishes.

       -fmem-report-wpa
           Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory allocation for the WPA phase only.

       -fpre-ipa-mem-report
       -fpost-ipa-mem-report
           Makes the  compiler  print  some  statistics  about  permanent  memory  allocation  before  or  after
           interprocedural optimization.

       -fprofile-report
           Makes  the  compiler print some statistics about consistency of the (estimated) profile and effect of
           individual passes.

       -fstack-usage
           Makes the compiler output stack usage information for the program,  on  a  per-function  basis.   The
           filename for the dump is made by appending .su to the auxname.  auxname is generated from the name of
           the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an executable, otherwise it is the basename of
           the source file.  An entry is made up of three fields:

           •   The name of the function.

           •   A number of bytes.

           •   One or more qualifiers: "static", "dynamic", "bounded".

           The  qualifier  "static"  means that the function manipulates the stack statically: a fixed number of
           bytes are allocated for the frame  on  function  entry  and  released  on  function  exit;  no  stack
           adjustments are otherwise made in the function.  The second field is this fixed number of bytes.

           The qualifier "dynamic" means that the function manipulates the stack dynamically: in addition to the
           static  allocation  described  above,  stack  adjustments  are  made in the body of the function, for
           example to push/pop arguments around function calls.  If the qualifier "bounded" is also present, the
           amount of these adjustments is bounded at compile time and the second field is an upper bound of  the
           total amount of stack used by the function.  If it is not present, the amount of these adjustments is
           not bounded at compile time and the second field only represents the bounded part.

       -fprofile-arcs
           Add  code  so that program flow arcs are instrumented.  During execution the program records how many
           times each branch and call is executed and how many times it is taken or returns.  When the  compiled
           program exits it saves this data to a file called auxname.gcda for each source file.  The data may be
           used  for  profile-directed  optimizations  (-fbranch-probabilities),  or  for test coverage analysis
           (-ftest-coverage).  Each object file's auxname is generated from the name  of  the  output  file,  if
           explicitly  specified  and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is the basename of the source
           file.  In both cases any suffix is removed (e.g. foo.gcda for input file dir/foo.c,  or  dir/foo.gcda
           for output file specified as -o dir/foo.o).

       --coverage
           This  option  is  used  to compile and link code instrumented for coverage analysis.  The option is a
           synonym for -fprofile-arcs -ftest-coverage (when compiling)  and  -lgcov  (when  linking).   See  the
           documentation for those options for more details.

           •   Compile  the source files with -fprofile-arcs plus optimization and code generation options.  For
               test coverage analysis, use the additional -ftest-coverage option.  You do not  need  to  profile
               every source file in a program.

           •   Link your object files with -lgcov or -fprofile-arcs (the latter implies the former).

           •   Run  the  program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile information.  This may
               be repeated any number of times.  You can run concurrent instances of your program, and  provided
               that  the  file  system  supports locking, the data files will be correctly updated.  Also "fork"
               calls are detected and correctly handled (double counting will not happen).

           •   For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with the same optimization and
               code generation options plus -fbranch-probabilities.

           •   For test coverage analysis, use gcov to produce human readable information  from  the  .gcno  and
               .gcda files.  Refer to the gcov documentation for further information.

           With -fprofile-arcs, for each function of your program GCC creates a program flow graph, then finds a
           spanning  tree  for  the graph.  Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be instrumented:
           the compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are executed.  When an arc is the
           only exit or only entrance to a block, the instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise,
           a new basic block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.

       -ftest-coverage
           Produce a notes file that the gcov code-coverage utility can use  to  show  program  coverage.   Each
           source  file's  note  file  is  called  auxname.gcno.  Refer to the -fprofile-arcs option above for a
           description of auxname and instructions on how to generate test coverage data.  Coverage data matches
           the source files more closely if you do not optimize.

       -fdbg-cnt-list
           Print the name and the counter upper bound for all debug counters.

       -fdbg-cnt=counter-value-list
           Set the internal debug  counter  upper  bound.   counter-value-list  is  a  comma-separated  list  of
           name:value  pairs which sets the upper bound of each debug counter name to value.  All debug counters
           have the initial upper bound of "UINT_MAX"; thus "dbg_cnt()" returns true  always  unless  the  upper
           bound  is set by this option.  For example, with -fdbg-cnt=dce:10,tail_call:0, "dbg_cnt(dce)" returns
           true only for first 10 invocations.

       -fenable-kind-pass
       -fdisable-kind-pass=range-list
           This is a set of options that are used  to  explicitly  disable/enable  optimization  passes.   These
           options  are  intended  for  use  for  debugging  GCC.  Compiler users should use regular options for
           enabling/disabling passes instead.

           -fdisable-ipa-pass
               Disable IPA pass pass. pass is the pass name.  If the same pass  is  statically  invoked  in  the
               compiler  multiple times, the pass name should be appended with a sequential number starting from
               1.

           -fdisable-rtl-pass
           -fdisable-rtl-pass=range-list
               Disable RTL pass pass.  pass is the pass name.  If the same pass is  statically  invoked  in  the
               compiler  multiple times, the pass name should be appended with a sequential number starting from
               1.  range-list is a comma-separated list of function ranges or assembler names.  Each range is  a
               number pair separated by a colon.  The range is inclusive in both ends.  If the range is trivial,
               the  number  pair  can be simplified as a single number.  If the function's call graph node's uid
               falls within one of the specified ranges, the pass is disabled for that  function.   The  uid  is
               shown  in  the  function  header of a dump file, and the pass names can be dumped by using option
               -fdump-passes.

           -fdisable-tree-pass
           -fdisable-tree-pass=range-list
               Disable tree pass pass.  See -fdisable-rtl for the description of option arguments.

           -fenable-ipa-pass
               Enable IPA pass pass.  pass is the pass name.  If the same pass  is  statically  invoked  in  the
               compiler  multiple times, the pass name should be appended with a sequential number starting from
               1.

           -fenable-rtl-pass
           -fenable-rtl-pass=range-list
               Enable RTL pass pass.  See -fdisable-rtl for option argument description and examples.

           -fenable-tree-pass
           -fenable-tree-pass=range-list
               Enable tree pass pass.  See -fdisable-rtl for the description of option arguments.

           Here are some examples showing uses of these options.

                   # disable ccp1 for all functions
                      -fdisable-tree-ccp1
                   # disable complete unroll for function whose cgraph node uid is 1
                      -fenable-tree-cunroll=1
                   # disable gcse2 for functions at the following ranges [1,1],
                   # [300,400], and [400,1000]
                   # disable gcse2 for functions foo and foo2
                      -fdisable-rtl-gcse2=foo,foo2
                   # disable early inlining
                      -fdisable-tree-einline
                   # disable ipa inlining
                      -fdisable-ipa-inline
                   # enable tree full unroll
                      -fenable-tree-unroll

       -dletters
       -fdump-rtl-pass
       -fdump-rtl-pass=filename
           Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified by  letters.   This  is  used  for
           debugging  the  RTL-based  passes  of the compiler.  The file names for most of the dumps are made by
           appending a pass number and a word to the dumpname, and the files are created in the directory of the
           output file. In case of =filename option, the dump is output on the given file instead  of  the  pass
           numbered  dump  files. Note that the pass number is computed statically as passes get registered into
           the pass manager.  Thus the numbering is not related to the dynamic order of execution of passes.  In
           particular, a pass installed by a plugin could have a number over  200  even  if  it  executed  quite
           early.  dumpname is generated from the name of the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not
           an  executable,  otherwise  it  is the basename of the source file. These switches may have different
           effects when -E is used for preprocessing.

           Debug dumps can be enabled with a -fdump-rtl switch or some -d option letters.  Here are the possible
           letters for use in pass and letters, and their meanings:

           -fdump-rtl-alignments
               Dump after branch alignments have been computed.

           -fdump-rtl-asmcons
               Dump after fixing rtl statements that have unsatisfied in/out constraints.

           -fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
               Dump after auto-inc-dec discovery.  This pass is only run on architectures that have auto inc  or
               auto dec instructions.

           -fdump-rtl-barriers
               Dump after cleaning up the barrier instructions.

           -fdump-rtl-bbpart
               Dump after partitioning hot and cold basic blocks.

           -fdump-rtl-bbro
               Dump after block reordering.

           -fdump-rtl-btl1
           -fdump-rtl-btl2
               -fdump-rtl-btl1  and -fdump-rtl-btl2 enable dumping after the two branch target load optimization
               passes.

           -fdump-rtl-bypass
               Dump after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations.

           -fdump-rtl-combine
               Dump after the RTL instruction combination pass.

           -fdump-rtl-compgotos
               Dump after duplicating the computed gotos.

           -fdump-rtl-ce1
           -fdump-rtl-ce2
           -fdump-rtl-ce3
               -fdump-rtl-ce1, -fdump-rtl-ce2, and -fdump-rtl-ce3 enable dumping after the three  if  conversion
               passes.

           -fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
               Dump after hard register copy propagation.

           -fdump-rtl-csa
               Dump after combining stack adjustments.

           -fdump-rtl-cse1
           -fdump-rtl-cse2
               -fdump-rtl-cse1 and -fdump-rtl-cse2 enable dumping after the two common subexpression elimination
               passes.

           -fdump-rtl-dce
               Dump after the standalone dead code elimination passes.

           -fdump-rtl-dbr
               Dump after delayed branch scheduling.

           -fdump-rtl-dce1
           -fdump-rtl-dce2
               -fdump-rtl-dce1 and -fdump-rtl-dce2 enable dumping after the two dead store elimination passes.

           -fdump-rtl-eh
               Dump after finalization of EH handling code.

           -fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
               Dump after conversion of EH handling range regions.

           -fdump-rtl-expand
               Dump after RTL generation.

           -fdump-rtl-fwprop1
           -fdump-rtl-fwprop2
               -fdump-rtl-fwprop1  and  -fdump-rtl-fwprop2  enable  dumping  after  the  two forward propagation
               passes.

           -fdump-rtl-gcse1
           -fdump-rtl-gcse2
               -fdump-rtl-gcse1  and  -fdump-rtl-gcse2  enable  dumping  after   global   common   subexpression
               elimination.

           -fdump-rtl-init-regs
               Dump after the initialization of the registers.

           -fdump-rtl-initvals
               Dump after the computation of the initial value sets.

           -fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
               Dump after converting to cfglayout mode.

           -fdump-rtl-ira
               Dump after iterated register allocation.

           -fdump-rtl-jump
               Dump after the second jump optimization.

           -fdump-rtl-loop2
               -fdump-rtl-loop2 enables dumping after the rtl loop optimization passes.

           -fdump-rtl-mach
               Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, if that pass exists.

           -fdump-rtl-mode_sw
               Dump after removing redundant mode switches.

           -fdump-rtl-rnreg
               Dump after register renumbering.

           -fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
               Dump after converting from cfglayout mode.

           -fdump-rtl-peephole2
               Dump after the peephole pass.

           -fdump-rtl-postreload
               Dump after post-reload optimizations.

           -fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
               Dump after generating the function prologues and epilogues.

           -fdump-rtl-sched1
           -fdump-rtl-sched2
               -fdump-rtl-sched1 and -fdump-rtl-sched2 enable dumping after the basic block scheduling passes.

           -fdump-rtl-ree
               Dump after sign/zero extension elimination.

           -fdump-rtl-seqabstr
               Dump after common sequence discovery.

           -fdump-rtl-shorten
               Dump after shortening branches.

           -fdump-rtl-sibling
               Dump after sibling call optimizations.

           -fdump-rtl-split1
           -fdump-rtl-split2
           -fdump-rtl-split3
           -fdump-rtl-split4
           -fdump-rtl-split5
               -fdump-rtl-split1,  -fdump-rtl-split2, -fdump-rtl-split3, -fdump-rtl-split4 and -fdump-rtl-split5
               enable dumping after five rounds of instruction splitting.

           -fdump-rtl-sms
               Dump after modulo scheduling.  This pass is only run on some architectures.

           -fdump-rtl-stack
               Dump after conversion  from  GCC's  "flat  register  file"  registers  to  the  x87's  stack-like
               registers.  This pass is only run on x86 variants.

           -fdump-rtl-subreg1
           -fdump-rtl-subreg2
               -fdump-rtl-subreg1 and -fdump-rtl-subreg2 enable dumping after the two subreg expansion passes.

           -fdump-rtl-unshare
               Dump after all rtl has been unshared.

           -fdump-rtl-vartrack
               Dump after variable tracking.

           -fdump-rtl-vregs
               Dump after converting virtual registers to hard registers.

           -fdump-rtl-web
               Dump after live range splitting.

           -fdump-rtl-regclass
           -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
           -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
           -fdump-rtl-dfinit
           -fdump-rtl-dfinish
               These dumps are defined but always produce empty files.

           -da
           -fdump-rtl-all
               Produce all the dumps listed above.

           -dA Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.

           -dD Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to normal output.

           -dH Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.

           -dp Annotate  the  assembler  output with a comment indicating which pattern and alternative is used.
               The length of each instruction is also printed.

           -dP Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.   Also  turns  on  -dp
               annotation.

           -dx Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it.  Usually used with -fdump-rtl-expand.

       -fdump-noaddr
           When  doing  debugging  dumps,  suppress  address output.  This makes it more feasible to use diff on
           debugging dumps for compiler invocations with different compiler binaries and/or different text / bss
           / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.

       -fdump-unnumbered
           When doing debugging dumps, suppress instruction numbers and address  output.   This  makes  it  more
           feasible  to  use  diff  on  debugging  dumps  for  compiler  invocations  with different options, in
           particular with and without -g.

       -fdump-unnumbered-links
           When doing debugging dumps (see -d option above), suppress instruction numbers for the links  to  the
           previous and next instructions in a sequence.

       -fdump-translation-unit (C++ only)
       -fdump-translation-unit-options (C++ only)
           Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation unit to a file.  The file name
           is  made  by  appending .tu to the source file name, and the file is created in the same directory as
           the output file.  If the -options form is used, options controls the details of the dump as described
           for the -fdump-tree options.

       -fdump-class-hierarchy (C++ only)
       -fdump-class-hierarchy-options (C++ only)
           Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function table layout  to  a  file.   The
           file  name  is  made by appending .class to the source file name, and the file is created in the same
           directory as the output file.  If the -options form is used, options controls the details of the dump
           as described for the -fdump-tree options.

       -fdump-ipa-switch
           Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis language tree to a file.  The file
           name is generated by appending a switch specific suffix to the source file  name,  and  the  file  is
           created in the same directory as the output file.  The following dumps are possible:

           all Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps.

           cgraph
               Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused function removal, and inlining decisions.

           inline
               Dump after function inlining.

       -fdump-passes
           Dump the list of optimization passes that are turned on and off by the current command-line options.

       -fdump-statistics-option
           Enable  and  control  dumping  of  pass statistics in a separate file.  The file name is generated by
           appending a suffix ending in .statistics to the source file name, and the file is created in the same
           directory as the output file.  If the -option form is used, -stats causes counters to be summed  over
           the whole compilation unit while -details dumps every event as the passes generate them.  The default
           with no option is to sum counters for each function compiled.

       -fdump-tree-switch
       -fdump-tree-switch-options
       -fdump-tree-switch-options=filename
           Control  the  dumping  at various stages of processing the intermediate language tree to a file.  The
           file name is generated by appending a switch-specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is
           created in the same directory as the output file. In case of =filename option, the dump is output  on
           the given file instead of the auto named dump files.  If the -options form is used, options is a list
           of  - separated options which control the details of the dump.  Not all options are applicable to all
           dumps; those that are not meaningful are ignored.  The following options are available

           address
               Print the address of each node.  Usually this is not meaningful as it changes  according  to  the
               environment  and  source  file.   Its  primary  use  is  for  tying  up  a dump file with a debug
               environment.

           asmname
               If "DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME" has been set for  a  given  decl,  use  that  in  the  dump  instead  of
               "DECL_NAME".   Its primary use is ease of use working backward from mangled names in the assembly
               file.

           slim
               When dumping front-end intermediate representations, inhibit dumping of members  of  a  scope  or
               body  of  a  function merely because that scope has been reached.  Only dump such items when they
               are directly reachable by some other path.

               When dumping pretty-printed trees, this option inhibits dumping the bodies of control structures.

               When dumping RTL, print the RTL in  slim  (condensed)  form  instead  of  the  default  LISP-like
               representation.

           raw Print  a  raw  representation  of  the  tree.  By default, trees are pretty-printed into a C-like
               representation.

           details
               Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option). Also include information from  the
               optimization passes.

           stats
               Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored by every dump option).

           blocks
               Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).

           graph
               For  each  of  the  other  indicated  dump  files (-fdump-rtl-pass), dump a representation of the
               control flow graph suitable for viewing with GraphViz to file.passid.pass.dot.  Each function  in
               the file is pretty-printed as a subgraph, so that GraphViz can render them all in a single plot.

               This option currently only works for RTL dumps, and the RTL is always dumped in slim form.

           vops
               Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.

           lineno
               Enable showing line numbers for statements.

           uid Enable showing the unique ID ("DECL_UID") for each variable.

           verbose
               Enable showing the tree dump for each statement.

           eh  Enable showing the EH region number holding each statement.

           scev
               Enable showing scalar evolution analysis details.

           optimized
               Enable showing optimization information (only available in certain passes).

           missed
               Enable showing missed optimization information (only available in certain passes).

           notes
               Enable other detailed optimization information (only available in certain passes).

           =filename
               Instead  of  an  auto named dump file, output into the given file name. The file names stdout and
               stderr are treated specially and are considered already open standard streams. For example,

                       gcc -O2 -ftree-vectorize -fdump-tree-vect-blocks=foo.dump
                            -fdump-tree-pre=stderr file.c

               outputs vectorizer dump into foo.dump, while the  PRE  dump  is  output  on  to  stderr.  If  two
               conflicting  dump  filenames  are  given  for the same pass, then the latter option overrides the
               earlier one.

           all Turn on all options, except raw, slim, verbose and lineno.

           optall
               Turn on all optimization options, i.e., optimized, missed, and note.

           The following tree dumps are possible:

           original
               Dump before any tree based optimization, to file.original.

           optimized
               Dump after all tree based optimization, to file.optimized.

           gimple
               Dump each function before and after the gimplification pass to a file.  The file name is made  by
               appending .gimple to the source file name.

           cfg Dump  the control flow graph of each function to a file.  The file name is made by appending .cfg
               to the source file name.

           ch  Dump each function after copying loop headers.  The file name is made by  appending  .ch  to  the
               source file name.

           ssa Dump  SSA  related  information to a file.  The file name is made by appending .ssa to the source
               file name.

           alias
               Dump aliasing information for each function.  The file name is made by appending  .alias  to  the
               source file name.

           ccp Dump each function after CCP.  The file name is made by appending .ccp to the source file name.

           storeccp
               Dump  each  function after STORE-CCP.  The file name is made by appending .storeccp to the source
               file name.

           pre Dump trees after partial redundancy elimination.  The file name is made by appending .pre to  the
               source file name.

           fre Dump  trees  after  full  redundancy elimination.  The file name is made by appending .fre to the
               source file name.

           copyprop
               Dump trees after copy propagation.  The file name is made by appending .copyprop  to  the  source
               file name.

           store_copyprop
               Dump  trees  after store copy-propagation.  The file name is made by appending .store_copyprop to
               the source file name.

           dce Dump each function after dead code elimination.  The file name is made by appending .dce  to  the
               source file name.

           sra Dump  each  function after performing scalar replacement of aggregates.  The file name is made by
               appending .sra to the source file name.

           sink
               Dump each function after performing code sinking.  The file name is made by  appending  .sink  to
               the source file name.

           dom Dump  each  function  after  applying  dominator  tree  optimizations.   The file name is made by
               appending .dom to the source file name.

           dse Dump each function after applying dead store elimination.  The file name  is  made  by  appending
               .dse to the source file name.

           phiopt
               Dump  each  function after optimizing PHI nodes into straightline code.  The file name is made by
               appending .phiopt to the source file name.

           forwprop
               Dump each function after forward propagating single use variables.  The  file  name  is  made  by
               appending .forwprop to the source file name.

           copyrename
               Dump  each  function  after  applying  the  copy  rename  optimization.  The file name is made by
               appending .copyrename to the source file name.

           nrv Dump each function after applying the named return value optimization on generic trees.  The file
               name is made by appending .nrv to the source file name.

           vect
               Dump each function after applying vectorization of loops.  The file name  is  made  by  appending
               .vect to the source file name.

           slp Dump  each  function  after  applying  vectorization  of  basic blocks.  The file name is made by
               appending .slp to the source file name.

           vrp Dump each function after Value Range Propagation (VRP).  The file name is made by appending  .vrp
               to the source file name.

           all Enable all the available tree dumps with the flags provided in this option.

       -fopt-info
       -fopt-info-options
       -fopt-info-options=filename
           Controls  optimization  dumps from various optimization passes. If the -options form is used, options
           is a list of - separated options to select the dump details and optimizations.   If  options  is  not
           specified,  it  defaults to optimized for details and optall for optimization groups. If the filename
           is not specified, it defaults to stderr. Note that the output filename will be overwritten in case of
           multiple translation units. If a combined output from multiple translation units is  desired,  stderr
           should be used instead.

           The  options  can be divided into two groups, 1) options describing the verbosity of the dump, and 2)
           options describing which optimizations should be included. The options from both the  groups  can  be
           freely  mixed  as  they  are  non-overlapping.  However, in case of any conflicts, the latter options
           override the earlier options on the command line. Though multiple -fopt-info  options  are  accepted,
           only  one  of them can have =filename. If other filenames are provided then all but the first one are
           ignored.

           The dump verbosity has the following options

           optimized
               Print information when an optimization is successfully applied. It is up  to  a  pass  to  decide
               which  information  is  relevant. For example, the vectorizer passes print the source location of
               loops which got successfully vectorized.

           missed
               Print information about missed optimizations. Individual  passes  control  which  information  to
               include in the output. For example,

                       gcc -O2 -ftree-vectorize -fopt-info-vec-missed

               will  print  information  about  missed  optimization  opportunities from vectorization passes on
               stderr.

           note
               Print verbose information about optimizations, such as  certain  transformations,  more  detailed
               messages about decisions etc.

           all Print detailed optimization information. This includes optimized, missed, and note.

           The  second  set  of  options  describes  a group of optimizations and may include one or more of the
           following.

           ipa Enable dumps from all interprocedural optimizations.

           loop
               Enable dumps from all loop optimizations.

           inline
               Enable dumps from all inlining optimizations.

           vec Enable dumps from all vectorization optimizations.

           optall
               Enable dumps from all optimizations. This is a superset of the optimization groups listed above.

           For example,

                   gcc -O3 -fopt-info-missed=missed.all

           outputs missed optimization report from all the passes into missed.all.

           As another example,

                   gcc -O3 -fopt-info-inline-optimized-missed=inline.txt

           will output information about missed optimizations as  well  as  optimized  locations  from  all  the
           inlining passes into inline.txt.

           If  the  filename  is provided, then the dumps from all the applicable optimizations are concatenated
           into the filename.  Otherwise the dump is output onto stderr. If options is omitted, it  defaults  to
           all-optall,  which  means  dump all available optimization info from all the passes. In the following
           example, all optimization info is output on to stderr.

                   gcc -O3 -fopt-info

           Note that -fopt-info-vec-missed behaves the same as -fopt-info-missed-vec.

           As another example, consider

                   gcc -fopt-info-vec-missed=vec.miss -fopt-info-loop-optimized=loop.opt

           Here the two output filenames vec.miss and loop.opt are in conflict since only  one  output  file  is
           allowed.  In  this  case,  only the first option takes effect and the subsequent options are ignored.
           Thus  only  the  vec.miss  is  produced  which  contains  dumps  from  the  vectorizer  about  missed
           opportunities.

       -frandom-seed=string
           This  option  provides  a  seed that GCC uses in place of random numbers in generating certain symbol
           names that have to be different in every compiled file.  It is also used to place  unique  stamps  in
           coverage  data files and the object files that produce them.  You can use the -frandom-seed option to
           produce reproducibly identical object files.

           The string should be different for every file you compile.

       -fsched-verbose=n
           On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the amount of debugging  output  the
           scheduler  prints.   This  information  is  written  to  standard  error, unless -fdump-rtl-sched1 or
           -fdump-rtl-sched2 is specified, in which case it is output to the usual dump listing file, .sched1 or
           .sched2 respectively.  However for n greater than nine, the output  is  always  printed  to  standard
           error.

           For  n  greater  than  zero,  -fsched-verbose  outputs  the same information as -fdump-rtl-sched1 and
           -fdump-rtl-sched2.  For n greater than one, it also output basic block probabilities, detailed  ready
           list  information  and  unit/insn  info.   For  n  greater  than two, it includes RTL at abort point,
           control-flow and regions info.  And for n over four, -fsched-verbose also includes dependence info.

       -save-temps
       -save-temps=cwd
           Store the usual "temporary" intermediate files permanently; place them in the current  directory  and
           name  them  based on the source file.  Thus, compiling foo.c with -c -save-temps produces files foo.i
           and foo.s, as well as foo.o.  This creates a preprocessed foo.i output file even though the  compiler
           now normally uses an integrated preprocessor.

           When  used  in  combination  with the -x command-line option, -save-temps is sensible enough to avoid
           over writing an input source file with the same extension as an intermediate file.  The corresponding
           intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the source file before using -save-temps.

           If you invoke GCC in parallel, compiling several different source files that share a common base name
           in different subdirectories or the same source file compiled for multiple output destinations, it  is
           likely  that  the  different  parallel  compilers  will  interfere with each other, and overwrite the
           temporary files.  For instance:

                   gcc -save-temps -o outdir1/foo.o indir1/foo.c&
                   gcc -save-temps -o outdir2/foo.o indir2/foo.c&

           may result in foo.i and foo.o being written to simultaneously by both compilers.

       -save-temps=obj
           Store the usual "temporary" intermediate files permanently.  If the -o option is used, the  temporary
           files are based on the object file.  If the -o option is not used, the -save-temps=obj switch behaves
           like -save-temps.

           For example:

                   gcc -save-temps=obj -c foo.c
                   gcc -save-temps=obj -c bar.c -o dir/xbar.o
                   gcc -save-temps=obj foobar.c -o dir2/yfoobar

           creates foo.i, foo.s, dir/xbar.i, dir/xbar.s, dir2/yfoobar.i, dir2/yfoobar.s, and dir2/yfoobar.o.

       -time[=file]
           Report  the  CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation sequence.  For C source files, this
           is the compiler proper and assembler (plus the linker if linking is done).

           Without the specification of an output file, the output looks like this:

                   # cc1 0.12 0.01
                   # as 0.00 0.01

           The first number on each line is the "user time", that is time spent executing  the  program  itself.
           The  second  number is "system time", time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the
           program.  Both numbers are in seconds.

           With the specification of an output file, the output is appended to the named file, and it looks like
           this:

                   0.12 0.01 cc1 <options>
                   0.00 0.01 as <options>

           The "user time" and the "system time" are moved before the program name, and the  options  passed  to
           the  program  are  displayed, so that one can later tell what file was being compiled, and with which
           options.

       -fvar-tracking
           Run variable tracking pass.  It computes where variables are stored at each position in code.  Better
           debugging  information  is  then  generated  (if  the  debugging  information  format  supports  this
           information).

           It  is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (-Os, -O, -O2, ...), debugging information
           (-g) and the debug info format supports it.

       -fvar-tracking-assignments
           Annotate assignments to user variables early in the compilation and attempt to carry the  annotations
           over  throughout  the  compilation all the way to the end, in an attempt to improve debug information
           while optimizing.  Use of -gdwarf-4 is recommended along with it.

           It can be enabled even if var-tracking is  disabled,  in  which  case  annotations  are  created  and
           maintained, but discarded at the end.

       -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
           Toggle -fvar-tracking-assignments, in the same way that -gtoggle toggles -g.

       -print-file-name=library
           Print  the full absolute name of the library file library that would be used when linking---and don't
           do anything else.  With this option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints  the  file
           name.

       -print-multi-directory
           Print  the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any other switches present in the
           command line.  This directory is supposed to exist in GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.

       -print-multi-lib
           Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches that enable them.  The directory
           name is separated from the switches by ;, and each switch starts with an @ instead of the -,  without
           spaces between multiple switches.  This is supposed to ease shell processing.

       -print-multi-os-directory
           Print  the  path to OS libraries for the selected multilib, relative to some lib subdirectory.  If OS
           libraries are present in the lib subdirectory and no multilibs are used, this is usually just  .,  if
           OS  libraries  are  present  in  libsuffix  sibling  directories this prints e.g. ../lib64, ../lib or
           ../lib32, or if OS libraries are present in lib/subdir subdirectories it prints e.g.  amd64,  sparcv9
           or ev6.

       -print-multiarch
           Print the path to OS libraries for the selected multiarch, relative to some lib subdirectory.

       -print-prog-name=program
           Like -print-file-name, but searches for a program such as cpp.

       -print-libgcc-file-name
           Same as -print-file-name=libgcc.a.

           This  is  useful when you use -nostdlib or -nodefaultlibs but you do want to link with libgcc.a.  You
           can do:

                   gcc -nostdlib <files>... `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`

       -print-search-dirs
           Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of program and library directories
           gcc searches---and don't do anything else.

           This is useful when gcc prints the error message installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file
           or directory.  To resolve this you either need to put cpp0 and the other  compiler  components  where
           gcc  expects  to  find them, or you can set the environment variable GCC_EXEC_PREFIX to the directory
           where you installed them.  Don't forget the trailing /.

       -print-sysroot
           Print the target sysroot directory that is used during  compilation.   This  is  the  target  sysroot
           specified  either at configure time or using the --sysroot option, possibly with an extra suffix that
           depends on compilation options.  If no target sysroot is specified, the option prints nothing.

       -print-sysroot-headers-suffix
           Print the suffix added to the target sysroot when searching for headers, or  give  an  error  if  the
           compiler is not configured with such a suffix---and don't do anything else.

       -dumpmachine
           Print the compiler's target machine (for example, i686-pc-linux-gnu)---and don't do anything else.

       -dumpversion
           Print the compiler version (for example, 3.0)---and don't do anything else.

       -dumpspecs
           Print  the  compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else.  (This is used when GCC itself is
           being built.)

       -fno-eliminate-unused-debug-types
           Normally, when producing DWARF 2 output, GCC avoids producing debug symbol output for types that  are
           nowhere  used  in  the source file being compiled.  Sometimes it is useful to have GCC emit debugging
           information for all types declared in a compilation unit, regardless  of  whether  or  not  they  are
           actually  used in that compilation unit, for example if, in the debugger, you want to cast a value to
           a type that is not actually used in your program  (but  is  declared).   More  often,  however,  this
           results in a significant amount of wasted space.

   Options That Control Optimization
       These options control various sorts of optimizations.

       Without  any  optimization  option,  the compiler's goal is to reduce the cost of compilation and to make
       debugging produce the expected results.  Statements are independent: if  you  stop  the  program  with  a
       breakpoint  between  statements,  you  can  then assign a new value to any variable or change the program
       counter to any other statement in the function and get exactly the results you  expect  from  the  source
       code.

       Turning  on  optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve the performance and/or code size at
       the expense of compilation time and possibly the ability to debug the program.

       The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has  of  the  program.   Compiling  multiple
       files  at once to a single output file mode allows the compiler to use information gained from all of the
       files when compiling each of them.

       Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag.  Only optimizations that have a flag are  listed
       in this section.

       Most  optimizations  are  only  enabled  if  an  -O level is set on the command line.  Otherwise they are
       disabled, even if individual optimization flags are specified.

       Depending on the target and how GCC was configured, a slightly different  set  of  optimizations  may  be
       enabled  at  each  -O level than those listed here.  You can invoke GCC with -Q --help=optimizers to find
       out the exact set of optimizations that are enabled at each level.

       -O
       -O1 Optimize.  Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time,  and  a  lot  more  memory  for  a  large
           function.

           With  -O,  the  compiler  tries  to  reduce  code  size  and  execution  time, without performing any
           optimizations that take a great deal of compilation time.

           -O turns on the following optimization flags:

           -fauto-inc-dec   -fcompare-elim   -fcprop-registers   -fdce   -fdefer-pop   -fdelayed-branch    -fdse
           -fguess-branch-probability    -fif-conversion2    -fif-conversion    -fipa-pure-const   -fipa-profile
           -fipa-reference   -fmerge-constants   -fsplit-wide-types    -ftree-bit-ccp    -ftree-builtin-call-dce
           -ftree-ccp  -ftree-ch  -ftree-copyrename  -ftree-dce -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse -ftree-forwprop
           -ftree-fre -ftree-phiprop -ftree-slsr -ftree-sra -ftree-pta -ftree-ter -funit-at-a-time

           -O also turns on -fomit-frame-pointer on machines where doing so does not interfere with debugging.

       -O2 Optimize even more.  GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations that do  not  involve  a  space-
           speed  tradeoff.   As compared to -O, this option increases both compilation time and the performance
           of the generated code.

           -O2 turns on all optimization flags specified by -O.  It also turns  on  the  following  optimization
           flags:  -fthread-jumps  -falign-functions  -falign-jumps -falign-loops  -falign-labels -fcaller-saves
           -fcrossjumping  -fcse-follow-jumps   -fcse-skip-blocks  -fdelete-null-pointer-checks   -fdevirtualize
           -fdevirtualize-speculatively   -fexpensive-optimizations   -fgcse   -fgcse-lm  -fhoist-adjacent-loads
           -finline-small-functions    -findirect-inlining    -fipa-sra    -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference
           -foptimize-sibling-calls   -fpartial-inlining   -fpeephole2   -freorder-blocks    -freorder-functions
           -frerun-cse-after-loop   -fsched-interblock    -fsched-spec    -fschedule-insns     -fschedule-insns2
           -fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge -ftree-pre -ftree-vrp

           Please note the warning under -fgcse about invoking -O2 on programs that use computed gotos.

           NOTE: In Ubuntu 8.10 and later versions, -D_FORTIFY_SOURCE=2 is set by default, and is activated when
           -O  is set to 2 or higher.  This enables additional compile-time and run-time checks for several libc
           functions.  To disable, specify either -U_FORTIFY_SOURCE or -D_FORTIFY_SOURCE=0.

       -O3 Optimize yet more.  -O3  turns  on  all  optimizations  specified  by  -O2  and  also  turns  on  the
           -finline-functions,        -funswitch-loops,       -fpredictive-commoning,       -fgcse-after-reload,
           -ftree-loop-vectorize, -ftree-slp-vectorize, -fvect-cost-model, -ftree-partial-pre and -fipa-cp-clone
           options.

       -O0 Reduce compilation time and make debugging produce the expected results.  This is the default.

       -Os Optimize for size.  -Os enables all -O2 optimizations that do not typically increase code  size.   It
           also performs further optimizations designed to reduce code size.

           -Os  disables  the  following  optimization  flags:  -falign-functions   -falign-jumps  -falign-loops
           -falign-labels  -freorder-blocks  -freorder-blocks-and-partition -fprefetch-loop-arrays

       -Ofast
           Disregard strict standards compliance.  -Ofast  enables  all  -O3  optimizations.   It  also  enables
           optimizations  that  are  not valid for all standard-compliant programs.  It turns on -ffast-math and
           the Fortran-specific -fno-protect-parens and -fstack-arrays.

       -Og Optimize debugging experience.  -Og enables optimizations that do not interfere  with  debugging.  It
           should  be  the  optimization  level  of choice for the standard edit-compile-debug cycle, offering a
           reasonable level of optimization while maintaining fast compilation and a good debugging experience.

           If you use multiple -O options, with or without level numbers, the last such option is the  one  that
           is effective.

       Options of the form -fflag specify machine-independent flags.  Most flags have both positive and negative
       forms; the negative form of -ffoo is -fno-foo.  In the table below, only one of the forms is listed---the
       one you typically use.  You can figure out the other form by either removing no- or adding it.

       The  following  options  control  specific optimizations.  They are either activated by -O options or are
       related to ones that are.  You can use the following flags  in  the  rare  cases  when  "fine-tuning"  of
       optimizations to be performed is desired.

       -fno-defer-pop
           Always  pop  the arguments to each function call as soon as that function returns.  For machines that
           must pop arguments after a function call, the compiler normally  lets  arguments  accumulate  on  the
           stack for several function calls and pops them all at once.

           Disabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fforward-propagate
           Perform  a forward propagation pass on RTL.  The pass tries to combine two instructions and checks if
           the result can be simplified.  If loop unrolling is active, two passes are performed and  the  second
           is scheduled after loop unrolling.

           This option is enabled by default at optimization levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -ffp-contract=style
           -ffp-contract=off   disables   floating-point  expression  contraction.   -ffp-contract=fast  enables
           floating-point expression contraction such as forming of fused multiply-add operations if the  target
           has  native  support  for  them.   -ffp-contract=on  enables floating-point expression contraction if
           allowed by  the  language  standard.   This  is  currently  not  implemented  and  treated  equal  to
           -ffp-contract=off.

           The default is -ffp-contract=fast.

       -fomit-frame-pointer
           Don't  keep  the  frame  pointer  in  a  register for functions that don't need one.  This avoids the
           instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available in
           many functions.  It also makes debugging impossible on some machines.

           On some machines, such as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because  the  standard  calling  sequence
           automatically  handles  the  frame  pointer and nothing is saved by pretending it doesn't exist.  The
           machine-description macro "FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED" controls whether a target  machine  supports  this
           flag.

           Starting  with  GCC  version  4.6,  the  default  setting  (when  not optimizing for size) for 32-bit
           GNU/Linux x86 and 32-bit Darwin x86 targets has been changed to  -fomit-frame-pointer.   The  default
           can  be  reverted  to  -fno-omit-frame-pointer  by  configuring  GCC  with the --enable-frame-pointer
           configure option.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -foptimize-sibling-calls
           Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fno-inline
           Do not expand any functions inline apart from those marked with the "always_inline" attribute.   This
           is the default when not optimizing.

           Single functions can be exempted from inlining by marking them with the "noinline" attribute.

       -finline-small-functions
           Integrate  functions  into  their callers when their body is smaller than expected function call code
           (so overall size of program gets smaller).  The compiler heuristically decides  which  functions  are
           simple  enough  to  be  worth  integrating in this way.  This inlining applies to all functions, even
           those not declared inline.

           Enabled at level -O2.

       -findirect-inlining
           Inline also indirect calls that are discovered to  be  known  at  compile  time  thanks  to  previous
           inlining.    This   option   has   any  effect  only  when  inlining  itself  is  turned  on  by  the
           -finline-functions or -finline-small-functions options.

           Enabled at level -O2.

       -finline-functions
           Consider  all  functions  for  inlining,  even  if  they  are  not  declared  inline.   The  compiler
           heuristically decides which functions are worth integrating in this way.

           If  all  calls  to  a  given function are integrated, and the function is declared "static", then the
           function is normally not output as assembler code in its own right.

           Enabled at level -O3.

       -finline-functions-called-once
           Consider all "static" functions called once for inlining into their  caller  even  if  they  are  not
           marked  "inline".   If  a  call to a given function is integrated, then the function is not output as
           assembler code in its own right.

           Enabled at levels -O1, -O2, -O3 and -Os.

       -fearly-inlining
           Inline functions marked by "always_inline" and functions whose body seems smaller than  the  function
           call overhead early before doing -fprofile-generate instrumentation and real inlining pass.  Doing so
           makes  profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining faster on programs having large chains of
           nested wrapper functions.

           Enabled by default.

       -fipa-sra
           Perform  interprocedural  scalar  replacement  of  aggregates,  removal  of  unused  parameters   and
           replacement of parameters passed by reference by parameters passed by value.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3 and -Os.

       -finline-limit=n
           By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined.  This flag allows coarse control of
           this limit.  n is the size of functions that can be inlined in number of pseudo instructions.

           Inlining  is  actually  controlled  by a number of parameters, which may be specified individually by
           using --param name=value.  The -finline-limit=n option sets some of these parameters as follows:

           max-inline-insns-single
               is set to n/2.

           max-inline-insns-auto
               is set to n/2.

           See below for a documentation of the individual parameters controlling inlining and for the  defaults
           of these parameters.

           Note: there may be no value to -finline-limit that results in default behavior.

           Note:  pseudo  instruction  represents,  in  this  particular  context,  an  abstract  measurement of
           function's size.  In no way does it represent a count of assembly instructions and as such its  exact
           meaning might change from one release to an another.

       -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
           This  is a more fine-grained version of -fkeep-inline-functions, which applies only to functions that
           are declared using the "dllexport" attribute or declspec

       -fkeep-inline-functions
           In C, emit "static" functions that are declared "inline" into the object file, even if  the  function
           has  been  inlined  into all of its callers.  This switch does not affect functions using the "extern
           inline" extension in GNU C90.  In C++, emit any and all inline functions into the object file.

       -fkeep-static-consts
           Emit variables declared "static const" when optimization isn't  turned  on,  even  if  the  variables
           aren't referenced.

           GCC  enables  this  option  by  default.  If you want to force the compiler to check if a variable is
           referenced, regardless of whether or not optimization is turned on, use  the  -fno-keep-static-consts
           option.

       -fmerge-constants
           Attempt  to  merge  identical  constants  (string  constants  and  floating-point  constants)  across
           compilation units.

           This option is the default for optimized compilation if the assembler and  linker  support  it.   Use
           -fno-merge-constants to inhibit this behavior.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fmerge-all-constants
           Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.

           This  option  implies  -fmerge-constants.   In addition to -fmerge-constants this considers e.g. even
           constant initialized arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating-point  types.
           Languages  like  C or C++ require each variable, including multiple instances of the same variable in
           recursive calls, to have distinct locations, so using this option results in non-conforming behavior.

       -fmodulo-sched
           Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first scheduling pass.   This  pass  looks  at
           innermost loops and reorders their instructions by overlapping different iterations.

       -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
           Perform  more  aggressive  SMS-based  modulo scheduling with register moves allowed.  By setting this
           flag certain anti-dependences edges are deleted, which triggers the generation of reg-moves based  on
           the life-range analysis.  This option is effective only with -fmodulo-sched enabled.

       -fno-branch-count-reg
           Do  not  use "decrement and branch" instructions on a count register, but instead generate a sequence
           of instructions that decrement a register, compare it  against  zero,  then  branch  based  upon  the
           result.   This  option  is  only  meaningful  on  architectures that support such instructions, which
           include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.

           The default is -fbranch-count-reg.

       -fno-function-cse
           Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction  that  calls  a  constant  function
           contain the function's address explicitly.

           This  option  results  in less efficient code, but some strange hacks that alter the assembler output
           may be confused by the optimizations performed when this option is not used.

           The default is -ffunction-cse

       -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
           If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that are initialized to zero into
           BSS.  This can save space in the resulting code.

           This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly rely on variables going  to  the
           data  section---e.g.,  so that the resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or
           make assumptions based on that.

           The default is -fzero-initialized-in-bss.

       -fthread-jumps
           Perform optimizations that check to see if a jump branches to a  location  where  another  comparison
           subsumed  by  the first is found.  If so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of
           the second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether the condition is known to
           be true or false.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fsplit-wide-types
           When using a type that occupies multiple registers, such as "long long" on a 32-bit system, split the
           registers apart and allocate them independently.  This  normally  generates  better  code  for  those
           types, but may make debugging more difficult.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fcse-follow-jumps
           In common subexpression elimination (CSE), scan through jump instructions when the target of the jump
           is  not reached by any other path.  For example, when CSE encounters an "if" statement with an "else"
           clause, CSE follows the jump when the condition tested is false.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fcse-skip-blocks
           This is similar to -fcse-follow-jumps, but causes CSE to follow jumps that  conditionally  skip  over
           blocks.   When  CSE  encounters a simple "if" statement with no else clause, -fcse-skip-blocks causes
           CSE to follow the jump around the body of the "if".

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -frerun-cse-after-loop
           Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations are performed.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fgcse
           Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass.  This pass also performs global constant  and
           copy propagation.

           Note:  When  compiling  a  program using computed gotos, a GCC extension, you may get better run-time
           performance if you disable the global common subexpression elimination pass by  adding  -fno-gcse  to
           the command line.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fgcse-lm
           When  -fgcse-lm  is  enabled, global common subexpression elimination attempts to move loads that are
           only killed by stores into themselves.  This allows a loop containing a  load/store  sequence  to  be
           changed to a load outside the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.

           Enabled by default when -fgcse is enabled.

       -fgcse-sm
           When  -fgcse-sm is enabled, a store motion pass is run after global common subexpression elimination.
           This pass attempts to move stores out of loops.  When  used  in  conjunction  with  -fgcse-lm,  loops
           containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load before the loop and a store after the loop.

           Not enabled at any optimization level.

       -fgcse-las
           When  -fgcse-las  is  enabled,  the global common subexpression elimination pass eliminates redundant
           loads that come after stores to the same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).

           Not enabled at any optimization level.

       -fgcse-after-reload
           When -fgcse-after-reload is enabled, a redundant load elimination pass  is  performed  after  reload.
           The purpose of this pass is to clean up redundant spilling.

       -faggressive-loop-optimizations
           This  option  tells the loop optimizer to use language constraints to derive bounds for the number of
           iterations of a loop.  This assumes that loop code does not invoke undefined behavior by for  example
           causing  signed  integer  overflows  or  out-of-bound  array  accesses.  The bounds for the number of
           iterations of a loop are used to guide loop unrolling and peeling and loop exit  test  optimizations.
           This option is enabled by default.

       -funsafe-loop-optimizations
           This option tells the loop optimizer to assume that loop indices do not overflow, and that loops with
           nontrivial exit condition are not infinite.  This enables a wider range of loop optimizations even if
           the   loop   optimizer   itself   cannot  prove  that  these  assumptions  are  valid.   If  you  use
           -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations, the compiler warns you if it finds this kind of loop.

       -fcrossjumping
           Perform cross-jumping transformation.  This transformation unifies equivalent  code  and  saves  code
           size.  The resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fauto-inc-dec
           Combine  increments  or decrements of addresses with memory accesses.  This pass is always skipped on
           architectures that do not have instructions to support this.  Enabled by default at -O and higher  on
           architectures that support this.

       -fdce
           Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on RTL.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fdse
           Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on RTL.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fif-conversion
           Attempt  to  transform  conditional  jumps  into  branch-less  equivalents.   This  includes  use  of
           conditional moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions,  and  some  tricks  doable  by  standard
           arithmetics.   The  use  of  conditional  execution  on  chips where it is available is controlled by
           "if-conversion2".

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fif-conversion2
           Use  conditional  execution  (where  available)  to  transform  conditional  jumps  into  branch-less
           equivalents.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fdeclone-ctor-dtor
           The  C++  ABI  requires  multiple  entry  points  for  constructors  and  destructors: one for a base
           subobject, one for a complete object, and one for a virtual destructor  that  calls  operator  delete
           afterwards.   For  a  hierarchy  with virtual bases, the base and complete variants are clones, which
           means two copies of the function.  With this option, the base and complete variants are changed to be
           thunks that call a common implementation.

           Enabled by -Os.

       -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
           Assume that programs cannot safely dereference null pointers,  and  that  no  code  or  data  element
           resides  there.   This  enables simple constant folding optimizations at all optimization levels.  In
           addition, other optimization passes in GCC use this flag to control  global  dataflow  analyses  that
           eliminate  useless  checks  for null pointers; these assume that if a pointer is checked after it has
           already been dereferenced, it cannot be null.

           Note   however   that   in   some    environments    this    assumption    is    not    true.     Use
           -fno-delete-null-pointer-checks  to  disable  this  optimization  for  programs  that  depend on that
           behavior.

           Some targets, especially embedded ones, disable this option at all levels.  Otherwise it  is  enabled
           at all levels: -O0, -O1, -O2, -O3, -Os.  Passes that use the information are enabled independently at
           different optimization levels.

       -fdevirtualize
           Attempt  to convert calls to virtual functions to direct calls.  This is done both within a procedure
           and interprocedurally as  part  of  indirect  inlining  ("-findirect-inlining")  and  interprocedural
           constant propagation (-fipa-cp).  Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fdevirtualize-speculatively
           Attempt  to convert calls to virtual functions to speculative direct calls.  Based on the analysis of
           the type inheritance graph, determine for a given call the set of  likely  targets.  If  the  set  is
           small,  preferably  of  size  1,  change the call into an conditional deciding on direct and indirect
           call.  The speculative calls enable more optimizations, such as inlining.   When  they  seem  useless
           after further optimization, they are converted back into original form.

       -fexpensive-optimizations
           Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -free
           Attempt  to  remove  redundant  extension  instructions.   This  is especially helpful for the x86-64
           architecture, which implicitly zero-extends in 64-bit registers after writing to their  lower  32-bit
           half.

           Enabled for Alpha, AArch64 and x86 at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fno-lifetime-dse
           In  C++  the value of an object is only affected by changes within its lifetime: when the constructor
           begins, the object has an indeterminate value, and any changes during the lifetime of the object  are
           dead  when  the object is destroyed.  Normally dead store elimination will take advantage of this; if
           your code relies on the value of the object storage persisting beyond the lifetime of the object, you
           can use this flag to disable this optimization.

       -flive-range-shrinkage
           Attempt to decrease register pressure through register live range shrinkage.   This  is  helpful  for
           fast processors with small or moderate size register sets.

       -fira-algorithm=algorithm
           Use  the  specified coloring algorithm for the integrated register allocator.  The algorithm argument
           can be priority, which specifies Chow's priority coloring,  or  CB,  which  specifies  Chaitin-Briggs
           coloring.   Chaitin-Briggs  coloring  is not implemented for all architectures, but for those targets
           that do support it, it is the default because it generates better code.

       -fira-region=region
           Use specified regions for the integrated register allocator.  The region argument should  be  one  of
           the following:

           all Use all loops as register allocation regions.  This can give the best results for machines with a
               small and/or irregular register set.

           mixed
               Use  all  loops except for loops with small register pressure as the regions.  This value usually
               gives the best results in most cases and for most architectures, and is enabled by  default  when
               compiling with optimization for speed (-O, -O2, ...).

           one Use  all  functions as a single region.  This typically results in the smallest code size, and is
               enabled by default for -Os or -O0.

       -fira-hoist-pressure
           Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in the code hoisting pass for decisions to  hoist  expressions.
           This option usually results in smaller code, but it can slow the compiler down.

           This option is enabled at level -Os for all targets.

       -fira-loop-pressure
           Use  IRA  to  evaluate register pressure in loops for decisions to move loop invariants.  This option
           usually results in generation of faster and smaller code on machines with large register files (>= 32
           registers), but it can slow the compiler down.

           This option is enabled at level -O3 for some targets.

       -fno-ira-share-save-slots
           Disable sharing of stack slots used for saving call-used hard registers living through a call.   Each
           hard register gets a separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are larger.

       -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
           Disable  sharing  of  stack slots allocated for pseudo-registers.  Each pseudo-register that does not
           get a hard register gets a separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are larger.

       -fira-verbose=n
           Control the verbosity of the dump file for the integrated register allocator.  The default  value  is
           5.  If the value n is greater or equal to 10, the dump output is sent to stderr using the same format
           as n minus 10.

       -fdelayed-branch
           If  supported  for  the  target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to exploit instruction slots
           available after delayed branch instructions.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fschedule-insns
           If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to  eliminate  execution  stalls
           due  to required data being unavailable.  This helps machines that have slow floating point or memory
           load instructions by allowing other instructions to be  issued  until  the  result  of  the  load  or
           floating-point instruction is required.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -fschedule-insns2
           Similar to -fschedule-insns, but requests an additional pass of instruction scheduling after register
           allocation  has  been  done.  This is especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
           registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fno-sched-interblock
           Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks.  This is normally enabled by default when scheduling
           before register allocation, i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fno-sched-spec
           Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions.  This is normally enabled  by  default  when
           scheduling before register allocation, i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-pressure
           Enable register pressure sensitive insn scheduling before register allocation.  This only makes sense
           when  scheduling  before  register  allocation  is  enabled,  i.e. with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or
           higher.  Usage of this option can improve the generated code and  decrease  its  size  by  preventing
           register  pressure  increase  above  the  number of available hard registers and subsequent spills in
           register allocation.

       -fsched-spec-load
           Allow speculative motion of some load instructions.  This only makes  sense  when  scheduling  before
           register allocation, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
           Allow  speculative  motion  of  more load instructions.  This only makes sense when scheduling before
           register allocation, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-stalled-insns
       -fsched-stalled-insns=n
           Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the queue  of  stalled  insns  into  the
           ready list during the second scheduling pass.  -fno-sched-stalled-insns means that no insns are moved
           prematurely,  -fsched-stalled-insns=0  means  there is no limit on how many queued insns can be moved
           prematurely.  -fsched-stalled-insns without a value is equivalent to -fsched-stalled-insns=1.

       -fsched-stalled-insns-dep
       -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=n
           Define how many insn groups (cycles) are examined for a dependency  on  a  stalled  insn  that  is  a
           candidate  for premature removal from the queue of stalled insns.  This has an effect only during the
           second scheduling pass, and only if -fsched-stalled-insns is used.   -fno-sched-stalled-insns-dep  is
           equivalent  to  -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=0.  -fsched-stalled-insns-dep without a value is equivalent
           to -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=1.

       -fsched2-use-superblocks
           When scheduling after register allocation, use superblock  scheduling.   This  allows  motion  across
           basic  block  boundaries,  resulting  in  faster  schedules.  This option is experimental, as not all
           machine descriptions used by GCC model the CPU closely enough to avoid unreliable  results  from  the
           algorithm.

           This  only  makes  sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e. with -fschedule-insns2 or at
           -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-group-heuristic
           Enable the group heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors the instruction that belongs to a
           schedule group.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or
           -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
           Enable the critical-path heuristic in the scheduler.   This  heuristic  favors  instructions  on  the
           critical  path.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or
           -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
           Enable the speculative instruction heuristic in the scheduler.   This  heuristic  favors  speculative
           instructions  with  greater  dependency  weakness.   This  is  enabled  by default when scheduling is
           enabled, i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-rank-heuristic
           Enable the rank heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors the  instruction  belonging  to  a
           basic  block  with greater size or frequency.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled,
           i.e.  with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-last-insn-heuristic
           Enable the last-instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors the  instruction  that
           is  less  dependent on the last instruction scheduled.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is
           enabled, i.e. with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
           Enable the dependent-count heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors  the  instruction  that
           has  more  instructions depending on it.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.
           with -fschedule-insns or -fschedule-insns2 or at -O2 or higher.

       -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
           Modulo scheduling is performed before traditional scheduling.  If a loop is modulo  scheduled,  later
           scheduling passes may change its schedule.  Use this option to control that behavior.

       -fselective-scheduling
           Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective scheduling runs instead of the
           first scheduler pass.

       -fselective-scheduling2
           Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective scheduling runs instead of the
           second scheduler pass.

       -fsel-sched-pipelining
           Enable software pipelining of innermost loops during selective scheduling.  This option has no effect
           unless one of -fselective-scheduling or -fselective-scheduling2 is turned on.

       -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
           When  pipelining  loops  during  selective scheduling, also pipeline outer loops.  This option has no
           effect unless -fsel-sched-pipelining is turned on.

       -fshrink-wrap
           Emit function prologues only before parts of the function that need it, rather than at the top of the
           function.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fcaller-saves
           Enable allocation of values to registers that are clobbered by  function  calls,  by  emitting  extra
           instructions  to save and restore the registers around such calls.  Such allocation is done only when
           it seems to result in better code.

           This option is always enabled by default on certain machines,  usually  those  which  have  no  call-
           preserved registers to use instead.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fcombine-stack-adjustments
           Tracks stack adjustments (pushes and pops) and stack memory references and then tries to find ways to
           combine them.

           Enabled by default at -O1 and higher.

       -fconserve-stack
           Attempt  to  minimize stack usage.  The compiler attempts to use less stack space, even if that makes
           the program slower.  This option implies setting the  large-stack-frame  parameter  to  100  and  the
           large-stack-frame-growth parameter to 400.

       -ftree-reassoc
           Perform reassociation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-pre
           Perform  partial  redundancy  elimination (PRE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and
           -O3.

       -ftree-partial-pre
           Make partial redundancy elimination (PRE) more aggressive.  This flag is enabled by default at -O3.

       -ftree-forwprop
           Perform forward propagation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-fre
           Perform full redundancy elimination (FRE) on trees.  The difference between FRE and PRE is  that  FRE
           only considers expressions that are computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation.  This
           analysis  is  faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.  This flag is enabled by default
           at -O and higher.

       -ftree-phiprop
           Perform hoisting of loads from conditional pointers on trees.  This pass is enabled by default at  -O
           and higher.

       -fhoist-adjacent-loads
           Speculatively  hoist  loads  from  both  branches  of  an if-then-else if the loads are from adjacent
           locations in the same structure and the target architecture has a conditional move instruction.  This
           flag is enabled by default at -O2 and higher.

       -ftree-copy-prop
           Perform copy propagation on trees.  This pass eliminates unnecessary copy operations.  This  flag  is
           enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fipa-pure-const
           Discover which functions are pure or constant.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fipa-reference
           Discover  which  static  variables  do not escape the compilation unit.  Enabled by default at -O and
           higher.

       -fipa-pta
           Perform interprocedural pointer analysis and interprocedural  modification  and  reference  analysis.
           This  option can cause excessive memory and compile-time usage on large compilation units.  It is not
           enabled by default at any optimization level.

       -fipa-profile
           Perform interprocedural profile propagation.  The functions  called  only  from  cold  functions  are
           marked  as  cold.  Also  functions  executed once (such as "cold", "noreturn", static constructors or
           destructors) are identified. Cold functions and loop less parts of functions executed once  are  then
           optimized for size.  Enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -fipa-cp
           Perform  interprocedural  constant  propagation.  This optimization analyzes the program to determine
           when values passed to functions are constants and then optimizes accordingly.  This optimization  can
           substantially  increase  performance if the application has constants passed to functions.  This flag
           is enabled by default at -O2, -Os and -O3.

       -fipa-cp-clone
           Perform function cloning to  make  interprocedural  constant  propagation  stronger.   When  enabled,
           interprocedural  constant  propagation performs function cloning when externally visible function can
           be called with  constant  arguments.   Because  this  optimization  can  create  multiple  copies  of
           functions,  it  may significantly increase code size (see --param ipcp-unit-growth=value).  This flag
           is enabled by default at -O3.

       -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference
           Detect paths which trigger erroneous or undefined behaviour due  to  dereferencing  a  NULL  pointer.
           Isolate  those  paths  from  the main control flow and turn the statement with erroneous or undefined
           behaviour into a trap.

       -fisolate-erroneous-paths-attribute
           Detect paths which trigger erroneous or undefined behaviour due a NULL value  being  used  in  a  way
           which  is forbidden by a "returns_nonnull" or "nonnull" attribute.  Isolate those paths from the main
           control flow and turn the statement with erroneous or undefined behaviour into a trap.  This  is  not
           currently enabled, but may be enabled by "-O2" in the future.

       -ftree-sink
           Perform forward store motion  on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-bit-ccp
           Perform  sparse  conditional  bit  constant  propagation  on  trees  and  propagate pointer alignment
           information.  This pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default at  -O  and
           higher.  It requires that -ftree-ccp is enabled.

       -ftree-ccp
           Perform  sparse  conditional  constant  propagation (CCP) on trees.  This pass only operates on local
           scalar variables and is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-switch-conversion
           Perform conversion of simple initializations in a switch to  initializations  from  a  scalar  array.
           This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and higher.

       -ftree-tail-merge
           Look  for  identical  code  sequences.   When  found,  replace  one  with  a jump to the other.  This
           optimization is known as tail merging or cross jumping.  This flag is enabled by default at  -O2  and
           higher.   The compilation time in this pass can be limited using max-tail-merge-comparisons parameter
           and max-tail-merge-iterations parameter.

       -ftree-dce
           Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-builtin-call-dce
           Perform conditional dead code elimination (DCE) for calls to built-in functions that may set  "errno"
           but  are otherwise side-effect free.  This flag is enabled by default at -O2 and higher if -Os is not
           also specified.

       -ftree-dominator-opts
           Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy propagation, redundancy elimination, range
           propagation and expression simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal.  This  also  performs
           jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-dse
           Perform  dead  store elimination (DSE) on trees.  A dead store is a store into a memory location that
           is later overwritten by another store without any intervening loads.  In this case the earlier  store
           can be deleted.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-ch
           Perform  loop  header  copying on trees.  This is beneficial since it increases effectiveness of code
           motion optimizations.  It also saves one jump.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.  It
           is not enabled for -Os, since it usually increases code size.

       -ftree-loop-optimize
           Perform loop optimizations on trees.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-loop-linear
           Perform loop interchange transformations on tree.  Same as  -floop-interchange.   To  use  this  code
           transformation, GCC has to be configured with --with-ppl and --with-cloog to enable the Graphite loop
           transformation infrastructure.

       -floop-interchange
           Perform loop interchange transformations on loops.  Interchanging two nested loops switches the inner
           and outer loops.  For example, given a loop like:

                   DO J = 1, M
                     DO I = 1, N
                       A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           loop interchange transforms the loop as if it were written:

                   DO I = 1, N
                     DO J = 1, M
                       A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           which  can  be  beneficial when "N" is larger than the caches, because in Fortran, the elements of an
           array are stored in memory contiguously  by  column,  and  the  original  loop  iterates  over  rows,
           potentially  creating  at  each  access a cache miss.  This optimization applies to all the languages
           supported by GCC and is not limited to Fortran.  To use this  code  transformation,  GCC  has  to  be
           configured   with   --with-ppl   and   --with-cloog   to  enable  the  Graphite  loop  transformation
           infrastructure.

       -floop-strip-mine
           Perform loop strip mining transformations on loops.  Strip mining  splits  a  loop  into  two  nested
           loops.   The  outer  loop  has  strides equal to the strip size and the inner loop has strides of the
           original loop within a strip.  The  strip  length  can  be  changed  using  the  loop-block-tile-size
           parameter.  For example, given a loop like:

                   DO I = 1, N
                     A(I) = A(I) + C
                   ENDDO

           loop strip mining transforms the loop as if it were written:

                   DO II = 1, N, 51
                     DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
                       A(I) = A(I) + C
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           This  optimization  applies  to all the languages supported by GCC and is not limited to Fortran.  To
           use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured with --with-ppl and --with-cloog to enable the
           Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.

       -floop-block
           Perform loop blocking transformations on loops.  Blocking strip mines each loop in the loop nest such
           that the memory accesses of the element loops fit inside caches.  The strip  length  can  be  changed
           using the loop-block-tile-size parameter.  For example, given a loop like:

                   DO I = 1, N
                     DO J = 1, M
                       A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           loop blocking transforms the loop as if it were written:

                   DO II = 1, N, 51
                     DO JJ = 1, M, 51
                       DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
                         DO J = JJ, min (JJ + 50, M)
                           A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
                         ENDDO
                       ENDDO
                     ENDDO
                   ENDDO

           which  can be beneficial when "M" is larger than the caches, because the innermost loop iterates over
           a smaller amount of data which can be kept in the caches.   This  optimization  applies  to  all  the
           languages  supported  by GCC and is not limited to Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has
           to be configured with  --with-ppl  and  --with-cloog  to  enable  the  Graphite  loop  transformation
           infrastructure.

       -fgraphite-identity
           Enable  the  identity  transformation  for  graphite.   For  every  SCoP  we  generate the polyhedral
           representation and transform it back to gimple.  Using -fgraphite-identity we can check the costs  or
           benefits  of  the  GIMPLE  -> GRAPHITE -> GIMPLE transformation.  Some minimal optimizations are also
           performed by the code generator CLooG, like index splitting and dead code elimination in loops.

       -floop-nest-optimize
           Enable the ISL based loop nest optimizer.  This is a generic loop nest optimizer based on  the  Pluto
           optimization algorithms.  It calculates a loop structure optimized for data-locality and parallelism.
           This option is experimental.

       -floop-parallelize-all
           Use  the  Graphite  data dependence analysis to identify loops that can be parallelized.  Parallelize
           all the loops that can be analyzed to not contain loop carried dependences without checking  that  it
           is profitable to parallelize the loops.

       -fcheck-data-deps
           Compare the results of several data dependence analyzers.  This option is used for debugging the data
           dependence analyzers.

       -ftree-loop-if-convert
           Attempt to transform conditional jumps in the innermost loops to branch-less equivalents.  The intent
           is  to  remove  control-flow  from  the  innermost  loops  in  order  to  improve  the ability of the
           vectorization pass to handle these loops.  This is enabled by default if vectorization is enabled.

       -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores
           Attempt to also if-convert conditional jumps containing memory writes.  This  transformation  can  be
           unsafe  for  multi-threaded  programs  as  it transforms conditional memory writes into unconditional
           memory writes.  For example,

                   for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
                     if (cond)
                       A[i] = expr;

           is transformed to

                   for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
                     A[i] = cond ? expr : A[i];

           potentially producing data races.

       -ftree-loop-distribution
           Perform loop distribution.  This flag can improve cache performance on  big  loop  bodies  and  allow
           further  loop  optimizations, like parallelization or vectorization, to take place.  For example, the
           loop

                   DO I = 1, N
                     A(I) = B(I) + C
                     D(I) = E(I) * F
                   ENDDO

           is transformed to

                   DO I = 1, N
                      A(I) = B(I) + C
                   ENDDO
                   DO I = 1, N
                      D(I) = E(I) * F
                   ENDDO

       -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns
           Perform loop distribution of patterns that can be code generated with calls to a library.  This  flag
           is enabled by default at -O3.

           This pass distributes the initialization loops and generates a call to memset zero.  For example, the
           loop

                   DO I = 1, N
                     A(I) = 0
                     B(I) = A(I) + I
                   ENDDO

           is transformed to

                   DO I = 1, N
                      A(I) = 0
                   ENDDO
                   DO I = 1, N
                      B(I) = A(I) + I
                   ENDDO

           and the initialization loop is transformed into a call to memset zero.

       -ftree-loop-im
           Perform  loop  invariant motion on trees.  This pass moves only invariants that are hard to handle at
           RTL level  (function  calls,  operations  that  expand  to  nontrivial  sequences  of  insns).   With
           -funswitch-loops  it also moves operands of conditions that are invariant out of the loop, so that we
           can use just trivial invariantness analysis in  loop  unswitching.   The  pass  also  includes  store
           motion.

       -ftree-loop-ivcanon
           Create  a  canonical  counter  for  number  of  iterations  in  loops for which determining number of
           iterations requires complicated analysis.  Later optimizations then may determine the number  easily.
           Useful especially in connection with unrolling.

       -fivopts
           Perform  induction  variable  optimizations  (strength  reduction,  induction  variable  merging  and
           induction variable elimination) on trees.

       -ftree-parallelize-loops=n
           Parallelize loops, i.e., split their iteration space to run in n threads.  This is only possible  for
           loops  whose  iterations  are independent and can be arbitrarily reordered.  The optimization is only
           profitable on multiprocessor machines, for loops that are CPU-intensive, rather than constrained e.g.
           by memory bandwidth.  This option implies -pthread, and thus is only supported on targets  that  have
           support for -pthread.

       -ftree-pta
           Perform  function-local  points-to  analysis  on  trees.   This  flag is enabled by default at -O and
           higher.

       -ftree-sra
           Perform scalar replacement of aggregates.  This pass replaces structure references  with  scalars  to
           prevent committing structures to memory too early.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-copyrename
           Perform copy renaming on trees.  This pass attempts to rename compiler temporaries to other variables
           at  copy  locations,  usually  resulting  in  variable names which more closely resemble the original
           variables.  This flag is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-coalesce-inlined-vars
           Tell the copyrename pass (see -ftree-copyrename) to attempt to combine small  user-defined  variables
           too,  but  only  if  they  were  inlined  from  other  functions.   It  is  a  more  limited  form of
           -ftree-coalesce-vars.  This may harm debug information of such inlined variables, but  it  will  keep
           variables  of  the  inlined-into  function  apart  from each other, such that they are more likely to
           contain the expected values in a debugging session.  This was the default in GCC versions older  than
           4.7.

       -ftree-coalesce-vars
           Tell  the  copyrename pass (see -ftree-copyrename) to attempt to combine small user-defined variables
           too, instead of just compiler temporaries.  This may severely limit the ability to debug an optimized
           program compiled with -fno-var-tracking-assignments.  In the negated form,  this  flag  prevents  SSA
           coalescing of user variables, including inlined ones.  This option is enabled by default.

       -ftree-ter
           Perform  temporary  expression  replacement  during  the  SSA->normal  phase.   Single use/single def
           temporaries are replaced at their use location with their defining expression.  This results in  non-
           GIMPLE  code,  but  gives  the  expanders  much more complex trees to work on resulting in better RTL
           generation.  This is enabled by default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-slsr
           Perform straight-line strength reduction on trees.  This  recognizes  related  expressions  involving
           multiplications  and  replaces them by less expensive calculations when possible.  This is enabled by
           default at -O and higher.

       -ftree-vectorize
           Perform vectorization on trees. This flag enables -ftree-loop-vectorize and  -ftree-slp-vectorize  if
           not explicitly specified.

       -ftree-loop-vectorize
           Perform loop vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at -O3 and when -ftree-vectorize
           is enabled.

       -ftree-slp-vectorize
           Perform  basic  block  vectorization  on  trees.  This  flag  is  enabled  by default at -O3 and when
           -ftree-vectorize is enabled.

       -fvect-cost-model=model
           Alter the cost model used for vectorization.  The  model  argument  should  be  one  of  "unlimited",
           "dynamic"  or  "cheap".   With  the  "unlimited"  model  the  vectorized  code-path  is assumed to be
           profitable while with the "dynamic" model a runtime check will  guard  the  vectorized  code-path  to
           enable  it only for iteration counts that will likely execute faster than when executing the original
           scalar loop.  The "cheap" model will disable vectorization of loops where  doing  so  would  be  cost
           prohibitive for example due to required runtime checks for data dependence or alignment but otherwise
           is  equal  to the "dynamic" model.  The default cost model depends on other optimization flags and is
           either "dynamic" or "cheap".

       -fsimd-cost-model=model
           Alter the cost model used for vectorization of loops  marked  with  the  OpenMP  or  Cilk  Plus  simd
           directive.  The model argument should be one of "unlimited", "dynamic", "cheap".  All values of model
           have  the  same  meaning  as  described in -fvect-cost-model and by default a cost model defined with
           -fvect-cost-model is used.

       -ftree-vrp
           Perform Value Range Propagation on trees.  This is similar to  the  constant  propagation  pass,  but
           instead of values, ranges of values are propagated.  This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary
           range  checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks.  This is enabled by default at -O2 and
           higher.  Null pointer check elimination is only done if -fdelete-null-pointer-checks is enabled.

       -ftracer
           Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation simplifies the control flow
           of the function allowing other optimizations to do a better job.

       -funroll-loops
           Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or upon entry to the  loop.
           -funroll-loops  implies  -frerun-cse-after-loop.   This  option makes code larger, and may or may not
           make it run faster.

       -funroll-all-loops
           Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when the  loop  is  entered.   This
           usually   makes   programs   run  more  slowly.   -funroll-all-loops  implies  the  same  options  as
           -funroll-loops,

       -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
           Enables expression of values of induction variables in later iterations of the  unrolled  loop  using
           the  value  in the first iteration.  This breaks long dependency chains, thus improving efficiency of
           the scheduling passes.

           A combination of -fweb and CSE is often sufficient to obtain the same effect.  However, that  is  not
           reliable  in  cases  where the loop body is more complicated than a single basic block.  It also does
           not work at all on some architectures due to restrictions in the CSE pass.

           This optimization is enabled by default.

       -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
           With this option, the compiler creates multiple copies of some local variables when unrolling a loop,
           which can result in superior code.

       -fpartial-inlining
           Inline parts of functions.  This option has any effect only when inlining itself is turned on by  the
           -finline-functions or -finline-small-functions options.

           Enabled at level -O2.

       -fpredictive-commoning
           Perform  predictive  commoning  optimization, i.e., reusing computations (especially memory loads and
           stores) performed in previous iterations of loops.

           This option is enabled at level -O3.

       -fprefetch-loop-arrays
           If supported by the  target  machine,  generate  instructions  to  prefetch  memory  to  improve  the
           performance of loops that access large arrays.

           This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly dependent on the structure of loops
           within the source code.

           Disabled at level -Os.

       -fno-peephole
       -fno-peephole2
           Disable  any  machine-specific  peephole  optimizations.   The  difference  between -fno-peephole and
           -fno-peephole2 is in how they are implemented in the compiler; some targets use  one,  some  use  the
           other, a few use both.

           -fpeephole is enabled by default.  -fpeephole2 enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fno-guess-branch-probability
           Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.

           GCC  uses  heuristics  to  guess  branch probabilities if they are not provided by profiling feedback
           (-fprofile-arcs).   These  heuristics  are  based  on  the  control  flow  graph.   If  some   branch
           probabilities  are  specified  by  __builtin_expect,  then  the  heuristics  are used to guess branch
           probabilities for the rest of the control flow graph, taking the __builtin_expect info into  account.
           The  interactions  between  the heuristics and __builtin_expect can be complex, and in some cases, it
           may be useful to disable the heuristics so  that  the  effects  of  __builtin_expect  are  easier  to
           understand.

           The default is -fguess-branch-probability at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -freorder-blocks
           Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of taken branches and improve
           code locality.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -freorder-blocks-and-partition
           In  addition  to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in order to reduce number of taken
           branches, partitions hot and cold basic blocks into separate sections of the assembly and  .o  files,
           to improve paging and cache locality performance.

           This  optimization  is  automatically  turned off in the presence of exception handling, for linkonce
           sections, for functions with a user-defined section attribute and on any architecture that  does  not
           support named sections.

           Enabled for x86 at levels -O2, -O3.

       -freorder-functions
           Reorder functions in the object file in order to improve code locality.  This is implemented by using
           special  subsections  ".text.hot"  for  most  frequently  executed functions and ".text.unlikely" for
           unlikely executed functions.  Reordering is done by the linker so object  file  format  must  support
           named sections and linker must place them in a reasonable way.

           Also  profile  feedback  must  be  available  to  make this option effective.  See -fprofile-arcs for
           details.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fstrict-aliasing
           Allow the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to the language being  compiled.
           For  C  (and  C++), this activates optimizations based on the type of expressions.  In particular, an
           object of one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an object of a  different  type,
           unless  the  types are almost the same.  For example, an "unsigned int" can alias an "int", but not a
           "void*" or a "double".  A character type may alias any other type.

           Pay special attention to code like this:

                   union a_union {
                     int i;
                     double d;
                   };

                   int f() {
                     union a_union t;
                     t.d = 3.0;
                     return t.i;
                   }

           The practice of reading from a different union member than the one most recently written  to  (called
           "type-punning") is common.  Even with -fstrict-aliasing, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
           is  accessed  through  the  union  type.  So, the code above works as expected.    However, this code
           might not:

                   int f() {
                     union a_union t;
                     int* ip;
                     t.d = 3.0;
                     ip = &t.i;
                     return *ip;
                   }

           Similarly, access by taking the address, casting the resulting pointer and dereferencing  the  result
           has undefined behavior, even if the cast uses a union type, e.g.:

                   int f() {
                     double d = 3.0;
                     return ((union a_union *) &d)->i;
                   }

           The -fstrict-aliasing option is enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fstrict-overflow
           Allow  the compiler to assume strict signed overflow rules, depending on the language being compiled.
           For C (and C++) this means that overflow when doing arithmetic  with  signed  numbers  is  undefined,
           which  means  that  the  compiler  may  assume  that  it  does  not  happen.   This  permits  various
           optimizations.  For example, the compiler assumes that an expression like "i + 10 > i" is always true
           for signed "i".  This assumption is only valid if signed overflow is undefined, as the expression  is
           false if "i + 10" overflows when using twos complement arithmetic.  When this option is in effect any
           attempt  to  determine  whether an operation on signed numbers overflows must be written carefully to
           not actually involve overflow.

           This option also allows the compiler to assume strict  pointer  semantics:  given  a  pointer  to  an
           object,  if  adding  an  offset  to  that  pointer does not produce a pointer to the same object, the
           addition is undefined.  This permits the compiler to conclude that "p + u > p" is always true  for  a
           pointer  "p"  and  unsigned integer "u".  This assumption is only valid because pointer wraparound is
           undefined, as the expression is false if "p + u" overflows using twos complement arithmetic.

           See also the -fwrapv option.  Using -fwrapv means that integer signed overflow is fully  defined:  it
           wraps.    When   -fwrapv   is   used,   there   is   no   difference  between  -fstrict-overflow  and
           -fno-strict-overflow for integers.  With -fwrapv  certain  types  of  overflow  are  permitted.   For
           example,  if  the  compiler gets an overflow when doing arithmetic on constants, the overflowed value
           can still be used with -fwrapv, but not otherwise.

           The -fstrict-overflow option is enabled at levels -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -falign-functions
       -falign-functions=n
           Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than n, skipping up to  n  bytes.   For
           instance,    -falign-functions=32    aligns   functions   to   the   next   32-byte   boundary,   but
           -falign-functions=24 aligns to the next 32-byte boundary only if this can  be  done  by  skipping  23
           bytes or less.

           -fno-align-functions and -falign-functions=1 are equivalent and mean that functions are not aligned.

           Some assemblers only support this flag when n is a power of two; in that case, it is rounded up.

           If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -falign-labels
       -falign-labels=n
           Align  all  branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to n bytes like -falign-functions.
           This option can easily make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the  branch
           target is reached in the usual flow of the code.

           -fno-align-labels and -falign-labels=1 are equivalent and mean that labels are not aligned.

           If  -falign-loops  or -falign-jumps are applicable and are greater than this value, then their values
           are used instead.

           If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default which  is  very  likely  to  be  1,
           meaning no alignment.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -falign-loops
       -falign-loops=n
           Align  loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to n bytes like -falign-functions.  If the loops
           are executed many times, this makes up for any execution of the dummy operations.

           -fno-align-loops and -falign-loops=1 are equivalent and mean that loops are not aligned.

           If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -falign-jumps
       -falign-jumps=n
           Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets where the  targets  can  only  be
           reached by jumping, skipping up to n bytes like -falign-functions.  In this case, no dummy operations
           need be executed.

           -fno-align-jumps and -falign-jumps=1 are equivalent and mean that loops are not aligned.

           If n is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.

           Enabled at levels -O2, -O3.

       -funit-at-a-time
           This   option   is   left   for   compatibility   reasons.  -funit-at-a-time  has  no  effect,  while
           -fno-unit-at-a-time implies -fno-toplevel-reorder and -fno-section-anchors.

           Enabled by default.

       -fno-toplevel-reorder
           Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and "asm" statements.  Output them in the  same  order
           that  they appear in the input file.  When this option is used, unreferenced static variables are not
           removed.  This option is intended to support existing code that relies on a particular ordering.  For
           new code, it is better to use attributes when possible.

           Enabled at level -O0.  When disabled explicitly,  it  also  implies  -fno-section-anchors,  which  is
           otherwise enabled at -O0 on some targets.

       -fweb
           Constructs  webs  as  commonly  used  for register allocation purposes and assign each web individual
           pseudo register.  This allows the register allocation pass to operate on pseudos directly,  but  also
           strengthens  several  other  optimization  passes,  such as CSE, loop optimizer and trivial dead code
           remover.  It can, however, make debugging impossible, since variables  no  longer  stay  in  a  "home
           register".

           Enabled by default with -funroll-loops.

       -fwhole-program
           Assume  that  the  current  compilation unit represents the whole program being compiled.  All public
           functions  and  variables  with  the  exception   of   "main"   and   those   merged   by   attribute
           "externally_visible"  become  static  functions  and  in  effect  are  optimized more aggressively by
           interprocedural optimizers.

           This option should not be used in combination with "-flto".   Instead  relying  on  a  linker  plugin
           should provide safer and more precise information.

       -flto[=n]
           This  option  runs  the  standard  link-time  optimizer.  When invoked with source code, it generates
           GIMPLE (one of GCC's internal representations) and writes it to special ELF sections  in  the  object
           file.   When  the  object  files are linked together, all the function bodies are read from these ELF
           sections and instantiated as if they had been part of the same translation unit.

           To use the link-time optimizer, -flto and optimization options should be specified  at  compile  time
           and during the final link.  For example:

                   gcc -c -O2 -flto foo.c
                   gcc -c -O2 -flto bar.c
                   gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.o bar.o

           The  first  two invocations to GCC save a bytecode representation of GIMPLE into special ELF sections
           inside foo.o and bar.o.  The final invocation reads the GIMPLE bytecode from foo.o and bar.o,  merges
           the  two  files into a single internal image, and compiles the result as usual.  Since both foo.o and
           bar.o are merged into a single image, this causes all the interprocedural analyses and  optimizations
           in  GCC to work across the two files as if they were a single one.  This means, for example, that the
           inliner is able to inline functions in bar.o into functions in foo.o and vice-versa.

           Another (simpler) way to enable link-time optimization is:

                   gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.c bar.c

           The above generates bytecode for  foo.c  and  bar.c,  merges  them  together  into  a  single  GIMPLE
           representation and optimizes them as usual to produce myprog.

           The  only  important  thing to keep in mind is that to enable link-time optimizations you need to use
           the GCC driver to perform the link-step.  GCC then automatically performs link-time  optimization  if
           any  of  the  objects  involved  were  compiled  with  the  -flto.   You generally should specify the
           optimization options to be used for link-time optimization though  GCC  will  try  to  be  clever  at
           guessing  an  optimization  level to use from the options used at compile-time if you fail to specify
           one at link-time.  You can always override the automatic decision to  do  link-time  optimization  at
           link-time by passing -fno-lto to the link command.

           To  make  whole  program  optimization  effective,  it  is  necessary  to  make certain whole program
           assumptions.  The compiler needs to know what functions and variables can be  accessed  by  libraries
           and runtime outside of the link-time optimized unit.  When supported by the linker, the linker plugin
           (see  -fuse-linker-plugin)  passes  information  to  the  compiler  about used and externally visible
           symbols.  When the linker plugin is not available,  -fwhole-program  should  be  used  to  allow  the
           compiler to make these assumptions, which leads to more aggressive optimization decisions.

           When  -fuse-linker-plugin  is  not  enabled  then,  when a file is compiled with -flto, the generated
           object file is larger than a regular object file because it contains GIMPLE bytecodes and  the  usual
           final  code  (see -ffat-lto-objects.  This means that object files with LTO information can be linked
           as normal object files; if -fno-lto is passed to the linker,  no  interprocedural  optimizations  are
           applied.   Note  that when -fno-fat-lto-objects is enabled the compile-stage is faster but you cannot
           perform a regular, non-LTO link on them.

           Additionally, the optimization flags used to compile individual files are not necessarily related  to
           those used at link time.  For instance,

                   gcc -c -O0 -ffat-lto-objects -flto foo.c
                   gcc -c -O0 -ffat-lto-objects -flto bar.c
                   gcc -o myprog -O3 foo.o bar.o

           This  produces  individual  object  files  with  unoptimized assembler code, but the resulting binary
           myprog is optimized at -O3.  If, instead, the final binary is generated with -fno-lto, then myprog is
           not optimized.

           When producing the final binary, GCC only applies link-time optimizations to those files that contain
           bytecode.  Therefore, you can mix and match object files and  libraries  with  GIMPLE  bytecodes  and
           final  object code.  GCC automatically selects which files to optimize in LTO mode and which files to
           link without further processing.

           There are some code generation flags preserved by GCC when generating bytecodes, as they need  to  be
           used  during the final link stage.  Generally options specified at link-time override those specified
           at compile-time.

           If you do not specify an optimization level option -O at link-time then GCC will compute one based on
           the optimization levels used when compiling the object files.  The highest  optimization  level  will
           win here.

           Currently,  the  following  options  and  their  setting  are  take  from  the first object file that
           explicitely  specified  it:  -fPIC,  -fpic,  -fpie,  -fcommon,  -fexceptions,  -fnon-call-exceptions,
           -fgnu-tm and all the -m target flags.

           Certain ABI changing flags are required to match in all compilation-units and trying to override this
           at  link-time with a conflicting value is ignored.  This includes options such as -freg-struct-return
           and -fpcc-struct-return.

           Other   options   such   as   -ffp-contract,    -fno-strict-overflow,    -fwrapv,    -fno-trapv    or
           -fno-strict-aliasing  are  passed through to the link stage and merged conservatively for conflicting
           translation units.  Specifically -fno-strict-overflow, -fwrapv and -fno-trapv take precedence and for
           example -ffp-contract=off takes precedence over -ffp-contract=fast.  You can override them at  linke-
           time.

           It is recommended that you compile all the files participating in the same link with the same options
           and also specify those options at link time.

           If  LTO  encounters  objects  with C linkage declared with incompatible types in separate translation
           units to be linked together (undefined behavior according to ISO C99 6.2.7), a  non-fatal  diagnostic
           may  be  issued.  The behavior is still undefined at run time.  Similar diagnostics may be raised for
           other languages.

           Another feature of LTO is that it is possible to apply interprocedural optimizations on files written
           in different languages:

                   gcc -c -flto foo.c
                   g++ -c -flto bar.cc
                   gfortran -c -flto baz.f90
                   g++ -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o baz.o -lgfortran

           Notice that the final link is done with g++ to get the C++ runtime libraries and -lgfortran is  added
           to  get the Fortran runtime libraries.  In general, when mixing languages in LTO mode, you should use
           the same link command options as when mixing languages in a regular (non-LTO) compilation.

           If object files containing GIMPLE bytecode are stored in a  library  archive,  say  libfoo.a,  it  is
           possible  to  extract  and use them in an LTO link if you are using a linker with plugin support.  To
           create static libraries suitable for LTO, use gcc-ar and gcc-ranlib instead of ar  and  "ranlib";  to
           show  the  symbols of object files with GIMPLE bytecode, use gcc-nm.  Those commands require that ar,
           ranlib  and  nm  have  been  compiled  with  plugin  support.   At  link  time,  use  the  the   flag
           -fuse-linker-plugin to ensure that the library participates in the LTO optimization process:

                   gcc -o myprog -O2 -flto -fuse-linker-plugin a.o b.o -lfoo

           With  the linker plugin enabled, the linker extracts the needed GIMPLE files from libfoo.a and passes
           them on to the running GCC to make them part of the aggregated GIMPLE image to be optimized.

           If you are not using a linker with plugin support and/or do not enable the linker  plugin,  then  the
           objects  inside  libfoo.a  are  extracted and linked as usual, but they do not participate in the LTO
           optimization process.  In order to make a static library suitable for both LTO optimization and usual
           linkage, compile its object files with -flto "-ffat-lto-objects".

           Link-time optimizations do not require the presence of the whole program to operate.  If the  program
           does  not  require any symbols to be exported, it is possible to combine -flto and -fwhole-program to
           allow the interprocedural optimizers to use more aggressive assumptions which may  lead  to  improved
           optimization  opportunities.   Use of -fwhole-program is not needed when linker plugin is active (see
           -fuse-linker-plugin).

           The current implementation of LTO makes no attempt to generate  bytecode  that  is  portable  between
           different  types  of hosts.  The bytecode files are versioned and there is a strict version check, so
           bytecode files generated in one version of GCC will not work with an older or newer version of GCC.

           Link-time optimization does not work well with generation of debugging information.  Combining  -flto
           with -g is currently experimental and expected to produce unexpected results.

           If  you specify the optional n, the optimization and code generation done at link time is executed in
           parallel using n parallel jobs by utilizing an installed make program.  The environment variable MAKE
           may be used to override the program used.  The default value for n is 1.

           You can also specify -flto=jobserver to use GNU make's job server mode to  determine  the  number  of
           parallel  jobs.  This  is useful when the Makefile calling GCC is already executing in parallel.  You
           must prepend a + to the command recipe in the parent Makefile for this to work.  This  option  likely
           only works if MAKE is GNU make.

       -flto-partition=alg
           Specify  the  partitioning  algorithm used by the link-time optimizer.  The value is either "1to1" to
           specify a partitioning mirroring the original source files or "balanced" to specify partitioning into
           equally sized chunks (whenever possible) or "max" to create new  partition  for  every  symbol  where
           possible.   Specifying  "none"  as  an algorithm disables partitioning and streaming completely.  The
           default value is "balanced". While "1to1" can be used as an  workaround  for  various  code  ordering
           issues, the "max" partitioning is intended for internal testing only.

       -flto-compression-level=n
           This  option  specifies the level of compression used for intermediate language written to LTO object
           files, and is only meaningful in  conjunction  with  LTO  mode  (-flto).   Valid  values  are  0  (no
           compression) to 9 (maximum compression).  Values outside this range are clamped to either 0 or 9.  If
           the option is not given, a default balanced compression setting is used.

       -flto-report
           Prints  a  report  with internal details on the workings of the link-time optimizer.  The contents of
           this report vary from version to version.  It is meant to be useful to GCC developers when processing
           object files in LTO mode (via -flto).

           Disabled by default.

       -flto-report-wpa
           Like -flto-report, but only print for the WPA phase of Link Time Optimization.

       -fuse-linker-plugin
           Enables the use of a linker plugin during link-time  optimization.   This  option  relies  on  plugin
           support in the linker, which is available in gold or in GNU ld 2.21 or newer.

           This option enables the extraction of object files with GIMPLE bytecode out of library archives. This
           improves  the  quality  of  optimization  by  exposing  more  code  to the link-time optimizer.  This
           information specifies what symbols can be accessed externally (by non-LTO object  or  during  dynamic
           linking).   Resulting  code  quality  improvements  on binaries (and shared libraries that use hidden
           visibility) are similar to "-fwhole-program".  See -flto for a description of the effect of this flag
           and how to use it.

           This option is enabled by default when LTO support in GCC is enabled and GCC was configured  for  use
           with a linker supporting plugins (GNU ld 2.21 or newer or gold).

       -ffat-lto-objects
           Fat  LTO  objects  are  object files that contain both the intermediate language and the object code.
           This makes them usable for both LTO linking and normal linking. This option is  effective  only  when
           compiling with -flto and is ignored at link time.

           -fno-fat-lto-objects improves compilation time over plain LTO, but requires the complete toolchain to
           be  aware  of  LTO.  It  requires  a  linker  with  linker  plugin  support  for basic functionality.
           Additionally, nm, ar and ranlib need to  support  linker  plugins  to  allow  a  full-featured  build
           environment  (capable of building static libraries etc).  GCC provides the gcc-ar, gcc-nm, gcc-ranlib
           wrappers to pass the right options to these tools. With non fat LTO makefiles need to be modified  to
           use them.

           The default is -fno-fat-lto-objects on targets with linker plugin support.

       -fcompare-elim
           After  register  allocation  and  post-register allocation instruction splitting, identify arithmetic
           instructions that compute processor flags similar to a comparison operation based on that arithmetic.
           If possible, eliminate the explicit comparison operation.

           This pass only applies to certain targets that cannot explicitly represent the  comparison  operation
           before register allocation is complete.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fuse-ld=bfd
           Use the bfd linker instead of the default linker.

       -fuse-ld=gold
           Use the gold linker instead of the default linker.

       -fcprop-registers
           After  register  allocation  and  post-register  allocation  instruction  splitting,  perform a copy-
           propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies and occasionally eliminate the copy.

           Enabled at levels -O, -O2, -O3, -Os.

       -fprofile-correction
           Profiles collected using an instrumented binary for multi-threaded programs may be  inconsistent  due
           to  missed  counter  updates. When this option is specified, GCC uses heuristics to correct or smooth
           out such inconsistencies. By default, GCC emits an error message  when  an  inconsistent  profile  is
           detected.

       -fprofile-dir=path
           Set  the  directory  to  search  for the profile data files in to path.  This option affects only the
           profile  data  generated  by  -fprofile-generate,  -ftest-coverage,  -fprofile-arcs   and   used   by
           -fprofile-use  and  -fbranch-probabilities and its related options.  Both absolute and relative paths
           can be used.  By default, GCC uses the current directory as path, thus the profile data file  appears
           in the same directory as the object file.

       -fprofile-generate
       -fprofile-generate=path
           Enable  options  usually  used  for  instrumenting  application  to  produce profile useful for later
           recompilation with profile feedback based optimization.  You must use  -fprofile-generate  both  when
           compiling and when linking your program.

           The following options are enabled: "-fprofile-arcs", "-fprofile-values", "-fvpt".

           If  path  is  specified,  GCC  looks  at  the  path  to  find  the  profile  feedback data files. See
           -fprofile-dir.

       -fprofile-use
       -fprofile-use=path
           Enable profile feedback directed optimizations, and  optimizations  generally  profitable  only  with
           profile feedback available.

           The   following   options   are   enabled:   "-fbranch-probabilities",   "-fvpt",   "-funroll-loops",
           "-fpeel-loops", "-ftracer", "-ftree-vectorize", "ftree-loop-distribute-patterns"

           By default, GCC emits an error message if the feedback profiles do not match the source  code.   This
           error  can  be  turned  into  a warning by using -Wcoverage-mismatch.  Note this may result in poorly
           optimized code.

           If path is specified,  GCC  looks  at  the  path  to  find  the  profile  feedback  data  files.  See
           -fprofile-dir.

       The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating-point arithmetic.  These options trade
       off between speed and correctness.  All must be specifically enabled.

       -ffloat-store
           Do  not  store  floating-point  variables  in  registers, and inhibit other options that might change
           whether a floating-point value is taken from a register or memory.

           This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such as the 68000  where  the  floating
           registers  (of the 68881) keep more precision than a "double" is supposed to have.  Similarly for the
           x86 architecture.  For most programs, the excess precision does only good, but a few programs rely on
           the precise definition of IEEE floating point.  Use -ffloat-store for such programs, after  modifying
           them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.

       -fexcess-precision=style
           This  option  allows further control over excess precision on machines where floating-point registers
           have more precision than the IEEE "float" and "double" types  and  the  processor  does  not  support
           operations  rounding  to  those  types.  By default, -fexcess-precision=fast is in effect; this means
           that operations are carried out in the precision of the registers and that it is  unpredictable  when
           rounding   to   the  types  specified  in  the  source  code  takes  place.   When  compiling  C,  if
           -fexcess-precision=standard is specified then excess precision follows the  rules  specified  in  ISO
           C99;  in  particular,  both  casts and assignments cause values to be rounded to their semantic types
           (whereas -ffloat-store only affects assignments).  This option is enabled  by  default  for  C  if  a
           strict conformance option such as -std=c99 is used.

           -fexcess-precision=standard  is  not  implemented  for  languages  other than C, and has no effect if
           -funsafe-math-optimizations or -ffast-math is specified.  On the  x86,  it  also  has  no  effect  if
           -mfpmath=sse  or  -mfpmath=sse+387  is  specified;  in  the former case, IEEE semantics apply without
           excess precision, and in the latter, rounding is unpredictable.

       -ffast-math
           Sets   -fno-math-errno,    -funsafe-math-optimizations,    -ffinite-math-only,    -fno-rounding-math,
           -fno-signaling-nans and -fcx-limited-range.

           This option causes the preprocessor macro "__FAST_MATH__" to be defined.

           This  option is not turned on by any -O option besides -Ofast since it can result in incorrect output
           for programs that depend on an exact implementation of IEEE  or  ISO  rules/specifications  for  math
           functions.  It  may,  however,  yield  faster code for programs that do not require the guarantees of
           these specifications.

       -fno-math-errno
           Do not set "errno" after calling math functions that are executed with a  single  instruction,  e.g.,
           "sqrt".   A  program that relies on IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
           for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.

           This option is not turned on by any -O option since it can result in incorrect  output  for  programs
           that  depend  on  an  exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math functions. It
           may, however,  yield  faster  code  for  programs  that  do  not  require  the  guarantees  of  these
           specifications.

           The default is -fmath-errno.

           On  Darwin  systems,  the  math  library  never  sets  "errno".  There is therefore no reason for the
           compiler to consider the possibility that it might, and -fno-math-errno is the default.

       -funsafe-math-optimizations
           Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume  that  arguments  and  results  are
           valid  and  (b) may violate IEEE or ANSI standards.  When used at link-time, it may include libraries
           or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other similar optimizations.

           This option is not turned on by any -O option since it can result in incorrect  output  for  programs
           that  depend  on  an  exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math functions. It
           may, however,  yield  faster  code  for  programs  that  do  not  require  the  guarantees  of  these
           specifications.     Enables    -fno-signed-zeros,    -fno-trapping-math,    -fassociative-math    and
           -freciprocal-math.

           The default is -fno-unsafe-math-optimizations.

       -fassociative-math
           Allow re-association of operands in series of floating-point operations.  This violates the ISO C and
           C++ language standard by possibly changing computation result.  NOTE: re-ordering may change the sign
           of zero as well as ignore NaNs and inhibit or create underflow or overflow (and thus cannot  be  used
           on code that relies on rounding behavior like "(x + 2**52) - 2**52".  May also reorder floating-point
           comparisons  and  thus  may  not be used when ordered comparisons are required.  This option requires
           that both -fno-signed-zeros and -fno-trapping-math be in effect.   Moreover,  it  doesn't  make  much
           sense   with   -frounding-math.   For   Fortran   the  option  is  automatically  enabled  when  both
           -fno-signed-zeros and -fno-trapping-math are in effect.

           The default is -fno-associative-math.

       -freciprocal-math
           Allow the reciprocal of a value to be  used  instead  of  dividing  by  the  value  if  this  enables
           optimizations.   For  example "x / y" can be replaced with "x * (1/y)", which is useful if "(1/y)" is
           subject to common subexpression elimination.  Note that this loses precision and increases the number
           of flops operating on the value.

           The default is -fno-reciprocal-math.

       -ffinite-math-only
           Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume that arguments and results are not NaNs
           or +-Infs.

           This option is not turned on by any -O option since it can result in incorrect  output  for  programs
           that  depend  on  an  exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for math functions. It
           may, however,  yield  faster  code  for  programs  that  do  not  require  the  guarantees  of  these
           specifications.

           The default is -fno-finite-math-only.

       -fno-signed-zeros
           Allow  optimizations  for  floating-point  arithmetic  that  ignore  the  signedness  of  zero.  IEEE
           arithmetic  specifies  the  behavior  of  distinct  +0.0  and  -0.0  values,  which  then   prohibits
           simplification  of  expressions  such  as x+0.0 or 0.0*x (even with -ffinite-math-only).  This option
           implies that the sign of a zero result isn't significant.

           The default is -fsigned-zeros.

       -fno-trapping-math
           Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate user-visible traps.  These traps
           include division by zero, overflow, underflow, inexact result and  invalid  operation.   This  option
           requires  that  -fno-signaling-nans  be  in effect.  Setting this option may allow faster code if one
           relies on "non-stop" IEEE arithmetic, for example.

           This option should never be turned on by any -O option since it can result in  incorrect  output  for
           programs  that  depend  on  an  exact  implementation  of  IEEE  or ISO rules/specifications for math
           functions.

           The default is -ftrapping-math.

       -frounding-math
           Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default floating-point rounding behavior.  This
           is round-to-zero for all floating point to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest  for  all  other
           arithmetic  truncations.   This  option  should be specified for programs that change the FP rounding
           mode dynamically, or that may be executed with a non-default rounding  mode.   This  option  disables
           constant  folding  of  floating-point  expressions at compile time (which may be affected by rounding
           mode) and arithmetic transformations that are unsafe  in  the  presence  of  sign-dependent  rounding
           modes.

           The default is -fno-rounding-math.

           This  option  is  experimental and does not currently guarantee to disable all GCC optimizations that
           are affected by rounding mode.  Future versions of GCC may provide  finer  control  of  this  setting
           using C99's "FENV_ACCESS" pragma.  This command-line option will be used to specify the default state
           for "FENV_ACCESS".

       -fsignaling-nans
           Compile  code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible traps during floating-point
           operations.  Setting this option disables optimizations that may  change  the  number  of  exceptions
           visible with signaling NaNs.  This option implies -ftrapping-math.

           This option causes the preprocessor macro "__SUPPORT_SNAN__" to be defined.

           The default is -fno-signaling-nans.

           This  option  is  experimental and does not currently guarantee to disable all GCC optimizations that
           affect signaling NaN behavior.

       -fsingle-precision-constant
           Treat floating-point constants as single precision instead of implicitly converting them  to  double-
           precision constants.

       -fcx-limited-range
           When  enabled,  this  option states that a range reduction step is not needed when performing complex
           division.  Also, there is no checking whether the result of a complex multiplication or  division  is
           "NaN   +   I*NaN",  with  an  attempt  to  rescue  the  situation  in  that  case.   The  default  is
           -fno-cx-limited-range, but is enabled by -ffast-math.

           This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99 "CX_LIMITED_RANGE" pragma.  Nevertheless, the
           option applies to all languages.

       -fcx-fortran-rules
           Complex multiplication and division follow Fortran rules.  Range reduction is done as part of complex
           division, but there is no checking whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is "NaN
           + I*NaN", with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.

           The default is -fno-cx-fortran-rules.

       The following options control optimizations that may improve performance, but are not enabled by  any  -O
       options.  This section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.

       -fbranch-probabilities
           After  running  a  program  compiled  with  -fprofile-arcs,  you  can  compile it a second time using
           -fbranch-probabilities, to improve optimizations based on the number of times each branch was  taken.
           When  a  program  compiled  with -fprofile-arcs exits, it saves arc execution counts to a file called
           sourcename.gcda for each source file.  The information in this data file is  very  dependent  on  the
           structure  of  the  generated  code,  so  you must use the same source code and the same optimization
           options for both compilations.

           With -fbranch-probabilities, GCC puts a REG_BR_PROB note on each JUMP_INSN and CALL_INSN.  These  can
           be  used to improve optimization.  Currently, they are only used in one place: in reorg.c, instead of
           guessing which path a branch is most likely to take, the  REG_BR_PROB  values  are  used  to  exactly
           determine which path is taken more often.

       -fprofile-values
           If  combined  with  -fprofile-arcs, it adds code so that some data about values of expressions in the
           program is gathered.

           With -fbranch-probabilities, it reads back the data gathered from profiling values of expressions for
           usage in optimizations.

           Enabled with -fprofile-generate and -fprofile-use.

       -fprofile-reorder-functions
           Function reordering based on profile instrumentation collects first time of execution of  a  function
           and orders these functions in ascending order.

           Enabled with -fprofile-use.

       -fvpt
           If combined with -fprofile-arcs, this option instructs the compiler to add code to gather information
           about values of expressions.

           With  -fbranch-probabilities, it reads back the data gathered and actually performs the optimizations
           based on them.  Currently the optimizations include specialization of division operations  using  the
           knowledge about the value of the denominator.

       -frename-registers
           Attempt  to  avoid  false  dependencies  in scheduled code by making use of registers left over after
           register allocation.  This optimization most benefits processors with lots of  registers.   Depending
           on  the  debug  information  format adopted by the target, however, it can make debugging impossible,
           since variables no longer stay in a "home register".

           Enabled by default with -funroll-loops and -fpeel-loops.

       -ftracer
           Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation simplifies the control flow
           of the function allowing other optimizations to do a better job.

           Enabled with -fprofile-use.

       -funroll-loops
           Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or upon entry to the  loop.
           -funroll-loops  implies  -frerun-cse-after-loop,  -fweb  and  -frename-registers.   It  also turns on
           complete loop peeling (i.e. complete removal of loops with a small constant  number  of  iterations).
           This option makes code larger, and may or may not make it run faster.

           Enabled with -fprofile-use.

       -funroll-all-loops
           Unroll  all  loops,  even  if their number of iterations is uncertain when the loop is entered.  This
           usually  makes  programs  run  more  slowly.   -funroll-all-loops  implies  the   same   options   as
           -funroll-loops.

       -fpeel-loops
           Peels loops for which there is enough information that they do not roll much (from profile feedback).
           It  also turns on complete loop peeling (i.e. complete removal of loops with small constant number of
           iterations).

           Enabled with -fprofile-use.

       -fmove-loop-invariants
           Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer.  Enabled at level -O1

       -funswitch-loops
           Move branches with loop invariant conditions out of the loop, with duplicates of  the  loop  on  both
           branches (modified according to result of the condition).

       -ffunction-sections
       -fdata-sections
           Place  each  function  or  data  item  into its own section in the output file if the target supports
           arbitrary sections.  The name of the function or the name of the data item determines  the  section's
           name in the output file.

           Use  these  options  on  systems  where  the  linker can perform optimizations to improve locality of
           reference in the instruction space.  Most systems using the ELF object format  and  SPARC  processors
           running  Solaris  2  have  linkers  with such optimizations.  AIX may have these optimizations in the
           future.

           Only use these options when there are significant benefits from doing so.   When  you  specify  these
           options, the assembler and linker create larger object and executable files and are also slower.  You
           cannot  use  "gprof"  on  all  systems  if  you  specify  this option, and you may have problems with
           debugging if you specify both this option and -g.

       -fbranch-target-load-optimize
           Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue / epilogue threading.   The  use  of
           target  registers  can  typically be exposed only during reload, thus hoisting loads out of loops and
           doing inter-block scheduling needs a separate optimization pass.

       -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
           Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue / epilogue threading.

       -fbtr-bb-exclusive
           When performing branch target register load optimization, don't reuse branch target registers  within
           any basic block.

       -fstack-protector
           Emit  extra  code  to  check  for  buffer overflows, such as stack smashing attacks.  This is done by
           adding a guard variable to functions with vulnerable objects.   This  includes  functions  that  call
           "alloca", and functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes.  The guards are initialized when a function
           is  entered  and  then  checked when the function exits.  If a guard check fails, an error message is
           printed and the program exits.

       -fstack-protector-all
           Like -fstack-protector except that all functions are protected.

       -fstack-protector-strong
           Like -fstack-protector but includes additional functions to be protected --- those  that  have  local
           array definitions, or have references to local frame addresses.

           NOTE:  In Ubuntu 14.10 and later versions, -fstack-protector-strong is enabled by default for C, C++,
           ObjC, ObjC++, if none of -fno-stack-protector, -nostdlib, nor -ffreestanding are found.

       -fsection-anchors
           Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using shared "anchor" symbols to address
           nearby objects.  This transformation can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT accesses on
           some targets.

           For example, the implementation of the following function "foo":

                   static int a, b, c;
                   int foo (void) { return a + b + c; }

           usually  calculates  the  addresses  of  all  three  variables,  but   if   you   compile   it   with
           -fsection-anchors,  it  accesses  the  variables  from  a common anchor point instead.  The effect is
           similar to the following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):

                   int foo (void)
                   {
                     register int *xr = &x;
                     return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
                   }

           Not all targets support this option.

       --param name=value
           In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of optimization that is  done.   For
           example,  GCC does not inline functions that contain more than a certain number of instructions.  You
           can control some of these constants on the command line using the --param option.

           The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values, are tied to  the  internals  of  the
           compiler, and are subject to change without notice in future releases.

           In each case, the value is an integer.  The allowable choices for name are:

           predictable-branch-outcome
               When  branch  is  predicted  to be taken with probability lower than this threshold (in percent),
               then it is considered well predictable. The default is 10.

           max-crossjump-edges
               The maximum number of incoming edges to  consider  for  cross-jumping.   The  algorithm  used  by
               -fcrossjumping  is  O(N^2) in the number of edges incoming to each block.  Increasing values mean
               more  aggressive  optimization,  making  the  compilation  time  increase  with  probably   small
               improvement in executable size.

           min-crossjump-insns
               The  minimum  number  of instructions that must be matched at the end of two blocks before cross-
               jumping is performed on them.  This value is ignored in the case where all  instructions  in  the
               block being cross-jumped from are matched.  The default value is 5.

           max-grow-copy-bb-insns
               The  maximum  code  size  expansion  factor  when  copying  basic blocks instead of jumping.  The
               expansion is relative to a jump instruction.  The default value is 8.

           max-goto-duplication-insns
               The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that jumps to  a  computed  goto.   To
               avoid  O(N^2) behavior in a number of passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation
               process, and unfactors them as late as possible.  Only computed jumps  at  the  end  of  a  basic
               blocks with no more than max-goto-duplication-insns are unfactored.  The default value is 8.

           max-delay-slot-insn-search
               The  maximum  number  of instructions to consider when looking for an instruction to fill a delay
               slot.  If more than this arbitrary number of instructions are searched,  the  time  savings  from
               filling  the  delay  slot are minimal, so stop searching.  Increasing values mean more aggressive
               optimization, making the compilation time increase with probably small improvement  in  execution
               time.

           max-delay-slot-live-search
               When  trying  to  fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to consider when searching
               for a block with valid live register information.  Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means
               more aggressive optimization, increasing the compilation time.  This parameter should be  removed
               when the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the control-flow graph.

           max-gcse-memory
               The  approximate  maximum  amount  of memory that can be allocated in order to perform the global
               common subexpression elimination optimization.  If more memory than specified  is  required,  the
               optimization is not done.

           max-gcse-insertion-ratio
               If  the ratio of expression insertions to deletions is larger than this value for any expression,
               then RTL PRE inserts or removes the expression and thus leaves partially  redundant  computations
               in the instruction stream.  The default value is 20.

           max-pending-list-length
               The  maximum  number  of pending dependencies scheduling allows before flushing the current state
               and starting over.  Large functions with few branches or calls can create excessively large lists
               which needlessly consume memory and resources.

           max-modulo-backtrack-attempts
               The maximum number of backtrack attempts the scheduler should make when modulo scheduling a loop.
               Larger values can exponentially increase compilation time.

           max-inline-insns-single
               Several parameters control the tree inliner used in GCC.  This number sets the maximum number  of
               instructions  (counted  in  GCC's  internal  representation)  in  a single function that the tree
               inliner considers for  inlining.   This  only  affects  functions  declared  inline  and  methods
               implemented in a class declaration (C++).  The default value is 400.

           max-inline-insns-auto
               When you use -finline-functions (included in -O3), a lot of functions that would otherwise not be
               considered  for inlining by the compiler are investigated.  To those functions, a different (more
               restrictive) limit compared to functions declared inline can be applied.  The  default  value  is
               40.

           inline-min-speedup
               When  estimated  performance  improvement  of  caller + callee runtime exceeds this threshold (in
               precent), the function can be inlined regardless the limit on --param max-inline-insns-single and
               --param max-inline-insns-auto.

           large-function-insns
               The limit specifying really  large  functions.   For  functions  larger  than  this  limit  after
               inlining,  inlining  is  constrained  by --param large-function-growth.  This parameter is useful
               primarily to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-linear algorithms used by the back end.
               The default value is 2700.

           large-function-growth
               Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining in percents.  The default value  is
               100 which limits large function growth to 2.0 times the original size.

           large-unit-insns
               The limit specifying large translation unit.  Growth caused by inlining of units larger than this
               limit  is  limited  by --param inline-unit-growth.  For small units this might be too tight.  For
               example, consider a unit consisting of function A that is inline and B that just  calls  A  three
               times.   If  B  is small relative to A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such inlining is very
               sane.  For very large units consisting of small inlineable functions, however, the  overall  unit
               growth  limit is needed to avoid exponential explosion of code size.  Thus for smaller units, the
               size is increased to --param large-unit-insns before applying  --param  inline-unit-growth.   The
               default is 10000.

           inline-unit-growth
               Specifies  maximal  overall growth of the compilation unit caused by inlining.  The default value
               is 30 which limits unit growth to 1.3 times the original size.

           ipcp-unit-growth
               Specifies maximal overall growth of the  compilation  unit  caused  by  interprocedural  constant
               propagation.  The default value is 10 which limits unit growth to 1.1 times the original size.

           large-stack-frame
               The limit specifying large stack frames.  While inlining the algorithm is trying to not grow past
               this limit too much.  The default value is 256 bytes.

           large-stack-frame-growth
               Specifies maximal growth of large stack frames caused by inlining in percents.  The default value
               is 1000 which limits large stack frame growth to 11 times the original size.

           max-inline-insns-recursive
           max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
               Specifies  the  maximum  number  of  instructions  an out-of-line copy of a self-recursive inline
               function can grow into by performing recursive inlining.

               For functions declared inline, --param max-inline-insns-recursive is  taken  into  account.   For
               functions  not declared inline, recursive inlining happens only when -finline-functions (included
               in -O3) is enabled and --param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto is used.   The  default  value  is
               450.

           max-inline-recursive-depth
           max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
               Specifies the maximum recursion depth used for recursive inlining.

               For  functions  declared  inline,  --param max-inline-recursive-depth is taken into account.  For
               functions not declared inline, recursive inlining happens only when -finline-functions  (included
               in -O3) is enabled and --param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto is used.  The default value is 8.

           min-inline-recursive-probability
               Recursive  inlining is profitable only for function having deep recursion in average and can hurt
               for function having little recursion depth by increasing  the  prologue  size  or  complexity  of
               function body to other optimizers.

               When  profile  feedback  is  available (see -fprofile-generate) the actual recursion depth can be
               guessed from probability that function recurses via a  given  call  expression.   This  parameter
               limits  inlining  only  to  call  expressions  whose  probability exceeds the given threshold (in
               percents).  The default value is 10.

           early-inlining-insns
               Specify growth that the early inliner can make.  In effect it increases the  amount  of  inlining
               for code having a large abstraction penalty.  The default value is 10.

           max-early-inliner-iterations
           max-early-inliner-iterations
               Limit  of  iterations  of the early inliner.  This basically bounds the number of nested indirect
               calls the early inliner can resolve.  Deeper chains are still handled by late inlining.

           comdat-sharing-probability
           comdat-sharing-probability
               Probability (in percent) that C++ inline  function  with  comdat  visibility  are  shared  across
               multiple compilation units.  The default value is 20.

           min-vect-loop-bound
               The  minimum  number  of iterations under which loops are not vectorized when -ftree-vectorize is
               used.  The number of iterations after vectorization needs to be greater than the value  specified
               by this option to allow vectorization.  The default value is 0.

           gcse-cost-distance-ratio
               Scaling  factor  in  calculation  of  maximum  distance  an  expression  can  be  moved  by  GCSE
               optimizations.  This is currently supported only in the  code  hoisting  pass.   The  bigger  the
               ratio,  the  more aggressive code hoisting is with simple expressions, i.e., the expressions that
               have  cost  less  than  gcse-unrestricted-cost.   Specifying  0  disables  hoisting   of   simple
               expressions.  The default value is 10.

           gcse-unrestricted-cost
               Cost,  roughly  measured  as  the  cost  of  a  single typical machine instruction, at which GCSE
               optimizations do not constrain  the  distance  an  expression  can  travel.   This  is  currently
               supported only in the code hoisting pass.  The lesser the cost, the more aggressive code hoisting
               is.   Specifying 0 allows all expressions to travel unrestricted distances.  The default value is
               3.

           max-hoist-depth
               The depth of search in the dominator tree for expressions  to  hoist.   This  is  used  to  avoid
               quadratic  behavior  in hoisting algorithm.  The value of 0 does not limit on the search, but may
               slow down compilation of huge functions.  The default value is 30.

           max-tail-merge-comparisons
               The maximum amount of similar bbs to compare a bb with.  This is used to avoid quadratic behavior
               in tree tail merging.  The default value is 10.

           max-tail-merge-iterations
               The maximum amount of iterations  of  the  pass  over  the  function.   This  is  used  to  limit
               compilation time in tree tail merging.  The default value is 2.

           max-unrolled-insns
               The  maximum  number of instructions that a loop may have to be unrolled.  If a loop is unrolled,
               this parameter also determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.

           max-average-unrolled-insns
               The maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of their execution  that  a  loop  may
               have  to  be  unrolled.  If a loop is unrolled, this parameter also determines how many times the
               loop code is unrolled.

           max-unroll-times
               The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.

           max-peeled-insns
               The maximum number of instructions that a loop may have to be peeled.  If a loop is peeled,  this
               parameter also determines how many times the loop code is peeled.

           max-peel-times
               The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.

           max-peel-branches
               The maximum number of branches on the hot path through the peeled sequence.

           max-completely-peeled-insns
               The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.

           max-completely-peel-times
               The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for complete peeling.

           max-completely-peel-loop-nest-depth
               The maximum depth of a loop nest suitable for complete peeling.

           max-unswitch-insns
               The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.

           max-unswitch-level
               The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.

           lim-expensive
               The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop invariant motion.

           iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
               Bound  on number of candidates for induction variables, below which all candidates are considered
               for each use in induction variable optimizations.  If there are more candidates than  this,  only
               the most relevant ones are considered to avoid quadratic time complexity.

           iv-max-considered-uses
               The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that contain more induction variable uses.

           iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
               If  the  number  of  candidates  in  the  set  is  smaller  than this value, always try to remove
               unnecessary ivs from the set when adding a new one.

           scev-max-expr-size
               Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions analyzer.  Large expressions slow  the
               analyzer.

           scev-max-expr-complexity
               Bound  on  the  complexity  of  the  expressions  in  the  scalar  evolutions  analyzer.  Complex
               expressions slow the analyzer.

           omega-max-vars
               The maximum number of variables in an Omega constraint system.  The default value is 128.

           omega-max-geqs
               The maximum number of inequalities in an Omega constraint system.  The default value is 256.

           omega-max-eqs
               The maximum number of equalities in an Omega constraint system.  The default value is 128.

           omega-max-wild-cards
               The maximum number of wildcard variables that the Omega solver is able to  insert.   The  default
               value is 18.

           omega-hash-table-size
               The size of the hash table in the Omega solver.  The default value is 550.

           omega-max-keys
               The maximal number of keys used by the Omega solver.  The default value is 500.

           omega-eliminate-redundant-constraints
               When  set  to 1, use expensive methods to eliminate all redundant constraints.  The default value
               is 0.

           vect-max-version-for-alignment-checks
               The maximum number of run-time checks that can  be  performed  when  doing  loop  versioning  for
               alignment in the vectorizer.

           vect-max-version-for-alias-checks
               The  maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when doing loop versioning for alias
               in the vectorizer.

           vect-max-peeling-for-alignment
               The maximum number of loop peels to enhance access alignment for vectorizer. Value -1  means  'no
               limit'.

           max-iterations-to-track
               The  maximum  number of iterations of a loop the brute-force algorithm for analysis of the number
               of iterations of the loop tries to evaluate.

           hot-bb-count-ws-permille
               A basic block profile count is considered hot if it contributes to  the  given  permillage  (i.e.
               0...1000) of the entire profiled execution.

           hot-bb-frequency-fraction
               Select fraction of the entry block frequency of executions of basic block in function given basic
               block needs to have to be considered hot.

           max-predicted-iterations
               The  maximum  number  of  loop iterations we predict statically.  This is useful in cases where a
               function contains a single loop with known bound and another loop with unknown bound.  The  known
               number  of  iterations  is predicted correctly, while the unknown number of iterations average to
               roughly 10.  This means that the loop without bounds appears artificially cold  relative  to  the
               other one.

           builtin-expect-probability
               Control  the  probability  of  the  expression having the specified value. This parameter takes a
               percentage (i.e. 0 ... 100) as input.  The default probability of 90 is obtained empirically.

           align-threshold
               Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of a basic block in a  function  to  align
               the basic block.

           align-loop-iterations
               A loop expected to iterate at least the selected number of iterations is aligned.

           tracer-dynamic-coverage
           tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
               This  value  is  used  to  limit  superblock  formation  once  the  given  percentage of executed
               instructions is covered.  This limits unnecessary code size expansion.

               The tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback is used only when profile feedback is available.   The  real
               profiles  (as opposed to statically estimated ones) are much less balanced allowing the threshold
               to be larger value.

           tracer-max-code-growth
               Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given percentage.  This is a rather artificial
               limit, as most of the duplicates are eliminated later in cross jumping, so it may be set to  much
               higher values than is the desired code growth.

           tracer-min-branch-ratio
               Stop  reverse  growth  when  the reverse probability of best edge is less than this threshold (in
               percent).

           tracer-min-branch-ratio
           tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
               Stop forward growth if the best edge has probability lower than this threshold.

               Similarly to tracer-dynamic-coverage two values are present,  one  for  compilation  for  profile
               feedback  and one for compilation without.  The value for compilation with profile feedback needs
               to be more conservative (higher) in order to make tracer effective.

           max-cse-path-length
               The maximum number of basic blocks on path that CSE considers.  The default is 10.

           max-cse-insns
               The maximum number of instructions CSE processes before flushing.  The default is 1000.

           ggc-min-expand
               GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation.  This parameter  specifies  the
               minimum  percentage  by  which  the  garbage collector's heap should be allowed to expand between
               collections.  Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code generation.

               The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of 100% when RAM >= 1GB.  If "getrlimit"
               is available, the notion of "RAM" is the smallest of actual RAM and "RLIMIT_DATA" or "RLIMIT_AS".
               If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower bound  of  30%  is  used.
               Setting  this  parameter  and ggc-min-heapsize to zero causes a full collection to occur at every
               opportunity.  This is extremely slow, but can be useful for debugging.

           ggc-min-heapsize
               Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering to collect garbage.   The
               first  collection  occurs  after  the  heap  expands  by ggc-min-expand% beyond ggc-min-heapsize.
               Again, tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code generation.

               The default is the smaller of RAM/8, RLIMIT_RSS, or a limit that tries to ensure that RLIMIT_DATA
               or RLIMIT_AS are not exceeded, but with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and an upper bound
               of 131072 (128 megabytes).  If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on  a  particular  platform,  the
               lower  bound is used.  Setting this parameter very large effectively disables garbage collection.
               Setting this parameter and ggc-min-expand to zero causes a full  collection  to  occur  at  every
               opportunity.

           max-reload-search-insns
               The  maximum  number  of  instruction  reload  should  look  backward  for  equivalent  register.
               Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the compilation  time  increase  with
               probably slightly better performance.  The default value is 100.

           max-cselib-memory-locations
               The  maximum  number of memory locations cselib should take into account.  Increasing values mean
               more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with probably slightly  better
               performance.  The default value is 500.

           reorder-blocks-duplicate
           reorder-blocks-duplicate-feedback
               Used  by  the  basic  block  reordering  pass  to  decide  whether to use unconditional branch or
               duplicate the code on its destination.  Code is duplicated when its  estimated  size  is  smaller
               than  this  value  multiplied by the estimated size of unconditional jump in the hot spots of the
               program.

               The reorder-block-duplicate-feedback is used only when profile feedback is available.  It may  be
               set  to  higher values than reorder-block-duplicate since information about the hot spots is more
               accurate.

           max-sched-ready-insns
               The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the scheduler should consider at any  given
               time during the first scheduling pass.  Increasing values mean more thorough searches, making the
               compilation time increase with probably little benefit.  The default value is 100.

           max-sched-region-blocks
               The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for interblock scheduling.  The default
               value is 10.

           max-pipeline-region-blocks
               The  maximum  number  of  blocks  in  a  region  to be considered for pipelining in the selective
               scheduler.  The default value is 15.

           max-sched-region-insns
               The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for interblock scheduling.  The  default
               value is 100.

           max-pipeline-region-insns
               The  maximum  number  of  insns  in  a  region  to  be considered for pipelining in the selective
               scheduler.  The default value is 200.

           min-spec-prob
               The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching  a  source  block  for  interblock  speculative
               scheduling.  The default value is 40.

           max-sched-extend-regions-iters
               The  maximum  number  of  iterations  through  CFG to extend regions.  A value of 0 (the default)
               disables region extensions.

           max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
               The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered  for  speculative  motion.   The  default
               value is 3.

           sched-spec-prob-cutoff
               The  minimal  probability  of  speculation  success  (in percents), so that speculative insns are
               scheduled.  The default value is 40.

           sched-spec-state-edge-prob-cutoff
               The minimum probability an edge must have for the scheduler to save its  state  across  it.   The
               default value is 10.

           sched-mem-true-dep-cost
               Minimal  distance  (in  CPU  cycles) between store and load targeting same memory locations.  The
               default value is 1.

           selsched-max-lookahead
               The maximum size of the lookahead window of selective scheduling.  It is a depth  of  search  for
               available instructions.  The default value is 50.

           selsched-max-sched-times
               The  maximum  number of times that an instruction is scheduled during selective scheduling.  This
               is the limit on the number of iterations through which the instruction  may  be  pipelined.   The
               default value is 2.

           selsched-max-insns-to-rename
               The maximum number of best instructions in the ready list that are considered for renaming in the
               selective scheduler.  The default value is 2.

           sms-min-sc
               The minimum value of stage count that swing modulo scheduler generates.  The default value is 2.

           max-last-value-rtl
               The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be recorded in an expression in combiner for
               a pseudo register as last known value of that register.  The default is 10000.

           integer-share-limit
               Small integer constants can use a shared data structure, reducing the compiler's memory usage and
               increasing  its  speed.   This  sets the maximum value of a shared integer constant.  The default
               value is 256.

           ssp-buffer-size
               The  minimum  size  of  buffers  (i.e.  arrays)  that  receive  stack  smashing  protection  when
               -fstack-protection is used.

               This  default  before  Ubuntu  10.10  was  "8".  Currently  it  is "4", to increase the number of
               functions protected by the stack protector.

           min-size-for-stack-sharing
               The minimum size of variables taking part in stack slot sharing when not optimizing. The  default
               value is 32.

           max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
               Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to be duplicated when threading jumps.

           max-fields-for-field-sensitive
               Maximum  number  of  fields  in  a  structure  treated in a field sensitive manner during pointer
               analysis.  The default is zero for -O0 and -O1, and 100 for -Os, -O2, and -O3.

           prefetch-latency
               Estimate on average number of instructions that  are  executed  before  prefetch  finishes.   The
               distance prefetched ahead is proportional to this constant.  Increasing this number may also lead
               to less streams being prefetched (see simultaneous-prefetches).

           simultaneous-prefetches
               Maximum number of prefetches that can run at the same time.

           l1-cache-line-size
               The size of cache line in L1 cache, in bytes.

           l1-cache-size
               The size of L1 cache, in kilobytes.

           l2-cache-size
               The size of L2 cache, in kilobytes.

           min-insn-to-prefetch-ratio
               The  minimum  ratio  between  the  number  of instructions and the number of prefetches to enable
               prefetching in a loop.

           prefetch-min-insn-to-mem-ratio
               The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and  the  number  of  memory  references  to
               enable prefetching in a loop.

           use-canonical-types
               Whether  the  compiler should use the "canonical" type system.  By default, this should always be
               1, which uses a more efficient internal mechanism for comparing types in C++  and  Objective-C++.
               However, if bugs in the canonical type system are causing compilation failures, set this value to
               0 to disable canonical types.

           switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio
               Switch initialization conversion refuses to create arrays that are bigger than switch-conversion-
               max-branch-ratio times the number of branches in the switch.

           max-partial-antic-length
               Maximum  length  of the partial antic set computed during the tree partial redundancy elimination
               optimization (-ftree-pre) when optimizing at -O3 and above.  For some sorts of  source  code  the
               enhanced  partial  redundancy  elimination optimization can run away, consuming all of the memory
               available on the host machine.  This parameter sets a limit on the length of the  sets  that  are
               computed, which prevents the runaway behavior.  Setting a value of 0 for this parameter allows an
               unlimited set length.

           sccvn-max-scc-size
               Maximum  size  of a strongly connected component (SCC) during SCCVN processing.  If this limit is
               hit, SCCVN processing for the whole function is not done and optimizations depending  on  it  are
               disabled.  The default maximum SCC size is 10000.

           sccvn-max-alias-queries-per-access
               Maximum  number  of  alias-oracle  queries we perform when looking for redundancies for loads and
               stores.  If this limit is hit the search is aborted and the  load  or  store  is  not  considered
               redundant.  The number of queries is algorithmically limited to the number of stores on all paths
               from the load to the function entry.  The default maxmimum number of queries is 1000.

           ira-max-loops-num
               IRA  uses  regional  register  allocation by default.  If a function contains more loops than the
               number given by this parameter, only at most the given number  of  the  most  frequently-executed
               loops form regions for regional register allocation.  The default value of the parameter is 100.

           ira-max-conflict-table-size
               Although  IRA  uses a sophisticated algorithm to compress the conflict table, the table can still
               require excessive amounts of memory for huge functions.  If the conflict  table  for  a  function
               could  be more than the size in MB given by this parameter, the register allocator instead uses a
               faster, simpler, and lower-quality algorithm that does not  require  building  a  pseudo-register
               conflict table.  The default value of the parameter is 2000.

           ira-loop-reserved-regs
               IRA  can  be used to evaluate more accurate register pressure in loops for decisions to move loop
               invariants (see -O3).  The number of available registers reserved  for  some  other  purposes  is
               given by this parameter.  The default value of the parameter is 2, which is the minimal number of
               registers  needed  by  typical  instructions.   This  value  is  the  best  found  from  numerous
               experiments.

           loop-invariant-max-bbs-in-loop
               Loop invariant motion can be very expensive, both in compilation time and  in  amount  of  needed
               compile-time  memory,  with  very  large loops.  Loops with more basic blocks than this parameter
               won't have loop invariant motion optimization performed  on  them.   The  default  value  of  the
               parameter is 1000 for -O1 and 10000 for -O2 and above.

           loop-max-datarefs-for-datadeps
               Building  data  dapendencies is expensive for very large loops.  This parameter limits the number
               of data references in loops that are considered for data dependence analysis.  These large  loops
               are no handled by the optimizations using loop data dependencies.  The default value is 1000.

           max-vartrack-size
               Sets  a  maximum  number of hash table slots to use during variable tracking dataflow analysis of
               any function.  If this limit is exceeded with variable tracking at assignments enabled,  analysis
               for  that  function  is retried without it, after removing all debug insns from the function.  If
               the limit is exceeded even without debug insns, var tracking analysis is completely disabled  for
               the function.  Setting the parameter to zero makes it unlimited.

           max-vartrack-expr-depth
               Sets  a  maximum  number  of  recursion  levels  when  attempting  to map variable names or debug
               temporaries to  value  expressions.   This  trades  compilation  time  for  more  complete  debug
               information.   If  this  is  set  too  low,  value  expressions  that  are available and could be
               represented in debug information may end up not being used; setting this higher  may  enable  the
               compiler  to  find more complex debug expressions, but compile time and memory use may grow.  The
               default is 12.

           min-nondebug-insn-uid
               Use uids starting at this parameter for  nondebug  insns.   The  range  below  the  parameter  is
               reserved  exclusively  for debug insns created by -fvar-tracking-assignments, but debug insns may
               get (non-overlapping) uids above it if the reserved range is exhausted.

           ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor
               IPA-SRA replaces a pointer to an aggregate with one  or  more  new  parameters  only  when  their
               cumulative  size  is  less  or  equal to ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor times the size of the original
               pointer parameter.

           tm-max-aggregate-size
               When making copies of thread-local variables in a transaction, this parameter specifies the  size
               in  bytes  after  which variables are saved with the logging functions as opposed to save/restore
               code sequence pairs.  This option only applies when using -fgnu-tm.

           graphite-max-nb-scop-params
               To avoid exponential effects in the Graphite loop transforms,  the  number  of  parameters  in  a
               Static  Control  Part  (SCoP)  is bounded.  The default value is 10 parameters.  A variable whose
               value is unknown at compilation time and defined outside a SCoP is a parameter of the SCoP.

           graphite-max-bbs-per-function
               To avoid exponential effects in the detection of SCoPs, the size of  the  functions  analyzed  by
               Graphite is bounded.  The default value is 100 basic blocks.

           loop-block-tile-size
               Loop  blocking  or strip mining transforms, enabled with -floop-block or -floop-strip-mine, strip
               mine each loop in the loop nest by a given number of iterations.  The strip length can be changed
               using the loop-block-tile-size parameter.  The default value is 51 iterations.

           ipa-cp-value-list-size
               IPA-CP attempts to track all possible values and types passed to a function's parameter in  order
               to  propagate them and perform devirtualization.  ipa-cp-value-list-size is the maximum number of
               values and types it stores per one formal parameter of a function.

           ipa-cp-eval-threshold
               IPA-CP calculates its own score of cloning profitability heuristics and  performs  those  cloning
               opportunities with scores that exceed ipa-cp-eval-threshold.

           ipa-max-agg-items
               IPA-CP  is  also  capable to propagate a number of scalar values passed in an aggregate. ipa-max-
               agg-items controls the maximum number of such values per one parameter.

           ipa-cp-loop-hint-bonus
               When IPA-CP determines that a cloning candidate would make the number of  iterations  of  a  loop
               known,  it  adds  a  bonus  of  ipa-cp-loop-hint-bonus  bonus  to  the profitability score of the
               candidate.

           ipa-cp-array-index-hint-bonus
               When IPA-CP determines that a cloning candidate would make the index of an array access known, it
               adds a bonus of ipa-cp-array-index-hint-bonus bonus to the profitability score of the candidate.

           lto-partitions
               Specify desired number of partitions produced during WHOPR compilation.  The number of partitions
               should exceed the number of CPUs used for compilation.  The default value is 32.

           lto-minpartition
               Size of minimal partition for WHOPR (in  estimated  instructions).   This  prevents  expenses  of
               splitting very small programs into too many partitions.

           cxx-max-namespaces-for-diagnostic-help
               The  maximum  number  of  namespaces to consult for suggestions when C++ name lookup fails for an
               identifier.  The default is 1000.

           sink-frequency-threshold
               The maximum relative execution frequency  (in  percents)  of  the  target  block  relative  to  a
               statement's  original  block to allow statement sinking of a statement.  Larger numbers result in
               more aggressive statement sinking.  The default value is 75.   A  small  positive  adjustment  is
               applied for statements with memory operands as those are even more profitable so sink.

           max-stores-to-sink
               The  maximum  number  of  conditional  stores  paires  that  can  be  sunk.   Set  to 0 if either
               vectorization (-ftree-vectorize) or  if-conversion  (-ftree-loop-if-convert)  is  disabled.   The
               default is 2.

           allow-load-data-races
               Allow  optimizers to introduce new data races on loads.  Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This
               option is enabled by default unless implicitly set by the -fmemory-model= option.

           allow-store-data-races
               Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on stores.  Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This
               option is enabled by default unless implicitly set by the -fmemory-model= option.

           allow-packed-load-data-races
               Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data loads.  Set to 1 to allow,  otherwise
               to 0.  This option is enabled by default unless implicitly set by the -fmemory-model= option.

           allow-packed-store-data-races
               Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data stores.  Set to 1 to allow, otherwise
               to 0.  This option is enabled by default unless implicitly set by the -fmemory-model= option.

           case-values-threshold
               The  smallest  number  of  different values for which it is best to use a jump-table instead of a
               tree of conditional branches.  If the value is 0, use the default for the machine.   The  default
               is 0.

           tree-reassoc-width
               Set  the maximum number of instructions executed in parallel in reassociated tree. This parameter
               overrides target dependent heuristics used by default if has non zero value.

           sched-pressure-algorithm
               Choose between the two  available  implementations  of  -fsched-pressure.   Algorithm  1  is  the
               original  implementation  and  is  the  more likely to prevent instructions from being reordered.
               Algorithm 2 was designed to be a compromise between the relatively conservative approach taken by
               algorithm 1 and the rather aggressive approach taken by the default scheduler.   It  relies  more
               heavily  on  having  a  regular  register  file  and  accurate  register  pressure  classes.  See
               haifa-sched.c in the GCC sources for more details.

               The default choice depends on the target.

           max-slsr-cand-scan
               Set the maximum number of existing candidates that will be considered when seeking a basis for  a
               new straight-line strength reduction candidate.

           asan-globals
               Enable  buffer  overflow  detection  for  global  objects.  This kind of protection is enabled by
               default if you are using -fsanitize=address option.  To disable  global  objects  protection  use
               --param asan-globals=0.

           asan-stack
               Enable  buffer  overflow  detection  for  stack  objects.   This kind of protection is enabled by
               default when using-fsanitize=address.  To  disable  stack  protection  use  --param  asan-stack=0
               option.

           asan-instrument-reads
               Enable buffer overflow detection for memory reads.  This kind of protection is enabled by default
               when    using   -fsanitize=address.    To   disable   memory   reads   protection   use   --param
               asan-instrument-reads=0.

           asan-instrument-writes
               Enable buffer overflow detection for memory writes.   This  kind  of  protection  is  enabled  by
               default  when  using  -fsanitize=address.   To  disable  memory  writes  protection  use  --param
               asan-instrument-writes=0 option.

           asan-memintrin
               Enable detection for built-in functions.  This kind of protection  is  enabled  by  default  when
               using -fsanitize=address.  To disable built-in functions protection use --param asan-memintrin=0.

           asan-use-after-return
               Enable  detection  of use-after-return.  This kind of protection is enabled by default when using
               -fsanitize=address   option.     To    disable    use-after-return    detection    use    --param
               asan-use-after-return=0.

           asan-instrumentation-with-call-threshold
               If  number  of memory accesses in function being instrumented is greater or equal to this number,
               use  callbacks  instead  of  inline  checks.   E.g.  to   disable   inline   code   use   --param
               asan-instrumentation-with-call-threshold=0.

   Options Controlling the Preprocessor
       These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source file before actual compilation.

       If  you  use  the -E option, nothing is done except preprocessing.  Some of these options make sense only
       together with -E because they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual compilation.

       -Wp,option
           You can use -Wp,option to bypass the  compiler  driver  and  pass  option  directly  through  to  the
           preprocessor.   If option contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.  However,
           many options are modified, translated or interpreted by the compiler driver before  being  passed  to
           the  preprocessor,  and  -Wp  forcibly  bypasses  this phase.  The preprocessor's direct interface is
           undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible you should  avoid  using  -Wp  and  let  the
           driver handle the options instead.

       -Xpreprocessor option
           Pass  option  as  an  option  to  the  preprocessor.   You  can  use  this  to supply system-specific
           preprocessor options that GCC does not recognize.

           If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use -Xpreprocessor twice, once for the
           option and once for the argument.

       -no-integrated-cpp
           Perform preprocessing as a separate pass before compilation.  By default, GCC performs  preprocessing
           as an integrated part of input tokenization and parsing.  If this option is provided, the appropriate
           language  front  end  (cc1,  cc1plus, or cc1obj for C, C++, and Objective-C, respectively) is instead
           invoked twice, once for preprocessing only and once for actual compilation of the preprocessed input.
           This option may be useful in conjunction with the -B or -wrapper  options  to  specify  an  alternate
           preprocessor  or perform additional processing of the program source between normal preprocessing and
           compilation.

       -D name
           Predefine name as a macro, with definition 1.

       -D name=definition
           The contents of definition are tokenized and processed as if they appeared during  translation  phase
           three  in  a  #define directive.  In particular, the definition will be truncated by embedded newline
           characters.

           If you are invoking the preprocessor from a shell or shell-like program  you  may  need  to  use  the
           shell's quoting syntax to protect characters such as spaces that have a meaning in the shell syntax.

           If  you  wish  to  define  a  function-like  macro  on the command line, write its argument list with
           surrounding parentheses before the equals sign (if any).  Parentheses are meaningful to most  shells,
           so you will need to quote the option.  With sh and csh, -D'name(args...)=definition' works.

           -D  and  -U options are processed in the order they are given on the command line.  All -imacros file
           and -include file options are processed after all -D and -U options.

       -U name
           Cancel any previous definition of name, either built in or provided with a -D option.

       -undef
           Do not predefine any system-specific or GCC-specific macros.  The standard predefined  macros  remain
           defined.

       -I dir
           Add  the directory dir to the list of directories to be searched for header files.  Directories named
           by -I are searched before the standard system  include  directories.   If  the  directory  dir  is  a
           standard  system include directory, the option is ignored to ensure that the default search order for
           system directories and the special treatment of system headers are not defeated .  If dir begins with
           "=", then the "=" will be replaced by the sysroot prefix; see --sysroot and -isysroot.

       -o file
           Write output to file.  This is the same as specifying file as the second non-option argument to  cpp.
           gcc has a different interpretation of a second non-option argument, so you must use -o to specify the
           output file.

       -Wall
           Turns  on  all  optional warnings which are desirable for normal code.  At present this is -Wcomment,
           -Wtrigraphs, -Wmultichar and a warning about integer promotion causing a  change  of  sign  in  "#if"
           expressions.   Note that many of the preprocessor's warnings are on by default and have no options to
           control them.

       -Wcomment
       -Wcomments
           Warn whenever a comment-start sequence /* appears in a /* comment, or  whenever  a  backslash-newline
           appears in a // comment.  (Both forms have the same effect.)

       -Wtrigraphs
           Most  trigraphs in comments cannot affect the meaning of the program.  However, a trigraph that would
           form an escaped newline (??/ at the end of a line) can, by changing where the comment begins or ends.
           Therefore, only trigraphs that would form escaped newlines produce warnings inside a comment.

           This option is implied by -Wall.  If -Wall  is  not  given,  this  option  is  still  enabled  unless
           trigraphs  are  enabled.   To  get  trigraph  conversion  without  warnings,  but get the other -Wall
           warnings, use -trigraphs -Wall -Wno-trigraphs.

       -Wtraditional
           Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and ISO C.  Also warn about  ISO
           C  constructs  that  have  no  traditional  C  equivalent, and problematic constructs which should be
           avoided.

       -Wundef
           Warn whenever an identifier which is not a macro is encountered  in  an  #if  directive,  outside  of
           defined.  Such identifiers are replaced with zero.

       -Wunused-macros
           Warn  about  macros  defined  in the main file that are unused.  A macro is used if it is expanded or
           tested for existence at least once.  The preprocessor will also warn if the macro has not  been  used
           at the time it is redefined or undefined.

           Built-in  macros,  macros  defined  on  the command line, and macros defined in include files are not
           warned about.

           Note: If a macro is actually used, but only used in skipped conditional blocks, then CPP will  report
           it  as  unused.   To  avoid  the  warning  in such a case, you might improve the scope of the macro's
           definition by, for example, moving it into the first skipped block.  Alternatively, you could provide
           a dummy use with something like:

                   #if defined the_macro_causing_the_warning
                   #endif

       -Wendif-labels
           Warn whenever an #else or an #endif are followed by text.  This usually happens in code of the form

                   #if FOO
                   ...
                   #else FOO
                   ...
                   #endif FOO

           The second and third "FOO" should be in comments, but often are not in older programs.  This  warning
           is on by default.

       -Werror
           Make all warnings into hard errors.  Source code which triggers warnings will be rejected.

       -Wsystem-headers
           Issue  warnings for code in system headers.  These are normally unhelpful in finding bugs in your own
           code, therefore suppressed.  If you are responsible for the system library, you may want to see them.

       -w  Suppress all warnings, including those which GNU CPP issues by default.

       -pedantic
           Issue all the mandatory diagnostics listed in the C standard.  Some of them are left out by  default,
           since they trigger frequently on harmless code.

       -pedantic-errors
           Issue  all  the mandatory diagnostics, and make all mandatory diagnostics into errors.  This includes
           mandatory diagnostics that GCC issues without -pedantic but treats as warnings.

       -M  Instead of outputting the result of preprocessing, output a rule suitable  for  make  describing  the
           dependencies  of  the main source file.  The preprocessor outputs one make rule containing the object
           file name for that source file, a colon, and the names of all the  included  files,  including  those
           coming from -include or -imacros command line options.

           Unless  specified  explicitly  (with  -MT  or  -MQ), the object file name consists of the name of the
           source file with any suffix replaced with object file suffix and with  any  leading  directory  parts
           removed.  If there are many included files then the rule is split into several lines using \-newline.
           The rule has no commands.

           This  option  does  not  suppress the preprocessor's debug output, such as -dM.  To avoid mixing such
           debug output with the dependency rules you should explicitly specify the dependency output file  with
           -MF, or use an environment variable like DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT.  Debug output will still be sent to the
           regular output stream as normal.

           Passing -M to the driver implies -E, and suppresses warnings with an implicit -w.

       -MM Like -M but do not mention header files that are found in system header directories, nor header files
           that are included, directly or indirectly, from such a header.

           This  implies that the choice of angle brackets or double quotes in an #include directive does not in
           itself determine whether that header will appear in -MM dependency output.  This is a  slight  change
           in semantics from GCC versions 3.0 and earlier.

       -MF file
           When  used  with -M or -MM, specifies a file to write the dependencies to.  If no -MF switch is given
           the preprocessor sends the rules to the same place it would have sent preprocessed output.

           When used with the driver options -MD or -MMD, -MF overrides the default dependency output file.

       -MG In conjunction with an option such as -M requesting dependency generation, -MG assumes missing header
           files are generated files and adds them to  the  dependency  list  without  raising  an  error.   The
           dependency filename is taken directly from the "#include" directive without prepending any path.  -MG
           also suppresses preprocessed output, as a missing header file renders this useless.

           This feature is used in automatic updating of makefiles.

       -MP This option instructs CPP to add a phony target for each dependency other than the main file, causing
           each  to  depend  on  nothing.   These dummy rules work around errors make gives if you remove header
           files without updating the Makefile to match.

           This is typical output:

                   test.o: test.c test.h

                   test.h:

       -MT target
           Change the target of the rule emitted by dependency generation.  By default CPP takes the name of the
           main input file, deletes any directory components and any file suffix such as  .c,  and  appends  the
           platform's usual object suffix.  The result is the target.

           An  -MT  option  will  set  the  target  to  be exactly the string you specify.  If you want multiple
           targets, you can specify them as a single argument to -MT, or use multiple -MT options.

           For example, -MT '$(objpfx)foo.o' might give

                   $(objpfx)foo.o: foo.c

       -MQ target
           Same as -MT, but it quotes any characters which are special to Make.  -MQ '$(objpfx)foo.o' gives

                   $$(objpfx)foo.o: foo.c

           The default target is automatically quoted, as if it were given with -MQ.

       -MD -MD is equivalent to -M -MF file, except that -E is not implied.  The driver determines file based on
           whether an -o option is given.  If it is, the driver uses its argument  but  with  a  suffix  of  .d,
           otherwise  it  takes  the  name  of  the input file, removes any directory components and suffix, and
           applies a .d suffix.

           If -MD is used in conjunction with -E, any -o switch is understood to specify the  dependency  output
           file, but if used without -E, each -o is understood to specify a target object file.

           Since -E is not implied, -MD can be used to generate a dependency output file as a side-effect of the
           compilation process.

       -MMD
           Like -MD except mention only user header files, not system header files.

       -fpch-deps
           When  using  precompiled  headers,  this flag will cause the dependency-output flags to also list the
           files from the precompiled header's dependencies.  If not specified only the precompiled header would
           be listed and not the files that were used to create it because those files are not consulted when  a
           precompiled header is used.

       -fpch-preprocess
           This  option  allows  use  of a precompiled header together with -E.  It inserts a special "#pragma",
           "#pragma GCC pch_preprocess "filename"" in the output to mark the place where the precompiled  header
           was  found, and its filename.  When -fpreprocessed is in use, GCC recognizes this "#pragma" and loads
           the PCH.

           This option is off by default, because the resulting preprocessed output is only really  suitable  as
           input to GCC.  It is switched on by -save-temps.

           You  should not write this "#pragma" in your own code, but it is safe to edit the filename if the PCH
           file is available in a different location.  The filename may be absolute or it  may  be  relative  to
           GCC's current directory.

       -x c
       -x c++
       -x objective-c
       -x assembler-with-cpp
           Specify the source language: C, C++, Objective-C, or assembly.  This has nothing to do with standards
           conformance  or extensions; it merely selects which base syntax to expect.  If you give none of these
           options, cpp will deduce the language from the extension of the source file:  .c,  .cc,  .m,  or  .S.
           Some other common extensions for C++ and assembly are also recognized.  If cpp does not recognize the
           extension, it will treat the file as C; this is the most generic mode.

           Note:  Previous  versions  of  cpp  accepted  a -lang option which selected both the language and the
           standards conformance level.  This option has been removed, because it conflicts with the -l option.

       -std=standard
       -ansi
           Specify the standard to which the  code  should  conform.   Currently  CPP  knows  about  C  and  C++
           standards; others may be added in the future.

           standard may be one of:

           "c90"
           "c89"
           "iso9899:1990"
               The ISO C standard from 1990.  c90 is the customary shorthand for this version of the standard.

               The -ansi option is equivalent to -std=c90.

           "iso9899:199409"
               The 1990 C standard, as amended in 1994.

           "iso9899:1999"
           "c99"
           "iso9899:199x"
           "c9x"
               The  revised  ISO  C standard, published in December 1999.  Before publication, this was known as
               C9X.

           "iso9899:2011"
           "c11"
           "c1x"
               The revised ISO C standard, published in December 2011.  Before publication, this  was  known  as
               C1X.

           "gnu90"
           "gnu89"
               The 1990 C standard plus GNU extensions.  This is the default.

           "gnu99"
           "gnu9x"
               The 1999 C standard plus GNU extensions.

           "gnu11"
           "gnu1x"
               The 2011 C standard plus GNU extensions.

           "c++98"
               The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.

           "gnu++98"
               The same as -std=c++98 plus GNU extensions.  This is the default for C++ code.

       -I- Split  the  include path.  Any directories specified with -I options before -I- are searched only for
           headers requested with "#include "file""; they are not searched for "#include <file>".  If additional
           directories are specified with -I options after the -I-,  those  directories  are  searched  for  all
           #include directives.

           In  addition, -I- inhibits the use of the directory of the current file directory as the first search
           directory for "#include "file"".  This option has been deprecated.

       -nostdinc
           Do not search the standard system directories for  header  files.   Only  the  directories  you  have
           specified with -I options (and the directory of the current file, if appropriate) are searched.

       -nostdinc++
           Do  not  search  for  header  files in the C++-specific standard directories, but do still search the
           other standard directories.  (This option is used when building the C++ library.)

       -include file
           Process file as if "#include "file"" appeared as the first line of the primary source file.  However,
           the first directory searched for  file  is  the  preprocessor's  working  directory  instead  of  the
           directory  containing  the main source file.  If not found there, it is searched for in the remainder
           of the "#include "..."" search chain as normal.

           If multiple -include options are given, the files are included  in  the  order  they  appear  on  the
           command line.

       -imacros file
           Exactly  like  -include,  except that any output produced by scanning file is thrown away.  Macros it
           defines remain defined.  This allows you to acquire  all  the  macros  from  a  header  without  also
           processing its declarations.

           All files specified by -imacros are processed before all files specified by -include.

       -idirafter dir
           Search  dir  for  header  files,  but  do it after all directories specified with -I and the standard
           system directories have been exhausted.  dir is treated as a system include directory.  If dir begins
           with "=", then the "=" will be replaced by the sysroot prefix; see --sysroot and -isysroot.

       -iprefix prefix
           Specify prefix as the prefix for  subsequent  -iwithprefix  options.   If  the  prefix  represents  a
           directory, you should include the final /.

       -iwithprefix dir
       -iwithprefixbefore dir
           Append  dir  to the prefix specified previously with -iprefix, and add the resulting directory to the
           include search path.  -iwithprefixbefore puts it in the same place -I  would;  -iwithprefix  puts  it
           where -idirafter would.

       -isysroot dir
           This  option  is  like  the  --sysroot  option,  but  applies only to header files (except for Darwin
           targets, where it applies to both header files and libraries).  See the  --sysroot  option  for  more
           information.

       -imultilib dir
           Use dir as a subdirectory of the directory containing target-specific C++ headers.

       -isystem dir
           Search  dir  for  header  files, after all directories specified by -I but before the standard system
           directories.  Mark it as a system directory, so that it gets the same special treatment as is applied
           to the standard system directories.  If dir begins with "=", then the "=" will  be  replaced  by  the
           sysroot prefix; see --sysroot and -isysroot.

       -iquote dir
           Search  dir  only  for  header  files  requested  with  "#include "file"";  they are not searched for
           "#include <file>", before all directories specified by -I and before the standard system directories.
           If dir begins with "=", then the "=" will be replaced  by  the  sysroot  prefix;  see  --sysroot  and
           -isysroot.

       -fdirectives-only
           When preprocessing, handle directives, but do not expand macros.

           The option's behavior depends on the -E and -fpreprocessed options.

           With  -E,  preprocessing  is  limited  to the handling of directives such as "#define", "#ifdef", and
           "#error".  Other preprocessor operations, such as macro expansion and  trigraph  conversion  are  not
           performed.  In addition, the -dD option is implicitly enabled.

           With  -fpreprocessed, predefinition of command line and most builtin macros is disabled.  Macros such
           as "__LINE__", which are contextually dependent, are handled normally.  This enables  compilation  of
           files previously preprocessed with "-E -fdirectives-only".

           With  both  -E  and  -fpreprocessed, the rules for -fpreprocessed take precedence.  This enables full
           preprocessing of files previously preprocessed with "-E -fdirectives-only".

       -fdollars-in-identifiers
           Accept $ in identifiers.

       -fextended-identifiers
           Accept universal character names in identifiers.  This option is experimental; in a future version of
           GCC, it will be enabled by default for C99 and C++.

       -fno-canonical-system-headers
           When preprocessing, do not shorten system header paths with canonicalization.

       -fpreprocessed
           Indicate to the preprocessor that the input file has  already  been  preprocessed.   This  suppresses
           things  like  macro  expansion, trigraph conversion, escaped newline splicing, and processing of most
           directives.  The preprocessor still recognizes and removes comments, so that  you  can  pass  a  file
           preprocessed  with  -C to the compiler without problems.  In this mode the integrated preprocessor is
           little more than a tokenizer for the front ends.

           -fpreprocessed is implicit if the input file has one of the extensions .i, .ii or .mi.  These are the
           extensions that GCC uses for preprocessed files created by -save-temps.

       -ftabstop=width
           Set the distance between tab stops.  This helps the preprocessor report  correct  column  numbers  in
           warnings  or  errors,  even  if tabs appear on the line.  If the value is less than 1 or greater than
           100, the option is ignored.  The default is 8.

       -fdebug-cpp
           This option is only useful for debugging GCC.  When used with -E, dumps debugging  information  about
           location maps.  Every token in the output is preceded by the dump of the map its location belongs to.
           The dump of the map holding the location of a token would be:

                   {"P":F</file/path>;"F":F</includer/path>;"L":<line_num>;"C":<col_num>;"S":<system_header_p>;"M":<map_address>;"E":<macro_expansion_p>,"loc":<location>}

           When used without -E, this option has no effect.

       -ftrack-macro-expansion[=level]
           Track  locations of tokens across macro expansions. This allows the compiler to emit diagnostic about
           the current macro expansion stack when a compilation error occurs in a macro  expansion.  Using  this
           option  makes  the preprocessor and the compiler consume more memory. The level parameter can be used
           to choose the level of precision of token location tracking thus decreasing the memory consumption if
           necessary. Value 0 of level de-activates this  option  just  as  if  no  -ftrack-macro-expansion  was
           present  on  the  command  line.  Value  1 tracks tokens locations in a degraded mode for the sake of
           minimal memory overhead. In this mode all tokens resulting from the expansion of  an  argument  of  a
           function-like macro have the same location. Value 2 tracks tokens locations completely. This value is
           the most memory hungry.  When this option is given no argument, the default parameter value is 2.

           Note that -ftrack-macro-expansion=2 is activated by default.

       -fexec-charset=charset
           Set  the  execution  character  set,  used for string and character constants.  The default is UTF-8.
           charset can be any encoding supported by the system's "iconv" library routine.

       -fwide-exec-charset=charset
           Set the wide execution character set, used for wide string and character constants.  The  default  is
           UTF-32  or  UTF-16, whichever corresponds to the width of "wchar_t".  As with -fexec-charset, charset
           can be any encoding supported by the  system's  "iconv"  library  routine;  however,  you  will  have
           problems with encodings that do not fit exactly in "wchar_t".

       -finput-charset=charset
           Set  the  input  character  set, used for translation from the character set of the input file to the
           source character set used by GCC.  If the locale does not specify, or GCC cannot get this information
           from the locale, the default is UTF-8.  This can be overridden by either the locale or  this  command
           line  option.  Currently the command line option takes precedence if there's a conflict.  charset can
           be any encoding supported by the system's "iconv" library routine.

       -fworking-directory
           Enable generation of linemarkers in the preprocessor output that  will  let  the  compiler  know  the
           current  working  directory  at  the  time  of  preprocessing.   When  this  option  is  enabled, the
           preprocessor will emit, after the initial linemarker, a second linemarker with  the  current  working
           directory  followed  by  two  slashes.   GCC  will  use  this  directory,  when  it's  present in the
           preprocessed input, as the directory emitted as the  current  working  directory  in  some  debugging
           information formats.  This option is implicitly enabled if debugging information is enabled, but this
           can  be  inhibited  with  the  negated form -fno-working-directory.  If the -P flag is present in the
           command line, this option has no effect, since no "#line" directives are emitted whatsoever.

       -fno-show-column
           Do not print column numbers in diagnostics.  This may be necessary if diagnostics are  being  scanned
           by a program that does not understand the column numbers, such as dejagnu.

       -A predicate=answer
           Make  an  assertion  with  the  predicate predicate and answer answer.  This form is preferred to the
           older form -A predicate(answer), which is still supported, because it  does  not  use  shell  special
           characters.

       -A -predicate=answer
           Cancel an assertion with the predicate predicate and answer answer.

       -dCHARS
           CHARS  is a sequence of one or more of the following characters, and must not be preceded by a space.
           Other characters are interpreted by the compiler proper, or reserved for future versions of GCC,  and
           so  are  silently  ignored.   If  you  specify  characters  whose  behavior  conflicts, the result is
           undefined.

           M   Instead of the normal output, generate a list of #define directives for all  the  macros  defined
               during  the  execution of the preprocessor, including predefined macros.  This gives you a way of
               finding out what is predefined in your version of the preprocessor.  Assuming you  have  no  file
               foo.h, the command

                       touch foo.h; cpp -dM foo.h

               will show all the predefined macros.

               If you use -dM without the -E option, -dM is interpreted as a synonym for -fdump-rtl-mach.

           D   Like M except in two respects: it does not include the predefined macros, and it outputs both the
               #define  directives  and  the  result  of preprocessing.  Both kinds of output go to the standard
               output file.

           N   Like D, but emit only the macro names, not their expansions.

           I   Output #include directives in addition to the result of preprocessing.

           U   Like D except that only macros that are expanded, or whose definedness is tested in  preprocessor
               directives,  are  output;  the  output  is delayed until the use or test of the macro; and #undef
               directives are also output for macros tested but undefined at the time.

       -P  Inhibit generation of linemarkers in the output from the preprocessor.  This  might  be  useful  when
           running  the  preprocessor on something that is not C code, and will be sent to a program which might
           be confused by the linemarkers.

       -C  Do not discard comments.  All comments are passed through to the output file, except for comments  in
           processed directives, which are deleted along with the directive.

           You  should  be prepared for side effects when using -C; it causes the preprocessor to treat comments
           as tokens in their own right.  For example, comments appearing at  the  start  of  what  would  be  a
           directive  line  have  the  effect of turning that line into an ordinary source line, since the first
           token on the line is no longer a #.

       -CC Do not discard comments, including during macro expansion.  This is like  -C,  except  that  comments
           contained within macros are also passed through to the output file where the macro is expanded.

           In addition to the side-effects of the -C option, the -CC option causes all C++-style comments inside
           a  macro  to  be  converted  to  C-style  comments.   This is to prevent later use of that macro from
           inadvertently commenting out the remainder of the source line.

           The -CC option is generally used to support lint comments.

       -traditional-cpp
           Try to imitate the behavior of old-fashioned C preprocessors, as opposed to ISO C preprocessors.

       -trigraphs
           Process trigraph sequences.  These are three-character sequences, all  starting  with  ??,  that  are
           defined  by  ISO  C  to  stand  for single characters.  For example, ??/ stands for \, so '??/n' is a
           character constant for a newline.  By default, GCC  ignores  trigraphs,  but  in  standard-conforming
           modes it converts them.  See the -std and -ansi options.

           The nine trigraphs and their replacements are

                   Trigraph:       ??(  ??)  ??<  ??>  ??=  ??/  ??'  ??!  ??-
                   Replacement:      [    ]    {    }    #    \    ^    |    ~

       -remap
           Enable  special code to work around file systems which only permit very short file names, such as MS-
           DOS.

       --help
       --target-help
           Print text describing all the command line options instead of preprocessing anything.

       -v  Verbose mode.  Print out GNU CPP's version number at the beginning of execution, and report the final
           form of the include path.

       -H  Print the name of each header file used, in addition  to  other  normal  activities.   Each  name  is
           indented  to  show  how deep in the #include stack it is.  Precompiled header files are also printed,
           even if they are found to be invalid; an invalid precompiled header file is printed with ...x  and  a
           valid one with ...! .

       -version
       --version
           Print  out  GNU  CPP's  version  number.   With  one dash, proceed to preprocess as normal.  With two
           dashes, exit immediately.

   Passing Options to the Assembler
       You can pass options to the assembler.

       -Wa,option
           Pass option as an option to the assembler.  If option contains commas,  it  is  split  into  multiple
           options at the commas.

       -Xassembler option
           Pass  option  as  an  option  to the assembler.  You can use this to supply system-specific assembler
           options that GCC does not recognize.

           If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use -Xassembler twice,  once  for  the
           option and once for the argument.

   Options for Linking
       These  options  come into play when the compiler links object files into an executable output file.  They
       are meaningless if the compiler is not doing a link step.

       object-file-name
           A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is considered to name an object file  or
           library.   (Object  files  are  distinguished  from  libraries  by  the  linker according to the file
           contents.)  If linking is done, these object files are used as input to the linker.

       -c
       -S
       -E  If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and object file names should not be used
           as arguments.

       -llibrary
       -l library
           Search the library named library when linking.   (The  second  alternative  with  the  library  as  a
           separate argument is only for POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)

           It  makes  a difference where in the command you write this option; the linker searches and processes
           libraries and object files in the order they are specified.  Thus, foo.o -lz bar.o searches library z
           after file foo.o but before bar.o.  If bar.o refers to functions in z, those  functions  may  not  be
           loaded.

           The  linker  searches  a standard list of directories for the library, which is actually a file named
           liblibrary.a.  The linker then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.

           The directories searched include several standard system directories plus any that you  specify  with
           -L.

           Normally  the  files found this way are library files---archive files whose members are object files.
           The linker handles an archive file by scanning through it for members which define symbols that  have
           so far been referenced but not defined.  But if the file that is found is an ordinary object file, it
           is linked in the usual fashion.  The only difference between using an -l option and specifying a file
           name is that -l surrounds library with lib and .a and searches several directories.

       -lobjc
           You need this special case of the -l option in order to link an Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.

       -nostartfiles
           Do  not  use  the standard system startup files when linking.  The standard system libraries are used
           normally, unless -nostdlib or -nodefaultlibs is used.

       -nodefaultlibs
           Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.  Only the libraries you specify are passed  to
           the  linker,  and  options  specifying  linkage  of the system libraries, such as "-static-libgcc" or
           "-shared-libgcc", are ignored.  The standard startup files are used normally, unless -nostartfiles is
           used.

           The compiler may generate calls to "memcmp", "memset", "memcpy" and  "memmove".   These  entries  are
           usually  resolved  by  entries  in  libc.   These  entry points should be supplied through some other
           mechanism when this option is specified.

       -nostdlib
           Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.  No startup  files  and  only
           the  libraries  you  specify  are  passed to the linker, and options specifying linkage of the system
           libraries, such as "-static-libgcc" or "-shared-libgcc", are ignored.

           The compiler may generate calls to "memcmp", "memset", "memcpy" and  "memmove".   These  entries  are
           usually  resolved  by  entries  in  libc.   These  entry points should be supplied through some other
           mechanism when this option is specified.

           One of the standard libraries bypassed by -nostdlib and -nodefaultlibs  is  libgcc.a,  a  library  of
           internal subroutines which GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special needs
           for some languages.

           In  most  cases,  you  need  libgcc.a even when you want to avoid other standard libraries.  In other
           words, when you specify -nostdlib or -nodefaultlibs you should usually specify -lgcc as  well.   This
           ensures  that  you have no unresolved references to internal GCC library subroutines.  (An example of
           such an internal subroutine is __main, used to ensure C++ constructors are called.)

       -pie
           Produce a position independent executable on targets that support it.  For predictable  results,  you
           must  also  specify  the same set of options used for compilation (-fpie, -fPIE, or model suboptions)
           when you specify this linker option.

       -rdynamic
           Pass the flag -export-dynamic to the ELF linker, on targets  that  support  it.  This  instructs  the
           linker to add all symbols, not only used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed for
           some uses of "dlopen" or to allow obtaining backtraces from within a program.

       -s  Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.

       -static
           On  systems  that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared libraries.  On other
           systems, this option has no effect.

       -shared
           Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects to form an executable.   Not  all
           systems  support this option.  For predictable results, you must also specify the same set of options
           used for compilation (-fpic, -fPIC, or model suboptions) when you specify this linker option.[1]

       -shared-libgcc
       -static-libgcc
           On systems that provide libgcc as a shared library, these options force the use of either the  shared
           or  static  version,  respectively.   If  no shared version of libgcc was built when the compiler was
           configured, these options have no effect.

           There are several situations in which an application should use the  shared  libgcc  instead  of  the
           static  version.   The  most  common  of  these  is  when  the  application wishes to throw and catch
           exceptions across different shared libraries.  In that case, each of the libraries  as  well  as  the
           application itself should use the shared libgcc.

           Therefore,  the  G++  and  GCJ  drivers  automatically add -shared-libgcc whenever you build a shared
           library or a main executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so this is  the
           right thing to do.

           If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you may find that they are not always
           linked  with  the  shared  libgcc.   If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a non-GNU
           linker or a GNU linker that does not support option --eh-frame-hdr, it links the  shared  version  of
           libgcc  into  shared libraries by default.  Otherwise, it takes advantage of the linker and optimizes
           away the linking with the shared version of libgcc, linking with the  static  version  of  libgcc  by
           default.   This  allows  exceptions  to  propagate  through  such shared libraries, without incurring
           relocation costs at library load time.

           However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch exceptions, you must  link  it
           using  the  G++  or  GCJ  driver,  as appropriate for the languages used in the program, or using the
           option -shared-libgcc, such that it is linked with the shared libgcc.

       -static-libasan
           When the -fsanitize=address option is used to link a program,  the  GCC  driver  automatically  links
           against  libasan.   If  libasan is available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used,
           then this links against the shared version of libasan.  The -static-libasan option  directs  the  GCC
           driver to link libasan statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.

       -static-libtsan
           When  the  -fsanitize=thread  option  is  used  to link a program, the GCC driver automatically links
           against libtsan.  If libtsan is available as a shared library, and the -static option  is  not  used,
           then  this  links  against the shared version of libtsan.  The -static-libtsan option directs the GCC
           driver to link libtsan statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.

       -static-liblsan
           When the -fsanitize=leak option is used to link a program, the GCC driver automatically links against
           liblsan.  If liblsan is available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used, then  this
           links  against  the  shared version of liblsan.  The -static-liblsan option directs the GCC driver to
           link liblsan statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.

       -static-libubsan
           When the -fsanitize=undefined option is used to link a program, the GCC  driver  automatically  links
           against  libubsan.  If libubsan is available as a shared library, and the -static option is not used,
           then this links against the shared version of libubsan.  The -static-libubsan option directs the  GCC
           driver to link libubsan statically, without necessarily linking other libraries statically.

       -static-libstdc++
           When  the  g++  program  is  used  to  link  a  C++  program, it normally automatically links against
           libstdc++.  If libstdc++ is available as a shared library, and the -static option is not  used,  then
           this links against the shared version of libstdc++.  That is normally fine.  However, it is sometimes
           useful  to  freeze  the version of libstdc++ used by the program without going all the way to a fully
           static link.  The -static-libstdc++ option directs the  g++  driver  to  link  libstdc++  statically,
           without necessarily linking other libraries statically.

       -symbolic
           Bind  references  to  global  symbols  when  building  a  shared  object.   Warn about any unresolved
           references (unless overridden by the link editor option -Xlinker  -z  -Xlinker  defs).   Only  a  few
           systems support this option.

       -T script
           Use  script as the linker script.  This option is supported by most systems using the GNU linker.  On
           some targets, such as bare-board targets without an operating system, the -T option may  be  required
           when linking to avoid references to undefined symbols.

       -Xlinker option
           Pass  option  as  an option to the linker.  You can use this to supply system-specific linker options
           that GCC does not recognize.

           If you want to pass an option that takes a separate argument, you must use -Xlinker twice,  once  for
           the  option  and  once  for  the  argument.  For example, to pass -assert definitions, you must write
           -Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions.  It does not work to  write  -Xlinker  "-assert  definitions",
           because this passes the entire string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.

           When  using  the  GNU linker, it is usually more convenient to pass arguments to linker options using
           the option=value  syntax  than  as  separate  arguments.   For  example,  you  can  specify  -Xlinker
           -Map=output.map  rather  than  -Xlinker -Map -Xlinker output.map.  Other linkers may not support this
           syntax for command-line options.

       -Wl,option
           Pass option as an option to the linker.  If option contains commas, it is split into multiple options
           at the commas.  You  can  use  this  syntax  to  pass  an  argument  to  the  option.   For  example,
           -Wl,-Map,output.map  passes  -Map  output.map to the linker.  When using the GNU linker, you can also
           get the same effect with -Wl,-Map=output.map.

           NOTE: In Ubuntu 8.10 and later versions, for LDFLAGS, the option -Wl,-z,relro is used.   To  disable,
           use -Wl,-z,norelro.

       -u symbol
           Pretend  the  symbol  symbol is undefined, to force linking of library modules to define it.  You can
           use -u multiple times with different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.

   Options for Directory Search
       These options specify directories to search for  header  files,  for  libraries  and  for  parts  of  the
       compiler:

       -Idir
           Add  the  directory dir to the head of the list of directories to be searched for header files.  This
           can be used to override a system header file, substituting your own version, since these  directories
           are  searched  before the system header file directories.  However, you should not use this option to
           add directories that contain vendor-supplied system header files (use -isystem for that).  If you use
           more than one -I option, the directories are scanned in  left-to-right  order;  the  standard  system
           directories come after.

           If  a  standard  system  include directory, or a directory specified with -isystem, is also specified
           with -I, the -I option is ignored.  The directory is still searched but as a system directory at  its
           normal  position  in  the  system include chain.  This is to ensure that GCC's procedure to fix buggy
           system headers and the ordering for the "include_next" directive are not inadvertently  changed.   If
           you  really need to change the search order for system directories, use the -nostdinc and/or -isystem
           options.

       -iplugindir=dir
           Set  the  directory  to  search  for  plugins  that  are   passed   by   -fplugin=name   instead   of
           -fplugin=path/name.so.   This  option  is  not  meant  to be used by the user, but only passed by the
           driver.

       -iquotedir
           Add the directory dir to the head of the list of directories to be searched for header files only for
           the case of #include "file"; they are not searched for #include <file>, otherwise just like -I.

       -Ldir
           Add directory dir to the list of directories to be searched for -l.

       -Bprefix
           This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries, include files, and data files of  the
           compiler itself.

           The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms cpp, cc1, as and ld.  It tries prefix
           as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and without machine/version/.

           For  each  subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the -B prefix, if any.  If that name
           is not found, or if -B is not specified, the driver tries two standard  prefixes,  /usr/lib/gcc/  and
           /usr/local/lib/gcc/.   If  neither  of  those  results  in  a file name that is found, the unmodified
           program name is searched for using the directories specified in your PATH environment variable.

           The compiler checks to see if the path provided by the -B refers to a directory, and if necessary  it
           adds a directory separator character at the end of the path.

           -B  prefixes  that effectively specify directory names also apply to libraries in the linker, because
           the compiler translates these options into -L options for the linker.  They  also  apply  to  include
           files  in  the  preprocessor, because the compiler translates these options into -isystem options for
           the preprocessor.  In this case, the compiler appends include to the prefix.

           The runtime support file libgcc.a can also be searched for using the -B prefix, if needed.  If it  is
           not found there, the two standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all.  The file is left out of
           the link if it is not found by those means.

           Another  way  to  specify  a  prefix  much  like  the  -B  prefix  is to use the environment variable
           GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.

           As a special kludge, if the path provided by -B is [dir/]stageN/, where N is a number in the range  0
           to 9, then it is replaced by [dir/]include.  This is to help with boot-strapping the compiler.

       -specs=file
           Process  file  after the compiler reads in the standard specs file, in order to override the defaults
           which the gcc driver program uses when determining what switches to pass to  cc1,  cc1plus,  as,  ld,
           etc.   More  than  one  -specs=file  can  be specified on the command line, and they are processed in
           order, from left to right.

       --sysroot=dir
           Use dir as the logical root directory for headers  and  libraries.   For  example,  if  the  compiler
           normally  searches  for  headers  in  /usr/include  and  libraries  in  /usr/lib, it instead searches
           dir/usr/include and dir/usr/lib.

           If you use both this option and the -isysroot option, then the --sysroot option applies to libraries,
           but the -isysroot option applies to header files.

           The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary support  for  this  option.   If  your
           linker does not support this option, the header file aspect of --sysroot still works, but the library
           aspect does not.

       --no-sysroot-suffix
           For  some targets, a suffix is added to the root directory specified with --sysroot, depending on the
           other options used, so that headers may for example be found  in  dir/suffix/usr/include  instead  of
           dir/usr/include.  This option disables the addition of such a suffix.

       -I- This  option  has  been deprecated.  Please use -iquote instead for -I directories before the -I- and
           remove the -I-.  Any directories you specify with -I options before the -I- option are searched  only
           for the case of #include "file"; they are not searched for #include <file>.

           If additional directories are specified with -I options after the -I-, these directories are searched
           for all #include directives.  (Ordinarily all -I directories are used this way.)

           In  addition,  the -I- option inhibits the use of the current directory (where the current input file
           came from) as the first search directory for #include "file".  There  is  no  way  to  override  this
           effect of -I-.  With -I. you can specify searching the directory that is current when the compiler is
           invoked.   That  is  not  exactly  the same as what the preprocessor does by default, but it is often
           satisfactory.

           -I- does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories for  header  files.   Thus,  -I-  and
           -nostdinc are independent.

   Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
       The  usual  way  to  run GCC is to run the executable called gcc, or machine-gcc when cross-compiling, or
       machine-gcc-version to run a version other than the one that was installed last.

   Hardware Models and Configurations
       Each target machine types can have its own special options, starting with -m,  to  choose  among  various
       hardware  models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020, floating coprocessor or none.  A single
       installed version of the compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according  to  the  options
       specified.

       Some  configurations  of  the compiler also support additional special options, usually for compatibility
       with other compilers on the same platform.

       AArch64 Options

       These options are defined for AArch64 implementations:

       -mabi=name
           Generate code for the specified data model.  Permissible values are ilp32 for  SysV-like  data  model
           where  int,  long  int and pointer are 32-bit, and lp64 for SysV-like data model where int is 32-bit,
           but long int and pointer are 64-bit.

           The default depends on the specific target configuration.  Note that the LP64 and ILP32 ABIs are  not
           link-compatible;  you  must compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a compatible
           set of libraries.

       -mbig-endian
           Generate big-endian code.  This is the default when GCC is configured for an aarch64_be-*-* target.

       -mgeneral-regs-only
           Generate code which uses only the general registers.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate little-endian code.  This is the default when GCC is configured for an aarch64-*-*  but  not
           an aarch64_be-*-* target.

       -mcmodel=tiny
           Generate code for the tiny code model.  The program and its statically defined symbols must be within
           1GB  of  each  other.  Pointers are 64 bits.  Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.  This
           model is not fully implemented and mostly treated as small.

       -mcmodel=small
           Generate code for the small code model.  The program and  its  statically  defined  symbols  must  be
           within  4GB  of each other.  Pointers are 64 bits.  Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.
           This is the default code model.

       -mcmodel=large
           Generate code for the large code model.  This makes no  assumptions  about  addresses  and  sizes  of
           sections.  Pointers are 64 bits.  Programs can be statically linked only.

       -mstrict-align
           Do not assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.

       -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
       -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
           Omit or keep the frame pointer in leaf functions.  The former behaviour is the default.

       -mtls-dialect=desc
           Use  TLS  descriptors  as  the  thread-local storage mechanism for dynamic accesses of TLS variables.
           This is the default.

       -mtls-dialect=traditional
           Use traditional TLS as the thread-local storage mechanism for dynamic accesses of TLS variables.

       -mfix-cortex-a53-835769
       -mno-fix-cortex-a53-835769
           Enable or disable the workaround for the ARM Cortex-A53 erratum number  835769.   This  will  involve
           inserting  a  NOP  instruction  between  memory  instructions  and 64-bit integer multiply-accumulate
           instructions.

       -mfix-cortex-a53-843419
       -mno-fix-cortex-a53-843419
           Enable or disable the workaround  for  the  ARM  Cortex-A53  erratum  number  843419.   This  erratum
           workaround is made at link time and this will only pass the corresponding flag to the linker.

       -march=name
           Specify  the  name  of the target architecture, optionally suffixed by one or more feature modifiers.
           This option has the form -march=arch{+[no]feature}*, where the only permissible  value  for  arch  is
           armv8-a.  The permissible values for feature are documented in the sub-section below.

           Where conflicting feature modifiers are specified, the right-most feature is used.

           GCC uses this name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating assembly code.

           Where  -march  is  specified without either of -mtune or -mcpu also being specified, the code will be
           tuned to perform well across a range of target processors implementing the target architecture.

       -mtune=name
           Specify the name of the target processor for which GCC should  tune  the  performance  of  the  code.
           Permissible values for this option are: generic, cortex-a53, cortex-a57.

           Additionally,  this  option  can  specify  that  GCC  should  tune  the performance of the code for a
           big.LITTLE system.  The only permissible value is cortex-a57.cortex-a53.

           Where none of -mtune=, -mcpu= or -march= are specified, the code will be tuned to perform well across
           a range of target processors.

           This option cannot be suffixed by feature modifiers.

       -mcpu=name
           Specify the name of the target processor, optionally suffixed by one or more feature modifiers.  This
           option has the form -mcpu=cpu{+[no]feature}*, where the permissible values for cpu are  the  same  as
           those available for -mtune.

           The permissible values for feature are documented in the sub-section below.

           Where conflicting feature modifiers are specified, the right-most feature is used.

           GCC  uses  this name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating assembly code
           (as if by -march) and to determine the target processor for which to tune for performance (as  if  by
           -mtune).   Where  this  option  is  used  in  conjunction  with  -march or -mtune, those options take
           precedence over the appropriate part of this option.

       -march and -mcpu feature modifiers

       Feature modifiers used with -march and -mcpu can be one the following:

       crc Enable CRC extension.

       crypto
           Enable Crypto extension.  This implies Advanced SIMD is enabled.

       fp  Enable floating-point instructions.

       simd
           Enable Advanced SIMD instructions.  This implies floating-point instructions are  enabled.   This  is
           the default for all current possible values for options -march and -mcpu=.

       Adapteva Epiphany Options

       These -m options are defined for Adapteva Epiphany:

       -mhalf-reg-file
           Don't allocate any register in the range "r32"..."r63".  That allows code to run on hardware variants
           that lack these registers.

       -mprefer-short-insn-regs
           Preferrentially  allocate  registers  that  allow  short  instruction generation.  This can result in
           increased instruction count, so this may either reduce or increase overall code size.

       -mbranch-cost=num
           Set the cost of branches to roughly num "simple" instructions.  This cost is only a heuristic and  is
           not guaranteed to produce consistent results across releases.

       -mcmove
           Enable the generation of conditional moves.

       -mnops=num
           Emit num NOPs before every other generated instruction.

       -mno-soft-cmpsf
           For single-precision floating-point comparisons, emit an "fsub" instruction and test the flags.  This
           is  faster than a software comparison, but can get incorrect results in the presence of NaNs, or when
           two different small numbers are compared such that their  difference  is  calculated  as  zero.   The
           default is -msoft-cmpsf, which uses slower, but IEEE-compliant, software comparisons.

       -mstack-offset=num
           Set the offset between the top of the stack and the stack pointer.  E.g., a value of 8 means that the
           eight  bytes  in  the  range  "sp+0...sp+7"  can  be used by leaf functions without stack allocation.
           Values other than 8 or 16 are untested and unlikely to work.  Note also that this option changes  the
           ABI;  compiling  a  program  with a different stack offset than the libraries have been compiled with
           generally does not work.  This option can be useful if you want to  evaluate  if  a  different  stack
           offset  would  give  you  better  code, but to actually use a different stack offset to build working
           programs, it is recommended to configure the toolchain with the  appropriate  --with-stack-offset=num
           option.

       -mno-round-nearest
           Make  the  scheduler  assume  that  the  rounding  mode  has  been set to truncating.  The default is
           -mround-nearest.

       -mlong-calls
           If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all calls might be beyond the offset range of  the
           "b"  / "bl" instructions, and therefore load the function address into a register before performing a
           (otherwise direct) call.  This is the default.

       -mshort-calls
           If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all direct calls are in the range  of  the  "b"  /
           "bl" instructions, so use these instructions for direct calls.  The default is -mlong-calls.

       -msmall16
           Assume  addresses can be loaded as 16-bit unsigned values.  This does not apply to function addresses
           for which -mlong-calls semantics are in effect.

       -mfp-mode=mode
           Set the prevailing mode of the floating-point unit.  This determines the floating-point mode that  is
           provided  and  expected  at  function  call  and  return  time.   Making this mode match the mode you
           predominantly need at  function  start  can  make  your  programs  smaller  and  faster  by  avoiding
           unnecessary mode switches.

           mode can be set to one the following values:

           caller
               Any mode at function entry is valid, and retained or restored when the function returns, and when
               it calls other functions.  This mode is useful for compiling libraries or other compilation units
               you  might  want  to incorporate into different programs with different prevailing FPU modes, and
               the convenience of being able to use a single object file outweighs the size and  speed  overhead
               for any extra mode switching that might be needed, compared with what would be needed with a more
               specific choice of prevailing FPU mode.

           truncate
               This  is  the mode used for floating-point calculations with truncating (i.e. round towards zero)
               rounding mode.  That includes conversion from floating point to integer.

           round-nearest
               This is the mode used for  floating-point  calculations  with  round-to-nearest-or-even  rounding
               mode.

           int This  is  the  mode  used  to perform integer calculations in the FPU, e.g.  integer multiply, or
               integer multiply-and-accumulate.

           The default is -mfp-mode=caller

       -mnosplit-lohi
       -mno-postinc
       -mno-postmodify
           Code generation tweaks that disable, respectively, splitting of 32-bit  loads,  generation  of  post-
           increment  addresses,  and  generation  of  post-modify  addresses.   The  defaults  are msplit-lohi,
           -mpost-inc, and -mpost-modify.

       -mnovect-double
           Change the preferred SIMD mode to SImode.   The  default  is  -mvect-double,  which  uses  DImode  as
           preferred SIMD mode.

       -max-vect-align=num
           The  maximum  alignment for SIMD vector mode types.  num may be 4 or 8.  The default is 8.  Note that
           this is an ABI change, even though many library function interfaces are unaffected if they don't  use
           SIMD vector modes in places that affect size and/or alignment of relevant types.

       -msplit-vecmove-early
           Split  vector  moves  into  single word moves before reload.  In theory this can give better register
           allocation, but so far the reverse seems to be generally the case.

       -m1reg-reg
           Specify a register to hold the constant -1, which makes loading small negative constants and  certain
           bitmasks  faster.   Allowable values for reg are r43 and r63, which specify use of that register as a
           fixed register, and none, which means that no register is used for  this  purpose.   The  default  is
           -m1reg-none.

       ARC Options

       The following options control the architecture variant for which code is being compiled:

       -mbarrel-shifter
           Generate  instructions  supported  by  barrel shifter.  This is the default unless -mcpu=ARC601 is in
           effect.

       -mcpu=cpu
           Set architecture type, register usage, and instruction scheduling parameters for cpu.  There are also
           shortcut alias options available for backward compatibility and convenience.   Supported  values  for
           cpu are

           ARC600
               Compile for ARC600.  Aliases: -mA6, -mARC600.

           ARC601
               Compile for ARC601.  Alias: -mARC601.

           ARC700
               Compile  for  ARC700.   Aliases:  -mA7,  -mARC700.   This  is  the  default  when configured with
               --with-cpu=arc700.

       -mdpfp
       -mdpfp-compact
           FPX: Generate Double Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the compact implementation.

       -mdpfp-fast
           FPX: Generate Double Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the fast implementation.

       -mno-dpfp-lrsr
           Disable LR and SR instructions from using FPX extension aux registers.

       -mea
           Generate Extended arithmetic instructions.  Currently only "divaw", "adds", "subs", and  "sat16"  are
           supported.  This is always enabled for -mcpu=ARC700.

       -mno-mpy
           Do not generate mpy instructions for ARC700.

       -mmul32x16
           Generate 32x16 bit multiply and mac instructions.

       -mmul64
           Generate mul64 and mulu64 instructions.  Only valid for -mcpu=ARC600.

       -mnorm
           Generate norm instruction.  This is the default if -mcpu=ARC700 is in effect.

       -mspfp
       -mspfp-compact
           FPX: Generate Single Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the compact implementation.

       -mspfp-fast
           FPX: Generate Single Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the fast implementation.

       -msimd
           Enable   generation   of  ARC  SIMD  instructions  via  target-specific  builtins.   Only  valid  for
           -mcpu=ARC700.

       -msoft-float
           This option ignored; it is provided for compatibility purposes only.  Software floating point code is
           emitted by default, and this default can overridden by FPX options; mspfp, mspfp-compact,  or  mspfp-
           fast for single precision, and mdpfp, mdpfp-compact, or mdpfp-fast for double precision.

       -mswap
           Generate swap instructions.

       The following options are passed through to the assembler, and also define preprocessor macro symbols.

       -mdsp-packa
           Passed  down to the assembler to enable the DSP Pack A extensions.  Also sets the preprocessor symbol
           "__Xdsp_packa".

       -mdvbf
           Passed down to the assembler  to  enable  the  dual  viterbi  butterfly  extension.   Also  sets  the
           preprocessor symbol "__Xdvbf".

       -mlock
           Passed  down  to  the assembler to enable the Locked Load/Store Conditional extension.  Also sets the
           preprocessor symbol "__Xlock".

       -mmac-d16
           Passed down to the assembler.  Also sets the preprocessor symbol "__Xxmac_d16".

       -mmac-24
           Passed down to the assembler.  Also sets the preprocessor symbol "__Xxmac_24".

       -mrtsc
           Passed down to the assembler to enable the 64-bit Time-Stamp  Counter  extension  instruction.   Also
           sets the preprocessor symbol "__Xrtsc".

       -mswape
           Passed  down  to the assembler to enable the swap byte ordering extension instruction.  Also sets the
           preprocessor symbol "__Xswape".

       -mtelephony
           Passed down to the assembler to enable dual and single operand instructions for telephony.  Also sets
           the preprocessor symbol "__Xtelephony".

       -mxy
           Passed down to the assembler to enable the XY Memory extension.  Also sets  the  preprocessor  symbol
           "__Xxy".

       The following options control how the assembly code is annotated:

       -misize
           Annotate assembler instructions with estimated addresses.

       -mannotate-align
           Explain what alignment considerations lead to the decision to make an instruction short or long.

       The following options are passed through to the linker:

       -marclinux
           Passed  through to the linker, to specify use of the "arclinux" emulation.  This option is enabled by
           default in tool chains built for "arc-linux-uclibc" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets  when  profiling
           is not requested.

       -marclinux_prof
           Passed  through  to  the  linker,  to  specify  use of the "arclinux_prof" emulation.  This option is
           enabled by default in tool chains built for "arc-linux-uclibc" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets  when
           profiling is requested.

       The following options control the semantics of generated code:

       -mepilogue-cfi
           Enable generation of call frame information for epilogues.

       -mno-epilogue-cfi
           Disable generation of call frame information for epilogues.

       -mlong-calls
           Generate  call  insns  as  register  indirect calls, thus providing access to the full 32-bit address
           range.

       -mmedium-calls
           Don't use less than 25 bit addressing  range  for  calls,  which  is  the  offset  available  for  an
           unconditional branch-and-link instruction.  Conditional execution of function calls is suppressed, to
           allow  use  of the 25-bit range, rather than the 21-bit range with conditional branch-and-link.  This
           is the default for tool chains built for "arc-linux-uclibc" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets.

       -mno-sdata
           Do not generate sdata references.  This is the default for tool chains built  for  "arc-linux-uclibc"
           and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets.

       -mucb-mcount
           Instrument  with  mcount  calls  as  used  in  UCB code.  I.e. do the counting in the callee, not the
           caller.  By default ARC instrumentation counts in the caller.

       -mvolatile-cache
           Use ordinarily cached memory accesses for volatile references.  This is the default.

       -mno-volatile-cache
           Enable cache bypass for volatile references.

       The following options fine tune code generation:

       -malign-call
           Do alignment optimizations for call instructions.

       -mauto-modify-reg
           Enable the use of pre/post modify with register displacement.

       -mbbit-peephole
           Enable bbit peephole2.

       -mno-brcc
           This option disables a target-specific pass in arc_reorg to generate "BRcc" instructions.  It has  no
           effect on "BRcc" generation driven by the combiner pass.

       -mcase-vector-pcrel
           Use  pc-relative  switch  case  tables - this enables case table shortening.  This is the default for
           -Os.

       -mcompact-casesi
           Enable compact casesi pattern.  This is the default for -Os.

       -mno-cond-exec
           Disable ARCompact specific pass to generate conditional execution instructions.  Due  to  delay  slot
           scheduling  and  interactions  between  operand  numbers, literal sizes, instruction lengths, and the
           support for conditional execution, the target-independent pass to generate conditional  execution  is
           often  lacking,  so  the  ARC port has kept a special pass around that tries to find more conditional
           execution generating opportunities after register  allocation,  branch  shortening,  and  delay  slot
           scheduling  have been done.  This pass generally, but not always, improves performance and code size,
           at the cost of extra compilation time, which is why there is an option to switch it off.  If you have
           a  problem  with  call  instructions  exceeding  their  allowable  offset  range  because  they   are
           conditionalized, you should consider using -mmedium-calls instead.

       -mearly-cbranchsi
           Enable pre-reload use of the cbranchsi pattern.

       -mexpand-adddi
           Expand "adddi3" and "subdi3" at rtl generation time into "add.f", "adc" etc.

       -mindexed-loads
           Enable  the  use  of indexed loads.  This can be problematic because some optimizers will then assume
           the that indexed stores exist, which is not the case.

       -mlra
           Enable Local Register Allocation.  This is still experimental for ARC, so  by  default  the  compiler
           uses standard reload (i.e. -mno-lra).

       -mlra-priority-none
           Don't indicate any priority for target registers.

       -mlra-priority-compact
           Indicate target register priority for r0..r3 / r12..r15.

       -mlra-priority-noncompact
           Reduce target regsiter priority for r0..r3 / r12..r15.

       -mno-millicode
           When  optimizing  for  size (using -Os), prologues and epilogues that have to save or restore a large
           number of registers are often shortened by using call to  a  special  function  in  libgcc;  this  is
           referred  to  as  a millicode call.  As these calls can pose performance issues, and/or cause linking
           issues when linking in a nonstandard way,  this  option  is  provided  to  turn  off  millicode  call
           generation.

       -mmixed-code
           Tweak  register  allocation  to help 16-bit instruction generation.  This generally has the effect of
           decreasing the average instruction size while increasing the instruction count.

       -mq-class
           Enable 'q' instruction alternatives.  This is the default for -Os.

       -mRcq
           Enable Rcq constraint handling - most short code generation depends on this.  This is the default.

       -mRcw
           Enable Rcw constraint handling - ccfsm condexec mostly depends on this.  This is the default.

       -msize-level=level
           Fine-tune size optimization with regards to instruction lengths and alignment.  The recognized values
           for level are:

           0   No size optimization.  This level is deprecated and treated like 1.

           1   Short instructions are used opportunistically.

           2   In addition, alignment of loops and of code after barriers are dropped.

           3   In addition, optional data alignment is dropped, and the option Os is enabled.

           This defaults to 3 when -Os is in effect.  Otherwise, the behavior when this is not set is equivalent
           to level 1.

       -mtune=cpu
           Set instruction scheduling parameters for cpu, overriding any implied by -mcpu=.

           Supported values for cpu are

           ARC600
               Tune for ARC600 cpu.

           ARC601
               Tune for ARC601 cpu.

           ARC700
               Tune for ARC700 cpu with standard multiplier block.

           ARC700-xmac
               Tune for ARC700 cpu with XMAC block.

           ARC725D
               Tune for ARC725D cpu.

           ARC750D
               Tune for ARC750D cpu.

       -mmultcost=num
           Cost to assume for a multiply instruction, with 4 being equal to a normal instruction.

       -munalign-prob-threshold=probability
           Set probability threshold for unaligning branches.  When tuning for ARC700 and optimizing for  speed,
           branches  without  filled  delay  slot  are  preferably  emitted unaligned and long, unless profiling
           indicates that the probability for the branch to be taken  is  below  probability.   The  default  is
           (REG_BR_PROB_BASE/2), i.e. 5000.

       The  following  options  are  maintained  for  backward compatibility, but are now deprecated and will be
       removed in a future release:

       -margonaut
           Obsolete FPX.

       -mbig-endian
       -EB Compile code for big endian targets.  Use of these options is now  deprecated.   Users  wanting  big-
           endian  code,  should  use  the "arceb-elf32" and "arceb-linux-uclibc" targets when building the tool
           chain, for which big-endian is the default.

       -mlittle-endian
       -EL Compile code for little endian targets.  Use of these  options  is  now  deprecated.   Users  wanting
           little-endian  code  should use the "arc-elf32" and "arc-linux-uclibc" targets when building the tool
           chain, for which little-endian is the default.

       -mbarrel_shifter
           Replaced by -mbarrel-shifter

       -mdpfp_compact
           Replaced by -mdpfp-compact

       -mdpfp_fast
           Replaced by -mdpfp-fast

       -mdsp_packa
           Replaced by -mdsp-packa

       -mEA
           Replaced by -mea

       -mmac_24
           Replaced by -mmac-24

       -mmac_d16
           Replaced by -mmac-d16

       -mspfp_compact
           Replaced by -mspfp-compact

       -mspfp_fast
           Replaced by -mspfp-fast

       -mtune=cpu
           Values arc600, arc601, arc700 and arc700-xmac for cpu are replaced  by  ARC600,  ARC601,  ARC700  and
           ARC700-xmac respectively

       -multcost=num
           Replaced by -mmultcost.

       ARM Options

       These -m options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM) architectures:

       -mabi=name
           Generate code for the specified ABI.  Permissible values are: apcs-gnu, atpcs, aapcs, aapcs-linux and
           iwmmxt.

       -mapcs-frame
           Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call Standard for all functions, even
           if this is not strictly necessary for correct execution of the code.  Specifying -fomit-frame-pointer
           with  this  option  causes  the  stack frames not to be generated for leaf functions.  The default is
           -mno-apcs-frame.

       -mapcs
           This is a synonym for -mapcs-frame.

       -mthumb-interwork
           Generate code that supports calling between the ARM and Thumb instruction sets.  Without this option,
           on pre-v5 architectures, the two instruction sets cannot be reliably used inside  one  program.   The
           default  is  -mno-thumb-interwork,  since slightly larger code is generated when -mthumb-interwork is
           specified.  In AAPCS configurations this option is meaningless.

       -mno-sched-prolog
           Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prologue, or the merging of those  instruction
           with  the  instructions  in  the  function's  body.   This  means  that  all  functions  start with a
           recognizable set of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of  different  function
           prologues),  and  this  information can be used to locate the start of functions inside an executable
           piece of code.  The default is -msched-prolog.

       -mfloat-abi=name
           Specifies which floating-point ABI to use.  Permissible values are: soft, softfp and hard.

           Specifying soft causes GCC to generate output containing library calls for floating-point operations.
           softfp allows the generation of code using hardware floating-point instructions, but still  uses  the
           soft-float  calling conventions.  hard allows generation of floating-point instructions and uses FPU-
           specific calling conventions.

           The default depends on the specific target configuration.  Note that the  hard-float  and  soft-float
           ABIs are not link-compatible; you must compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a
           compatible set of libraries.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate  code  for  a processor running in little-endian mode.  This is the default for all standard
           configurations.

       -mbig-endian
           Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the  default  is  to  compile  code  for  a
           little-endian processor.

       -mwords-little-endian
           This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.  Generate code for a little-
           endian  word  order  but a big-endian byte order.  That is, a byte order of the form 32107654.  Note:
           this option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for big-endian ARM  processors
           generated by versions of the compiler prior to 2.8.  This option is now deprecated.

       -march=name
           This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture.  GCC uses this name to determine what kind of
           instructions  it can emit when generating assembly code.  This option can be used in conjunction with
           or instead of the -mcpu= option.  Permissible names are: armv2, armv2a, armv3, armv3m, armv4, armv4t,
           armv5, armv5t, armv5e, armv5te, armv6, armv6j, armv6t2, armv6z,  armv6zk,  armv6-m,  armv7,  armv7-a,
           armv7-r, armv7-m, armv7e-m, armv7ve, armv8-a, armv8-a+crc, iwmmxt, iwmmxt2, ep9312.

           -march=armv7ve is the armv7-a architecture with virtualization extensions.

           -march=armv8-a+crc  enables  code  generation for the ARMv8-A architecture together with the optional
           CRC32 extensions.

           -march=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the architecture of the build computer.  At present,
           this feature is only supported on GNU/Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the  auto-
           detect is unsuccessful the option has no effect.

       -mtune=name
           This  option specifies the name of the target ARM processor for which GCC should tune the performance
           of the code.  For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using  this  option.
           Permissible  names  are: arm2, arm250, arm3, arm6, arm60, arm600, arm610, arm620, arm7, arm7m, arm7d,
           arm7dm,  arm7di,  arm7dmi,  arm70,  arm700,  arm700i,  arm710,  arm710c,  arm7100,  arm720,  arm7500,
           arm7500fe,  arm7tdmi,  arm7tdmi-s, arm710t, arm720t, arm740t, strongarm, strongarm110, strongarm1100,
           strongarm1110, arm8, arm810, arm9, arm9e, arm920, arm920t, arm922t, arm946e-s, arm966e-s,  arm968e-s,
           arm926ej-s,   arm940t,  arm9tdmi,  arm10tdmi,  arm1020t,  arm1026ej-s,  arm10e,  arm1020e,  arm1022e,
           arm1136j-s, arm1136jf-s, mpcore, mpcorenovfp, arm1156t2-s, arm1156t2f-s,  arm1176jz-s,  arm1176jzf-s,
           cortex-a5,   cortex-a7,   cortex-a8,   cortex-a9,  cortex-a12,  cortex-a15,  cortex-a53,  cortex-a57,
           cortex-r4,  cortex-r4f,   cortex-r5,   cortex-r7,   cortex-m4,   cortex-m3,   cortex-m1,   cortex-m0,
           cortex-m0plus,  marvell-pj4, xscale, iwmmxt, iwmmxt2, ep9312, fa526, fa626, fa606te, fa626te, fmp626,
           fa726te.

           Additionally, this option can specify that GCC  should  tune  the  performance  of  the  code  for  a
           big.LITTLE system.  Permissible names are: cortex-a15.cortex-a7, cortex-a57.cortex-a53.

           -mtune=generic-arch  specifies  that GCC should tune the performance for a blend of processors within
           architecture arch.  The aim is to generate code that run well on the current most popular processors,
           balancing between optimizations that benefit  some  CPUs  in  the  range,  and  avoiding  performance
           pitfalls  of  other CPUs.  The effects of this option may change in future GCC versions as CPU models
           come and go.

           -mtune=native causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU of the build  computer.   At  present,  this
           feature is only supported on GNU/Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect
           is unsuccessful the option has no effect.

       -mcpu=name
           This  specifies  the  name of the target ARM processor.  GCC uses this name to derive the name of the
           target ARM architecture (as if specified by -march) and the ARM processor type for which to tune  for
           performance  (as  if  specified  by -mtune).  Where this option is used in conjunction with -march or
           -mtune, those options take precedence over the appropriate part of this option.

           Permissible names for this option are the same as those for -mtune.

           -mcpu=generic-arch is also permissible, and is equivalent to  -march=arch  -mtune=generic-arch.   See
           -mtune for more information.

           -mcpu=native  causes  the  compiler  to  auto-detect the CPU of the build computer.  At present, this
           feature is only supported on GNU/Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect
           is unsuccessful the option has no effect.

       -mfpu=name
           This specifies what floating-point hardware (or hardware  emulation)  is  available  on  the  target.
           Permissible  names  are:  vfp,  vfpv3,  vfpv3-fp16, vfpv3-d16, vfpv3-d16-fp16, vfpv3xd, vfpv3xd-fp16,
           neon,  neon-fp16,  vfpv4,  vfpv4-d16,   fpv4-sp-d16,   neon-vfpv4,   fp-armv8,   neon-fp-armv8,   and
           crypto-neon-fp-armv8.

           If -msoft-float is specified this specifies the format of floating-point values.

           If  the  selected  floating-point  hardware  includes the NEON extension (e.g. -mfpu=neon), note that
           floating-point   operations   are   not   generated   by   GCC's   auto-vectorization   pass   unless
           -funsafe-math-optimizations  is  also  specified.   This  is  because  NEON  hardware  does not fully
           implement the IEEE 754 standard for floating-point arithmetic  (in  particular  denormal  values  are
           treated as zero), so the use of NEON instructions may lead to a loss of precision.

       -mfp16-format=name
           Specify  the  format of the "__fp16" half-precision floating-point type.  Permissible names are none,
           ieee, and alternative; the default is none, in which case the "__fp16" type is not defined.

       -mstructure-size-boundary=n
           The sizes of all structures and unions are rounded up to a multiple of the number of bits set by this
           option.  Permissible values are 8, 32 and 64.  The default value  varies  for  different  toolchains.
           For  the  COFF  targeted  toolchain  the  default  value  is 8.  A value of 64 is only allowed if the
           underlying ABI supports it.

           Specifying a larger number can produce faster, more efficient code, but can also increase the size of
           the program.  Different values are potentially incompatible.  Code compiled  with  one  value  cannot
           necessarily  expect  to  work  with  code  or libraries compiled with another value, if they exchange
           information using structures or unions.

       -mabort-on-noreturn
           Generate a call to the function "abort" at the end of a "noreturn" function.  It is executed  if  the
           function tries to return.

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Tells  the  compiler  to  perform  function calls by first loading the address of the function into a
           register and then performing a subroutine call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target
           function lies outside of the 64-megabyte addressing range of the offset-based version  of  subroutine
           call instruction.

           Even  if this switch is enabled, not all function calls are turned into long calls.  The heuristic is
           that static functions, functions that have the short-call attribute, functions that  are  inside  the
           scope  of  a  #pragma  no_long_calls  directive,  and  functions  whose definitions have already been
           compiled within the current compilation unit are not turned into long calls.  The exceptions to  this
           rule  are  that  weak  function  definitions,  functions  with the long-call attribute or the section
           attribute, and functions that are within the scope of  a  #pragma  long_calls  directive  are  always
           turned into long calls.

           This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying -mno-long-calls restores the default behavior, as
           does  placing  the function calls within the scope of a #pragma long_calls_off directive.  Note these
           switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to  handle  function  calls  via  function
           pointers.

       -msingle-pic-base
           Treat  the  register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than loading it in the prologue for
           each function.  The runtime system is responsible for initializing this register with an  appropriate
           value before execution begins.

       -mpic-register=reg
           Specify  the register to be used for PIC addressing.  For standard PIC base case, the default will be
           any suitable register determined by compiler.  For single PIC base case, the default is R9 if  target
           is EABI based or stack-checking is enabled, otherwise the default is R10.

       -mpic-data-is-text-relative
           Assume  that  each  data  segments  are relative to text segment at load time.  Therefore, it permits
           addressing data using PC-relative operations.  This option is on by default for  targets  other  than
           VxWorks RTP.

       -mpoke-function-name
           Write the name of each function into the text section, directly preceding the function prologue.  The
           generated code is similar to this:

                        t0
                            .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
                            .align
                        t1
                            .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
                        arm_poke_function_name
                            mov     ip, sp
                            stmfd   sp!, {fp, ip, lr, pc}
                            sub     fp, ip, #4

           When  performing  a  stack  backtrace, code can inspect the value of "pc" stored at "fp + 0".  If the
           trace function then looks at location "pc - 12" and the top 8 bits are set, then we know  that  there
           is  a  function  name  embedded  immediately  preceding  this  location  and  has length "((pc[-3]) &
           0xff000000)".

       -mthumb
       -marm
           Select between generating code that  executes  in  ARM  and  Thumb  states.   The  default  for  most
           configurations  is  to  generate  code  that executes in ARM state, but the default can be changed by
           configuring GCC with the --with-mode=state configure option.

       -mtpcs-frame
           Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure  Call  Standard  for  all  non-leaf
           functions.   (A  leaf  function  is  one  that  does  not  call any other functions.)  The default is
           -mno-tpcs-frame.

       -mtpcs-leaf-frame
           Generate a stack frame that is compliant  with  the  Thumb  Procedure  Call  Standard  for  all  leaf
           functions.   (A  leaf  function  is  one  that  does  not  call any other functions.)  The default is
           -mno-apcs-leaf-frame.

       -mcallee-super-interworking
           Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM instruction set header which
           switches to Thumb mode before executing the rest of the function.  This allows these functions to  be
           called  from  non-interworking  code.   This  option  is  not  valid  in AAPCS configurations because
           interworking is enabled by default.

       -mcaller-super-interworking
           Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to execute correctly  regardless  of
           whether  the target code has been compiled for interworking or not.  There is a small overhead in the
           cost of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.  This option is not  valid  in  AAPCS
           configurations because interworking is enabled by default.

       -mtp=name
           Specify  the  access  model  for  the thread local storage pointer.  The valid models are soft, which
           generates calls to "__aeabi_read_tp", cp15, which fetches the thread  pointer  from  "cp15"  directly
           (supported  in  the  arm6k  architecture),  and  auto,  which  uses the best available method for the
           selected processor.  The default setting is auto.

       -mtls-dialect=dialect
           Specify the dialect to use for accessing thread local storage.  Two dialects are supported---gnu  and
           gnu2.   The  gnu  dialect selects the original GNU scheme for supporting local and global dynamic TLS
           models.  The gnu2 dialect selects the GNU descriptor scheme, which provides  better  performance  for
           shared libraries.  The GNU descriptor scheme is compatible with the original scheme, but does require
           new  assembler, linker and library support.  Initial and local exec TLS models are unaffected by this
           option and always use the original scheme.

       -mword-relocations
           Only generate absolute relocations on word-sized values  (i.e.  R_ARM_ABS32).   This  is  enabled  by
           default  on  targets (uClinux, SymbianOS) where the runtime loader imposes this restriction, and when
           -fpic or -fPIC is specified.

       -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
           Some Cortex-M3 cores can cause data corruption when "ldrd" instructions with overlapping  destination
           and  base  registers  are  used.   This  option avoids generating these instructions.  This option is
           enabled by default when -mcpu=cortex-m3 is specified.

       -munaligned-access
       -mno-unaligned-access
           Enables (or disables) reading and writing of 16- and 32- bit values from addresses that are  not  16-
           or  32-  bit  aligned.   By  default  unaligned  access is disabled for all pre-ARMv6 and all ARMv6-M
           architectures, and enabled for all other architectures.  If unaligned  access  is  not  enabled  then
           words in packed data structures will be accessed a byte at a time.

           The  ARM attribute "Tag_CPU_unaligned_access" will be set in the generated object file to either true
           or false, depending upon the setting of this  option.   If  unaligned  access  is  enabled  then  the
           preprocessor symbol "__ARM_FEATURE_UNALIGNED" will also be defined.

       -mneon-for-64bits
           Enables using Neon to handle scalar 64-bits operations. This is disabled by default since the cost of
           moving data from core registers to Neon is high.

       -mslow-flash-data
           Assume  loading  data  from  flash  is  slower  than fetching instruction.  Therefore literal load is
           minimized for better performance.  This option is only supported when compiling for  ARMv7  M-profile
           and off by default.

       -mrestrict-it
           Restricts  generation  of  IT  blocks to conform to the rules of ARMv8.  IT blocks can only contain a
           single 16-bit instruction from a select set of instructions. This option is on by default  for  ARMv8
           Thumb mode.

       AVR Options

       These options are defined for AVR implementations:

       -mmcu=mcu
           Specify Atmel AVR instruction set architectures (ISA) or MCU type.

           The default for this option is@tie{}"avr2".

           GCC supports the following AVR devices and ISAs:

           "avr2"
               "Classic"  devices  with  up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.  mcu@tie{}= "attiny22", "attiny26",
               "at90c8534",  "at90s2313",  "at90s2323",  "at90s2333",  "at90s2343",  "at90s4414",   "at90s4433",
               "at90s4434", "at90s8515", "at90s8535".

           "avr25"
               "Classic"  devices  with  up  to  8@tie{}KiB  of  program memory and with the "MOVW" instruction.
               mcu@tie{}=  "ata5272",   "ata6289",   "attiny13",   "attiny13a",   "attiny2313",   "attiny2313a",
               "attiny24",   "attiny24a",  "attiny25",  "attiny261",  "attiny261a",  "attiny43u",  "attiny4313",
               "attiny44",  "attiny44a",  "attiny45",   "attiny461",   "attiny461a",   "attiny48",   "attiny84",
               "attiny84a", "attiny85", "attiny861", "attiny861a", "attiny87", "attiny88", "at86rf401".

           "avr3"
               "Classic"   devices   with   16@tie{}KiB  up  to  64@tie{}KiB  of   program  memory.   mcu@tie{}=
               "at43usb355", "at76c711".

           "avr31"
               "Classic" devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.  mcu@tie{}= "atmega103", "at43usb320".

           "avr35"
               "Classic" devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB  of  program  memory  and  with  the  "MOVW"
               instruction.    mcu@tie{}=  "ata5505",  "atmega16u2",  "atmega32u2",  "atmega8u2",  "attiny1634",
               "attiny167", "at90usb162", "at90usb82".

           "avr4"
               "Enhanced" devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program  memory.   mcu@tie{}=  "ata6285",  "ata6286",
               "atmega48",   "atmega48a",   "atmega48p",   "atmega48pa",  "atmega8",  "atmega8a",  "atmega8hva",
               "atmega8515",  "atmega8535",  "atmega88",  "atmega88a",  "atmega88p",  "atmega88pa",  "at90pwm1",
               "at90pwm2", "at90pwm2b", "at90pwm3", "at90pwm3b", "at90pwm81".

           "avr5"
               "Enhanced"  devices  with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program memory.  mcu@tie{}= "ata5790",
               "ata5790n", "ata5795", "atmega16",  "atmega16a",  "atmega16hva",  "atmega16hva2",  "atmega16hvb",
               "atmega16hvbrevb",    "atmega16m1",    "atmega16u4",   "atmega161",   "atmega162",   "atmega163",
               "atmega164a",   "atmega164p",    "atmega164pa",    "atmega165",    "atmega165a",    "atmega165p",
               "atmega165pa", "atmega168", "atmega168a", "atmega168p", "atmega168pa", "atmega169", "atmega169a",
               "atmega169p", "atmega169pa", "atmega26hvg", "atmega32", "atmega32a", "atmega32c1", "atmega32hvb",
               "atmega32hvbrevb",   "atmega32m1",   "atmega32u4",   "atmega32u6",   "atmega323",   "atmega324a",
               "atmega324p",   "atmega324pa",    "atmega325",    "atmega325a",    "atmega325p",    "atmega3250",
               "atmega3250a",    "atmega3250p",    "atmega3250pa",   "atmega328",   "atmega328p",   "atmega329",
               "atmega329a",   "atmega329p",   "atmega329pa",   "atmega3290",   "atmega3290a",    "atmega3290p",
               "atmega3290pa", "atmega406", "atmega48hvf", "atmega64", "atmega64a", "atmega64c1", "atmega64hve",
               "atmega64m1",    "atmega64rfa2",    "atmega64rfr2",   "atmega640",   "atmega644",   "atmega644a",
               "atmega644p",   "atmega644pa",    "atmega645",    "atmega645a",    "atmega645p",    "atmega6450",
               "atmega6450a",    "atmega6450p",    "atmega649",    "atmega649a",   "atmega649p",   "atmega6490",
               "atmega6490a", "atmega6490p", "at90can32", "at90can64", "at90pwm161", "at90pwm216", "at90pwm316",
               "at90scr100", "at90usb646", "at90usb647", "at94k", "m3000".

           "avr51"
               "Enhanced" devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.   mcu@tie{}=  "atmega128",  "atmega128a",
               "atmega128rfa1",   "atmega1280",   "atmega1281",   "atmega1284",   "atmega1284p",   "at90can128",
               "at90usb1286", "at90usb1287".

           "avr6"
               "Enhanced" devices  with  3-byte  PC,  i.e.  with  more  than  128@tie{}KiB  of  program  memory.
               mcu@tie{}= "atmega2560", "atmega2561".

           "avrxmega2"
               "XMEGA"  devices  with  more than 8@tie{}KiB and up to 64@tie{}KiB of program memory.  mcu@tie{}=
               "atmxt112sl", "atmxt224", "atmxt224e", "atmxt336s", "atxmega16a4", "atxmega16a4u", "atxmega16c4",
               "atxmega16d4",  "atxmega32a4",  "atxmega32a4u",  "atxmega32c4",   "atxmega32d4",   "atxmega32e5",
               "atxmega32x1".

           "avrxmega4"
               "XMEGA"  devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.  mcu@tie{}=
               "atxmega64a3",  "atxmega64a3u",  "atxmega64a4u",  "atxmega64b1",  "atxmega64b3",   "atxmega64c3",
               "atxmega64d3", "atxmega64d4".

           "avrxmega5"
               "XMEGA" devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of program memory and more than
               64@tie{}KiB of RAM.  mcu@tie{}= "atxmega64a1", "atxmega64a1u".

           "avrxmega6"
               "XMEGA"  devices  with  more  than  128@tie{}KiB  of  program  memory.   mcu@tie{}=  "atmxt540s",
               "atmxt540sreva", "atxmega128a3", "atxmega128a3u", "atxmega128b1", "atxmega128b3", "atxmega128c3",
               "atxmega128d3", "atxmega128d4", "atxmega192a3", "atxmega192a3u", "atxmega192c3",  "atxmega192d3",
               "atxmega256a3",     "atxmega256a3b",     "atxmega256a3bu",    "atxmega256a3u",    "atxmega256c3",
               "atxmega256d3", "atxmega384c3", "atxmega384d3".

           "avrxmega7"
               "XMEGA" devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory and more than 64@tie{}KiB  of  RAM.
               mcu@tie{}= "atxmega128a1", "atxmega128a1u", "atxmega128a4u".

           "avr1"
               This  ISA  is  implemented  by the minimal AVR core and supported for assembler only.  mcu@tie{}=
               "attiny11", "attiny12", "attiny15", "attiny28", "at90s1200".

       -maccumulate-args
           Accumulate outgoing function arguments and  acquire/release  the  needed  stack  space  for  outgoing
           function  arguments  once in function prologue/epilogue.  Without this option, outgoing arguments are
           pushed before calling a function and popped afterwards.

           Popping the arguments after the function call can be expensive on AVR so that accumulating the  stack
           space might lead to smaller executables because arguments need not to be removed from the stack after
           such a function call.

           This  option can lead to reduced code size for functions that perform several calls to functions that
           get their arguments on the stack like calls to printf-like functions.

       -mbranch-cost=cost
           Set the branch costs for conditional branch instructions to cost.  Reasonable  values  for  cost  are
           small, non-negative integers. The default branch cost is 0.

       -mcall-prologues
           Functions  prologues/epilogues  are  expanded  as  calls  to  appropriate  subroutines.  Code size is
           smaller.

       -mint8
           Assume "int" to be 8-bit integer.  This affects the sizes of all types: a "char" is 1 byte, an  "int"
           is  1  byte,  a "long" is 2 bytes, and "long long" is 4 bytes.  Please note that this option does not
           conform to the C standards, but it results in smaller code size.

       -mno-interrupts
           Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.  Code size is smaller.

       -mrelax
           Try to replace "CALL" resp. "JMP" instruction by the shorter  "RCALL"  resp.  "RJMP"  instruction  if
           applicable.   Setting  "-mrelax"  just  adds the "--relax" option to the linker command line when the
           linker is called.

           Jump relaxing is performed by the linker because jump offsets are not known before code  is  located.
           Therefore,  the  assembler  code  generated  by the compiler is the same, but the instructions in the
           executable may differ from instructions in the assembler code.

           Relaxing must be turned on if linker stubs are needed, see the section on  "EIND"  and  linker  stubs
           below.

       -msp8
           Treat the stack pointer register as an 8-bit register, i.e. assume the high byte of the stack pointer
           is zero.  In general, you don't need to set this option by hand.

           This option is used internally by the compiler to select and build multilibs for architectures "avr2"
           and  "avr25".   These  architectures  mix devices with and without "SPH".  For any setting other than
           "-mmcu=avr2" or "-mmcu=avr25" the compiler driver will add or remove this option  from  the  compiler
           proper's  command  line,  because  the compiler then knows if the device or architecture has an 8-bit
           stack pointer and thus no "SPH" register or not.

       -mstrict-X
           Use address register "X" in a way proposed by the hardware.  This means that  "X"  is  only  used  in
           indirect, post-increment or pre-decrement addressing.

           Without  this  option,  the  "X"  register  may  be  used in the same way as "Y" or "Z" which then is
           emulated by additional instructions.  For example, loading a value with "X+const" addressing  with  a
           small non-negative "const < 64" to a register Rn is performed as

                   adiw r26, const   ; X += const
                   ld   <Rn>, X        ; <Rn> = *X
                   sbiw r26, const   ; X -= const

       -mtiny-stack
           Only change the lower 8@tie{}bits of the stack pointer.

       -Waddr-space-convert
           Warn  about  conversions  between address spaces in the case where the resulting address space is not
           contained in the incoming address space.

       "EIND" and Devices with more than 128 Ki Bytes of Flash

       Pointers in the implementation are 16@tie{}bits wide.  The address of a function or label is  represented
       as  word  address so that indirect jumps and calls can target any code address in the range of 64@tie{}Ki
       words.

       In order to facilitate indirect jump on devices with more than 128@tie{}Ki bytes of program memory space,
       there is a special function register called "EIND" that serves as most significant  part  of  the  target
       address when "EICALL" or "EIJMP" instructions are used.

       Indirect  jumps and calls on these devices are handled as follows by the compiler and are subject to some
       limitations:

       •   The compiler never sets "EIND".

       •   The compiler uses "EIND" implicitely in "EICALL"/"EIJMP" instructions or might read  "EIND"  directly
           in order to emulate an indirect call/jump by means of a "RET" instruction.

       •   The  compiler assumes that "EIND" never changes during the startup code or during the application. In
           particular, "EIND" is not saved/restored in function or interrupt service routine prologue/epilogue.

       •   For indirect calls to functions and computed goto, the linker generates stubs. Stubs  are  jump  pads
           sometimes  also  called  trampolines.  Thus,  the  indirect call/jump jumps to such a stub.  The stub
           contains a direct jump to the desired address.

       •   Linker relaxation must be turned on so that the linker will  generate  the  stubs  correctly  an  all
           situaltion.  See  the  compiler  option  "-mrelax" and the linler option "--relax".  There are corner
           cases where the linker is supposed to generate stubs but aborts  without  relaxation  and  without  a
           helpful error message.

       •   The  default  linker  script is arranged for code with "EIND = 0".  If code is supposed to work for a
           setup with "EIND != 0", a custom linker script has to be used in order to place  the  sections  whose
           name start with ".trampolines" into the segment where "EIND" points to.

       •   The  startup  code  from  libgcc never sets "EIND".  Notice that startup code is a blend of code from
           libgcc  and  AVR-LibC.   For  the  impact  of  AVR-LibC  on  "EIND",  see  the   AVR-LibC user manual
           ("http://nongnu.org/avr-libc/user-manual/").

       •   It  is  legitimate  for  user-specific  startup  code to set up "EIND" early, for example by means of
           initialization code located in section ".init3". Such code runs prior to general  startup  code  that
           initializes  RAM  and  calls  constructors, but after the bit of startup code from AVR-LibC that sets
           "EIND" to the segment where the vector table is located.

                   #include <avr/io.h>

                   static void
                   __attribute__((section(".init3"),naked,used,no_instrument_function))
                   init3_set_eind (void)
                   {
                     __asm volatile ("ldi r24,pm_hh8(__trampolines_start)\n\t"
                                     "out %i0,r24" :: "n" (&EIND) : "r24","memory");
                   }

           The "__trampolines_start" symbol is defined in the linker script.

       •   Stubs are generated automatically by the linker if the following two conditions are met:

           -<The address of a label is taken by means of the "gs" modifier>
               (short for generate stubs) like so:

                       LDI r24, lo8(gs(<func>))
                       LDI r25, hi8(gs(<func>))

           -<The final location of that label is in a code segment>
               outside the segment where the stubs are located.

       •   The compiler emits such "gs" modifiers for code labels in the following situations:

           -<Taking address of a function or code label.>
           -<Computed goto.>
           -<If prologue-save function is used, see -mcall-prologues>
               command-line option.

           -<Switch/case dispatch tables. If you do not want such dispatch>
               tables you can specify the -fno-jump-tables command-line option.

           -<C and C++ constructors/destructors called during startup/shutdown.>
           -<If the tools hit a "gs()" modifier explained above.>
       •   Jumping to non-symbolic addresses like so is not supported:

                   int main (void)
                   {
                       /* Call function at word address 0x2 */
                       return ((int(*)(void)) 0x2)();
                   }

           Instead, a stub has to be set up, i.e. the function has to be called through a  symbol  ("func_4"  in
           the example):

                   int main (void)
                   {
                       extern int func_4 (void);

                       /* Call function at byte address 0x4 */
                       return func_4();
                   }

           and the application be linked with "-Wl,--defsym,func_4=0x4".  Alternatively, "func_4" can be defined
           in the linker script.

       Handling of the "RAMPD", "RAMPX", "RAMPY" and "RAMPZ" Special Function Registers

       Some  AVR  devices  support  memories  larger than the 64@tie{}KiB range that can be accessed with 16-bit
       pointers.  To access memory locations outside this 64@tie{}KiB range, the contentent of a "RAMP" register
       is used as high part of the address: The "X", "Y", "Z" address register is concatenated with the "RAMPX",
       "RAMPY", "RAMPZ" special function register, respectively, to get a wide address.  Similarly,  "RAMPD"  is
       used together with direct addressing.

       •   The startup code initializes the "RAMP" special function registers with zero.

       •   If  a  AVR  Named  Address  Spaces,named  address space other than generic or "__flash" is used, then
           "RAMPZ" is set as needed before the operation.

       •   If the device supports RAM larger than 64@tie{}KiB and  the  compiler  needs  to  change  "RAMPZ"  to
           accomplish an operation, "RAMPZ" is reset to zero after the operation.

       •   If  the  device  comes with a specific "RAMP" register, the ISR prologue/epilogue saves/restores that
           SFR and initializes it with zero in case the ISR code might (implicitly) use it.

       •   RAM larger than 64@tie{}KiB is not supported by GCC for AVR targets.  If you use inline assembler  to
           read from locations outside the 16-bit address range and change one of the "RAMP" registers, you must
           reset it to zero after the access.

       AVR Built-in Macros

       GCC  defines  several  built-in  macros  so  that  the  user code can test for the presence or absence of
       features.  Almost any of the following built-in macros are deduced  from  device  capabilities  and  thus
       triggered by the "-mmcu=" command-line option.

       For even more AVR-specific built-in macros see AVR Named Address Spaces and AVR Built-in Functions.

       "__AVR_ARCH__"
           Build-in  macro that resolves to a decimal number that identifies the architecture and depends on the
           "-mmcu=mcu" option.  Possible values are:

           2, 25, 3, 31, 35, 4, 5, 51, 6, 102, 104, 105, 106, 107

           for mcu="avr2", "avr25", "avr3", "avr31", "avr35",  "avr4",  "avr5",  "avr51",  "avr6",  "avrxmega2",
           "avrxmega4",  "avrxmega5",  "avrxmega6",  "avrxmega7", respectively.  If mcu specifies a device, this
           built-in macro is set accordingly. For example, with "-mmcu=atmega8" the macro will be defined to 4.

       "__AVR_Device__"
           Setting "-mmcu=device" defines this built-in macro which reflects the  device's  name.  For  example,
           "-mmcu=atmega8"   defines   the   built-in   macro   "__AVR_ATmega8__",   "-mmcu=attiny261a"  defines
           "__AVR_ATtiny261A__", etc.

           The built-in macros' names follow the scheme "__AVR_Device__" where Device is the device name as from
           the AVR user manual. The difference between Device in the built-in macro and device in "-mmcu=device"
           is that the latter is always lowercase.

           If device is not a device but only a core architecture like "avr51", this macro will not be defined.

       "__AVR_XMEGA__"
           The device / architecture belongs to the XMEGA family of devices.

       "__AVR_HAVE_ELPM__"
           The device has the the "ELPM" instruction.

       "__AVR_HAVE_ELPMX__"
           The device has the "ELPM Rn,Z" and "ELPM Rn,Z+" instructions.

       "__AVR_HAVE_MOVW__"
           The device has the "MOVW" instruction to perform 16-bit register-register moves.

       "__AVR_HAVE_LPMX__"
           The device has the "LPM Rn,Z" and "LPM Rn,Z+" instructions.

       "__AVR_HAVE_MUL__"
           The device has a hardware multiplier.

       "__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__"
           The device has the "JMP" and "CALL" instructions.  This  is  the  case  for  devices  with  at  least
           16@tie{}KiB of program memory.

       "__AVR_HAVE_EIJMP_EICALL__"
       "__AVR_3_BYTE_PC__"
           The  device  has  the "EIJMP" and "EICALL" instructions.  This is the case for devices with more than
           128@tie{}KiB of program memory.  This also means that the program counter (PC) is 3@tie{}bytes wide.

       "__AVR_2_BYTE_PC__"
           The program counter (PC) is 2@tie{}bytes wide. This is the case for devices with up  to  128@tie{}KiB
           of program memory.

       "__AVR_HAVE_8BIT_SP__"
       "__AVR_HAVE_16BIT_SP__"
           The  stack  pointer  (SP)  register is treated as 8-bit respectively 16-bit register by the compiler.
           The definition of these macros is affected by "-mtiny-stack".

       "__AVR_HAVE_SPH__"
       "__AVR_SP8__"
           The device has the SPH (high part of stack pointer) special function register or has an  8-bit  stack
           pointer,  respectively.   The  definition of these macros is affected by "-mmcu=" and in the cases of
           "-mmcu=avr2" and "-mmcu=avr25" also by "-msp8".

       "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPD__"
       "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPX__"
       "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPY__"
       "__AVR_HAVE_RAMPZ__"
           The device has the "RAMPD", "RAMPX", "RAMPY", "RAMPZ" special function register, respectively.

       "__NO_INTERRUPTS__"
           This macro reflects the "-mno-interrupts" command line option.

       "__AVR_ERRATA_SKIP__"
       "__AVR_ERRATA_SKIP_JMP_CALL__"
           Some AVR devices (AT90S8515, ATmega103) must not skip  32-bit  instructions  because  of  a  hardware
           erratum.   Skip instructions are "SBRS", "SBRC", "SBIS", "SBIC" and "CPSE".  The second macro is only
           defined if "__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__" is also set.

       "__AVR_ISA_RMW__"
           The device has Read-Modify-Write instructions (XCH, LAC, LAS and LAT).

       "__AVR_SFR_OFFSET__=offset"
           Instructions that can address I/O special function registers directly like "IN", "OUT",  "SBI",  etc.
           may  use a different address as if addressed by an instruction to access RAM like "LD" or "STS". This
           offset depends on the device architecture and has to be subtracted from the RAM address in  order  to
           get the respective I/O@tie{}address.

       "__WITH_AVRLIBC__"
           The  compiler  is  configured  to be used together with AVR-Libc.  See the "--with-avrlibc" configure
           option.

       Blackfin Options

       -mcpu=cpu[-sirevision]
           Specifies the name of the target Blackfin processor.  Currently, cpu can  be  one  of  bf512,  bf514,
           bf516,  bf518,  bf522,  bf523,  bf524, bf525, bf526, bf527, bf531, bf532, bf533, bf534, bf536, bf537,
           bf538, bf539, bf542, bf544, bf547, bf548, bf549,  bf542m,  bf544m,  bf547m,  bf548m,  bf549m,  bf561,
           bf592.

           The  optional  sirevision  specifies  the  silicon  revision  of  the target Blackfin processor.  Any
           workarounds available for the targeted silicon revision are  enabled.   If  sirevision  is  none,  no
           workarounds  are  enabled.   If  sirevision  is  any,  all workarounds for the targeted processor are
           enabled.  The "__SILICON_REVISION__" macro is defined to  two  hexadecimal  digits  representing  the
           major  and  minor numbers in the silicon revision.  If sirevision is none, the "__SILICON_REVISION__"
           is not defined.  If sirevision is any, the "__SILICON_REVISION__" is defined to be 0xffff.   If  this
           optional  sirevision  is  not  used,  GCC  assumes  the latest known silicon revision of the targeted
           Blackfin processor.

           GCC defines a preprocessor macro for the specified cpu.  For  the  bfin-elf  toolchain,  this  option
           causes the hardware BSP provided by libgloss to be linked in if -msim is not given.

           Without this option, bf532 is used as the processor by default.

           Note that support for bf561 is incomplete.  For bf561, only the preprocessor macro is defined.

       -msim
           Specifies  that  the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes the simulator BSP provided by
           libgloss to be linked in.  This option  has  effect  only  for  bfin-elf  toolchain.   Certain  other
           options, such as -mid-shared-library and -mfdpic, imply -msim.

       -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
           Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This avoids the instructions to save,
           set  up  and  restore  frame  pointers  and makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The
           option -fomit-frame-pointer removes the frame pointer for all functions, which might  make  debugging
           harder.

       -mspecld-anomaly
           When  enabled,  the compiler ensures that the generated code does not contain speculative loads after
           jump instructions. If this option is used, "__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_LOADS" is defined.

       -mno-specld-anomaly
           Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from occurring.

       -mcsync-anomaly
           When enabled, the compiler  ensures  that  the  generated  code  does  not  contain  CSYNC  or  SSYNC
           instructions    too    soon    after    conditional    branches.     If    this   option   is   used,
           "__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_SYNCS" is defined.

       -mno-csync-anomaly
           Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions from  occurring  too  soon  after  a
           conditional branch.

       -mlow-64k
           When  enabled,  the  compiler is free to take advantage of the knowledge that the entire program fits
           into the low 64k of memory.

       -mno-low-64k
           Assume that the program is arbitrarily large.  This is the default.

       -mstack-check-l1
           Do stack checking using information placed into L1 scratchpad memory by the uClinux kernel.

       -mid-shared-library
           Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.  This allows for  execute  in
           place  and shared libraries in an environment without virtual memory management.  This option implies
           -fPIC.  With a bfin-elf target, this option implies -msim.

       -mno-id-shared-library
           Generate code that doesn't assume ID-based shared libraries are being used.  This is the default.

       -mleaf-id-shared-library
           Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method, but assumes that this library
           or executable won't link against any other ID shared libraries.  That  allows  the  compiler  to  use
           faster code for jumps and calls.

       -mno-leaf-id-shared-library
           Do  not  assume that the code being compiled won't link against any ID shared libraries.  Slower code
           is generated for jump and call insns.

       -mshared-library-id=n
           Specifies the identification number of the ID-based shared  library  being  compiled.   Specifying  a
           value  of 0 generates more compact code; specifying other values forces the allocation of that number
           to the current library but is no more space- or time-efficient than omitting this option.

       -msep-data
           Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different area of memory from the  text
           segment.   This  allows  for  execute in place in an environment without virtual memory management by
           eliminating relocations against the text section.

       -mno-sep-data
           Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.  This is the default.

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the address  of  the  function  into  a
           register and then performing a subroutine call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target
           function  lies  outside of the 24-bit addressing range of the offset-based version of subroutine call
           instruction.

           This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying -mno-long-calls restores  the  default  behavior.
           Note  these  switches  have no effect on how the compiler generates code to handle function calls via
           function pointers.

       -mfast-fp
           Link with the fast floating-point library. This library  relaxes  some  of  the  IEEE  floating-point
           standard's rules for checking inputs against Not-a-Number (NAN), in the interest of performance.

       -minline-plt
           Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are not known to bind locally.  It
           has no effect without -mfdpic.

       -mmulticore
           Build  a  standalone  application for multicore Blackfin processors.  This option causes proper start
           files and link scripts supporting multicore to be used, and defines the macro "__BFIN_MULTICORE".  It
           can only be used with -mcpu=bf561[-sirevision].

           This option can  be  used  with  -mcorea  or  -mcoreb,  which  selects  the  one-application-per-core
           programming model.  Without -mcorea or -mcoreb, the single-application/dual-core programming model is
           used. In this model, the main function of Core B should be named as "coreb_main".

           If this option is not used, the single-core application programming model is used.

       -mcorea
           Build  a  standalone  application  for  Core  A  of  BF561  when  using  the one-application-per-core
           programming model. Proper start files and link scripts are used to support  Core  A,  and  the  macro
           "__BFIN_COREA" is defined.  This option can only be used in conjunction with -mmulticore.

       -mcoreb
           Build  a  standalone  application  for  Core  B  of  BF561  when  using  the one-application-per-core
           programming model. Proper start files and link scripts are used to support  Core  B,  and  the  macro
           "__BFIN_COREB"  is  defined. When this option is used, "coreb_main" should be used instead of "main".
           This option can only be used in conjunction with -mmulticore.

       -msdram
           Build a standalone application for SDRAM. Proper start files and link scripts are  used  to  put  the
           application  into SDRAM, and the macro "__BFIN_SDRAM" is defined.  The loader should initialize SDRAM
           before loading the application.

       -micplb
           Assume that ICPLBs are enabled at run time.  This has an effect on certain anomaly workarounds.   For
           Linux  targets,  the default is to assume ICPLBs are enabled; for standalone applications the default
           is off.

       C6X Options

       -march=name
           This specifies the name of the target architecture.  GCC uses this name to  determine  what  kind  of
           instructions  it  can  emit when generating assembly code.  Permissible names are: c62x, c64x, c64x+,
           c67x, c67x+, c674x.

       -mbig-endian
           Generate code for a big-endian target.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default.

       -msim
           Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.

       -msdata=default
           Put small global and static data in the .neardata section, which is pointed  to  by  register  "B14".
           Put  small  uninitialized  global  and  static  data  in  the  .bss section, which is adjacent to the
           .neardata section.  Put small read-only data into the .rodata section.   The  corresponding  sections
           used for large pieces of data are .fardata, .far and .const.

       -msdata=all
           Put  all  data, not just small objects, into the sections reserved for small data, and use addressing
           relative to the "B14" register to access them.

       -msdata=none
           Make no use of the sections reserved for small data, and use absolute addresses to access  all  data.
           Put all initialized global and static data in the .fardata section, and all uninitialized data in the
           .far section.  Put all constant data into the .const section.

       CRIS Options

       These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.

       -march=architecture-type
       -mcpu=architecture-type
           Generate  code  for the specified architecture.  The choices for architecture-type are v3, v8 and v10
           for respectively ETRAX 4, ETRAX 100, and ETRAX 100 LX.  Default is v0 except for cris-axis-linux-gnu,
           where the default is v10.

       -mtune=architecture-type
           Tune to architecture-type everything applicable about the generated code, except for the ABI and  the
           set   of   available   instructions.    The  choices  for  architecture-type  are  the  same  as  for
           -march=architecture-type.

       -mmax-stack-frame=n
           Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds n bytes.

       -metrax4
       -metrax100
           The options -metrax4 and -metrax100 are synonyms for -march=v3 and -march=v8 respectively.

       -mmul-bug-workaround
       -mno-mul-bug-workaround
           Work around a bug in the "muls" and "mulu" instructions for CPU models where it applies.  This option
           is active by default.

       -mpdebug
           Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly code.  This  option  also  has
           the  effect  of turning off the #NO_APP formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of
           the assembly file.

       -mcc-init
           Do  not  use  condition-code  results  from  previous  instruction;  always  emit  compare  and  test
           instructions before use of condition codes.

       -mno-side-effects
           Do not emit instructions with side effects in addressing modes other than post-increment.

       -mstack-align
       -mno-stack-align
       -mdata-align
       -mno-data-align
       -mconst-align
       -mno-const-align
           These options (no- options) arrange (eliminate arrangements) for the stack frame, individual data and
           constants  to  be  aligned  for  the  maximum  single data access size for the chosen CPU model.  The
           default is to arrange for 32-bit alignment.  ABI details such as structure layout are not affected by
           these options.

       -m32-bit
       -m16-bit
       -m8-bit
           Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these options  arrange  for  stack  frame,
           writable  data  and  constants  to  all  be  32-bit,  16-bit or 8-bit aligned.  The default is 32-bit
           alignment.

       -mno-prologue-epilogue
       -mprologue-epilogue
           With -mno-prologue-epilogue, the normal function prologue and epilogue which set up the  stack  frame
           are  omitted  and  no  return  instructions  or return sequences are generated in the code.  Use this
           option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no warnings or errors are generated
           when call-saved registers must be saved, or storage for local variables needs to be allocated.

       -mno-gotplt
       -mgotplt
           With -fpic and -fPIC, don't generate (do generate) instruction  sequences  that  load  addresses  for
           functions  from the PLT part of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
           PLT.  The default is -mgotplt.

       -melf
           Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.

       -mlinux
           Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.

       -sim
           This option, recognized for the cris-axis-elf, arranges to link with input-output  functions  from  a
           simulator library.  Code, initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.

       -sim2
           Like -sim, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at 0x40000000 and zero-initialized data
           at 0x80000000.

       CR16 Options

       These options are defined specifically for the CR16 ports.

       -mmac
           Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.

       -mcr16cplus
       -mcr16c
           Generate code for CR16C or CR16C+ architecture. CR16C+ architecture is default.

       -msim
           Links the library libsim.a which is in compatible with simulator. Applicable to ELF compiler only.

       -mint32
           Choose integer type as 32-bit wide.

       -mbit-ops
           Generates "sbit"/"cbit" instructions for bit manipulations.

       -mdata-model=model
           Choose  a data model. The choices for model are near, far or medium. medium is default.  However, far
           is not valid with -mcr16c, as the CR16C architecture does not support the far data model.

       Darwin Options

       These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin operating system.

       FSF GCC on Darwin does not create  "fat"  object  files;  it  creates  an  object  file  for  the  single
       architecture  that  GCC  was  built to target.  Apple's GCC on Darwin does create "fat" files if multiple
       -arch options are used; it does so by running the compiler or  linker  multiple  times  and  joining  the
       results together with lipo.

       The  subtype of the file created (like ppc7400 or ppc970 or i686) is determined by the flags that specify
       the ISA that GCC is targeting, like -mcpu or -march.  The -force_cpusubtype_ALL option  can  be  used  to
       override this.

       The  Darwin  tools  vary  in their behavior when presented with an ISA mismatch.  The assembler, as, only
       permits instructions to be used that are valid for the subtype of the  file  it  is  generating,  so  you
       cannot   put   64-bit   instructions  in  a  ppc750  object  file.   The  linker  for  shared  libraries,
       /usr/bin/libtool, fails and prints an error if asked to create a shared library with a  less  restrictive
       subtype  than  its  input  files (for instance, trying to put a ppc970 object file in a ppc7400 library).
       The linker for executables, ld, quietly gives the executable the most restrictive subtype of any  of  its
       input files.

       -Fdir
           Add  the  framework  directory  dir  to the head of the list of directories to be searched for header
           files.  These directories are interleaved with those specified by -I options and  are  scanned  in  a
           left-to-right order.

           A  framework  directory  is  a  directory  with  frameworks in it.  A framework is a directory with a
           Headers and/or PrivateHeaders directory contained directly in it that ends in .framework.   The  name
           of  a  framework is the name of this directory excluding the .framework.  Headers associated with the
           framework are found in  one  of  those  two  directories,  with  Headers  being  searched  first.   A
           subframework  is  a  framework  directory that is in a framework's Frameworks directory.  Includes of
           subframework headers can only appear in a header of a framework that contains the subframework, or in
           a sibling subframework header.  Two subframeworks are siblings if they occur in the  same  framework.
           A subframework should not have the same name as a framework; a warning is issued if this is violated.
           Currently  a  subframework cannot have subframeworks; in the future, the mechanism may be extended to
           support  this.   The  standard  frameworks   can   be   found   in   /System/Library/Frameworks   and
           /Library/Frameworks.   An example include looks like "#include <Framework/header.h>", where Framework
           denotes the name of the framework and header.h is found in the PrivateHeaders or Headers directory.

       -iframeworkdir
           Like -F except the directory is a treated as a system directory.  The main  difference  between  this
           -iframework  and  -F  is  that with -iframework the compiler does not warn about constructs contained
           within header files found via dir.  This option is valid only for the C family of languages.

       -gused
           Emit debugging information for symbols that are used.   For  stabs  debugging  format,  this  enables
           -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols.  This is by default ON.

       -gfull
           Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.

       -mmacosx-version-min=version
           The  earliest  version  of  MacOS  X  that this executable will run on is version.  Typical values of
           version include 10.1, 10.2, and 10.3.9.

           If the compiler was built to use the system's headers by default, then the default for this option is
           the system version on which the compiler is running, otherwise the default is to  make  choices  that
           are compatible with as many systems and code bases as possible.

       -mkernel
           Enable  kernel development mode.  The -mkernel option sets -static, -fno-common, -fno-use-cxa-atexit,
           -fno-exceptions, -fno-non-call-exceptions, -fapple-kext, -fno-weak and  -fno-rtti  where  applicable.
           This mode also sets -mno-altivec, -msoft-float, -fno-builtin and -mlong-branch for PowerPC targets.

       -mone-byte-bool
           Override  the defaults for bool so that sizeof(bool)==1.  By default sizeof(bool) is 4 when compiling
           for Darwin/PowerPC and 1 when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this option has no effect on x86.

           Warning: The -mone-byte-bool switch causes GCC to generate code that is not  binary  compatible  with
           code generated without that switch.  Using this switch may require recompiling all other modules in a
           program, including system libraries.  Use this switch to conform to a non-default data model.

       -mfix-and-continue
       -ffix-and-continue
       -findirect-data
           Generate code suitable for fast turnaround development, such as to allow GDB to dynamically load ".o"
           files  into  already-running  programs.   -findirect-data  and  -ffix-and-continue  are  provided for
           backwards compatibility.

       -all_load
           Loads all members of static archive libraries.  See man ld(1) for more information.

       -arch_errors_fatal
           Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture to be fatal.

       -bind_at_load
           Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will bind all  undefined  references
           when the file is loaded or launched.

       -bundle
           Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.  See man ld(1) for more information.

       -bundle_loader executable
           This  option  specifies  the  executable  that will load the build output file being linked.  See man
           ld(1) for more information.

       -dynamiclib
           When passed this option, GCC produces a dynamic library instead of an executable when linking,  using
           the Darwin libtool command.

       -force_cpusubtype_ALL
           This  causes  GCC's  output  file  to have the ALL subtype, instead of one controlled by the -mcpu or
           -march option.

       -allowable_client  client_name
       -client_name
       -compatibility_version
       -current_version
       -dead_strip
       -dependency-file
       -dylib_file
       -dylinker_install_name
       -dynamic
       -exported_symbols_list
       -filelist
       -flat_namespace
       -force_flat_namespace
       -headerpad_max_install_names
       -image_base
       -init
       -install_name
       -keep_private_externs
       -multi_module
       -multiply_defined
       -multiply_defined_unused
       -noall_load
       -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
       -nofixprebinding
       -nomultidefs
       -noprebind
       -noseglinkedit
       -pagezero_size
       -prebind
       -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
       -private_bundle
       -read_only_relocs
       -sectalign
       -sectobjectsymbols
       -whyload
       -seg1addr
       -sectcreate
       -sectobjectsymbols
       -sectorder
       -segaddr
       -segs_read_only_addr
       -segs_read_write_addr
       -seg_addr_table
       -seg_addr_table_filename
       -seglinkedit
       -segprot
       -segs_read_only_addr
       -segs_read_write_addr
       -single_module
       -static
       -sub_library
       -sub_umbrella
       -twolevel_namespace
       -umbrella
       -undefined
       -unexported_symbols_list
       -weak_reference_mismatches
       -whatsloaded
           These options are passed to the Darwin linker.  The Darwin linker man page describes them in detail.

       DEC Alpha Options

       These -m options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:

       -mno-soft-float
       -msoft-float
           Use (do not use) the  hardware  floating-point  instructions  for  floating-point  operations.   When
           -msoft-float  is  specified,  functions  in  libgcc.a  are used to perform floating-point operations.
           Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the floating-point operations, or compiled in  such
           a  way  as to call such emulations routines, these routines issue floating-point operations.   If you
           are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point operations, you must ensure  that  the  library  is
           built so as not to call them.

           Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are required to have floating-point
           registers.

       -mfp-reg
       -mno-fp-regs
           Generate  code  that  uses  (does  not  use)  the  floating-point register set.  -mno-fp-regs implies
           -msoft-float.  If the floating-point register set is not used, floating-point operands are passed  in
           integer  registers  as  if  they were integers and floating-point results are passed in $0 instead of
           $f0.  This is a non-standard calling sequence, so any function  with  a  floating-point  argument  or
           return value called by code compiled with -mno-fp-regs must also be compiled with that option.

           A  typical  use  of  this  option is building a kernel that does not use, and hence need not save and
           restore, any floating-point registers.

       -mieee
           The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for maximum performance.   It  is
           mostly  compliant  with  the  IEEE  floating-point  standard.  However, for full compliance, software
           assistance is required.  This option  generates  code  fully  IEEE-compliant  code  except  that  the
           inexact-flag  is  not  maintained  (see  below).  If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro
           "_IEEE_FP" is defined during compilation.  The resulting code  is  less  efficient  but  is  able  to
           correctly  support  denormalized  numbers  and  exceptional  IEEE  values  such  as  not-a-number and
           plus/minus infinity.  Other Alpha compilers call this option -ieee_with_no_inexact.

       -mieee-with-inexact
           This is like -mieee except the generated code also maintains the IEEE inexact-flag.  Turning on  this
           option  causes the generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math.  In addition to "_IEEE_FP",
           "_IEEE_FP_EXACT" is defined as a preprocessor macro.  On some  Alpha  implementations  the  resulting
           code may execute significantly slower than the code generated by default.  Since there is very little
           code  that  depends  on  the  inexact-flag, you should normally not specify this option.  Other Alpha
           compilers call this option -ieee_with_inexact.

       -mfp-trap-mode=trap-mode
           This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.  Other Alpha compilers call  this
           option -fptm trap-mode.  The trap mode can be set to one of four values:

           n   This  is  the default (normal) setting.  The only traps that are enabled are the ones that cannot
               be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero trap).

           u   In addition to the traps enabled by n, underflow traps are enabled as well.

           su  Like u, but  the  instructions  are  marked  to  be  safe  for  software  completion  (see  Alpha
               architecture manual for details).

           sui Like su, but inexact traps are enabled as well.

       -mfp-rounding-mode=rounding-mode
           Selects  the  IEEE  rounding  mode.  Other Alpha compilers call this option -fprm rounding-mode.  The
           rounding-mode can be one of:

           n   Normal IEEE rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards the nearest machine number
               or towards the even machine number in case of a tie.

           m   Round towards minus infinity.

           c   Chopped rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards zero.

           d   Dynamic rounding mode.   A  field  in  the  floating-point  control  register  (fpcr,  see  Alpha
               architecture  reference  manual) controls the rounding mode in effect.  The C library initializes
               this register for rounding towards plus infinity.  Thus, unless your program modifies the fpcr, d
               corresponds to round towards plus infinity.

       -mtrap-precision=trap-precision
           In the  Alpha  architecture,  floating-point  traps  are  imprecise.   This  means  without  software
           assistance  it  is impossible to recover from a floating trap and program execution normally needs to
           be terminated.  GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers  in  determining
           the  exact  location  that  caused  a  floating-point  trap.   Depending  on  the  requirements of an
           application, different levels of precisions can be selected:

           p   Program precision.  This option is the default and means a trap handler can only  identify  which
               program caused a floating-point exception.

           f   Function  precision.   The  trap  handler can determine the function that caused a floating-point
               exception.

           i   Instruction precision.  The trap handler can  determine  the  exact  instruction  that  caused  a
               floating-point exception.

           Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called -scope_safe and -resumption_safe.

       -mieee-conformant
           This  option  marks  the  generated code as IEEE conformant.  You must not use this option unless you
           also specify -mtrap-precision=i and either -mfp-trap-mode=su or -mfp-trap-mode=sui.  Its only  effect
           is to emit the line .eflag 48 in the function prologue of the generated assembly file.

       -mbuild-constants
           Normally  GCC  examines  a  32- or 64-bit integer constant to see if it can construct it from smaller
           constants in two or three instructions.  If it cannot, it outputs  the  constant  as  a  literal  and
           generates code to load it from the data segment at run time.

           Use  this  option to require GCC to construct all integer constants using code, even if it takes more
           instructions (the maximum is six).

           You typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic loader.  Itself a shared library,  it
           must  relocate  itself  in  memory  before  it  can  find the variables and constants in its own data
           segment.

       -mbwx
       -mno-bwx
       -mcix
       -mno-cix
       -mfix
       -mno-fix
       -mmax
       -mno-max
           Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX, CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets.
           The default is to use the instruction sets supported by the CPU type specified via -mcpu=  option  or
           that of the CPU on which GCC was built if none is specified.

       -mfloat-vax
       -mfloat-ieee
           Generate  code  that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating-point arithmetic instead of IEEE single
           and double precision.

       -mexplicit-relocs
       -mno-explicit-relocs
           Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol relocations except  via  assembler  macros.
           Use  of  these macros does not allow optimal instruction scheduling.  GNU binutils as of version 2.12
           supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark which relocations should  apply  to
           which  instructions.   This option is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the capabilities of
           the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.

       -msmall-data
       -mlarge-data
           When -mexplicit-relocs is in effect, static data  is  accessed  via  gp-relative  relocations.   When
           -msmall-data  is  used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a small data area (the ".sdata"
           and ".sbss" sections) and are accessed via 16-bit relocations off of the $gp register.   This  limits
           the  size  of  the  small  data  area to 64KB, but allows the variables to be directly accessed via a
           single instruction.

           The default is -mlarge-data.  With this option the data area is limited to just below 2GB.   Programs
           that  require  more  than  2GB  of  data must use "malloc" or "mmap" to allocate the data in the heap
           instead of in the program's data segment.

           When generating code for shared libraries, -fpic implies -msmall-data and -fPIC implies -mlarge-data.

       -msmall-text
       -mlarge-text
           When -msmall-text is used, the compiler assumes that the  code  of  the  entire  program  (or  shared
           library)  fits  in  4MB, and is thus reachable with a branch instruction.  When -msmall-data is used,
           the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the same $gp value, and thus reduce  the  number
           of instructions required for a function call from 4 to 1.

           The default is -mlarge-text.

       -mcpu=cpu_type
           Set  the  instruction  set  and instruction scheduling parameters for machine type cpu_type.  You can
           specify either the EV  style  name  or  the  corresponding  chip  number.   GCC  supports  scheduling
           parameters  for  the  EV4,  EV5  and  EV6 family of processors and chooses the default values for the
           instruction set from the processor you specify.  If you do not specify a processor type, GCC defaults
           to the processor on which the compiler was built.

           Supported values for cpu_type are

           ev4
           ev45
           21064
               Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.

           ev5
           21164
               Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.

           ev56
           21164a
               Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.

           pca56
           21164pc
           21164PC
               Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.

           ev6
           21264
               Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.

           ev67
           21264a
               Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.

           Native toolchains also support the value native, which selects the best architecture option  for  the
           host processor.  -mcpu=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.

       -mtune=cpu_type
           Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type cpu_type.  The instruction set is not
           changed.

           Native  toolchains  also support the value native, which selects the best architecture option for the
           host processor.  -mtune=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.

       -mmemory-latency=time
           Sets the latency  the  scheduler  should  assume  for  typical  memory  references  as  seen  by  the
           application.   This  number is highly dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
           and the size of the external cache on the machine.

           Valid options for time are

           number
               A decimal number representing clock cycles.

           L1
           L2
           L3
           main
               The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for "typical" EV4  &  EV5  hardware
               for  the  Level  1,  2  &  3  caches (also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main
               memory.  Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.

       FR30 Options

       These options are defined specifically for the FR30 port.

       -msmall-model
           Use the small address space model.  This can produce smaller  code,  but  it  does  assume  that  all
           symbolic values and addresses fit into a 20-bit range.

       -mno-lsim
           Assume  that  runtime  support  has  been  provided  and so there is no need to include the simulator
           library (libsim.a) on the linker command line.

       FRV Options

       -mgpr-32
           Only use the first 32 general-purpose registers.

       -mgpr-64
           Use all 64 general-purpose registers.

       -mfpr-32
           Use only the first 32 floating-point registers.

       -mfpr-64
           Use all 64 floating-point registers.

       -mhard-float
           Use hardware instructions for floating-point operations.

       -msoft-float
           Use library routines for floating-point operations.

       -malloc-cc
           Dynamically allocate condition code registers.

       -mfixed-cc
           Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only use "icc0" and "fcc0".

       -mdword
           Change ABI to use double word insns.

       -mno-dword
           Do not use double word instructions.

       -mdouble
           Use floating-point double instructions.

       -mno-double
           Do not use floating-point double instructions.

       -mmedia
           Use media instructions.

       -mno-media
           Do not use media instructions.

       -mmuladd
           Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.

       -mno-muladd
           Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.

       -mfdpic
           Select the FDPIC ABI, which uses function descriptors to represent pointers  to  functions.   Without
           any PIC/PIE-related options, it implies -fPIE.  With -fpic or -fpie, it assumes GOT entries and small
           data  are  within  a  12-bit  range  from  the GOT base address; with -fPIC or -fPIE, GOT offsets are
           computed with 32 bits.  With a bfin-elf target, this option implies -msim.

       -minline-plt
           Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are not known to bind locally.  It
           has no effect without -mfdpic.  It's enabled by default if optimizing for  speed  and  compiling  for
           shared  libraries  (i.e.,  -fPIC  or  -fpic),  or when an optimization option such as -O3 or above is
           present in the command line.

       -mTLS
           Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.

       -mtls
           Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.

       -mgprel-ro
           Enable the use of "GPREL" relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data that is  known  to  be  in  read-only
           sections.   It's  enabled  by  default,  except  for -fpic or -fpie: even though it may help make the
           global offset table smaller, it trades 1 instruction for  4.   With  -fPIC  or  -fPIE,  it  trades  3
           instructions  for 4, one of which may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need for a GOT
           entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a win.  If it is not, -mno-gprel-ro can be
           used to disable it.

       -multilib-library-pic
           Link with the (library, not FD) pic libraries.  It's implied by -mlibrary-pic, as well  as  by  -fPIC
           and -fpic without -mfdpic.  You should never have to use it explicitly.

       -mlinked-fp
           Follow  the  EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer whenever a stack frame is allocated.
           This option is enabled by default and can be disabled with -mno-linked-fp.

       -mlong-calls
           Use indirect addressing to call functions outside the current  compilation  unit.   This  allows  the
           functions to be placed anywhere within the 32-bit address space.

       -malign-labels
           Try  to  align  labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting NOPs into the previous packet.  This option
           only has an effect when VLIW packing is enabled.  It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds  NOPs
           to existing ones.

       -mlibrary-pic
           Generate position-independent EABI code.

       -macc-4
           Use only the first four media accumulator registers.

       -macc-8
           Use all eight media accumulator registers.

       -mpack
           Pack VLIW instructions.

       -mno-pack
           Do not pack VLIW instructions.

       -mno-eflags
           Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.

       -mcond-move
           Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-cond-move
           Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mscc
           Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-scc
           Disable the use of conditional set instructions.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mcond-exec
           Enable the use of conditional execution (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-cond-exec
           Disable the use of conditional execution.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mvliw-branch
           Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-vliw-branch
           Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mmulti-cond-exec
           Enable optimization of "&&" and "||" in conditional execution (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-multi-cond-exec
           Disable optimization of "&&" and "||" in conditional execution.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mnested-cond-exec
           Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -mno-nested-cond-exec
           Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.

           This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed in a future version.

       -moptimize-membar
           This  switch removes redundant "membar" instructions from the compiler-generated code.  It is enabled
           by default.

       -mno-optimize-membar
           This switch disables the automatic removal of redundant  "membar"  instructions  from  the  generated
           code.

       -mtomcat-stats
           Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.

       -mcpu=cpu
           Select the processor type for which to generate code.  Possible values are frv, fr550, tomcat, fr500,
           fr450, fr405, fr400, fr300 and simple.

       GNU/Linux Options

       These -m options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:

       -mglibc
           Use  the  GNU  C  library.   This is the default except on *-*-linux-*uclibc* and *-*-linux-*android*
           targets.

       -muclibc
           Use uClibc C library.  This is the default on *-*-linux-*uclibc* targets.

       -mbionic
           Use Bionic C library.  This is the default on *-*-linux-*android* targets.

       -mandroid
           Compile code compatible with Android platform.  This is the default on *-*-linux-*android* targets.

           When compiling, this option enables -mbionic, -fPIC, -fno-exceptions and -fno-rtti by default.   When
           linking, this option makes the GCC driver pass Android-specific options to the linker.  Finally, this
           option causes the preprocessor macro "__ANDROID__" to be defined.

       -tno-android-cc
           Disable  compilation  effects  of -mandroid, i.e., do not enable -mbionic, -fPIC, -fno-exceptions and
           -fno-rtti by default.

       -tno-android-ld
           Disable linking effects of -mandroid, i.e., pass standard Linux linking options to the linker.

       H8/300 Options

       These -m options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:

       -mrelax
           Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the linker option -relax.

       -mh Generate code for the H8/300H.

       -ms Generate code for the H8S.

       -mn Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode.  This switch must be used either  with  -mh
           or -ms.

       -ms2600
           Generate code for the H8S/2600.  This switch must be used with -ms.

       -mexr
           Extended  registers  are stored on stack before execution of function with monitor attribute. Default
           option is -mexr.  This option is valid only for H8S targets.

       -mno-exr
           Extended registers are not stored on stack before  execution  of  function  with  monitor  attribute.
           Default option is -mno-exr.  This option is valid only for H8S targets.

       -mint32
           Make "int" data 32 bits by default.

       -malign-300
           On  the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.  The default for the H8/300H
           and H8S is to align longs and floats on 4-byte boundaries.  -malign-300 causes them to be aligned  on
           2-byte boundaries.  This option has no effect on the H8/300.

       HPPA Options

       These -m options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:

       -march=architecture-type
           Generate  code for the specified architecture.  The choices for architecture-type are 1.0 for PA 1.0,
           1.1 for PA 1.1, and 2.0 for PA 2.0 processors.  Refer to /usr/lib/sched.models on an HP-UX system  to
           determine  the  proper  architecture  option  for  your  machine.   Code  compiled for lower numbered
           architectures runs on higher numbered architectures, but not the other way around.

       -mpa-risc-1-0
       -mpa-risc-1-1
       -mpa-risc-2-0
           Synonyms for -march=1.0, -march=1.1, and -march=2.0 respectively.

       -mjump-in-delay
           Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional  jump  instructions  by  modifying  the  return
           pointer for the function call to be the target of the conditional jump.

       -mdisable-fpregs
           Prevent  floating-point  registers  from  being  used in any manner.  This is necessary for compiling
           kernels that perform lazy context switching of floating-point registers.  If you use this option  and
           attempt to perform floating-point operations, the compiler aborts.

       -mdisable-indexing
           Prevent  the  compiler  from  using indexing address modes.  This avoids some rather obscure problems
           when compiling MIG generated code under MACH.

       -mno-space-regs
           Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers.  This allows  GCC  to  generate  faster
           indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.

           Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.

       -mfast-indirect-calls
           Generate  code  that  assumes  calls never cross space boundaries.  This allows GCC to emit code that
           performs faster indirect calls.

           This option does not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested functions.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register allocator cannot use.  This is useful when compiling  kernel  code.   A  register  range  is
           specified  as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified separated
           by a comma.

       -mlong-load-store
           Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes required by the HP-UX 10  linker.   This
           is equivalent to the +k option to the HP compilers.

       -mportable-runtime
           Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.

       -mgas
           Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.

       -mschedule=cpu-type
           Schedule  code  according to the constraints for the machine type cpu-type.  The choices for cpu-type
           are 700 7100, 7100LC, 7200, 7300 and 8000.  Refer to /usr/lib/sched.models  on  an  HP-UX  system  to
           determine the proper scheduling option for your machine.  The default scheduling is 8000.

       -mlinker-opt
           Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker.  Note this makes symbolic debugging impossible.  It
           also  triggers  a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9 linkers in which they give bogus error messages when
           linking some programs.

       -msoft-float
           Generate output containing library calls for floating point.  Warning: the  requisite  libraries  are
           not  available  for  all HPPA targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
           used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your own arrangements  to
           provide suitable library functions for cross-compilation.

           -msoft-float  changes  the calling convention in the output file; therefore, it is only useful if you
           compile all of a program with this option.  In particular, you need to compile libgcc.a, the  library
           that comes with GCC, with -msoft-float in order for this to work.

       -msio
           Generate  the  predefine,  "_SIO",  for  server  IO.   The  default  is  -mwsio.   This generates the
           predefines, "__hp9000s700", "__hp9000s700__" and "_WSIO", for  workstation  IO.   These  options  are
           available under HP-UX and HI-UX.

       -mgnu-ld
           Use options specific to GNU ld.  This passes -shared to ld when building a shared library.  It is the
           default  when GCC is configured, explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker.  This option does not
           affect which ld is called; it only changes what parameters are passed to that ld.   The  ld  that  is
           called is determined by the --with-ld configure option, GCC's program search path, and finally by the
           user's  PATH.   The  linker  used  by GCC can be printed using which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`.  This
           option is only available on the 64-bit HP-UX GCC, i.e. configured with hppa*64*-*-hpux*.

       -mhp-ld
           Use options specific to HP ld.  This passes -b to ld  when  building  a  shared  library  and  passes
           +Accept  TypeMismatch  to  ld  on all links.  It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
           implicitly, with the HP linker.  This option does not affect which ld is called; it only changes what
           parameters are passed to that ld.  The ld that is called is determined  by  the  --with-ld  configure
           option,  GCC's  program  search  path, and finally by the user's PATH.  The linker used by GCC can be
           printed using which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`.  This option is only available  on  the  64-bit  HP-UX
           GCC, i.e. configured with hppa*64*-*-hpux*.

       -mlong-calls
           Generate code that uses long call sequences.  This ensures that a call is always able to reach linker
           generated  stubs.  The default is to generate long calls only when the distance from the call site to
           the beginning of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a predefined limit set
           by the branch type being used.  The  limits  for  normal  calls  are  7,600,000  and  240,000  bytes,
           respectively for the PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures.  Sibcalls are always limited at 240,000 bytes.

           Distances  are measured from the beginning of functions when using the -ffunction-sections option, or
           when using the -mgas and -mno-portable-runtime options together under HP-UX with the SOM linker.

           It is normally not desirable to use this option as it  degrades  performance.   However,  it  may  be
           useful in large applications, particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.

           The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the assembler and linker, and the type of
           code  being  generated.  The impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic symbol-
           difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.  However, an indirect  call  is  used  on
           32-bit ELF systems in pic code and it is quite long.

       -munix=unix-std
           Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the specified UNIX standard.  The choices for
           unix-std  are  93, 95 and 98.  93 is supported on all HP-UX versions.  95 is available on HP-UX 10.10
           and later.  98 is available on HP-UX 11.11 and later.  The default values are 93 for HP-UX 10.00,  95
           for HP-UX 10.10 though to 11.00, and 98 for HP-UX 11.11 and later.

           -munix=93  provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.  -munix=95 provides additional predefines
           for "XOPEN_UNIX" and  "_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED",  and  the  startfile  unix95.o.   -munix=98  provides
           additional  predefines  for  "_XOPEN_UNIX",  "_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED", "_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE" and
           "_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500", and the startfile unix98.o.

           It is important to note that this option changes the interfaces for  various  library  routines.   It
           also  affects  the operational behavior of the C library.  Thus, extreme care is needed in using this
           option.

           Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX standard must test, set and  restore
           the variable __xpg4_extended_mask as appropriate.  Most GNU software doesn't provide this capability.

       -nolibdld
           Suppress  the  generation of link options to search libdld.sl when the -static option is specified on
           HP-UX 10 and later.

       -static
           The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on libdld.sl.  There isn't an  archive
           version of libdld.sl.  Thus, when the -static option is specified, special link options are needed to
           resolve this dependency.

           On  HP-UX  10  and  later,  the GCC driver adds the necessary options to link with libdld.sl when the
           -static option is specified.  This causes the resulting binary to be dynamic.  On  the  64-bit  port,
           the  linkers  generate  dynamic binaries by default in any case.  The -nolibdld option can be used to
           prevent the GCC driver from adding these link options.

       -threads
           Add support for multithreading with the dce thread library under HP-UX.  This option sets  flags  for
           both the preprocessor and linker.

       Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options

       These -m options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of computers:

       -march=cpu-type
           Generate  instructions  for  the machine type cpu-type.  In contrast to -mtune=cpu-type, which merely
           tunes the generated code for the specified cpu-type, -march=cpu-type allows GCC to generate code that
           may not run at all on processors other than the one indicated.   Specifying  -march=cpu-type  implies
           -mtune=cpu-type.

           The choices for cpu-type are:

           native
               This  selects  the CPU to generate code for at compilation time by determining the processor type
               of the compiling machine.  Using -march=native enables all instruction subsets supported  by  the
               local  machine  (hence  the  result  might  not  run on different machines).  Using -mtune=native
               produces code optimized for the local machine under the constraints of the  selected  instruction
               set.

           i386
               Original Intel i386 CPU.

           i486
               Intel i486 CPU.  (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)

           i586
           pentium
               Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.

           pentium-mmx
               Intel Pentium MMX CPU, based on Pentium core with MMX instruction set support.

           pentiumpro
               Intel Pentium Pro CPU.

           i686
               When  used  with  -march,  the  Pentium Pro instruction set is used, so the code runs on all i686
               family chips.  When used with -mtune, it has the same meaning as generic.

           pentium2
               Intel Pentium II CPU, based on Pentium Pro core with MMX instruction set support.

           pentium3
           pentium3m
               Intel Pentium III CPU, based on Pentium Pro core with MMX and SSE instruction set support.

           pentium-m
               Intel Pentium M; low-power version of Intel Pentium III CPU with MMX, SSE  and  SSE2  instruction
               set support.  Used by Centrino notebooks.

           pentium4
           pentium4m
               Intel Pentium 4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.

           prescott
               Improved version of Intel Pentium 4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.

           nocona
               Improved  version  of  Intel  Pentium  4  CPU  with  64-bit  extensions,  MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3
               instruction set support.

           core2
               Intel Core 2 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3 instruction set support.

           nehalem
               Intel Nehalem CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2 and  POPCNT
               instruction set support.

           westmere
               Intel  Westmere  CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT,
               AES and PCLMUL instruction set support.

           sandybridge
               Intel Sandy Bridge CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX,  SSE,  SSE2,  SSE3,  SSSE3,  SSE4.1,  SSE4.2,
               POPCNT, AVX, AES and PCLMUL instruction set support.

           ivybridge
               Intel Ivy Bridge CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT,
               AVX, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND and F16C instruction set support.

           haswell
               Intel  Haswell  CPU  with  64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2,
               POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2 and F16C instruction set support.

           broadwell
               Intel Broadwell CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,  SSE4.1,  SSE4.2,
               POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA, BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED, ADCX and PREFETCHW
               instruction set support.

           bonnell
               Intel  Bonnell  CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3 instruction set
               support.

           silvermont
               Intel Silvermont CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1,  SSE4.2,
               POPCNT, AES, PCLMUL and RDRND instruction set support.

           k6  AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.

           k6-2
           k6-3
               Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support.

           athlon
           athlon-tbird
               AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3DNow! and SSE prefetch instructions support.

           athlon-4
           athlon-xp
           athlon-mp
               Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow! and full SSE instruction set support.

           k8
           opteron
           athlon64
           athlon-fx
               Processors  based  on  the  AMD  K8  core  with x86-64 instruction set support, including the AMD
               Opteron, Athlon 64, and Athlon 64  FX  processors.   (This  supersets  MMX,  SSE,  SSE2,  3DNow!,
               enhanced 3DNow! and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)

           k8-sse3
           opteron-sse3
           athlon64-sse3
               Improved versions of AMD K8 cores with SSE3 instruction set support.

           amdfam10
           barcelona
               CPUs  based  on  AMD  Family 10h cores with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets MMX,
               SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)

           bdver1
               CPUs based on AMD Family 15h cores with x86-64 instruction set support.   (This  supersets  FMA4,
               AVX,  XOP,  LWP,  AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and
               64-bit instruction set extensions.)

           bdver2
               AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This  supersets  BMI,  TBM,
               F16C,  FMA,  FMA4, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1,
               SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)

           bdver3
               AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This  supersets  BMI,  TBM,
               F16C, FMA, FMA4, FSGSBASE, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3,
               SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.

           bdver4
               AMD  Family  15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets BMI, BMI2,
               TBM, F16C, FMA, FMA4, FSGSBASE, AVX, AVX2, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MOVBE, MMX,  SSE,  SSE2,
               SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.

           btver1
               CPUs  based  on  AMD  Family 14h cores with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets MMX,
               SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4A, CX16, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)

           btver2
               CPUs based on AMD Family 16h cores with x86-64 instruction  set  support.  This  includes  MOVBE,
               F16C,  BMI,  AVX, PCL_MUL, AES, SSE4.2, SSE4.1, CX16, ABM, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE3, SSE2, SSE, MMX and
               64-bit instruction set extensions.

           winchip-c6
               IDT WinChip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX instruction set support.

           winchip2
               IDT WinChip 2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional  MMX  and  3DNow!   instruction  set
               support.

           c3  VIA  C3  CPU with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support.  (No scheduling is implemented for this
               chip.)

           c3-2
               VIA C3-2 (Nehemiah/C5XL) CPU with MMX  and  SSE  instruction  set  support.   (No  scheduling  is
               implemented for this chip.)

           geode
               AMD Geode embedded processor with MMX and 3DNow! instruction set support.

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Tune  to  cpu-type  everything applicable about the generated code, except for the ABI and the set of
           available instructions.  While picking a specific cpu-type schedules things  appropriately  for  that
           particular  chip, the compiler does not generate any code that cannot run on the default machine type
           unless you use a -march=cpu-type option.  For example, if GCC  is  configured  for  i686-pc-linux-gnu
           then -mtune=pentium4 generates code that is tuned for Pentium 4 but still runs on i686 machines.

           The  choices  for  cpu-type are the same as for -march.  In addition, -mtune supports 2 extra choices
           for cpu-type:

           generic
               Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/AMD64/EM64T processors.  If you know the  CPU  on
               which  your  code will run, then you should use the corresponding -mtune or -march option instead
               of -mtune=generic.  But, if you do not know exactly what CPU users of your application will have,
               then you should use this option.

               As new processors are deployed in the marketplace, the  behavior  of  this  option  will  change.
               Therefore,  if  you  upgrade to a newer version of GCC, code generation controlled by this option
               will change to reflect the processors that are most common at the time that  version  of  GCC  is
               released.

               There  is  no -march=generic option because -march indicates the instruction set the compiler can
               use, and there is no generic instruction set applicable to all processors.  In  contrast,  -mtune
               indicates  the  processor  (or,  in  this  case,  collection of processors) for which the code is
               optimized.

           intel
               Produce code optimized for the most current Intel processors, which are  Haswell  and  Silvermont
               for  this  version  of GCC.  If you know the CPU on which your code will run, then you should use
               the corresponding -mtune or -march option  instead  of  -mtune=intel.   But,  if  you  want  your
               application performs better on both Haswell and Silvermont, then you should use this option.

               As new Intel processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior of this option will change.
               Therefore,  if  you  upgrade to a newer version of GCC, code generation controlled by this option
               will change to reflect the most current Intel processors at the  time  that  version  of  GCC  is
               released.

               There  is  no  -march=intel  option because -march indicates the instruction set the compiler can
               use, and there is no common instruction set applicable to all processors.   In  contrast,  -mtune
               indicates  the  processor  (or,  in  this  case,  collection of processors) for which the code is
               optimized.

       -mcpu=cpu-type
           A deprecated synonym for -mtune.

       -mfpmath=unit
           Generate floating-point arithmetic for selected unit unit.  The choices for unit are:

           387 Use the standard 387 floating-point coprocessor present on the majority  of  chips  and  emulated
               otherwise.   Code  compiled  with  this option runs almost everywhere.  The temporary results are
               computed in 80-bit precision instead of  the  precision  specified  by  the  type,  resulting  in
               slightly  different results compared to most of other chips.  See -ffloat-store for more detailed
               description.

               This is the default choice for i386 compiler.

           sse Use scalar floating-point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.  This instruction  set
               is  supported  by  Pentium  III  and  newer chips, and in the AMD line by Athlon-4, Athlon XP and
               Athlon MP chips.  The earlier version of the SSE instruction set supports  only  single-precision
               arithmetic,  thus the double and extended-precision arithmetic are still done using 387.  A later
               version, present only in Pentium 4 and AMD x86-64  chips,  supports  double-precision  arithmetic
               too.

               For  the  i386  compiler,  you  must  use -march=cpu-type, -msse or -msse2 switches to enable SSE
               extensions and make this option effective.  For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled
               by default.

               The resulting code should be considerably faster in the majority of cases and avoid the numerical
               instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing code that expects temporaries to be
               80 bits.

               This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler.

           sse,387
           sse+387
           both
               Attempt to utilize both instruction sets  at  once.   This  effectively  doubles  the  amount  of
               available  registers,  and  on  chips with separate execution units for 387 and SSE the execution
               resources too.  Use this option with care, as it is still experimental, because the GCC  register
               allocator does not model separate functional units well, resulting in unstable performance.

       -masm=dialect
           Output  assembly  instructions  using  selected  dialect.   Supported  choices  are intel or att (the
           default).  Darwin does not support intel.

       -mieee-fp
       -mno-ieee-fp
           Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating-point comparisons.  These correctly handle the
           case where the result of a comparison is unordered.

       -msoft-float
           Generate output containing library calls for floating point.

           Warning: the requisite libraries are not part of GCC.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual
           C compiler are used, but this can't be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must  make  your  own
           arrangements to provide suitable library functions for cross-compilation.

           On  machines  where  a  function  returns  floating-point  results  in the 80387 register stack, some
           floating-point opcodes may be emitted even if -msoft-float is used.

       -mno-fp-ret-in-387
           Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.

           The usual calling convention has functions return values of types "float"  and  "double"  in  an  FPU
           register, even if there is no FPU.  The idea is that the operating system should emulate an FPU.

           The option -mno-fp-ret-in-387 causes such values to be returned in ordinary CPU registers instead.

       -mno-fancy-math-387
           Some 387 emulators do not support the "sin", "cos" and "sqrt" instructions for the 387.  Specify this
           option  to  avoid  generating those instructions.  This option is the default on FreeBSD, OpenBSD and
           NetBSD.  This option is overridden when -march indicates that the target CPU always has an FPU and so
           the instruction does not need emulation.  These instructions are not generated unless  you  also  use
           the -funsafe-math-optimizations switch.

       -malign-double
       -mno-align-double
           Control  whether GCC aligns "double", "long double", and "long long" variables on a two-word boundary
           or a one-word boundary.  Aligning "double" variables on a two-word boundary produces code  that  runs
           somewhat faster on a Pentium at the expense of more memory.

           On x86-64, -malign-double is enabled by default.

           Warning:  if  you  use  the  -malign-double switch, structures containing the above types are aligned
           differently than the published application binary interface specifications for the 386  and  are  not
           binary compatible with structures in code compiled without that switch.

       -m96bit-long-double
       -m128bit-long-double
           These  switches  control  the  size  of  "long  double"  type.  The i386 application binary interface
           specifies the size to be 96 bits, so -m96bit-long-double is the default in 32-bit mode.

           Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) prefer "long double" to be  aligned  to  an  8-  or  16-byte
           boundary.   In  arrays  or  structures  conforming  to  the ABI, this is not possible.  So specifying
           -m128bit-long-double aligns "long double" to a 16-byte boundary by padding the "long double" with  an
           additional 32-bit zero.

           In  the  x86-64  compiler, -m128bit-long-double is the default choice as its ABI specifies that "long
           double" is aligned on 16-byte boundary.

           Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision over the x87 standard of 80 bits  for
           a "long double".

           Warning:  if  you override the default value for your target ABI, this changes the size of structures
           and arrays containing "long double" variables, as well as modifying the function  calling  convention
           for  functions taking "long double".  Hence they are not binary-compatible with code compiled without
           that switch.

       -mlong-double-64
       -mlong-double-80
       -mlong-double-128
           These switches control the size of "long double" type. A size of 64 bits makes the "long double" type
           equivalent to the "double" type. This is the default for 32-bit Bionic C library.  A size of 128 bits
           makes the "long double" type equivalent to the "__float128" type. This  is  the  default  for  64-bit
           Bionic C library.

           Warning:  if  you override the default value for your target ABI, this changes the size of structures
           and arrays containing "long double" variables, as well as modifying the function  calling  convention
           for  functions taking "long double".  Hence they are not binary-compatible with code compiled without
           that switch.

       -mlarge-data-threshold=threshold
           When -mcmodel=medium is specified, data objects larger than threshold are placed in  the  large  data
           section.   This  value  must  be  the same across all objects linked into the binary, and defaults to
           65535.

       -mrtd
           Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that take a fixed number of arguments
           return with the "ret num" instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.   This  saves  one
           instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments there.

           You  can  specify  that an individual function is called with this calling sequence with the function
           attribute stdcall.  You can also override the -mrtd option by using the function attribute cdecl.

           Warning: this calling convention is incompatible with the one normally used on Unix,  so  you  cannot
           use it if you need to call libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.

           Also,  you must provide function prototypes for all functions that take variable numbers of arguments
           (including "printf"); otherwise incorrect code is generated for calls to those functions.

           In addition, seriously incorrect code results if  you  call  a  function  with  too  many  arguments.
           (Normally, extra arguments are harmlessly ignored.)

       -mregparm=num
           Control  how many registers are used to pass integer arguments.  By default, no registers are used to
           pass arguments, and at most 3 registers can be used.  You can control this behavior  for  a  specific
           function by using the function attribute regparm.

           Warning:  if  you  use this switch, and num is nonzero, then you must build all modules with the same
           value, including any libraries.  This includes the system libraries and startup modules.

       -msseregparm
           Use SSE register passing conventions for float and double  arguments  and  return  values.   You  can
           control this behavior for a specific function by using the function attribute sseregparm.

           Warning:  if  you  use this switch then you must build all modules with the same value, including any
           libraries.  This includes the system libraries and startup modules.

       -mvect8-ret-in-mem
           Return 8-byte vectors in memory instead of MMX registers.  This is the default on Solaris@tie{}8  and
           9 and VxWorks to match the ABI of the Sun Studio compilers until version 12.  Later compiler versions
           (starting  with  Studio  12  Update@tie{}1)  follow  the  ABI used by other x86 targets, which is the
           default on Solaris@tie{}10 and later.  Only use this option if you need  to  remain  compatible  with
           existing code produced by those previous compiler versions or older versions of GCC.

       -mpc32
       -mpc64
       -mpc80
           Set  80387 floating-point precision to 32, 64 or 80 bits.  When -mpc32 is specified, the significands
           of results of floating-point operations are rounded to 24 bits (single precision); -mpc64 rounds  the
           significands  of results of floating-point operations to 53 bits (double precision) and -mpc80 rounds
           the significands of results of floating-point operations to  64  bits  (extended  double  precision),
           which  is  the default.  When this option is used, floating-point operations in higher precisions are
           not available to the programmer without setting the FPU control word explicitly.

           Setting the rounding of floating-point operations to less than the default 80  bits  can  speed  some
           programs  by  2%  or  more.   Note  that  some  mathematical libraries assume that extended-precision
           (80-bit) floating-point operations are enabled by default; routines in such  libraries  could  suffer
           significant  loss  of  accuracy,  typically  through so-called "catastrophic cancellation", when this
           option is used to set the precision to less than extended precision.

       -mstackrealign
           Realign the stack at entry.  On the Intel x86,  the  -mstackrealign  option  generates  an  alternate
           prologue  and  epilogue  that  realigns the run-time stack if necessary.  This supports mixing legacy
           codes that keep 4-byte stack alignment with modern codes that keep 16-byte stack  alignment  for  SSE
           compatibility.  See also the attribute "force_align_arg_pointer", applicable to individual functions.

       -mpreferred-stack-boundary=num
           Attempt   to   keep   the   stack  boundary  aligned  to  a  2  raised  to  num  byte  boundary.   If
           -mpreferred-stack-boundary is not specified, the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).

           Warning:  When  generating  code  for  the  x86-64  architecture  with   SSE   extensions   disabled,
           -mpreferred-stack-boundary=3  can  be  used  to  keep  the stack boundary aligned to 8 byte boundary.
           Since x86-64 ABI require 16 byte stack alignment, this is ABI incompatible and intended to be used in
           controlled environment where stack space is important limitation.  This option  will  lead  to  wrong
           code when functions compiled with 16 byte stack alignment (such as functions from a standard library)
           are  called  with  misaligned  stack.   In  this case, SSE instructions may lead to misaligned memory
           access traps.  In addition, variable arguments will  be  handled  incorrectly  for  16  byte  aligned
           objects  (including  x87  long  double  and  __int128), leading to wrong results.  You must build all
           modules with  -mpreferred-stack-boundary=3,  including  any  libraries.   This  includes  the  system
           libraries and startup modules.

       -mincoming-stack-boundary=num
           Assume   the   incoming   stack   is   aligned   to   a   2   raised   to   num  byte  boundary.   If
           -mincoming-stack-boundary is not specified, the one specified by -mpreferred-stack-boundary is used.

           On Pentium and Pentium Pro, "double" and "long double" values should be aligned to an 8-byte boundary
           (see -malign-double) or suffer significant run time  performance  penalties.   On  Pentium  III,  the
           Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type "__m128" may not work properly if it is not 16-byte aligned.

           To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary must be as aligned as that
           required  by  any  value stored on the stack.  Further, every function must be generated such that it
           keeps the stack aligned.  Thus calling a function compiled with a  higher  preferred  stack  boundary
           from  a  function compiled with a lower preferred stack boundary most likely misaligns the stack.  It
           is recommended that libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.

           This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally increases code size.  Code that is
           sensitive to stack space usage, such as embedded systems and operating system kernels,  may  want  to
           reduce the preferred alignment to -mpreferred-stack-boundary=2.

       -mmmx
       -mno-mmx
       -msse
       -mno-sse
       -msse2
       -mno-sse2
       -msse3
       -mno-sse3
       -mssse3
       -mno-ssse3
       -msse4.1
       -mno-sse4.1
       -msse4.2
       -mno-sse4.2
       -msse4
       -mno-sse4
       -mavx
       -mno-avx
       -mavx2
       -mno-avx2
       -mavx512f
       -mno-avx512f
       -mavx512pf
       -mno-avx512pf
       -mavx512er
       -mno-avx512er
       -mavx512cd
       -mno-avx512cd
       -msha
       -mno-sha
       -maes
       -mno-aes
       -mpclmul
       -mno-pclmul
       -mfsgsbase
       -mno-fsgsbase
       -mrdrnd
       -mno-rdrnd
       -mf16c
       -mno-f16c
       -mfma
       -mno-fma
       -mprefetchwt1
       -mno-prefetchwt1
       -msse4a
       -mno-sse4a
       -mfma4
       -mno-fma4
       -mxop
       -mno-xop
       -mlwp
       -mno-lwp
       -m3dnow
       -mno-3dnow
       -mpopcnt
       -mno-popcnt
       -mabm
       -mno-abm
       -mbmi
       -mbmi2
       -mno-bmi
       -mno-bmi2
       -mlzcnt
       -mno-lzcnt
       -mfxsr
       -mxsave
       -mxsaveopt
       -mrtm
       -mtbm
       -mno-tbm
           These  switches enable or disable the use of instructions in the MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1,
           AVX, AVX2, AVX512F, AVX512PF, AVX512ER, AVX512CD, SHA,  AES,  PCLMUL,  FSGSBASE,  RDRND,  F16C,  FMA,
           SSE4A,  FMA4,  XOP,  LWP,  ABM,  BMI,  BMI2,  FXSR,  XSAVE, XSAVEOPT, LZCNT, RTM, or 3DNow!  extended
           instruction sets.  These extensions are also  available  as  built-in  functions:  see  X86  Built-in
           Functions, for details of the functions enabled and disabled by these switches.

           To  generate  SSE/SSE2  instructions  automatically  from  floating-point  code  (as  opposed  to 387
           instructions), see -mfpmath=sse.

           GCC depresses SSEx instructions when -mavx is used. Instead, it generates new AVX instructions or AVX
           equivalence for all SSEx instructions when needed.

           These options enable GCC  to  use  these  extended  instructions  in  generated  code,  even  without
           -mfpmath=sse.   Applications that perform run-time CPU detection must compile separate files for each
           supported architecture, using the appropriate flags.  In particular,  the  file  containing  the  CPU
           detection code should be compiled without these options.

       -mdump-tune-features
           This  option  instructs  GCC  to  dump  the  names of the x86 performance tuning features and default
           settings. The names can be used in -mtune-ctrl=feature-list.

       -mtune-ctrl=feature-list
           This option is used to do fine grain control of x86 code  generation  features.   feature-list  is  a
           comma  separated  list  of  feature names. See also -mdump-tune-features. When specified, the feature
           will  be  turned  on  if  it  is  not  preceded  with  "^",  otherwise,  it  will  be   turned   off.
           -mtune-ctrl=feature-list  is  intended  to be used by GCC developers. Using it may lead to code paths
           not covered by testing and can potentially result in compiler ICEs or runtime errors.

       -mno-default
           This option instructs GCC to turn off all tunable features.  See  also  -mtune-ctrl=feature-list  and
           -mdump-tune-features.

       -mcld
           This  option  instructs  GCC to emit a "cld" instruction in the prologue of functions that use string
           instructions.  String instructions  depend  on  the  DF  flag  to  select  between  autoincrement  or
           autodecrement  mode.   While  the  ABI  specifies  the  DF flag to be cleared on function entry, some
           operating systems violate this  specification  by  not  clearing  the  DF  flag  in  their  exception
           dispatchers.   The  exception  handler  can  be  invoked  with  the DF flag set, which leads to wrong
           direction mode when string instructions are used.  This option can be enabled by  default  on  32-bit
           x86  targets  by  configuring  GCC  with  the  --enable-cld  configure  option.   Generation of "cld"
           instructions can be suppressed with the -mno-cld compiler option in this case.

       -mvzeroupper
           This option instructs GCC to emit a "vzeroupper" instruction before a transfer of control flow out of
           the function to minimize the AVX to SSE transition penalty as well as remove unnecessary  "zeroupper"
           intrinsics.

       -mprefer-avx128
           This  option instructs GCC to use 128-bit AVX instructions instead of 256-bit AVX instructions in the
           auto-vectorizer.

       -mcx16
           This option enables GCC to  generate  "CMPXCHG16B"  instructions.   "CMPXCHG16B"  allows  for  atomic
           operations  on  128-bit  double  quadword  (or oword) data types.  This is useful for high-resolution
           counters that can be updated by multiple processors (or cores).  This  instruction  is  generated  as
           part of atomic built-in functions: see __sync Builtins or __atomic Builtins for details.

       -msahf
           This  option  enables  generation  of "SAHF" instructions in 64-bit code.  Early Intel Pentium 4 CPUs
           with Intel 64 support, prior to the introduction of Pentium 4 G1 step in December  2005,  lacked  the
           "LAHF" and "SAHF" instructions which were supported by AMD64.  These are load and store instructions,
           respectively,  for  certain status flags.  In 64-bit mode, the "SAHF" instruction is used to optimize
           "fmod", "drem", and "remainder" built-in functions; see Other Builtins for details.

       -mmovbe
           This  option  enables  use  of  the  "movbe"  instruction  to   implement   "__builtin_bswap32"   and
           "__builtin_bswap64".

       -mcrc32
           This   option   enables   built-in   functions   "__builtin_ia32_crc32qi",  "__builtin_ia32_crc32hi",
           "__builtin_ia32_crc32si" and "__builtin_ia32_crc32di" to generate the "crc32" machine instruction.

       -mrecip
           This option enables use of "RCPSS" and "RSQRTSS" instructions (and their vectorized variants  "RCPPS"
           and  "RSQRTPS")  with  an additional Newton-Raphson step to increase precision instead of "DIVSS" and
           "SQRTSS" (and their  vectorized  variants)  for  single-precision  floating-point  arguments.   These
           instructions   are   generated   only  when  -funsafe-math-optimizations  is  enabled  together  with
           -finite-math-only and -fno-trapping-math.  Note that while the throughput of the sequence  is  higher
           than the throughput of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased
           by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994).

           Note  that  GCC  implements  "1.0f/sqrtf(x)"  in  terms  of  "RSQRTSS"  (or  "RSQRTPS")  already with
           -ffast-math (or the above option combination), and doesn't need -mrecip.

           Also note that GCC emits the above  sequence  with  additional  Newton-Raphson  step  for  vectorized
           single-float  division  and  vectorized  "sqrtf(x)"  already  with  -ffast-math  (or the above option
           combination), and doesn't need -mrecip.

       -mrecip=opt
           This option controls which reciprocal estimate instructions may be used.  opt  is  a  comma-separated
           list of options, which may be preceded by a ! to invert the option:

           all Enable all estimate instructions.

           default
               Enable the default instructions, equivalent to -mrecip.

           none
               Disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to -mno-recip.

           div Enable the approximation for scalar division.

           vec-div
               Enable the approximation for vectorized division.

           sqrt
               Enable the approximation for scalar square root.

           vec-sqrt
               Enable the approximation for vectorized square root.

           So,  for  example,  -mrecip=all,!sqrt enables all of the reciprocal approximations, except for square
           root.

       -mveclibabi=type
           Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an external library.  Supported values
           for type are svml for the Intel short vector math library and acml for the AMD math core library.  To
           use this option, both -ftree-vectorize and -funsafe-math-optimizations have to  be  enabled,  and  an
           SVML or ACML ABI-compatible library must be specified at link time.

           GCC   currently  emits  calls  to  "vmldExp2",  "vmldLn2",  "vmldLog102",  "vmldLog102",  "vmldPow2",
           "vmldTanh2",   "vmldTan2",   "vmldAtan2",   "vmldAtanh2",   "vmldCbrt2",   "vmldSinh2",   "vmldSin2",
           "vmldAsinh2", "vmldAsin2", "vmldCosh2", "vmldCos2", "vmldAcosh2", "vmldAcos2", "vmlsExp4", "vmlsLn4",
           "vmlsLog104",   "vmlsLog104",   "vmlsPow4",   "vmlsTanh4",   "vmlsTan4",  "vmlsAtan4",  "vmlsAtanh4",
           "vmlsCbrt4",   "vmlsSinh4",   "vmlsSin4",   "vmlsAsinh4",   "vmlsAsin4",   "vmlsCosh4",   "vmlsCos4",
           "vmlsAcosh4"  and  "vmlsAcos4"  for  corresponding  function  type when -mveclibabi=svml is used, and
           "__vrd2_sin", "__vrd2_cos", "__vrd2_exp", "__vrd2_log", "__vrd2_log2", "__vrd2_log10", "__vrs4_sinf",
           "__vrs4_cosf", "__vrs4_expf", "__vrs4_logf", "__vrs4_log2f", "__vrs4_log10f"  and  "__vrs4_powf"  for
           the corresponding function type when -mveclibabi=acml is used.

       -mabi=name
           Generate  code for the specified calling convention.  Permissible values are sysv for the ABI used on
           GNU/Linux and other systems, and ms for the Microsoft ABI.  The default is to use the  Microsoft  ABI
           when  targeting  Microsoft  Windows  and  the  SysV  ABI  on all other systems.  You can control this
           behavior for a specific function by using the function attribute ms_abi/sysv_abi.

       -mtls-dialect=type
           Generate code to access thread-local  storage  using  the  gnu  or  gnu2  conventions.   gnu  is  the
           conservative  default; gnu2 is more efficient, but it may add compile- and run-time requirements that
           cannot be satisfied on all systems.

       -mpush-args
       -mno-push-args
           Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters.  This method is shorter and usually equally fast as
           method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled by default.  In some cases disabling  it  may  improve
           performance because of improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.

       -maccumulate-outgoing-args
           If  enabled,  the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments is computed in the function
           prologue.  This is faster on most modern CPUs because of reduced  dependencies,  improved  scheduling
           and  reduced  stack  usage  when  the  preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2.  The drawback is a
           notable increase in code size.  This switch implies -mno-push-args.

       -mthreads
           Support thread-safe exception handling  on  MinGW.   Programs  that  rely  on  thread-safe  exception
           handling must compile and link all code with the -mthreads option.  When compiling, -mthreads defines
           "-D_MT";  when  linking, it links in a special thread helper library -lmingwthrd which cleans up per-
           thread exception-handling data.

       -mno-align-stringops
           Do not align the destination of inlined  string  operations.   This  switch  reduces  code  size  and
           improves performance in case the destination is already aligned, but GCC doesn't know about it.

       -minline-all-stringops
           By  default GCC inlines string operations only when the destination is known to be aligned to least a
           4-byte boundary.  This enables more inlining and increases code size, but may improve performance  of
           code that depends on fast "memcpy", "strlen", and "memset" for short lengths.

       -minline-stringops-dynamically
           For  string  operations  of unknown size, use run-time checks with inline code for small blocks and a
           library call for large blocks.

       -mstringop-strategy=alg
           Override the internal decision heuristic for the particular algorithm  to  use  for  inlining  string
           operations.  The allowed values for alg are:

           rep_byte
           rep_4byte
           rep_8byte
               Expand using i386 "rep" prefix of the specified size.

           byte_loop
           loop
           unrolled_loop
               Expand into an inline loop.

           libcall
               Always use a library call.

       -mmemcpy-strategy=strategy
           Override  the  internal decision heuristic to decide if "__builtin_memcpy" should be inlined and what
           inline algorithm to use when the expected size of the copy operation is known. strategy is  a  comma-
           separated  list  of  alg:max_size:dest_align  triplets.   alg  is  specified  in -mstringop-strategy,
           max_size specifies the max byte size with which inline  algorithm  alg  is  allowed.   For  the  last
           triplet,  the  max_size  must  be "-1". The max_size of the triplets in the list must be specified in
           increasing order.  The minimal byte size for alg is 0 for the first triplet and "max_size + 1" of the
           preceding range.

       -mmemset-strategy=strategy
           The option is  similar  to  -mmemcpy-strategy=  except  that  it  is  to  control  "__builtin_memset"
           expansion.

       -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
           Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This avoids the instructions to save,
           set  up,  and  restore  frame  pointers and makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The
           option -fomit-leaf-frame-pointer removes the frame pointer  for  leaf  functions,  which  might  make
           debugging harder.

       -mtls-direct-seg-refs
       -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
           Controls  whether  TLS  variables may be accessed with offsets from the TLS segment register (%gs for
           32-bit, %fs for 64-bit), or whether the thread base pointer must be added.  Whether or  not  this  is
           valid depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the segment to cover the entire TLS area.

           For systems that use the GNU C Library, the default is on.

       -msse2avx
       -mno-sse2avx
           Specify  that  the  assembler should encode SSE instructions with VEX prefix.  The option -mavx turns
           this on by default.

       -mfentry
       -mno-fentry
           If profiling is active (-pg), put the profiling counter call  before  the  prologue.   Note:  On  x86
           architectures the attribute "ms_hook_prologue" isn't possible at the moment for -mfentry and -pg.

       -m8bit-idiv
       -mno-8bit-idiv
           On  some processors, like Intel Atom, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is much faster than 32-bit/64-bit
           integer divide.  This option generates a run-time check.  If both dividend  and  divisor  are  within
           range of 0 to 255, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is used instead of 32-bit/64-bit integer divide.

       -mavx256-split-unaligned-load
       -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
           Split 32-byte AVX unaligned load and store.

       -mstack-protector-guard=guard
           Generate  stack  protection  code  using  canary at guard.  Supported locations are global for global
           canary or tls for per-thread canary in the TLS block (the default).  This option has effect only when
           -fstack-protector or -fstack-protector-all is specified.

       These -m switches are supported in addition to the above on x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.

       -m32
       -m64
       -mx32
       -m16
           Generate code for a 16-bit, 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The -m32 option sets  "int",  "long",  and
           pointer types to 32 bits, and generates code that runs on any i386 system.

           The -m64 option sets "int" to 32 bits and "long" and pointer types to 64 bits, and generates code for
           the  x86-64  architecture.   For  Darwin  only  the  -m64  option  also  turns  off  the -fno-pic and
           -mdynamic-no-pic options.

           The -mx32 option sets "int", "long", and pointer types to 32 bits, and generates code for the  x86-64
           architecture.

           The  -m16  option is the same as -m32, except for that it outputs the ".code16gcc" assembly directive
           at the beginning of the assembly output so that the binary can run in 16-bit mode.

       -mno-red-zone
           Do not use a so-called "red zone" for x86-64 code.  The red zone is mandated by the x86-64 ABI; it is
           a 128-byte area beyond the location of the stack pointer that is not modified by signal or  interrupt
           handlers  and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack pointer.  The flag
           -mno-red-zone disables this red zone.

       -mcmodel=small
           Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must be linked in the lower 2  GB
           of the address space.  Pointers are 64 bits.  Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.  This
           is the default code model.

       -mcmodel=kernel
           Generate  code for the kernel code model.  The kernel runs in the negative 2 GB of the address space.
           This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.

       -mcmodel=medium
           Generate code for the medium model: the program is linked in the lower 2 GB  of  the  address  space.
           Small  symbols  are also placed there.  Symbols with sizes larger than -mlarge-data-threshold are put
           into large data or BSS sections and can  be  located  above  2GB.   Programs  can  be  statically  or
           dynamically linked.

       -mcmodel=large
           Generate  code  for  the  large  model.  This model makes no assumptions about addresses and sizes of
           sections.

       -maddress-mode=long
           Generate code for long address mode.  This is only supported for 64-bit and x32 environments.  It  is
           the default address mode for 64-bit environments.

       -maddress-mode=short
           Generate code for short address mode.  This is only supported for 32-bit and x32 environments.  It is
           the default address mode for 32-bit and x32 environments.

       i386 and x86-64 Windows Options

       These additional options are available for Microsoft Windows targets:

       -mconsole
           This option specifies that a console application is to be generated, by instructing the linker to set
           the  PE header subsystem type required for console applications.  This option is available for Cygwin
           and MinGW targets and is enabled by default on those targets.

       -mdll
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies  that  a  DLL---a  dynamic  link
           library---is to be generated, enabling the selection of the required runtime startup object and entry
           point.

       -mnop-fun-dllimport
           This  option  is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that the "dllimport" attribute
           should be ignored.

       -mthread
           This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that MinGW-specific thread support is to  be
           used.

       -municode
           This  option  is  available  for MinGW-w64 targets.  It causes the "UNICODE" preprocessor macro to be
           predefined, and chooses Unicode-capable runtime startup code.

       -mwin32
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.   It  specifies  that  the  typical  Microsoft
           Windows  predefined  macros  are to be set in the pre-processor, but does not influence the choice of
           runtime library/startup code.

       -mwindows
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that a GUI application is to  be
           generated by instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type appropriately.

       -fno-set-stack-executable
           This  option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that the executable flag for the stack used
           by nested functions isn't set. This is necessary for binaries running in  kernel  mode  of  Microsoft
           Windows, as there the User32 API, which is used to set executable privileges, isn't available.

       -fwritable-relocated-rdata
           This option is available for MinGW and Cygwin targets.  It specifies that relocated-data in read-only
           section  is  put  into  .data  section.   This  is  a  necessary  for  older  runtimes not supporting
           modification of .rdata sections for pseudo-relocation.

       -mpe-aligned-commons
           This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It specifies that the GNU extension to the PE
           file format that permits the correct alignment of COMMON variables should  be  used  when  generating
           code.   It  is enabled by default if GCC detects that the target assembler found during configuration
           supports the feature.

       See also under i386 and x86-64 Options for standard options.

       IA-64 Options

       These are the -m options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.

       -mbig-endian
           Generate code for a big-endian target.  This is the default for HP-UX.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default for AIX5 and GNU/Linux.

       -mgnu-as
       -mno-gnu-as
           Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler.  This is the default.

       -mgnu-ld
       -mno-gnu-ld
           Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker.  This is the default.

       -mno-pic
           Generate code that does not use a global pointer register.  The result is  not  position  independent
           code, and violates the IA-64 ABI.

       -mvolatile-asm-stop
       -mno-volatile-asm-stop
           Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm statements.

       -mregister-names
       -mno-register-names
           Generate  (or  don't)  in,  loc,  and  out  register  names for the stacked registers.  This may make
           assembler output more readable.

       -mno-sdata
       -msdata
           Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section.  This may be  useful  for  working
           around optimizer bugs.

       -mconstant-gp
           Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value.  This is useful when compiling kernel
           code.

       -mauto-pic
           Generate  code  that is self-relocatable.  This implies -mconstant-gp.  This is useful when compiling
           firmware code.

       -minline-float-divide-min-latency
           Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values using the minimum latency algorithm.

       -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
           Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values using the maximum throughput algorithm.

       -mno-inline-float-divide
           Do not generate inline code for divides of floating-point values.

       -minline-int-divide-min-latency
           Generate code for inline divides of integer values using the minimum latency algorithm.

       -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
           Generate code for inline divides of integer values using the maximum throughput algorithm.

       -mno-inline-int-divide
           Do not generate inline code for divides of integer values.

       -minline-sqrt-min-latency
           Generate code for inline square roots using the minimum latency algorithm.

       -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
           Generate code for inline square roots using the maximum throughput algorithm.

       -mno-inline-sqrt
           Do not generate inline code for "sqrt".

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Do (don't) generate code that uses the fused multiply/add  or  multiply/subtract  instructions.   The
           default is to use these instructions.

       -mno-dwarf2-asm
       -mdwarf2-asm
           Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF 2 line number debugging info.  This may be useful
           when not using the GNU assembler.

       -mearly-stop-bits
       -mno-early-stop-bits
           Allow  stop  bits  to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the instruction that triggered the
           stop bit.  This can improve instruction scheduling, but does not always do so.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register allocator cannot use.  This is useful when compiling  kernel  code.   A  register  range  is
           specified  as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified separated
           by a comma.

       -mtls-size=tls-size
           Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets.  Valid values are 14, 22, and 64.

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values  are  itanium,  itanium1,  merced,
           itanium2, and mckinley.

       -milp32
       -mlp64
           Generate  code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer
           to 32 bits.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.   These  are
           HP-UX specific flags.

       -mno-sched-br-data-spec
       -msched-br-data-spec
           (Dis/En)able  data  speculative  scheduling  before  reload.   This  results  in generation of "ld.a"
           instructions and the corresponding check instructions ("ld.c" / "chk.a").  The default is 'disable'.

       -msched-ar-data-spec
       -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
           (En/Dis)able data speculative  scheduling  after  reload.   This  results  in  generation  of  "ld.a"
           instructions and the corresponding check instructions ("ld.c" / "chk.a").  The default is 'enable'.

       -mno-sched-control-spec
       -msched-control-spec
           (Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling.  This feature is available only during region scheduling
           (i.e.  before  reload).   This results in generation of the "ld.s" instructions and the corresponding
           check instructions "chk.s".  The default is 'disable'.

       -msched-br-in-data-spec
       -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
           (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are dependent on  the  data  speculative
           loads  before  reload.   This  is  effective  only with -msched-br-data-spec enabled.  The default is
           'enable'.

       -msched-ar-in-data-spec
       -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
           (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are dependent on  the  data  speculative
           loads  after  reload.   This  is  effective  only  with -msched-ar-data-spec enabled.  The default is
           'enable'.

       -msched-in-control-spec
       -mno-sched-in-control-spec
           (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that are dependent on the control speculative
           loads.  This is effective only with -msched-control-spec enabled.  The default is 'enable'.

       -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
       -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
           If enabled, data-speculative instructions are chosen for schedule only if there are no other  choices
           at  the  moment.   This makes the use of the data speculation much more conservative.  The default is
           'disable'.

       -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
       -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
           If enabled, control-speculative instructions are chosen for schedule  only  if  there  are  no  other
           choices  at  the  moment.  This makes the use of the control speculation much more conservative.  The
           default is 'disable'.

       -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
       -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
           If  enabled,  speculative  dependencies  are  considered  during  computation  of  the   instructions
           priorities.   This  makes  the  use  of  the  speculation  a  bit  more conservative.  The default is
           'disable'.

       -msched-spec-ldc
           Use a simple data speculation check.  This option is on by default.

       -msched-control-spec-ldc
           Use a simple check for control speculation.  This option is on by default.

       -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
           Place a stop bit after every cycle when scheduling.  This option is on by default.

       -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
           Assume that floating-point stores and loads are not likely to cause a conflict when placed  into  the
           same instruction group.  This option is disabled by default.

       -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
           Generate checks for control speculation in selective scheduling.  This flag is disabled by default.

       -msched-max-memory-insns=max-insns
           Limit on the number of memory insns per instruction group, giving lower priority to subsequent memory
           insns  attempting  to schedule in the same instruction group. Frequently useful to prevent cache bank
           conflicts.  The default value is 1.

       -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
           Makes the limit specified by msched-max-memory-insns a hard limit, disallowing more than that  number
           in  an  instruction  group.   Otherwise,  the limit is "soft", meaning that non-memory operations are
           preferred when the limit is reached, but memory operations may still be scheduled.

       LM32 Options

       These -m options are defined for the LatticeMico32 architecture:

       -mbarrel-shift-enabled
           Enable barrel-shift instructions.

       -mdivide-enabled
           Enable divide and modulus instructions.

       -mmultiply-enabled
           Enable multiply instructions.

       -msign-extend-enabled
           Enable sign extend instructions.

       -muser-enabled
           Enable user-defined instructions.

       M32C Options

       -mcpu=name
           Select the CPU for which code is generated.  name may be one of r8c for the R8C/Tiny series, m16c for
           the M16C (up to /60) series, m32cm for the M16C/80 series, or m32c for the M32C/80 series.

       -msim
           Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes an alternate runtime library to
           be linked in which supports, for example, file I/O.  You must not use  this  option  when  generating
           programs  that  will run on real hardware; you must provide your own runtime library for whatever I/O
           functions are needed.

       -memregs=number
           Specifies the number of memory-based pseudo-registers GCC uses during code generation.  These pseudo-
           registers are used like real registers, so there is a tradeoff between GCC's ability to fit the  code
           into  available  registers,  and  the performance penalty of using memory instead of registers.  Note
           that all modules in a program must be compiled with the same value for this option.  Because of that,
           you must not use this option with GCC's default runtime libraries.

       M32R/D Options

       These -m options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:

       -m32r2
           Generate code for the M32R/2.

       -m32rx
           Generate code for the M32R/X.

       -m32r
           Generate code for the M32R.  This is the default.

       -mmodel=small
           Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses can be loaded  with  the
           "ld24" instruction), and assume all subroutines are reachable with the "bl" instruction.  This is the
           default.

           The addressability of a particular object can be set with the "model" attribute.

       -mmodel=medium
           Assume  objects  may  be  anywhere  in  the  32-bit address space (the compiler generates "seth/add3"
           instructions to load their addresses), and  assume  all  subroutines  are  reachable  with  the  "bl"
           instruction.

       -mmodel=large
           Assume  objects  may  be  anywhere  in  the  32-bit address space (the compiler generates "seth/add3"
           instructions to load their addresses), and assume subroutines may not  be  reachable  with  the  "bl"
           instruction (the compiler generates the much slower "seth/add3/jl" instruction sequence).

       -msdata=none
           Disable  use  of  the small data area.  Variables are put into one of .data, .bss, or .rodata (unless
           the "section" attribute has been specified).  This is the default.

           The small data area consists of sections .sdata and .sbss.  Objects may  be  explicitly  put  in  the
           small data area with the "section" attribute using one of these sections.

       -msdata=sdata
           Put  small  global  and  static  data  in  the  small  data area, but do not generate special code to
           reference them.

       -msdata=use
           Put small global and static data in the  small  data  area,  and  generate  special  instructions  to
           reference them.

       -G num
           Put  global  and  static  objects less than or equal to num bytes into the small data or BSS sections
           instead of the normal data or BSS sections.  The default value of num is 8.  The -msdata option  must
           be set to one of sdata or use for this option to have any effect.

           All  modules  should  be compiled with the same -G num value.  Compiling with different values of num
           may or may not work; if it doesn't  the  linker  gives  an  error  message---incorrect  code  is  not
           generated.

       -mdebug
           Makes  the  M32R-specific  code  in the compiler display some statistics that might help in debugging
           programs.

       -malign-loops
           Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.

       -mno-align-loops
           Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops.  This is the default.

       -missue-rate=number
           Issue number instructions per cycle.  number can only be 1 or 2.

       -mbranch-cost=number
           number can only be 1 or 2.  If it is 1 then branches are preferred over conditional code, if it is 2,
           then the opposite applies.

       -mflush-trap=number
           Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache.  The default is 12.  Valid numbers are between 0
           and 15 inclusive.

       -mno-flush-trap
           Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.

       -mflush-func=name
           Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to  flush  the  cache.   The  default  is
           _flush_cache, but a function call is only used if a trap is not available.

       -mno-flush-func
           Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.

       M680x0 Options

       These  are  the  -m  options  defined for M680x0 and ColdFire processors.  The default settings depend on
       which architecture was selected when the compiler was  configured;  the  defaults  for  the  most  common
       choices are given below.

       -march=arch
           Generate  code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire instruction set architecture.  Permissible values of
           arch for M680x0 architectures are: 68000, 68010, 68020, 68030,  68040,  68060  and  cpu32.   ColdFire
           architectures  are  selected  according  to Freescale's ISA classification and the permissible values
           are: isaa, isaaplus, isab and isac.

           GCC defines a macro __mcfarch__ whenever it is generating code for a ColdFire target.   The  arch  in
           this macro is one of the -march arguments given above.

           When  used  together,  -march  and -mtune select code that runs on a family of similar processors but
           that is optimized for a particular microarchitecture.

       -mcpu=cpu
           Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire processor.  The M680x0 cpus are: 68000, 68010, 68020,
           68030, 68040, 68060, 68302, 68332 and cpu32.  The ColdFire cpus are given by the table  below,  which
           also classifies the CPUs into families:

           Family : -mcpu arguments
           51 : 51 51ac 51ag 51cn 51em 51je 51jf 51jg 51jm 51mm 51qe 51qm
           5206 : 5202 5204 5206
           5206e : 5206e
           5208 : 5207 5208
           5211a : 5210a 5211a
           5213 : 5211 5212 5213
           5216 : 5214 5216
           52235 : 52230 52231 52232 52233 52234 52235
           5225 : 5224 5225
           52259 : 52252 52254 52255 52256 52258 52259
           5235 : 5232 5233 5234 5235 523x
           5249 : 5249
           5250 : 5250
           5271 : 5270 5271
           5272 : 5272
           5275 : 5274 5275
           5282 : 5280 5281 5282 528x
           53017 : 53011 53012 53013 53014 53015 53016 53017
           5307 : 5307
           5329 : 5327 5328 5329 532x
           5373 : 5372 5373 537x
           5407 : 5407
           5475 : 5470 5471 5472 5473 5474 5475 547x 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484 5485

           -mcpu=cpu  overrides  -march=arch  if  arch  is compatible with cpu.  Other combinations of -mcpu and
           -march are rejected.

           GCC defines the  macro  __mcf_cpu_cpu  when  ColdFire  target  cpu  is  selected.   It  also  defines
           __mcf_family_family, where the value of family is given by the table above.

       -mtune=tune
           Tune the code for a particular microarchitecture within the constraints set by -march and -mcpu.  The
           M680x0  microarchitectures  are:  68000,  68010,  68020, 68030, 68040, 68060 and cpu32.  The ColdFire
           microarchitectures are: cfv1, cfv2, cfv3, cfv4 and cfv4e.

           You can also use -mtune=68020-40 for code that needs to run relatively well on 68020, 68030 and 68040
           targets.  -mtune=68020-60 is similar but includes 68060 targets as well.  These  two  options  select
           the same tuning decisions as -m68020-40 and -m68020-60 respectively.

           GCC  defines  the  macros  __mcarch  and __mcarch__ when tuning for 680x0 architecture arch.  It also
           defines mcarch unless either -ansi or a non-GNU -std option is used.  If GCC is tuning for a range of
           architectures, as selected by -mtune=68020-40 or -mtune=68020-60, it defines  the  macros  for  every
           architecture in the range.

           GCC  also  defines the macro __muarch__ when tuning for ColdFire microarchitecture uarch, where uarch
           is one of the arguments given above.

       -m68000
       -mc68000
           Generate output for a 68000.  This is the default when the compiler  is  configured  for  68000-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68000.

           Use  this  option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core, including the 68008, 68302, 68306,
           68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.

       -m68010
           Generate output for a 68010.  This is the default when the compiler  is  configured  for  68010-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68010.

       -m68020
       -mc68020
           Generate  output  for  a  68020.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for 68020-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68020.

       -m68030
           Generate output for a 68030.  This is the default when the compiler  is  configured  for  68030-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68030.

       -m68040
           Generate  output  for  a  68040.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for 68040-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68040.

           This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be emulated by software on  the
           68040.  Use this option if your 68040 does not have code to emulate those instructions.

       -m68060
           Generate  output  for  a  68060.  This is the default when the compiler is configured for 68060-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=68060.

           This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882  instructions  that  have  to  be  emulated  by
           software  on  the  68060.   Use  this  option  if  your  68060  does  not  have code to emulate those
           instructions.

       -mcpu32
           Generate output for a CPU32.  This is the default when the compiler  is  configured  for  CPU32-based
           systems.  It is equivalent to -march=cpu32.

           Use  this option for microcontrollers with a CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331, 68332,
           68333, 68334, 68336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.

       -m5200
           Generate output for a 520X ColdFire CPU.  This is the default when the  compiler  is  configured  for
           520X-based systems.  It is equivalent to -mcpu=5206, and is now deprecated in favor of that option.

           Use  this  option  for  microcontroller with a 5200 core, including the MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and
           MCF5206.

       -m5206e
           Generate output for a 5206e ColdFire CPU.  The option is now deprecated in favor  of  the  equivalent
           -mcpu=5206e.

       -m528x
           Generate  output  for a member of the ColdFire 528X family.  The option is now deprecated in favor of
           the equivalent -mcpu=528x.

       -m5307
           Generate output for a ColdFire 5307 CPU.  The option is now deprecated in  favor  of  the  equivalent
           -mcpu=5307.

       -m5407
           Generate  output  for  a  ColdFire 5407 CPU.  The option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent
           -mcpu=5407.

       -mcfv4e
           Generate output for a ColdFire V4e family CPU  (e.g.  547x/548x).   This  includes  use  of  hardware
           floating-point  instructions.  The option is equivalent to -mcpu=547x, and is now deprecated in favor
           of that option.

       -m68020-40
           Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.  This results  in  code  that
           can  run  relatively  efficiently  on either a 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code
           does use the 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.

           The option is equivalent to -march=68020 -mtune=68020-40.

       -m68020-60
           Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.  This results  in  code  that
           can  run  relatively  efficiently  on either a 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code
           does use the 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.

           The option is equivalent to -march=68020 -mtune=68020-60.

       -mhard-float
       -m68881
           Generate floating-point instructions.  This is the default for 68020  and  above,  and  for  ColdFire
           devices  that  have  an FPU.  It defines the macro __HAVE_68881__ on M680x0 targets and __mcffpu__ on
           ColdFire targets.

       -msoft-float
           Do not generate floating-point instructions; use library calls instead.   This  is  the  default  for
           68000, 68010, and 68832 targets.  It is also the default for ColdFire devices that have no FPU.

       -mdiv
       -mno-div
           Generate  (do  not  generate) ColdFire hardware divide and remainder instructions.  If -march is used
           without -mcpu, the default is "on" for ColdFire architectures and  "off"  for  M680x0  architectures.
           Otherwise,  the default is taken from the target CPU (either the default CPU, or the one specified by
           -mcpu).  For example, the default is "off" for -mcpu=5206 and "on" for -mcpu=5206e.

           GCC defines the macro __mcfhwdiv__ when this option is enabled.

       -mshort
           Consider type "int" to be 16 bits wide, like "short int".  Additionally,  parameters  passed  on  the
           stack are also aligned to a 16-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to 32-bit.

       -mno-short
           Do not consider type "int" to be 16 bits wide.  This is the default.

       -mnobitfield
       -mno-bitfield
           Do not use the bit-field instructions.  The -m68000, -mcpu32 and -m5200 options imply -mnobitfield.

       -mbitfield
           Do  use  the  bit-field instructions.  The -m68020 option implies -mbitfield.  This is the default if
           you use a configuration designed for a 68020.

       -mrtd
           Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that take a fixed number of arguments
           return with the "rtd" instruction, which pops  their  arguments  while  returning.   This  saves  one
           instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments there.

           This  calling  convention is incompatible with the one normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if
           you need to call libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.

           Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that take variable numbers of  arguments
           (including "printf"); otherwise incorrect code is generated for calls to those functions.

           In  addition,  seriously  incorrect  code  results  if  you  call a function with too many arguments.
           (Normally, extra arguments are harmlessly ignored.)

           The "rtd" instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030, 68040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but
           not by the 68000 or 5200.

       -mno-rtd
           Do not use the calling conventions selected by -mrtd.  This is the default.

       -malign-int
       -mno-align-int
           Control whether GCC aligns "int", "long", "long long", "float", "double", and "long double" variables
           on a 32-bit boundary (-malign-int) or a 16-bit  boundary  (-mno-align-int).   Aligning  variables  on
           32-bit  boundaries  produces  code  that runs somewhat faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the
           expense of more memory.

           Warning: if you use the  -malign-int  switch,  GCC  aligns  structures  containing  the  above  types
           differently than most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.

       -mpcrel
           Use  the  pc-relative  addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of using a global offset table.
           At present, this option implies -fpic, allowing at most a 16-bit offset for  pc-relative  addressing.
           -fPIC  is  not  presently supported with -mpcrel, though this could be supported for 68020 and higher
           processors.

       -mno-strict-align
       -mstrict-align
           Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references are handled by the system.

       -msep-data
           Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different area of memory from the  text
           segment.  This allows for execute-in-place in an environment without virtual memory management.  This
           option implies -fPIC.

       -mno-sep-data
           Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.  This is the default.

       -mid-shared-library
           Generate  code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.  This allows for execute-in-
           place and shared libraries in an environment without virtual memory management.  This option  implies
           -fPIC.

       -mno-id-shared-library
           Generate code that doesn't assume ID-based shared libraries are being used.  This is the default.

       -mshared-library-id=n
           Specifies  the  identification  number  of  the ID-based shared library being compiled.  Specifying a
           value of 0 generates more compact code; specifying other values forces the allocation of that  number
           to the current library, but is no more space- or time-efficient than omitting this option.

       -mxgot
       -mno-xgot
           When  generating position-independent code for ColdFire, generate code that works if the GOT has more
           than 8192 entries.  This code is larger and slower than  code  generated  without  this  option.   On
           M680x0 processors, this option is not needed; -fPIC suffices.

           GCC  normally  uses  a  single  instruction  to  load  values from the GOT.  While this is relatively
           efficient, it only works if the GOT is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger causes the linker  to
           report an error such as:

                   relocation truncated to fit: R_68K_GOT16O foobar

           If  this  happens,  you  should recompile your code with -mxgot.  It should then work with very large
           GOTs.  However, code generated with -mxgot is less efficient, since it takes 4 instructions to  fetch
           the value of a global symbol.

           Note that some linkers, including newer versions of the GNU linker, can create multiple GOTs and sort
           GOT  entries.   If you have such a linker, you should only need to use -mxgot when compiling a single
           object file that accesses more than 8192 GOT entries.  Very few do.

           These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position-independent code.

       MCore Options

       These are the -m options defined for the Motorola M*Core processors.

       -mhardlit
       -mno-hardlit
           Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two instructions or less.

       -mdiv
       -mno-div
           Use the divide instruction.  (Enabled by default).

       -mrelax-immediate
       -mno-relax-immediate
           Allow arbitrary-sized immediates in bit operations.

       -mwide-bitfields
       -mno-wide-bitfields
           Always treat bit-fields as "int"-sized.

       -m4byte-functions
       -mno-4byte-functions
           Force all functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary.

       -mcallgraph-data
       -mno-callgraph-data
           Emit callgraph information.

       -mslow-bytes
       -mno-slow-bytes
           Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.

       -mlittle-endian
       -mbig-endian
           Generate code for a little-endian target.

       -m210
       -m340
           Generate code for the 210 processor.

       -mno-lsim
           Assume that runtime support has been provided and so omit the simulator library (libsim.a)  from  the
           linker command line.

       -mstack-increment=size
           Set  the  maximum amount for a single stack increment operation.  Large values can increase the speed
           of programs that contain functions that need a large amount of stack space, but they can also trigger
           a segmentation fault if the stack is extended too much.  The default value is 0x1000.

       MeP Options

       -mabsdiff
           Enables the "abs" instruction, which is the absolute difference between two registers.

       -mall-opts
           Enables all the optional instructions---average, multiply,  divide,  bit  operations,  leading  zero,
           absolute difference, min/max, clip, and saturation.

       -maverage
           Enables the "ave" instruction, which computes the average of two registers.

       -mbased=n
           Variables  of size n bytes or smaller are placed in the ".based" section by default.  Based variables
           use the $tp register as a base register, and there is a 128-byte limit to the ".based" section.

       -mbitops
           Enables the bit operation instructions---bit test ("btstm"), set ("bsetm"), clear  ("bclrm"),  invert
           ("bnotm"), and test-and-set ("tas").

       -mc=name
           Selects which section constant data is placed in.  name may be "tiny", "near", or "far".

       -mclip
           Enables the "clip" instruction.  Note that "-mclip" is not useful unless you also provide "-mminmax".

       -mconfig=name
           Selects  one  of the built-in core configurations.  Each MeP chip has one or more modules in it; each
           module has a core CPU and a variety of coprocessors, optional  instructions,  and  peripherals.   The
           "MeP-Integrator" tool, not part of GCC, provides these configurations through this option; using this
           option is the same as using all the corresponding command-line options.  The default configuration is
           "default".

       -mcop
           Enables  the  coprocessor  instructions.   By  default,  this is a 32-bit coprocessor.  Note that the
           coprocessor is normally enabled via the "-mconfig=" option.

       -mcop32
           Enables the 32-bit coprocessor's instructions.

       -mcop64
           Enables the 64-bit coprocessor's instructions.

       -mivc2
           Enables IVC2 scheduling.  IVC2 is a 64-bit VLIW coprocessor.

       -mdc
           Causes constant variables to be placed in the ".near" section.

       -mdiv
           Enables the "div" and "divu" instructions.

       -meb
           Generate big-endian code.

       -mel
           Generate little-endian code.

       -mio-volatile
           Tells the compiler that any variable marked with the "io" attribute is to be considered volatile.

       -ml Causes variables to be assigned to the ".far" section by default.

       -mleadz
           Enables the "leadz" (leading zero) instruction.

       -mm Causes variables to be assigned to the ".near" section by default.

       -mminmax
           Enables the "min" and "max" instructions.

       -mmult
           Enables the multiplication and multiply-accumulate instructions.

       -mno-opts
           Disables all the optional instructions enabled by "-mall-opts".

       -mrepeat
           Enables the "repeat" and "erepeat" instructions, used for low-overhead looping.

       -ms Causes all variables to default to the ".tiny" section.  Note that there is  a  65536-byte  limit  to
           this section.  Accesses to these variables use the %gp base register.

       -msatur
           Enables  the  saturation  instructions.   Note  that  the  compiler does not currently generate these
           itself, but this option is included for compatibility with other tools, like "as".

       -msdram
           Link the SDRAM-based runtime instead of the default ROM-based runtime.

       -msim
           Link the simulator run-time libraries.

       -msimnovec
           Link the simulator runtime libraries, excluding built-in support for reset and exception vectors  and
           tables.

       -mtf
           Causes all functions to default to the ".far" section.  Without this option, functions default to the
           ".near" section.

       -mtiny=n
           Variables  that are n bytes or smaller are allocated to the ".tiny" section.  These variables use the
           $gp base register.  The default for this option is 4, but note that there's a 65536-byte limit to the
           ".tiny" section.

       MicroBlaze Options

       -msoft-float
           Use software emulation for floating point (default).

       -mhard-float
           Use hardware floating-point instructions.

       -mmemcpy
           Do not optimize block moves, use "memcpy".

       -mno-clearbss
           This option is deprecated.  Use -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss instead.

       -mcpu=cpu-type
           Use features of, and schedule code for, the given CPU.  Supported values are in the  format  vX.YY.Z,
           where X is a major version, YY is the minor version, and Z is compatibility code.  Example values are
           v3.00.a, v4.00.b, v5.00.a, v5.00.b, v5.00.b, v6.00.a.

       -mxl-soft-mul
           Use software multiply emulation (default).

       -mxl-soft-div
           Use software emulation for divides (default).

       -mxl-barrel-shift
           Use the hardware barrel shifter.

       -mxl-pattern-compare
           Use pattern compare instructions.

       -msmall-divides
           Use table lookup optimization for small signed integer divisions.

       -mxl-stack-check
           This option is deprecated.  Use -fstack-check instead.

       -mxl-gp-opt
           Use GP-relative ".sdata"/".sbss" sections.

       -mxl-multiply-high
           Use multiply high instructions for high part of 32x32 multiply.

       -mxl-float-convert
           Use hardware floating-point conversion instructions.

       -mxl-float-sqrt
           Use hardware floating-point square root instruction.

       -mbig-endian
           Generate code for a big-endian target.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code for a little-endian target.

       -mxl-reorder
           Use reorder instructions (swap and byte reversed load/store).

       -mxl-mode-app-model
           Select application model app-model.  Valid models are

           executable
               normal executable (default), uses startup code crt0.o.

           xmdstub
               for  use  with  Xilinx  Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) based software intrusive debug agent called
               xmdstub. This uses startup file crt1.o and sets the start address of the program to 0x800.

           bootstrap
               for applications that are loaded using a bootloader.  This model uses startup file  crt2.o  which
               does not contain a processor reset vector handler. This is suitable for transferring control on a
               processor reset to the bootloader rather than the application.

           novectors
               for applications that do not require any of the MicroBlaze vectors. This option may be useful for
               applications running within a monitoring application. This model uses crt3.o as a startup file.

           Option -xl-mode-app-model is a deprecated alias for -mxl-mode-app-model.

       MIPS Options

       -EB Generate big-endian code.

       -EL Generate little-endian code.  This is the default for mips*el-*-* configurations.

       -march=arch
           Generate  code  that  runs  on  arch,  which  can be the name of a generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a
           particular processor.  The ISA names are: mips1, mips2, mips3, mips4, mips32,  mips32r2,  mips64  and
           mips64r2.   The  processor  names  are:  4kc, 4km, 4kp, 4ksc, 4kec, 4kem, 4kep, 4ksd, 5kc, 5kf, 20kc,
           24kc, 24kf2_1, 24kf1_1, 24kec, 24kef2_1, 24kef1_1,  34kc,  34kf2_1,  34kf1_1,  34kn,  74kc,  74kf2_1,
           74kf1_1, 74kf3_2, 1004kc, 1004kf2_1, 1004kf1_1, loongson2e, loongson2f, loongson3a, m4k, m14k, m14kc,
           m14ke,  m14kec,  octeon,  octeon+,  octeon2,  orion, r2000, r3000, r3900, r4000, r4400, r4600, r4650,
           r4700, r6000, r8000, rm7000, rm9000, r10000, r12000, r14000, r16000, sb1,  sr71000,  vr4100,  vr4111,
           vr4120,  vr4130, vr4300, vr5000, vr5400, vr5500, xlr and xlp.  The special value from-abi selects the
           most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is, mips1  for  32-bit  ABIs  and  mips3  for
           64-bit ABIs).

           The  native  Linux/GNU  toolchain also supports the value native, which selects the best architecture
           option for the host processor.  -march=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the processor.

           In processor names, a final 000 can be abbreviated as k  (for  example,  -march=r2k).   Prefixes  are
           optional, and vr may be written r.

           Names  of the form nf2_1 refer to processors with FPUs clocked at half the rate of the core, names of
           the form nf1_1 refer to processors with FPUs clocked at the same rate as the core, and names  of  the
           form  nf3_2  refer  to  processors  with  FPUs  clocked a ratio of 3:2 with respect to the core.  For
           compatibility reasons, nf is accepted as a synonym for  nf2_1  while  nx  and  bfx  are  accepted  as
           synonyms for nf1_1.

           GCC  defines  two macros based on the value of this option.  The first is _MIPS_ARCH, which gives the
           name of target architecture, as a string.  The second has the form _MIPS_ARCH_foo, where foo  is  the
           capitalized  value  of  _MIPS_ARCH.  For example, -march=r2000 sets _MIPS_ARCH to "r2000" and defines
           the macro _MIPS_ARCH_R2000.

           Note that the _MIPS_ARCH macro uses the processor names given above.  In other words, it has the full
           prefix and does not abbreviate 000 as k.  In the case of  from-abi,  the  macro  names  the  resolved
           architecture (either "mips1" or "mips3").  It names the default architecture when no -march option is
           given.

       -mtune=arch
           Optimize  for arch.  Among other things, this option controls the way instructions are scheduled, and
           the perceived cost of arithmetic operations.  The list of arch values is the same as for -march.

           When this option is not used, GCC optimizes for the processor specified by -march.  By  using  -march
           and  -mtune  together,  it  is  possible  to  generate  code that runs on a family of processors, but
           optimize the code for one particular member of that family.

           -mtune defines the macros _MIPS_TUNE and _MIPS_TUNE_foo, which work in the same  way  as  the  -march
           ones described above.

       -mips1
           Equivalent to -march=mips1.

       -mips2
           Equivalent to -march=mips2.

       -mips3
           Equivalent to -march=mips3.

       -mips4
           Equivalent to -march=mips4.

       -mips32
           Equivalent to -march=mips32.

       -mips32r2
           Equivalent to -march=mips32r2.

       -mips64
           Equivalent to -march=mips64.

       -mips64r2
           Equivalent to -march=mips64r2.

       -mips16
       -mno-mips16
           Generate  (do  not  generate)  MIPS16  code.  If GCC is targeting a MIPS32 or MIPS64 architecture, it
           makes use of the MIPS16e ASE.

           MIPS16 code generation can also be controlled on a  per-function  basis  by  means  of  "mips16"  and
           "nomips16" attributes.

       -mflip-mips16
           Generate  MIPS16  code  on  alternating functions.  This option is provided for regression testing of
           mixed MIPS16/non-MIPS16 code generation, and is not intended for ordinary use in compiling user code.

       -minterlink-compressed
       -mno-interlink-compressed
           Require (do not require) that code using the standard (uncompressed) MIPS ISA be link-compatible with
           MIPS16 and microMIPS code, and vice versa.

           For example, code using the standard ISA encoding cannot jump directly to MIPS16 or  microMIPS  code;
           it  must  either  use  a  call or an indirect jump.  -minterlink-compressed therefore disables direct
           jumps unless GCC knows that the target of the jump is not compressed.

       -minterlink-mips16
       -mno-interlink-mips16
           Aliases of -minterlink-compressed and -mno-interlink-compressed.  These options predate the microMIPS
           ASE and are retained for backwards compatibility.

       -mabi=32
       -mabi=o64
       -mabi=n32
       -mabi=64
       -mabi=eabi
           Generate code for the given ABI.

           Note that the EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant.  GCC normally generates 64-bit  code  when  you
           select a 64-bit architecture, but you can use -mgp32 to get 32-bit code instead.

           For information about the O64 ABI, see <http://gcc.gnu.org/projects/mipso64-abi.html>.

           GCC  supports  a  variant of the o32 ABI in which floating-point registers are 64 rather than 32 bits
           wide.  You can select this combination with -mabi=32 -mfp64.  This ABI  relies  on  the  "mthc1"  and
           "mfhc1" instructions and is therefore only supported for MIPS32R2 processors.

           The  register  assignments  for arguments and return values remain the same, but each scalar value is
           passed in a single 64-bit register rather than a pair  of  32-bit  registers.   For  example,  scalar
           floating-point  values are returned in $f0 only, not a $f0/$f1 pair.  The set of call-saved registers
           also remains the same, but all 64 bits are saved.

       -mabicalls
       -mno-abicalls
           Generate (do not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style dynamic objects.  -mabicalls  is  the
           default for SVR4-based systems.

       -mshared
       -mno-shared
           Generate  (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent, and that can therefore be linked
           into shared libraries.  This option only affects -mabicalls.

           All -mabicalls code has traditionally been position-independent, regardless of options like -fPIC and
           -fpic.  However, as an extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute  accesses  for
           locally-binding  symbols.   It  can  also use shorter GP initialization sequences and generate direct
           calls to locally-defined functions.  This mode is selected by -mno-shared.

           -mno-shared depends on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates objects that can only be linked  by  the
           GNU linker.  However, the option does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only affects the
           ABI of relocatable objects.  Using -mno-shared generally makes executables both smaller and quicker.

           -mshared is the default.

       -mplt
       -mno-plt
           Assume  (do  not assume) that the static and dynamic linkers support PLTs and copy relocations.  This
           option only affects -mno-shared -mabicalls.  For the n64 ABI,  this  option  has  no  effect  without
           -msym32.

           You  can  make  -mplt  the  default by configuring GCC with --with-mips-plt.  The default is -mno-plt
           otherwise.

       -mxgot
       -mno-xgot
           Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global offset table.

           GCC normally uses a single instruction to load  values  from  the  GOT.   While  this  is  relatively
           efficient,  it only works if the GOT is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger causes the linker to
           report an error such as:

                   relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar

           If this happens, you should recompile your code with  -mxgot.   This  works  with  very  large  GOTs,
           although  the  code is also less efficient, since it takes three instructions to fetch the value of a
           global symbol.

           Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs.  If you have such a linker, you should only need  to
           use -mxgot when a single object file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries.  Very few do.

           These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position independent code.

       -mgp32
           Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.

       -mgp64
           Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.

       -mfp32
           Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.

       -mfp64
           Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.

       -mhard-float
           Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.

       -msoft-float
           Do  not  use  floating-point  coprocessor  instructions.  Implement floating-point calculations using
           library calls instead.

       -mno-float
           Equivalent to -msoft-float, but additionally asserts that the program being compiled does not perform
           any floating-point operations.  This option is presently  supported  only  by  some  bare-metal  MIPS
           configurations,  where  it may select a special set of libraries that lack all floating-point support
           (including, for example, the floating-point "printf" formats).  If code  compiled  with  "-mno-float"
           accidentally  contains  floating-point  operations,  it  is  likely to suffer a link-time or run-time
           failure.

       -msingle-float
           Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-precision operations.

       -mdouble-float
           Assume that the  floating-point  coprocessor  supports  double-precision  operations.   This  is  the
           default.

       -mabs=2008
       -mabs=legacy
           These  options  control  the treatment of the special not-a-number (NaN) IEEE 754 floating-point data
           with the "abs.fmt" and "neg.fmt" machine instructions.

           By default or when the -mabs=legacy is used the legacy treatment is selected.   In  this  case  these
           instructions  are considered arithmetic and avoided where correct operation is required and the input
           operand might be a NaN.  A longer sequence of instructions that manipulate the sign bit of  floating-
           point datum manually is used instead unless the -ffinite-math-only option has also been specified.

           The  -mabs=2008  option  selects  the  IEEE  754-2008 treatment.  In this case these instructions are
           considered non-arithmetic and therefore operating correctly in all  cases,  including  in  particular
           where  the  input  operand is a NaN.  These instructions are therefore always used for the respective
           operations.

       -mnan=2008
       -mnan=legacy
           These options control the encoding of the special not-a-number (NaN) IEEE 754 floating-point data.

           The -mnan=legacy option selects the legacy encoding.  In this case quiet NaNs (qNaNs) are denoted  by
           the  first  bit  of  their  trailing  significand  field being 0, whereas signalling NaNs (sNaNs) are
           denoted by the first bit of their trailing significand field being 1.

           The -mnan=2008 option selects the IEEE 754-2008 encoding.  In this case  qNaNs  are  denoted  by  the
           first  bit of their trailing significand field being 1, whereas sNaNs are denoted by the first bit of
           their trailing significand field being 0.

           The default is -mnan=legacy unless GCC has been configured with --with-nan=2008.

       -mllsc
       -mno-llsc
           Use (do not use) ll, sc, and sync instructions to implement atomic memory built-in  functions.   When
           neither option is specified, GCC uses the instructions if the target architecture supports them.

           -mllsc  is useful if the runtime environment can emulate the instructions and -mno-llsc can be useful
           when compiling for nonstandard ISAs.  You can make either option the default by configuring GCC  with
           --with-llsc and --without-llsc respectively.  --with-llsc is the default for some configurations; see
           the installation documentation for details.

       -mdsp
       -mno-dsp
           Use (do not use) revision 1 of the MIPS DSP ASE.
             This option defines the preprocessor macro __mips_dsp.  It also defines __mips_dsp_rev to 1.

       -mdspr2
       -mno-dspr2
           Use (do not use) revision 2 of the MIPS DSP ASE.
             This  option  defines  the  preprocessor  macros  __mips_dsp  and  __mips_dspr2.   It  also defines
           __mips_dsp_rev to 2.

       -msmartmips
       -mno-smartmips
           Use (do not use) the MIPS SmartMIPS ASE.

       -mpaired-single
       -mno-paired-single
           Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
             This option requires hardware floating-point support to be enabled.

       -mdmx
       -mno-mdmx
           Use (do not use) MIPS Digital Media Extension instructions.   This  option  can  only  be  used  when
           generating 64-bit code and requires hardware floating-point support to be enabled.

       -mips3d
       -mno-mips3d
           Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE.  The option -mips3d implies -mpaired-single.

       -mmicromips
       -mno-micromips
           Generate (do not generate) microMIPS code.

           MicroMIPS  code generation can also be controlled on a per-function basis by means of "micromips" and
           "nomicromips" attributes.

       -mmt
       -mno-mt
           Use (do not use) MT Multithreading instructions.

       -mmcu
       -mno-mcu
           Use (do not use) the MIPS MCU ASE instructions.

       -meva
       -mno-eva
           Use (do not use) the MIPS Enhanced Virtual Addressing instructions.

       -mvirt
       -mno-virt
           Use (do not use) the MIPS Virtualization Application Specific instructions.

       -mlong64
           Force "long" types to be 64 bits wide.  See -mlong32 for an explanation of the default  and  the  way
           that the pointer size is determined.

       -mlong32
           Force "long", "int", and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.

           The  default  size  of  "int"s,  "long"s and pointers depends on the ABI.  All the supported ABIs use
           32-bit "int"s.  The n64 ABI uses 64-bit "long"s, as does the  64-bit  EABI;  the  others  use  32-bit
           "long"s.   Pointers are the same size as "long"s, or the same size as integer registers, whichever is
           smaller.

       -msym32
       -mno-sym32
           Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values, regardless of  the  selected  ABI.   This
           option  is  useful  in  combination with -mabi=64 and -mno-abicalls because it allows GCC to generate
           shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.

       -G num
           Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section if that data is no bigger than num
           bytes.  GCC can then generate more efficient accesses to the data; see -mgpopt for details.

           The default -G option depends on the configuration.

       -mlocal-sdata
       -mno-local-sdata
           Extend (do not extend) the -G behavior to  local  data  too,  such  as  to  static  variables  in  C.
           -mlocal-sdata is the default for all configurations.

           If  the  linker  complains  that  an  application is using too much small data, you might want to try
           rebuilding the less performance-critical parts with -mno-local-sdata.  You might also want  to  build
           large libraries with -mno-local-sdata, so that the libraries leave more room for the main program.

       -mextern-sdata
       -mno-extern-sdata
           Assume  (do  not  assume) that externally-defined data is in a small data section if the size of that
           data is within the -G limit.  -mextern-sdata is the default for all configurations.

           If you compile a module Mod with -mextern-sdata -G num -mgpopt, and Mod  references  a  variable  Var
           that  is no bigger than num bytes, you must make sure that Var is placed in a small data section.  If
           Var is defined by another module, you must either compile that module with a high-enough  -G  setting
           or attach a "section" attribute to Var's definition.  If Var is common, you must link the application
           with a high-enough -G setting.

           The easiest way of satisfying these restrictions is to compile and link every module with the same -G
           option.   However, you may wish to build a library that supports several different small data limits.
           You can do this by compiling the library with the highest supported -G setting and additionally using
           -mno-extern-sdata to stop the library from making assumptions about externally-defined data.

       -mgpopt
       -mno-gpopt
           Use (do not use) GP-relative accesses for symbols that are known to be in a small data  section;  see
           -G, -mlocal-sdata and -mextern-sdata.  -mgpopt is the default for all configurations.

           -mno-gpopt  is  useful  for  cases  where  the  $gp  register might not hold the value of "_gp".  For
           example, if the code is part of a library that might be used in a boot monitor,  programs  that  call
           boot  monitor routines pass an unknown value in $gp.  (In such situations, the boot monitor itself is
           usually compiled with -G0.)

           -mno-gpopt implies -mno-local-sdata and -mno-extern-sdata.

       -membedded-data
       -mno-embedded-data
           Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible,  then  next  in  the  small  data
           section  if  possible,  otherwise  in  data.   This  gives slightly slower code than the default, but
           reduces the amount of RAM required when executing, and  thus  may  be  preferred  for  some  embedded
           systems.

       -muninit-const-in-rodata
       -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
           Put uninitialized "const" variables in the read-only data section.  This option is only meaningful in
           conjunction with -membedded-data.

       -mcode-readable=setting
           Specify  whether GCC may generate code that reads from executable sections.  There are three possible
           settings:

           -mcode-readable=yes
               Instructions may freely access executable sections.  This is the default setting.

           -mcode-readable=pcrel
               MIPS16 PC-relative load instructions can access executable sections, but other instructions  must
               not  do  so.   This option is useful on 4KSc and 4KSd processors when the code TLBs have the Read
               Inhibit bit set.  It is also useful  on  processors  that  can  be  configured  to  have  a  dual
               instruction/data  SRAM interface and that, like the M4K, automatically redirect PC-relative loads
               to the instruction RAM.

           -mcode-readable=no
               Instructions must not access executable sections.  This option can be useful on targets that  are
               configured  to  have  a  dual  instruction/data  SRAM  interface but that (unlike the M4K) do not
               automatically redirect PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.

       -msplit-addresses
       -mno-split-addresses
           Enable (disable) use of the "%hi()" and "%lo()" assembler relocation operators.  This option has been
           superseded by -mexplicit-relocs but is retained for backwards compatibility.

       -mexplicit-relocs
       -mno-explicit-relocs
           Use (do  not  use)  assembler  relocation  operators  when  dealing  with  symbolic  addresses.   The
           alternative, selected by -mno-explicit-relocs, is to use assembler macros instead.

           -mexplicit-relocs  is  the default if GCC was configured to use an assembler that supports relocation
           operators.

       -mcheck-zero-division
       -mno-check-zero-division
           Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.

           The default is -mcheck-zero-division.

       -mdivide-traps
       -mdivide-breaks
           MIPS systems check for division  by  zero  by  generating  either  a  conditional  trap  or  a  break
           instruction.  Using traps results in smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later.  Also,
           some  versions  of  the  Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap from generating the proper signal
           ("SIGFPE").  Use -mdivide-traps to allow conditional traps on architectures  that  support  them  and
           -mdivide-breaks to force the use of breaks.

           The  default  is  usually  -mdivide-traps,  but  this  can  be  overridden  at  configure  time using
           --with-divide=breaks.     Divide-by-zero    checks    can    be     completely     disabled     using
           -mno-check-zero-division.

       -mmemcpy
       -mno-memcpy
           Force  (do not force) the use of "memcpy()" for non-trivial block moves.  The default is -mno-memcpy,
           which allows GCC to inline most constant-sized copies.

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Disable (do not disable) use of the  "jal"  instruction.   Calling  functions  using  "jal"  is  more
           efficient but requires the caller and callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.

           This option has no effect on abicalls code.  The default is -mno-long-calls.

       -mmad
       -mno-mad
           Enable (disable) use of the "mad", "madu" and "mul" instructions, as provided by the R4650 ISA.

       -mimadd
       -mno-imadd
           Enable  (disable)  use  of  the  "madd"  and  "msub" integer instructions.  The default is -mimadd on
           architectures that support "madd" and "msub" except for the 74k architecture where it  was  found  to
           generate slower code.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Enable (disable) use of the floating-point multiply-accumulate instructions, when they are available.
           The default is -mfused-madd.

           On  the  R8000  CPU  when  multiply-accumulate  instructions  are  used,  the intermediate product is
           calculated to infinite precision and is not subject to the FCSR Flush  to  Zero  bit.   This  may  be
           undesirable  in  some  circumstances.  On other processors the result is numerically identical to the
           equivalent computation using separate multiply, add, subtract and negate instructions.

       -nocpp
           Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user assembler files (with a .s suffix) when
           assembling them.

       -mfix-24k
       -mno-fix-24k
           Work around the 24K E48 (lost data on stores during refill) errata.  The workarounds are  implemented
           by the assembler rather than by GCC.

       -mfix-r4000
       -mno-fix-r4000
           Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:

           -   A  double-word  or  a  variable  shift may give an incorrect result if executed immediately after
               starting an integer division.

           -   A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect  result  if  executed  while  an  integer
               multiplication is in progress.

           -   An  integer division may give an incorrect result if started in a delay slot of a taken branch or
               a jump.

       -mfix-r4400
       -mno-fix-r4400
           Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:

           -   A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect  result  if  executed  immediately  after
               starting an integer division.

       -mfix-r10000
       -mno-fix-r10000
           Work around certain R10000 errata:

           -   "ll"/"sc"  sequences  may  not behave atomically on revisions prior to 3.0.  They may deadlock on
               revisions 2.6 and earlier.

           This option can only  be  used  if  the  target  architecture  supports  branch-likely  instructions.
           -mfix-r10000 is the default when -march=r10000 is used; -mno-fix-r10000 is the default otherwise.

       -mfix-rm7000
       -mno-fix-rm7000
           Work  around  the  RM7000  "dmult"/"dmultu" errata.  The workarounds are implemented by the assembler
           rather than by GCC.

       -mfix-vr4120
       -mno-fix-vr4120
           Work around certain VR4120 errata:

           -   "dmultu" does not always produce the correct result.

           -   "div" and "ddiv" do not always produce the correct result if one of the operands is negative.

           The workarounds for the division errata rely on special functions in  libgcc.a.   At  present,  these
           functions are only provided by the "mips64vr*-elf" configurations.

           Other VR4120 errata require a NOP to be inserted between certain pairs of instructions.  These errata
           are handled by the assembler, not by GCC itself.

       -mfix-vr4130
           Work around the VR4130 "mflo"/"mfhi" errata.  The workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather
           than  by GCC, although GCC avoids using "mflo" and "mfhi" if the VR4130 "macc", "macchi", "dmacc" and
           "dmacchi" instructions are available instead.

       -mfix-sb1
       -mno-fix-sb1
           Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata.  (This flag currently works around the SB-1 revision 2 "F1"
           and "F2" floating-point errata.)

       -mr10k-cache-barrier=setting
           Specify whether GCC should insert cache barriers to avoid the side-effects  of  speculation  on  R10K
           processors.

           In  common  with  many  processors, the R10K tries to predict the outcome of a conditional branch and
           speculatively executes instructions from the "taken" branch.  It later aborts these  instructions  if
           the  predicted  outcome  is  wrong.   However,  on  the R10K, even aborted instructions can have side
           effects.

           This problem only affects kernel stores and, depending on the system, kernel loads.  As an example, a
           speculatively-executed store may load the target memory into cache and mark the cache line as  dirty,
           even  if  the  store  itself  is later aborted.  If a DMA operation writes to the same area of memory
           before the "dirty" line is flushed, the cached  data  overwrites  the  DMA-ed  data.   See  the  R10K
           processor manual for a full description, including other potential problems.

           One  workaround  is  to  insert  cache  barrier instructions before every memory access that might be
           speculatively   executed    and    that    might    have    side    effects    even    if    aborted.
           -mr10k-cache-barrier=setting  controls  GCC's  implementation  of  this  workaround.  It assumes that
           aborted accesses to any byte in the following regions does not have side effects:

           1.  the memory occupied by the current function's stack frame;

           2.  the memory occupied by an incoming stack argument;

           3.  the memory occupied by an object with a link-time-constant address.

           It is the kernel's responsibility to ensure that speculative accesses to  these  regions  are  indeed
           safe.

           If the input program contains a function declaration such as:

                   void foo (void);

           then  the implementation of "foo" must allow "j foo" and "jal foo" to be executed speculatively.  GCC
           honors this restriction for functions it compiles itself.  It  expects  non-GCC  functions  (such  as
           hand-written assembly code) to do the same.

           The option has three forms:

           -mr10k-cache-barrier=load-store
               Insert a cache barrier before a load or store that might be speculatively executed and that might
               have side effects even if aborted.

           -mr10k-cache-barrier=store
               Insert  a  cache  barrier before a store that might be speculatively executed and that might have
               side effects even if aborted.

           -mr10k-cache-barrier=none
               Disable the insertion of cache barriers.  This is the default setting.

       -mflush-func=func
       -mno-flush-func
           Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to not call  any  such  function.   If
           called, the function must take the same arguments as the common "_flush_func()", that is, the address
           of  the  memory  range  for  which  the cache is being flushed, the size of the memory range, and the
           number 3 (to flush both caches).  The default depends on the  target  GCC  was  configured  for,  but
           commonly is either _flush_func or __cpu_flush.

       mbranch-cost=num
           Set  the cost of branches to roughly num "simple" instructions.  This cost is only a heuristic and is
           not guaranteed to produce consistent results across releases.  A zero cost  redundantly  selects  the
           default, which is based on the -mtune setting.

       -mbranch-likely
       -mno-branch-likely
           Enable  or  disable  use  of  Branch  Likely instructions, regardless of the default for the selected
           architecture.  By default, Branch Likely instructions may be generated if they are supported  by  the
           selected  architecture.   An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures and processors that
           implement those architectures; for those, Branch Likely instructions are not be generated by  default
           because the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.

       -mfp-exceptions
       -mno-fp-exceptions
           Specifies whether FP exceptions are enabled.  This affects how FP instructions are scheduled for some
           processors.  The default is that FP exceptions are enabled.

           For  instance,  on  the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we are emitting 64-bit code, then we
           can use both FP pipes.  Otherwise, we can only use one FP pipe.

       -mvr4130-align
       -mno-vr4130-align
           The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two instructions together if the first
           one is 8-byte aligned.  When this option is enabled, GCC aligns pairs of instructions that it  thinks
           should execute in parallel.

           This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130.  It normally makes code faster, but at
           the expense of making it bigger.  It is enabled by default at optimization level -O3.

       -msynci
       -mno-synci
           Enable  (disable)  generation  of "synci" instructions on architectures that support it.  The "synci"
           instructions (if enabled) are generated when "__builtin___clear_cache()" is compiled.

           This option defaults to  "-mno-synci",  but  the  default  can  be  overridden  by  configuring  with
           "--with-synci".

           When  compiling  code for single processor systems, it is generally safe to use "synci".  However, on
           many multi-core (SMP) systems, it does not invalidate the instruction caches on  all  cores  and  may
           lead to undefined behavior.

       -mrelax-pic-calls
       -mno-relax-pic-calls
           Try  to turn PIC calls that are normally dispatched via register $25 into direct calls.  This is only
           possible if the linker can resolve the destination at link-time and  if  the  destination  is  within
           range for a direct call.

           -mrelax-pic-calls  is the default if GCC was configured to use an assembler and a linker that support
           the ".reloc" assembly directive and "-mexplicit-relocs" is in effect.   With  "-mno-explicit-relocs",
           this  optimization  can  be  performed  by  the  assembler and the linker alone without help from the
           compiler.

       -mmcount-ra-address
       -mno-mcount-ra-address
           Emit (do not emit) code that allows "_mcount" to modify the calling function's return address.   When
           enabled, this option extends the usual "_mcount" interface with a new ra-address parameter, which has
           type  "intptr_t  *"  and  is passed in register $12.  "_mcount" can then modify the return address by
           doing both of the following:

           •   Returning the new address in register $31.

           •   Storing the new address in "*ra-address", if ra-address is nonnull.

           The default is -mno-mcount-ra-address.

       MMIX Options

       These options are defined for the MMIX:

       -mlibfuncs
       -mno-libfuncs
           Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing  all  values  in  registers,  no
           matter the size.

       -mepsilon
       -mno-epsilon
           Generate  floating-point  comparison  instructions  that  compare  with  respect  to the "rE" epsilon
           register.

       -mabi=mmixware
       -mabi=gnu
           Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in  the  called  function)  are
           seen as registers $0 and up, as opposed to the GNU ABI which uses global registers $231 and up.

       -mzero-extend
       -mno-zero-extend
           When  reading  data  from  memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not use) zero-extending load
           instructions by default, rather than sign-extending ones.

       -mknuthdiv
       -mno-knuthdiv
           Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same  sign  as  the  divisor.   With  the
           default, -mno-knuthdiv, the sign of the remainder follows the sign of the dividend.  Both methods are
           arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.

       -mtoplevel-symbols
       -mno-toplevel-symbols
           Prepend  (do  not  prepend)  a  :  to  all  global symbols, so the assembly code can be used with the
           "PREFIX" assembly directive.

       -melf
           Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than  the  default  mmo  format  used  by  the  mmix
           simulator.

       -mbranch-predict
       -mno-branch-predict
           Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch prediction indicates a probable
           branch.

       -mbase-addresses
       -mno-base-addresses
           Generate  (do  not  generate)  code  that  uses  base  addresses.  Using a base address automatically
           generates a request (handled by the assembler and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global
           register.  The register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0 to 255  from
           the  value  held  in  the  register.   The  generally leads to short and fast code, but the number of
           different data items that can be addressed is limited.  This means that a program that uses  lots  of
           static data may require -mno-base-addresses.

       -msingle-exit
       -mno-single-exit
           Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each function.

       MN10300 Options

       These -m options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:

       -mmult-bug
           Generate  code  to  avoid  bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300 processors.  This is the
           default.

       -mno-mult-bug
           Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300 processors.

       -mam33
           Generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.

       -mno-am33
           Do not generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.  This is the default.

       -mam33-2
           Generate code using features specific to the AM33/2.0 processor.

       -mam34
           Generate code using features specific to the AM34 processor.

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Use the timing characteristics of the indicated CPU type when scheduling instructions.  This does not
           change the targeted processor type.  The CPU type must be one of mn10300, am33, am33-2 or am34.

       -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
           When generating a function that returns a  pointer,  return  the  pointer  in  both  "a0"  and  "d0".
           Otherwise,  the  pointer  is  returned  only  in  "a0", and attempts to call such functions without a
           prototype result in errors.  Note that this option is on by default; use -mno-return-pointer-on-d0 to
           disable it.

       -mno-crt0
           Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.

       -mrelax
           Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization  pass  to  shorten  branches,
           calls  and  absolute  memory addresses.  This option only has an effect when used on the command line
           for the final link step.

           This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.

       -mliw
           Allow the compiler to generate Long Instruction Word instructions if the target is the AM33 or later.
           This is the default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro __LIW__.

       -mnoliw
           Do not allow the compiler to generate Long Instruction Word instructions.  This  option  defines  the
           preprocessor macro __NO_LIW__.

       -msetlb
           Allow  the  compiler  to  generate the SETLB and Lcc instructions if the target is the AM33 or later.
           This is the default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro __SETLB__.

       -mnosetlb
           Do not allow  the  compiler  to  generate  SETLB  or  Lcc  instructions.   This  option  defines  the
           preprocessor macro __NO_SETLB__.

       Moxie Options

       -meb
           Generate big-endian code.  This is the default for moxie-*-* configurations.

       -mel
           Generate little-endian code.

       -mno-crt0
           Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.

       MSP430 Options

       These options are defined for the MSP430:

       -masm-hex
           Force  assembly output to always use hex constants.  Normally such constants are signed decimals, but
           this option is available for testsuite and/or aesthetic purposes.

       -mmcu=
           Select the MCU to target.  This is used to create a C preprocessor symbol based upon  the  MCU  name,
           converted  to  upper  case  and  pre-  and  post-  fixed with "__".  This in turn will be used by the
           "msp430.h" header file to select an MCU specific supplimentary header file.

           The option also sets the ISA to use.  If the MCU name is one that is known to only  support  the  430
           ISA  then  that  is selected, otherwise the 430X ISA is selected.  A generic MCU name of "msp430" can
           also be used to select the 430 ISA.  Similarly the generic "msp430x" MCU name will  select  the  430X
           ISA.

           In  addition  an  MCU  specific linker script will be added to the linker command line.  The script's
           name is the name of the MCU with ".ld" appended.  Thus specifying -mmcu=xxx on the gcc  command  line
           will  define  the  C preprocessor symbol "__XXX__" and cause the linker to search for a script called
           xxx.ld.

           This option is also passed on to the assembler.

       -mcpu=
           Specifies the ISA to use.  Accepted values are "msp430", "msp430x" and "msp430xv2".  This  option  is
           deprecated.  The -mmcu= option should be used to select the ISA.

       -msim
           Link  to  the  simulator  runtime  libraries  and linker script.  Overrides any scripts that would be
           selected by the -mmcu= option.

       -mlarge
           Use large-model addressing (20-bit pointers, 32-bit "size_t").

       -msmall
           Use small-model addressing (16-bit pointers, 16-bit "size_t").

       -mrelax
           This option is passed to the  assembler  and  linker,  and  allows  the  linker  to  perform  certain
           optimizations that cannot be done until the final link.

       mhwmult=
           Describes  the  type of hardware multiply supported by the target.  Accepted values are "none" for no
           hardware multiply, "16bit" for the original 16-bit-only multiply supported by  early  MCUs.   "32bit"
           for  the  16/32-bit  multiply  supported  by  later  MCUs  and  "f5series" for the 16/32-bit multiply
           supported by F5-series MCUs.  A value of "auto" can also be given.  This  tells  GCC  to  deduce  the
           hardware  multiply  support based upon the MCU name provided by the -mmcu option.  If no -mmcu option
           is specified then "32bit" hardware multiply support is assumed.  "auto" is the default setting.

           Hardware multiplies are normally performed by calling a library routine.  This  saves  space  in  the
           generated code.  When compiling at "-O3" or higher however the hardware multiplier is invoked inline.
           This makes for bigger, but faster code.

           The  hardware  multiply routines disable interrupts whilst running and restore the previous interrupt
           state when they finish.  This makes them safe to use inside interrupt handlers as well as  in  normal
           code.

       -minrt
           Enable  the  use  of a minimum runtime environment - no static initializers or constructors.  This is
           intended for memory-constrained devices.  The compiler will include special symbols in  some  objects
           that tell the linker and runtime which code fragments are required.

       NDS32 Options

       These options are defined for NDS32 implementations:

       -mbig-endian
           Generate code in big-endian mode.

       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code in little-endian mode.

       -mreduced-regs
           Use reduced-set registers for register allocation.

       -mfull-regs
           Use full-set registers for register allocation.

       -mcmov
           Generate conditional move instructions.

       -mno-cmov
           Do not generate conditional move instructions.

       -mperf-ext
           Generate performance extension instructions.

       -mno-perf-ext
           Do not generate performance extension instructions.

       -mv3push
           Generate v3 push25/pop25 instructions.

       -mno-v3push
           Do not generate v3 push25/pop25 instructions.

       -m16-bit
           Generate 16-bit instructions.

       -mno-16-bit
           Do not generate 16-bit instructions.

       -mgp-direct
           Generate GP base instructions directly.

       -mno-gp-direct
           Do no generate GP base instructions directly.

       -misr-vector-size=num
           Specify the size of each interrupt vector, which must be 4 or 16.

       -mcache-block-size=num
           Specify the size of each cache block, which must be a power of 2 between 4 and 512.

       -march=arch
           Specify the name of the target architecture.

       -mforce-fp-as-gp
           Prevent  $fp  being allocated during register allocation so that compiler is able to force performing
           fp-as-gp optimization.

       -mforbid-fp-as-gp
           Forbid using $fp to access static and  global  variables.   This  option  strictly  forbids  fp-as-gp
           optimization regardless of -mforce-fp-as-gp.

       -mex9
           Use special directives to guide linker doing ex9 optimization.

       -mctor-dtor
           Enable constructor/destructor feature.

       -mrelax
           Guide linker to relax instructions.

       Nios II Options

       These are the options defined for the Altera Nios II processor.

       -G num
           Put  global  and  static  objects less than or equal to num bytes into the small data or BSS sections
           instead of the normal data or BSS sections.  The default value of num is 8.

       -mgpopt
       -mno-gpopt
           Generate (do not generate) GP-relative accesses for objects in the small data or BSS  sections.   The
           default  is  -mgpopt  except  when -fpic or -fPIC is specified to generate position-independent code.
           Note that the Nios II ABI does not permit GP-relative accesses from shared libraries.

           You may need to specify -mno-gpopt explicitly when building programs that include  large  amounts  of
           small  data,  including  large  GOT  data  sections.  In this case, the 16-bit offset for GP-relative
           addressing may not be large enough to allow access to the entire small data section.

       -mel
       -meb
           Generate little-endian (default) or big-endian (experimental) code, respectively.

       -mbypass-cache
       -mno-bypass-cache
           Force all load and  store  instructions  to  always  bypass  cache  by  using  I/O  variants  of  the
           instructions. The default is not to bypass the cache.

       -mno-cache-volatile
       -mcache-volatile
           Volatile  memory  access  bypass the cache using the I/O variants of the load and store instructions.
           The default is not to bypass the cache.

       -mno-fast-sw-div
       -mfast-sw-div
           Do not use table-based fast divide for small numbers. The default is to use the fast  divide  at  -O3
           and above.

       -mno-hw-mul
       -mhw-mul
       -mno-hw-mulx
       -mhw-mulx
       -mno-hw-div
       -mhw-div
           Enable  or  disable  emitting  "mul",  "mulx"  and  "div" family of instructions by the compiler. The
           default is to emit "mul" and not emit "div" and "mulx".

       -mcustom-insn=N
       -mno-custom-insn
           Each -mcustom-insn=N option enables use of a custom instruction with encoding N when generating  code
           that  uses  insn.   For  example,  "-mcustom-fadds=253"  generates custom instruction 253 for single-
           precision floating-point add operations instead of the default behavior of using a library call.

           The following values of insn are supported.  Except as otherwise noted, floating-point operations are
           expected to be implemented with normal IEEE 754 semantics and correspond directly to the C  operators
           or the equivalent GCC built-in functions.

           Single-precision floating point:

           fadds, fsubs, fdivs, fmuls
               Binary arithmetic operations.

           fnegs
               Unary negation.

           fabss
               Unary absolute value.

           fcmpeqs, fcmpges, fcmpgts, fcmples, fcmplts, fcmpnes
               Comparison operations.

           fmins, fmaxs
               Floating-point  minimum and maximum.  These instructions are only generated if -ffinite-math-only
               is specified.

           fsqrts
               Unary square root operation.

           fcoss, fsins, ftans, fatans, fexps, flogs
               Floating-point trigonometric and exponential functions.  These instructions are only generated if
               -funsafe-math-optimizations is also specified.

           Double-precision floating point:

           faddd, fsubd, fdivd, fmuld
               Binary arithmetic operations.

           fnegd
               Unary negation.

           fabsd
               Unary absolute value.

           fcmpeqd, fcmpged, fcmpgtd, fcmpled, fcmpltd, fcmpned
               Comparison operations.

           fmind, fmaxd
               Double-precision   minimum   and   maximum.    These   instructions   are   only   generated   if
               -ffinite-math-only is specified.

           fsqrtd
               Unary square root operation.

           fcosd, fsind, ftand, fatand, fexpd, flogd
               Double-precision  trigonometric and exponential functions.  These instructions are only generated
               if -funsafe-math-optimizations is also specified.

           Conversions:

           fextsd
               Conversion from single precision to double precision.

           ftruncds
               Conversion from double precision to single precision.

           fixsi, fixsu, fixdi, fixdu
               Conversion from floating point to signed or unsigned integer types, with truncation towards zero.

           floatis, floatus, floatid, floatud
               Conversion from signed or unsigned integer types to floating-point types.

           In addition, all of the following transfer instructions for  internal  registers  X  and  Y  must  be
           provided  to use any of the double-precision floating-point instructions.  Custom instructions taking
           two double-precision source operands expect the first operand in the 64-bit register  X.   The  other
           operand (or only operand of a unary operation) is given to the custom arithmetic instruction with the
           least  significant  half  in  source  register  src1 and the most significant half in src2.  A custom
           instruction that returns a double-precision result returns  the  most  significant  32  bits  in  the
           destination  register  and  the  other  half  in  32-bit register Y.  GCC automatically generates the
           necessary code sequences to write register X and/or read register Y when  double-precision  floating-
           point instructions are used.

           fwrx
               Write src1 into the least significant half of X and src2 into the most significant half of X.

           fwry
               Write src1 into Y.

           frdxhi, frdxlo
               Read the most or least (respectively) significant half of X and store it in dest.

           frdy
               Read the value of Y and store it into dest.

           Note that you can gain more local control over generation of Nios II custom instructions by using the
           "target("custom-insn=N")" and "target("no-custom-insn")" function attributes or pragmas.

       -mcustom-fpu-cfg=name
           This  option  enables  a  predefined,  named  set  of custom instruction encodings (see -mcustom-insn
           above).  Currently, the following sets are defined:

           -mcustom-fpu-cfg=60-1 is  equivalent  to:  -mcustom-fmuls=252  -mcustom-fadds=253  -mcustom-fsubs=254
           -fsingle-precision-constant

           -mcustom-fpu-cfg=60-2  is  equivalent  to:  -mcustom-fmuls=252  -mcustom-fadds=253 -mcustom-fsubs=254
           -mcustom-fdivs=255 -fsingle-precision-constant

           -mcustom-fpu-cfg=72-3 is equivalent to: -mcustom-floatus=243 -mcustom-fixsi=244  -mcustom-floatis=245
           -mcustom-fcmpgts=246       -mcustom-fcmples=249       -mcustom-fcmpeqs=250       -mcustom-fcmpnes=251
           -mcustom-fmuls=252         -mcustom-fadds=253          -mcustom-fsubs=254          -mcustom-fdivs=255
           -fsingle-precision-constant

           Custom  instruction  assignments  given  by individual -mcustom-insn= options override those given by
           -mcustom-fpu-cfg=, regardless of the order of the options on the command line.

           Note that you can gain more local control  over  selection  of  a  FPU  configuration  by  using  the
           "target("custom-fpu-cfg=name")" function attribute or pragma.

       These additional -m options are available for the Altera Nios II ELF (bare-metal) target:

       -mhal
           Link  with  HAL BSP.  This suppresses linking with the GCC-provided C runtime startup and termination
           code, and is typically used in conjunction with -msys-crt0= to specify the location of the  alternate
           startup code provided by the HAL BSP.

       -msmallc
           Link with a limited version of the C library, -lsmallc, rather than Newlib.

       -msys-crt0=startfile
           startfile  is  the file name of the startfile (crt0) to use when linking.  This option is only useful
           in conjunction with -mhal.

       -msys-lib=systemlib
           systemlib is the library name of the library that provides low-level system calls required by  the  C
           library, e.g. "read" and "write".  This option is typically used to link with a library provided by a
           HAL BSP.

       PDP-11 Options

       These options are defined for the PDP-11:

       -mfpu
           Use  hardware  FPP floating point.  This is the default.  (FIS floating point on the PDP-11/40 is not
           supported.)

       -msoft-float
           Do not use hardware floating point.

       -mac0
           Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).

       -mno-ac0
           Return floating-point results in memory.  This is the default.

       -m40
           Generate code for a PDP-11/40.

       -m45
           Generate code for a PDP-11/45.  This is the default.

       -m10
           Generate code for a PDP-11/10.

       -mbcopy-builtin
           Use inline "movmemhi" patterns for copying memory.  This is the default.

       -mbcopy
           Do not use inline "movmemhi" patterns for copying memory.

       -mint16
       -mno-int32
           Use 16-bit "int".  This is the default.

       -mint32
       -mno-int16
           Use 32-bit "int".

       -mfloat64
       -mno-float32
           Use 64-bit "float".  This is the default.

       -mfloat32
       -mno-float64
           Use 32-bit "float".

       -mabshi
           Use "abshi2" pattern.  This is the default.

       -mno-abshi
           Do not use "abshi2" pattern.

       -mbranch-expensive
           Pretend that branches are expensive.  This is for experimenting with code generation only.

       -mbranch-cheap
           Do not pretend that branches are expensive.  This is the default.

       -munix-asm
           Use Unix assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for pdp11-*-bsd.

       -mdec-asm
           Use DEC assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured  for  any  PDP-11  target  other  than
           pdp11-*-bsd.

       picoChip Options

       These -m options are defined for picoChip implementations:

       -mae=ae_type
           Set  the  instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters for array element type
           ae_type.  Supported values for ae_type are ANY, MUL, and MAC.

           -mae=ANY selects a completely generic AE type.  Code generated with this option runs on  any  of  the
           other  AE types.  The code is not as efficient as it would be if compiled for a specific AE type, and
           some types of operation (e.g., multiplication) do not work properly on all types of AE.

           -mae=MUL selects a MUL AE type.  This is the most useful AE  type  for  compiled  code,  and  is  the
           default.

           -mae=MAC selects a DSP-style MAC AE.  Code compiled with this option may suffer from poor performance
           of byte (char) manipulation, since the DSP AE does not provide hardware support for byte load/stores.

       -msymbol-as-address
           Enable  the compiler to directly use a symbol name as an address in a load/store instruction, without
           first loading it into a register.  Typically, the use of this option generates larger programs, which
           run faster than when the option isn't used.  However, the results vary from program to program, so it
           is left as a user option, rather than being permanently enabled.

       -mno-inefficient-warnings
           Disables warnings about the generation of inefficient code.  These warnings  can  be  generated,  for
           example,  when compiling code that performs byte-level memory operations on the MAC AE type.  The MAC
           AE has no hardware support for  byte-level  memory  operations,  so  all  byte  load/stores  must  be
           synthesized  from  word  load/store  operations.   This  is inefficient and a warning is generated to
           indicate that you should rewrite the code to avoid byte operations, or to target an AE type that  has
           the necessary hardware support.  This option disables these warnings.

       PowerPC Options

       These are listed under

       RL78 Options

       -msim
           Links in additional target libraries to support operation within a simulator.

       -mmul=none
       -mmul=g13
       -mmul=rl78
           Specifies  the type of hardware multiplication support to be used.  The default is "none", which uses
           software multiplication functions.  The "g13" option is for the hardware  multiply/divide  peripheral
           only  on the RL78/G13 targets.  The "rl78" option is for the standard hardware multiplication defined
           in the RL78 software manual.

       IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options

       These -m options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:

       -mpowerpc-gpopt
       -mno-powerpc-gpopt
       -mpowerpc-gfxopt
       -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
       -mpowerpc64
       -mno-powerpc64
       -mmfcrf
       -mno-mfcrf
       -mpopcntb
       -mno-popcntb
       -mpopcntd
       -mno-popcntd
       -mfprnd
       -mno-fprnd
       -mcmpb
       -mno-cmpb
       -mmfpgpr
       -mno-mfpgpr
       -mhard-dfp
       -mno-hard-dfp
           You use these options to specify which instructions are available on the  processor  you  are  using.
           The default value of these options is determined when configuring GCC.  Specifying the -mcpu=cpu_type
           overrides  the specification of these options.  We recommend you use the -mcpu=cpu_type option rather
           than the options listed above.

           Specifying -mpowerpc-gpopt allows GCC to use the optional PowerPC architecture  instructions  in  the
           General  Purpose group, including floating-point square root.  Specifying -mpowerpc-gfxopt allows GCC
           to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics group, including floating-point
           select.

           The -mmfcrf option allows GCC  to  generate  the  move  from  condition  register  field  instruction
           implemented on the POWER4 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01 architecture.
           The  -mpopcntb option allows GCC to generate the popcount and double-precision FP reciprocal estimate
           instruction implemented on the POWER5 processor and other processors that support the  PowerPC  V2.02
           architecture.   The  -mpopcntd  option allows GCC to generate the popcount instruction implemented on
           the POWER7 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.06 architecture.   The  -mfprnd
           option  allows  GCC  to  generate  the  FP  round  to integer instructions implemented on the POWER5+
           processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture.  The -mcmpb option allows
           GCC to generate the  compare  bytes  instruction  implemented  on  the  POWER6  processor  and  other
           processors  that  support the PowerPC V2.05 architecture.  The -mmfpgpr option allows GCC to generate
           the FP move to/from general-purpose register instructions implemented on the  POWER6X  processor  and
           other  processors that support the extended PowerPC V2.05 architecture.  The -mhard-dfp option allows
           GCC to generate the decimal floating-point instructions implemented on some POWER processors.

           The -mpowerpc64 option allows GCC to generate the additional 64-bit instructions that  are  found  in
           the  full PowerPC64 architecture and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities.  GCC defaults to
           -mno-powerpc64.

       -mcpu=cpu_type
           Set architecture type, register  usage,  and  instruction  scheduling  parameters  for  machine  type
           cpu_type.   Supported  values  for  cpu_type  are  401, 403, 405, 405fp, 440, 440fp, 464, 464fp, 476,
           476fp, 505, 601, 602, 603, 603e, 604, 604e, 620, 630, 740, 7400, 7450, 750, 801, 821, 823, 860,  970,
           8540,  a2, e300c2, e300c3, e500mc, e500mc64, e5500, e6500, ec603e, G3, G4, G5, titan, power3, power4,
           power5, power5+, power6, power6x, power7, power8, powerpc, powerpc64, powerpc64le, and rs64.

           -mcpu=powerpc, -mcpu=powerpc64, and -mcpu=powerpc64le specify pure 32-bit  PowerPC  (either  endian),
           64-bit  big  endian  PowerPC  and  64-bit  little  endian PowerPC architecture machine types, with an
           appropriate, generic processor model assumed for scheduling purposes.

           The other options specify a specific processor.  Code generated under those options runs best on that
           processor, and may not run at all on others.

           The -mcpu options automatically enable or disable the following options:

           -maltivec    -mfprnd    -mhard-float    -mmfcrf    -mmultiple   -mpopcntb   -mpopcntd     -mpowerpc64
           -mpowerpc-gpopt   -mpowerpc-gfxopt   -msingle-float  -mdouble-float  -msimple-fpu  -mstring   -mmulhw
           -mdlmzb   -mmfpgpr  -mvsx  -mcrypto  -mdirect-move  -mpower8-fusion   -mpower8-vector   -mquad-memory
           -mquad-memory-atomic

           The particular options set for any particular CPU varies between compiler versions, depending on what
           setting  seems  to  produce  optimal  code  for  that  CPU; it doesn't necessarily reflect the actual
           hardware's capabilities.  If you wish to set an individual option to  a  particular  value,  you  may
           specify it after the -mcpu option, like -mcpu=970 -mno-altivec.

           On  AIX,  the  -maltivec  and  -mpowerpc64 options are not enabled or disabled by the -mcpu option at
           present because AIX does not have full support for these options.  You may still  enable  or  disable
           them individually if you're sure it'll work in your environment.

       -mtune=cpu_type
           Set  the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type cpu_type, but do not set the architecture
           type or register usage, as -mcpu=cpu_type does.  The same values for cpu_type are used for -mtune  as
           for  -mcpu.   If  both  are  specified, the code generated uses the architecture and registers set by
           -mcpu, but the scheduling parameters set by -mtune.

       -mcmodel=small
           Generate PowerPC64 code for the small model: The TOC is limited to 64k.

       -mcmodel=medium
           Generate PowerPC64 code for the medium model: The TOC and other static data may be up to a  total  of
           4G in size.

       -mcmodel=large
           Generate PowerPC64 code for the large model: The TOC may be up to 4G in size.  Other data and code is
           only limited by the 64-bit address space.

       -maltivec
       -mno-altivec
           Generate  code  that  uses  (does  not use) AltiVec instructions, and also enable the use of built-in
           functions that allow more direct access to the AltiVec instruction set.  You may  also  need  to  set
           -mabi=altivec to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI enhancements.

           When  -maltivec  is  used,  rather  than  -maltivec=le or -maltivec=be, the element order for Altivec
           intrinsics such as "vec_splat", "vec_extract",  and  "vec_insert"  will  match  array  element  order
           corresponding to the endianness of the target.  That is, element zero identifies the leftmost element
           in  a vector register when targeting a big-endian platform, and identifies the rightmost element in a
           vector register when targeting a little-endian platform.

       -maltivec=be
           Generate Altivec instructions using big-endian element order, regardless of  whether  the  target  is
           big- or little-endian.  This is the default when targeting a big-endian platform.

           The  element  order  is  used to interpret element numbers in Altivec intrinsics such as "vec_splat",
           "vec_extract", and "vec_insert".  By default, these will match array element order  corresponding  to
           the endianness for the target.

       -maltivec=le
           Generate  Altivec instructions using little-endian element order, regardless of whether the target is
           big- or little-endian.  This is the default when targeting a little-endian platform.  This option  is
           currently ignored when targeting a big-endian platform.

           The  element  order  is  used to interpret element numbers in Altivec intrinsics such as "vec_splat",
           "vec_extract", and "vec_insert".  By default, these will match array element order  corresponding  to
           the endianness for the target.

       -mvrsave
       -mno-vrsave
           Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.

       -mgen-cell-microcode
           Generate Cell microcode instructions.

       -mwarn-cell-microcode
           Warn  when  a Cell microcode instruction is emitted.  An example of a Cell microcode instruction is a
           variable shift.

       -msecure-plt
           Generate code that allows ld and ld.so to build executables and shared libraries with  non-executable
           ".plt" and ".got" sections.  This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.

       -mbss-plt
           Generate  code  that  uses  a  BSS ".plt" section that ld.so fills in, and requires ".plt" and ".got"
           sections that are both writable and executable.  This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.

       -misel
       -mno-isel
           This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.

       -misel=yes/no
           This switch has been deprecated.  Use -misel and -mno-isel instead.

       -mspe
       -mno-spe
           This switch enables or disables the generation of SPE simd instructions.

       -mpaired
       -mno-paired
           This switch enables or disables the generation of PAIRED simd instructions.

       -mspe=yes/no
           This option has been deprecated.  Use -mspe and -mno-spe instead.

       -mvsx
       -mno-vsx
           Generate code that uses (does not use) vector/scalar (VSX) instructions, and also enable the  use  of
           built-in functions that allow more direct access to the VSX instruction set.

       -mcrypto
       -mno-crypto
           Enable  the  use  (disable)  of  the built-in functions that allow direct access to the cryptographic
           instructions that were added in version 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA.

       -mdirect-move
       -mno-direct-move
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the instructions to move  data  between  the  general  purpose
           registers and the vector/scalar (VSX) registers that were added in version 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA.

       -mpower8-fusion
       -mno-power8-fusion
           Generate  code  that keeps (does not keeps) some integer operations adjacent so that the instructions
           can be fused together on power8 and later processors.

       -mpower8-vector
       -mno-power8-vector
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the vector and scalar instructions that were added in  version
           2.07  of the PowerPC ISA.  Also enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct access to
           the vector instructions.

       -mquad-memory
       -mno-quad-memory
           Generate code  that  uses  (does  not  use)  the  non-atomic  quad  word  memory  instructions.   The
           -mquad-memory option requires use of 64-bit mode.

       -mquad-memory-atomic
       -mno-quad-memory-atomic
           Generate   code   that   uses  (does  not  use)  the  atomic  quad  word  memory  instructions.   The
           -mquad-memory-atomic option requires use of 64-bit mode.

       -mfloat-gprs=yes/single/double/no
       -mfloat-gprs
           This switch enables or disables the generation of floating-point operations  on  the  general-purpose
           registers for architectures that support it.

           The argument yes or single enables the use of single-precision floating-point operations.

           The argument double enables the use of single and double-precision floating-point operations.

           The argument no disables floating-point operations on the general-purpose registers.

           This option is currently only available on the MPC854x.

       -m32
       -m64
           Generate  code  for  32-bit  or 64-bit environments of Darwin and SVR4 targets (including GNU/Linux).
           The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and generates  code  that  runs  on  any
           PowerPC  variant.   The  64-bit  environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits, and
           generates code for PowerPC64, as for -mpowerpc64.

       -mfull-toc
       -mno-fp-in-toc
       -mno-sum-in-toc
       -mminimal-toc
           Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for every  executable  file.   The
           -mfull-toc  option  is  selected  by default.  In that case, GCC allocates at least one TOC entry for
           each unique non-automatic variable  reference  in  your  program.   GCC  also  places  floating-point
           constants in the TOC.  However, only 16,384 entries are available in the TOC.

           If  you  receive  a linker error message that saying you have overflowed the available TOC space, you
           can reduce the amount of  TOC  space  used  with  the  -mno-fp-in-toc  and  -mno-sum-in-toc  options.
           -mno-fp-in-toc  prevents  GCC  from  putting  floating-point constants in the TOC and -mno-sum-in-toc
           forces GCC to generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at run time instead  of
           putting  that  sum  into  the TOC.  You may specify one or both of these options.  Each causes GCC to
           produce very slightly slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.

           If you still run out of space in the TOC even  when  you  specify  both  of  these  options,  specify
           -mminimal-toc  instead.   This option causes GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file.  When you
           specify this option, GCC produces code that is slower and larger but which uses extremely little  TOC
           space.  You may wish to use this option only on files that contain less frequently-executed code.

       -maix64
       -maix32
           Enable  64-bit  AIX  ABI  and  calling  convention:  64-bit  pointers,  64-bit  "long"  type, and the
           infrastructure needed to  support  them.   Specifying  -maix64  implies  -mpowerpc64,  while  -maix32
           disables the 64-bit ABI and implies -mno-powerpc64.  GCC defaults to -maix32.

       -mxl-compat
       -mno-xl-compat
           Produce  code  that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler semantics when using AIX-compatible ABI.
           Pass floating-point arguments to prototyped functions beyond the register  save  area  (RSA)  on  the
           stack  in  addition  to  argument  FPRs.   Do not assume that most significant double in 128-bit long
           double value is properly rounded when comparing values and converting to double.  Use XL symbol names
           for long double support routines.

           The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to handle an obscure K&R C  case
           of  calling  a  function  that takes the address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared.
           IBM XL compilers access floating-point arguments that do not fit in the RSA from  the  stack  when  a
           subroutine  is compiled without optimization.  Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
           stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by default and only  is  necessary
           when calling subroutines compiled by IBM XL compilers without optimization.

       -mpe
           Support IBM RS/6000 SP Parallel Environment (PE).  Link an application written to use message passing
           with special startup code to enable the application to run.  The system must have PE installed in the
           standard  location  (/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/), or the specs file must be overridden with the -specs= option
           to specify the appropriate directory location.  The Parallel Environment does not support threads, so
           the -mpe option and the -pthread option are incompatible.

       -malign-natural
       -malign-power
           On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option -malign-natural  overrides  the  ABI-
           defined  alignment  of  larger  types,  such  as  floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based
           boundary.  The option -malign-power instructs GCC to follow the ABI-specified alignment  rules.   GCC
           defaults to the standard alignment defined in the ABI.

           On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and -malign-power is not supported.

       -msoft-float
       -mhard-float
           Generate  code  that  does  not  use (uses) the floating-point register set.  Software floating-point
           emulation is provided if you use the -msoft-float option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.

       -msingle-float
       -mdouble-float
           Generate code for single- or  double-precision  floating-point  operations.   -mdouble-float  implies
           -msingle-float.

       -msimple-fpu
           Do not generate "sqrt" and "div" instructions for hardware floating-point unit.

       -mfpu=name
           Specify type of floating-point unit.  Valid values for name are sp_lite (equivalent to -msingle-float
           -msimple-fpu),   dp_lite   (equivalent   to  -mdouble-float  -msimple-fpu),  sp_full  (equivalent  to
           -msingle-float), and dp_full (equivalent to -mdouble-float).

       -mxilinx-fpu
           Perform optimizations for the floating-point unit on Xilinx PPC 405/440.

       -mmultiple
       -mno-multiple
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word instructions  and  the  store  multiple
           word  instructions.   These instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not generated
           on PowerPC systems.  Do not use -mmultiple on little-endian PowerPC systems, since those instructions
           do not work when the processor is in little-endian mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750  which
           permit these instructions in little-endian mode.

       -mstring
       -mno-string
           Generate  code  that  uses  (does  not  use)  the  load string instructions and the store string word
           instructions to save multiple registers and do small block moves.  These instructions  are  generated
           by  default  on  POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use -mstring on little-
           endian PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when the processor is  in  little-endian
           mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit these instructions in little-endian mode.

       -mupdate
       -mno-update
           Generate  code  that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions that update the base register
           to the address of the calculated memory location.  These instructions are generated by  default.   If
           you  use  -mno-update, there is a small window between the time that the stack pointer is updated and
           the address of the previous frame is stored, which means code  that  walks  the  stack  frame  across
           interrupts or signals may get corrupted data.

       -mavoid-indexed-addresses
       -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
           Generate  code  that  tries to avoid (not avoid) the use of indexed load or store instructions. These
           instructions can incur a performance penalty on Power6 processors in certain situations, such as when
           stepping through large arrays that cross a 16M boundary.  This option  is  enabled  by  default  when
           targeting Power6 and disabled otherwise.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Generate  code  that  uses  (does  not  use) the floating-point multiply and accumulate instructions.
           These instructions are generated by default  if  hardware  floating  point  is  used.   The  machine-
           dependent -mfused-madd option is now mapped to the machine-independent -ffp-contract=fast option, and
           -mno-fused-madd is mapped to -ffp-contract=off.

       -mmulhw
       -mno-mulhw
           Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and multiply-accumulate instructions on
           the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.  These instructions are generated by default when targeting
           those processors.

       -mdlmzb
       -mno-dlmzb
           Generate  code  that uses (does not use) the string-search dlmzb instruction on the IBM 405, 440, 464
           and 476 processors.  This instruction is generated by default when targeting those processors.

       -mno-bit-align
       -mbit-align
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures and unions that contain  bit-
           fields to be aligned to the base type of the bit-field.

           For  example,  by  default  a structure containing nothing but 8 "unsigned" bit-fields of length 1 is
           aligned to a 4-byte boundary and has a size of 4 bytes.  By using -mno-bit-align,  the  structure  is
           aligned to a 1-byte boundary and is 1 byte in size.

       -mno-strict-align
       -mstrict-align
           On  System  V.4  and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references are
           handled by the system.

       -mrelocatable
       -mno-relocatable
           Generate code that allows (does not allow) a static executable to be relocated to a different address
           at run time.  A simple embedded PowerPC system loader should relocate the entire contents of  ".got2"
           and  4-byte  locations  listed in the ".fixup" section, a table of 32-bit addresses generated by this
           option.  For this to work, all objects  linked  together  must  be  compiled  with  -mrelocatable  or
           -mrelocatable-lib.  -mrelocatable code aligns the stack to an 8-byte boundary.

       -mrelocatable-lib
       -mno-relocatable-lib
           Like  -mrelocatable, -mrelocatable-lib generates a ".fixup" section to allow static executables to be
           relocated  at  run  time,  but  -mrelocatable-lib  does  not  use  the  smaller  stack  alignment  of
           -mrelocatable.   Objects compiled with -mrelocatable-lib may be linked with objects compiled with any
           combination of the -mrelocatable options.

       -mno-toc
       -mtoc
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that register 2 contains a pointer to a
           global area pointing to the addresses used in the program.

       -mlittle
       -mlittle-endian
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the processor in little-endian mode.  The
           -mlittle-endian option is the same as -mlittle.

       -mbig
       -mbig-endian
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the processor in  big-endian  mode.   The
           -mbig-endian option is the same as -mbig.

       -mdynamic-no-pic
           On  Darwin  and  Mac  OS X systems, compile code so that it is not relocatable, but that its external
           references are relocatable.  The  resulting  code  is  suitable  for  applications,  but  not  shared
           libraries.

       -msingle-pic-base
           Treat  the  register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than loading it in the prologue for
           each function.  The runtime system is responsible for initializing this register with an  appropriate
           value before execution begins.

       -mprioritize-restricted-insns=priority
           This  option  controls  the priority that is assigned to dispatch-slot restricted instructions during
           the second scheduling pass.  The argument priority takes the value 0, 1, or 2 to assign no,  highest,
           or second-highest (respectively) priority to dispatch-slot restricted instructions.

       -msched-costly-dep=dependence_type
           This  option  controls  which  dependences  are  considered  costly  by the target during instruction
           scheduling.  The argument dependence_type takes one of the following values:

           no  No dependence is costly.

           all All dependences are costly.

           true_store_to_load
               A true dependence from store to load is costly.

           store_to_load
               Any dependence from store to load is costly.

           number
               Any dependence for which the latency is greater than or equal to number is costly.

       -minsert-sched-nops=scheme
           This option controls which NOP insertion scheme is used  during  the  second  scheduling  pass.   The
           argument scheme takes one of the following values:

           no  Don't insert NOPs.

           pad Pad  with  NOPs  any  dispatch  group  that  has vacant issue slots, according to the scheduler's
               grouping.

           regroup_exact
               Insert NOPs to force costly dependent insns into separate groups.  Insert exactly as many NOPs as
               needed to force an insn to a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.

           number
               Insert NOPs to force costly dependent insns into separate groups.  Insert number NOPs to force an
               insn to a new group.

       -mcall-sysv
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling conventions that adhere to  the
           March 1995 draft of the System V Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement.  This is
           the default unless you configured GCC using powerpc-*-eabiaix.

       -mcall-sysv-eabi
       -mcall-eabi
           Specify both -mcall-sysv and -meabi options.

       -mcall-sysv-noeabi
           Specify both -mcall-sysv and -mno-eabi options.

       -mcall-aixdesc
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the AIX operating system.

       -mcall-linux
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the Linux-based GNU system.

       -mcall-freebsd
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the FreeBSD operating system.

       -mcall-netbsd
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the NetBSD operating system.

       -mcall-openbsd
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the OpenBSD operating system.

       -maix-struct-return
           Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI).

       -msvr4-struct-return
           Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the SVR4 ABI).

       -mabi=abi-type
           Extend  the  current  ABI  with  a  particular extension, or remove such extension.  Valid values are
           altivec, no-altivec, spe, no-spe, ibmlongdouble, ieeelongdouble, elfv1, elfv2.

       -mabi=spe
           Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions.  This does not change the  default  ABI,  instead  it
           adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current ABI.

       -mabi=no-spe
           Disable Book-E SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI.

       -mabi=ibmlongdouble
           Change  the current ABI to use IBM extended-precision long double.  This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI
           option.

       -mabi=ieeelongdouble
           Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended-precision long double.  This is a  PowerPC  32-bit  Linux
           ABI option.

       -mabi=elfv1
           Change  the  current ABI to use the ELFv1 ABI.  This is the default ABI for big-endian PowerPC 64-bit
           Linux.  Overriding the default ABI  requires  special  system  support  and  is  likely  to  fail  in
           spectacular ways.

       -mabi=elfv2
           Change  the  current  ABI  to  use  the ELFv2 ABI.  This is the default ABI for little-endian PowerPC
           64-bit Linux.  Overriding the default ABI requires special system support and is likely  to  fail  in
           spectacular ways.

       -mprototype
       -mno-prototype
           On  System  V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to variable argument functions are
           properly prototyped.  Otherwise, the compiler must insert an instruction before every  non-prototyped
           call  to  set  or  clear bit 6 of the condition code register (CR) to indicate whether floating-point
           values are passed in the floating-point registers in case  the  function  takes  variable  arguments.
           With -mprototype, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions set or clear the bit.

       -msim
           On  embedded  PowerPC  systems,  assume  that  the  startup  module is called sim-crt0.o and that the
           standard  C  libraries  are  libsim.a  and  libc.a.   This  is  the  default  for   powerpc-*-eabisim
           configurations.

       -mmvme
           On  embedded  PowerPC  systems,  assume  that  the startup module is called crt0.o and the standard C
           libraries are libmvme.a and libc.a.

       -mads
           On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is  called  crt0.o  and  the  standard  C
           libraries are libads.a and libc.a.

       -myellowknife
           On  embedded  PowerPC  systems,  assume  that  the startup module is called crt0.o and the standard C
           libraries are libyk.a and libc.a.

       -mvxworks
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are compiling for a VxWorks system.

       -memb
           On embedded PowerPC systems, set the PPC_EMB bit in the  ELF  flags  header  to  indicate  that  eabi
           extended relocations are used.

       -meabi
       -mno-eabi
           On  System  V.4  and  embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the Embedded Applications Binary
           Interface (EABI), which is a set of modifications to the System V.4 specifications.  Selecting -meabi
           means that the stack is aligned to an 8-byte boundary, a function "__eabi" is called from  "main"  to
           set  up  the  EABI  environment,  and  the -msdata option can use both "r2" and "r13" to point to two
           separate small data areas.  Selecting -mno-eabi  means  that  the  stack  is  aligned  to  a  16-byte
           boundary,  no  EABI  initialization  function is called from "main", and the -msdata option only uses
           "r13" to point to a single small data area.  The -meabi option is on by default if you configured GCC
           using one of the powerpc*-*-eabi* options.

       -msdata=eabi
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized "const" global and static  data  in
           the  .sdata2 section, which is pointed to by register "r2".  Put small initialized non-"const" global
           and static data  in  the  .sdata  section,  which  is  pointed  to  by  register  "r13".   Put  small
           uninitialized  global  and static data in the .sbss section, which is adjacent to the .sdata section.
           The -msdata=eabi option is incompatible with the -mrelocatable option.  The -msdata=eabi option  also
           sets the -memb option.

       -msdata=sysv
           On  System  V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static data in the .sdata section,
           which is pointed to by register "r13".  Put small uninitialized global and static data in  the  .sbss
           section,  which  is adjacent to the .sdata section.  The -msdata=sysv option is incompatible with the
           -mrelocatable option.

       -msdata=default
       -msdata
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if -meabi is used, compile code the same as -msdata=eabi,
           otherwise compile code the same as -msdata=sysv.

       -msdata=data
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global data in the .sdata section.   Put  small
           uninitialized  global  data  in  the  .sbss section.  Do not use register "r13" to address small data
           however.  This is the default behavior unless other -msdata options are used.

       -msdata=none
       -mno-sdata
           On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data in the .data section, and all
           uninitialized data in the .bss section.

       -mblock-move-inline-limit=num
           Inline all block moves (such as calls to "memcpy" or structure copies) less  than  or  equal  to  num
           bytes.   The minimum value for num is 32 bytes on 32-bit targets and 64 bytes on 64-bit targets.  The
           default value is target-specific.

       -G num
           On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than or equal to  num  bytes  into  the
           small  data or BSS sections instead of the normal data or BSS section.  By default, num is 8.  The -G
           num switch is also passed to the linker.  All modules should be compiled with the same -G num value.

       -mregnames
       -mno-regnames
           On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register names in the  assembly  language
           output using symbolic forms.

       -mlongcall
       -mno-longcall
           By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer and more expensive calling sequence is
           required.   This  is required for calls farther than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current
           location.  A short call is generated if the compiler knows the call cannot be that  far  away.   This
           setting can be overridden by the "shortcall" function attribute, or by "#pragma longcall(0)".

           Some  linkers  are  capable  of detecting out-of-range calls and generating glue code on the fly.  On
           these systems, long calls are unnecessary and generate slower code.  As  of  this  writing,  the  AIX
           linker  can  do this, as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64.  It is planned to add this feature to the
           GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.

           On Darwin/PPC systems, "#pragma longcall" generates "jbsr callee, L42", plus a  branch  island  (glue
           code).   The  two target addresses represent the callee and the branch island.  The Darwin/PPC linker
           prefers the first address and generates a "bl callee" if the PPC "bl" instruction reaches the  callee
           directly;  otherwise,  the linker generates "bl L42" to call the branch island.  The branch island is
           appended to the body of the calling function; it computes the full 32-bit address of the  callee  and
           jumps to it.

           On  Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit to the glue for every direct call,
           and the Darwin linker decides whether to use or discard it.

           In the future, GCC may ignore all longcall specifications when the linker is known to generate glue.

       -mtls-markers
       -mno-tls-markers
           Mark (do not mark) calls to "__tls_get_addr" with a relocation specifying the function argument.  The
           relocation allows the linker to reliably associate function call with argument setup instructions for
           TLS optimization, which in turn allows GCC to better schedule the sequence.

       -pthread
           Adds support for multithreading with the pthreads library.  This  option  sets  flags  for  both  the
           preprocessor and linker.

       -mrecip
       -mno-recip
           This  option  enables use of the reciprocal estimate and reciprocal square root estimate instructions
           with additional Newton-Raphson steps to increase precision instead of doing a divide or  square  root
           and  divide  for  floating-point arguments.  You should use the -ffast-math option when using -mrecip
           (or    at    least    -funsafe-math-optimizations,    -finite-math-only,    -freciprocal-math     and
           -fno-trapping-math).   Note  that  while  the throughput of the sequence is generally higher than the
           throughput of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased by up to
           2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994) for reciprocal square roots.

       -mrecip=opt
           This option controls which reciprocal estimate instructions may be used.  opt  is  a  comma-separated
           list  of  options,  which  may  be preceded by a "!" to invert the option: "all": enable all estimate
           instructions, "default": enable the default instructions, equivalent to -mrecip, "none": disable  all
           estimate   instructions,  equivalent  to  -mno-recip;  "div":  enable  the  reciprocal  approximation
           instructions for both single and double precision; "divf":  enable  the  single-precision  reciprocal
           approximation   instructions;   "divd":   enable   the   double-precision   reciprocal  approximation
           instructions; "rsqrt": enable the reciprocal square root approximation instructions for  both  single
           and  double  precision;  "rsqrtf":  enable  the single-precision reciprocal square root approximation
           instructions;  "rsqrtd":  enable  the   double-precision   reciprocal   square   root   approximation
           instructions;

           So,  for example, -mrecip=all,!rsqrtd enables all of the reciprocal estimate instructions, except for
           the  "FRSQRTE",  "XSRSQRTEDP",  and  "XVRSQRTEDP"  instructions  which  handle  the  double-precision
           reciprocal square root calculations.

       -mrecip-precision
       -mno-recip-precision
           Assume  (do  not assume) that the reciprocal estimate instructions provide higher-precision estimates
           than  is  mandated  by  the  PowerPC  ABI.   Selecting  -mcpu=power6,  -mcpu=power7  or  -mcpu=power8
           automatically  selects -mrecip-precision.  The double-precision square root estimate instructions are
           not generated by default on low-precision machines, since  they  do  not  provide  an  estimate  that
           converges after three steps.

       -mveclibabi=type
           Specifies  the  ABI  type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an external library.  The only type
           supported at present is "mass", which specifies to  use  IBM's  Mathematical  Acceleration  Subsystem
           (MASS)  libraries  for vectorizing intrinsics using external libraries.  GCC currently emits calls to
           "acosd2", "acosf4",  "acoshd2",  "acoshf4",  "asind2",  "asinf4",  "asinhd2",  "asinhf4",  "atan2d2",
           "atan2f4",  "atand2", "atanf4", "atanhd2", "atanhf4", "cbrtd2", "cbrtf4", "cosd2", "cosf4", "coshd2",
           "coshf4", "erfcd2", "erfcf4", "erfd2", "erff4",  "exp2d2",  "exp2f4",  "expd2",  "expf4",  "expm1d2",
           "expm1f4",  "hypotd2", "hypotf4", "lgammad2", "lgammaf4", "log10d2", "log10f4", "log1pd2", "log1pf4",
           "log2d2", "log2f4",  "logd2",  "logf4",  "powd2",  "powf4",  "sind2",  "sinf4",  "sinhd2",  "sinhf4",
           "sqrtd2",  "sqrtf4",  "tand2", "tanf4", "tanhd2", and "tanhf4" when generating code for power7.  Both
           -ftree-vectorize and -funsafe-math-optimizations must also be enabled.  The MASS  libraries  must  be
           specified at link time.

       -mfriz
       -mno-friz
           Generate (do not generate) the "friz" instruction when the -funsafe-math-optimizations option is used
           to  optimize  rounding  of  floating-point  values to 64-bit integer and back to floating point.  The
           "friz" instruction does not return the same value if the floating-point number is too large to fit in
           an integer.

       -mpointers-to-nested-functions
       -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions
           Generate (do not generate) code to load up the static chain register (r11)  when  calling  through  a
           pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux systems where a function pointer points to a 3-word descriptor giving
           the  function  address, TOC value to be loaded in register r2, and static chain value to be loaded in
           register r11.  The -mpointers-to-nested-functions is on by default.  You cannot call through pointers
           to nested functions or pointers to functions compiled in other languages that use the static chain if
           you use the -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions.

       -msave-toc-indirect
       -mno-save-toc-indirect
           Generate (do not generate) code to save the TOC value in the reserved stack location in the  function
           prologue  if  the function calls through a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux systems.  If the TOC value
           is not saved in  the  prologue,  it  is  saved  just  before  the  call  through  the  pointer.   The
           -mno-save-toc-indirect option is the default.

       -mcompat-align-parm
       -mno-compat-align-parm
           Generate (do not generate) code to pass structure parameters with a maximum alignment of 64 bits, for
           compatibility with older versions of GCC.

           Older  versions  of GCC (prior to 4.9.0) incorrectly did not align a structure parameter on a 128-bit
           boundary when that structure contained a member requiring 128-bit alignment.  This  is  corrected  in
           more  recent  versions  of  GCC.   This  option  may be used to generate code that is compatible with
           functions compiled with older versions of GCC.

           The -mno-compat-align-parm option is the default.

       RX Options

       These command-line options are defined for RX targets:

       -m64bit-doubles
       -m32bit-doubles
           Make the "double" data type be 64 bits (-m64bit-doubles) or 32 bits (-m32bit-doubles) in  size.   The
           default  is  -m32bit-doubles.   Note RX floating-point hardware only works on 32-bit values, which is
           why the default is -m32bit-doubles.

       -fpu
       -nofpu
           Enables (-fpu) or disables (-nofpu) the use of RX floating-point hardware.  The  default  is  enabled
           for the RX600 series and disabled for the RX200 series.

           Floating-point  instructions are only generated for 32-bit floating-point values, however, so the FPU
           hardware is not used for doubles if the -m64bit-doubles option is used.

           Note If the -fpu option is enabled then -funsafe-math-optimizations is  also  enabled  automatically.
           This is because the RX FPU instructions are themselves unsafe.

       -mcpu=name
           Selects  the  type  of RX CPU to be targeted.  Currently three types are supported, the generic RX600
           and RX200 series hardware and the specific RX610 CPU.  The default is RX600.

           The only difference between RX600 and  RX610  is  that  the  RX610  does  not  support  the  "MVTIPL"
           instruction.

           The  RX200  series  does  not have a hardware floating-point unit and so -nofpu is enabled by default
           when this type is selected.

       -mbig-endian-data
       -mlittle-endian-data
           Store data (but not code) in the big-endian format.  The default  is  -mlittle-endian-data,  i.e.  to
           store data in the little-endian format.

       -msmall-data-limit=N
           Specifies the maximum size in bytes of global and static variables which can be placed into the small
           data  area.   Using  the small data area can lead to smaller and faster code, but the size of area is
           limited and it is up to the programmer to ensure that the area does  not  overflow.   Also  when  the
           small  data  area  is  used one of the RX's registers (usually "r13") is reserved for use pointing to
           this area, so it is no longer available for use by the compiler.  This could result in slower  and/or
           larger code if variables are pushed onto the stack instead of being held in this register.

           Note,  common  variables (variables that have not been initialized) and constants are not placed into
           the small data area as they are assigned to other sections in the output executable.

           The default value is zero, which disables this feature.  Note, this feature is not enabled by default
           with higher optimization levels (-O2 etc) because of the potentially detrimental effects of reserving
           a register.  It is up to the programmer to experiment and discover whether this feature is of benefit
           to their program.  See the description of the -mpid option  for  a  description  of  how  the  actual
           register to hold the small data area pointer is chosen.

       -msim
       -mno-sim
           Use the simulator runtime.  The default is to use the libgloss board-specific runtime.

       -mas100-syntax
       -mno-as100-syntax
           When  generating  assembler  output  use  a syntax that is compatible with Renesas's AS100 assembler.
           This syntax can also be handled by the GAS assembler, but it has  some  restrictions  so  it  is  not
           generated by default.

       -mmax-constant-size=N
           Specifies  the  maximum  size,  in  bytes,  of  a  constant  that  can  be used as an operand in a RX
           instruction.  Although the RX instruction set does allow constants of up to 4 bytes in length  to  be
           used  in instructions, a longer value equates to a longer instruction.  Thus in some circumstances it
           can be beneficial to restrict the size of constants that are used in  instructions.   Constants  that
           are too big are instead placed into a constant pool and referenced via register indirection.

           The value N can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 0 (the default) or 4 means that constants of any size
           are allowed.

       -mrelax
           Enable  linker  relaxation.  Linker relaxation is a process whereby the linker attempts to reduce the
           size of a program by finding shorter versions of various instructions.  Disabled by default.

       -mint-register=N
           Specify the number of registers to reserve for fast interrupt handler functions.  The value N can  be
           between  0  and  4.  A value of 1 means that register "r13" is reserved for the exclusive use of fast
           interrupt handlers.  A value of 2 reserves "r13" and "r12".  A value of 3 reserves "r13",  "r12"  and
           "r11",  and  a  value of 4 reserves "r13" through "r10".  A value of 0, the default, does not reserve
           any registers.

       -msave-acc-in-interrupts
           Specifies that interrupt handler functions should preserve the accumulator register.   This  is  only
           necessary  if  normal code might use the accumulator register, for example because it performs 64-bit
           multiplications.  The default is to ignore the accumulator  as  this  makes  the  interrupt  handlers
           faster.

       -mpid
       -mno-pid
           Enables  the  generation  of  position independent data.  When enabled any access to constant data is
           done via an offset from a base address held in a register.  This allows the location of constant data
           to be determined at run time without requiring the executable to be relocated, which is a benefit  to
           embedded  applications  with  tight memory constraints.  Data that can be modified is not affected by
           this option.

           Note, using this feature reserves a register, usually "r13", for  the  constant  data  base  address.
           This can result in slower and/or larger code, especially in complicated functions.

           The  actual  register  chosen  to  hold  the  constant  data  base  address  depends upon whether the
           -msmall-data-limit and/or  the  -mint-register  command-line  options  are  enabled.   Starting  with
           register "r13" and proceeding downwards, registers are allocated first to satisfy the requirements of
           -mint-register,  then  -mpid  and finally -msmall-data-limit.  Thus it is possible for the small data
           area register to be "r8" if both -mint-register=4 and -mpid are specified on the command line.

           By default this feature is not enabled.  The default can be restored via  the  -mno-pid  command-line
           option.

       -mno-warn-multiple-fast-interrupts
       -mwarn-multiple-fast-interrupts
           Prevents  GCC from issuing a warning message if it finds more than one fast interrupt handler when it
           is compiling a file.  The default is to issue a warning for each extra fast interrupt handler  found,
           as the RX only supports one such interrupt.

       Note:  The  generic GCC command-line option -ffixed-reg has special significance to the RX port when used
       with the "interrupt" function attribute.  This attribute indicates a function intended  to  process  fast
       interrupts.   GCC  ensures  that  it  only  uses  the registers "r10", "r11", "r12" and/or "r13" and only
       provided that the normal use of the corresponding registers have been restricted via the  -ffixed-reg  or
       -mint-register command-line options.

       S/390 and zSeries Options

       These are the -m options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.

       -mhard-float
       -msoft-float
           Use  (do  not  use)  the  hardware  floating-point  instructions  and  registers  for  floating-point
           operations.  When -msoft-float is specified, functions in libgcc.a are used to perform floating-point
           operations.  When -mhard-float is specified, the compiler generates IEEE floating-point instructions.
           This is the default.

       -mhard-dfp
       -mno-hard-dfp
           Use  (do  not  use)  the  hardware  decimal-floating-point  instructions  for  decimal-floating-point
           operations.   When  -mno-hard-dfp  is  specified,  functions in libgcc.a are used to perform decimal-
           floating-point operations.  When -mhard-dfp is specified, the  compiler  generates  decimal-floating-
           point hardware instructions.  This is the default for -march=z9-ec or higher.

       -mlong-double-64
       -mlong-double-128
           These switches control the size of "long double" type. A size of 64 bits makes the "long double" type
           equivalent to the "double" type. This is the default.

       -mbackchain
       -mno-backchain
           Store  (do  not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain pointer into the callee's stack
           frame.  A backchain may be needed to allow debugging using tools that do not understand DWARF 2  call
           frame  information.   When  -mno-packed-stack  is  in  effect, the backchain pointer is stored at the
           bottom of the stack frame; when -mpacked-stack is in effect, the backchain is placed into the topmost
           word of the 96/160 byte register save area.

           In general, code compiled with -mbackchain is call-compatible with code compiled with -mmo-backchain;
           however, use of the backchain for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is  built
           with  -mbackchain.   Note that the combination of -mbackchain, -mpacked-stack and -mhard-float is not
           supported.  In order to build a linux kernel use -msoft-float.

           The default is to not maintain the backchain.

       -mpacked-stack
       -mno-packed-stack
           Use (do not use) the packed stack layout.  When -mno-packed-stack is specified, the compiler uses the
           all fields of the 96/160 byte register save area only for their default purpose; unused fields  still
           take up stack space.  When -mpacked-stack is specified, register save slots are densely packed at the
           top of the register save area; unused space is reused for other purposes, allowing for more efficient
           use  of  the available stack space.  However, when -mbackchain is also in effect, the topmost word of
           the save area is always used to store the backchain, and the return address register is always  saved
           two words below the backchain.

           As  long  as  the  stack  frame  backchain  is  not used, code generated with -mpacked-stack is call-
           compatible with code generated with -mno-packed-stack.  Note that some non-FSF releases of  GCC  2.95
           for  S/390  or  zSeries  generated code that uses the stack frame backchain at run time, not just for
           debugging purposes.  Such code is not call-compatible with code compiled with -mpacked-stack.   Also,
           note that the combination of -mbackchain, -mpacked-stack and -mhard-float is not supported.  In order
           to build a linux kernel use -msoft-float.

           The default is to not use the packed stack layout.

       -msmall-exec
       -mno-small-exec
           Generate  (or  do  not generate) code using the "bras" instruction to do subroutine calls.  This only
           works reliably if the total executable size does not exceed 64k.  The default is to  use  the  "basr"
           instruction instead, which does not have this limitation.

       -m64
       -m31
           When  -m31  is  specified,  generate  code  compliant  to  the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI.  When -m64 is
           specified, generate code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI.  This allows GCC  in  particular
           to  generate 64-bit instructions.  For the s390 targets, the default is -m31, while the s390x targets
           default to -m64.

       -mzarch
       -mesa
           When -mzarch is specified, generate code using the instructions available  on  z/Architecture.   When
           -mesa  is  specified,  generate code using the instructions available on ESA/390.  Note that -mesa is
           not possible with -m64.  When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI,  the  default
           is -mesa.  When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is -mzarch.

       -mmvcle
       -mno-mvcle
           Generate  (or  do  not  generate)  code  using  the "mvcle" instruction to perform block moves.  When
           -mno-mvcle is specified, use a "mvc" loop instead.  This is the default unless optimizing for size.

       -mdebug
       -mno-debug
           Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.  The default  is  to  not  print
           debug information.

       -march=cpu-type
           Generate  code  that runs on cpu-type, which is the name of a system representing a certain processor
           type.  Possible values for cpu-type are g5, g6, z900, z990, z9-109,  z9-ec,  z10,  z196,  and  zEC12.
           When  generating code using the instructions available on z/Architecture, the default is -march=z900.
           Otherwise, the default is -march=g5.

       -mtune=cpu-type
           Tune to cpu-type everything applicable about the generated code, except for the ABI and  the  set  of
           available  instructions.   The list of cpu-type values is the same as for -march.  The default is the
           value used for -march.

       -mtpf-trace
       -mno-tpf-trace
           Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches to trace routines in the operating
           system.  This option is off by default, even when compiling for the TPF OS.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Generate code that uses (does not use)  the  floating-point  multiply  and  accumulate  instructions.
           These instructions are generated by default if hardware floating point is used.

       -mwarn-framesize=framesize
           Emit  a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame size.  Because this is a compile-time
           check it doesn't need to be a real problem when  the  program  runs.   It  is  intended  to  identify
           functions  that most probably cause a stack overflow.  It is useful to be used in an environment with
           limited stack size e.g. the linux kernel.

       -mwarn-dynamicstack
           Emit a warning if the function calls "alloca" or uses dynamically-sized arrays.  This is generally  a
           bad idea with a limited stack size.

       -mstack-guard=stack-guard
       -mstack-size=stack-size
           If  these  options  are  provided  the  S/390  back end emits additional instructions in the function
           prologue that trigger a trap if the stack size is stack-guard bytes above  the  stack-size  (remember
           that  the stack on S/390 grows downward).  If the stack-guard option is omitted the smallest power of
           2 larger than the frame size of the compiled function is chosen.  These options are  intended  to  be
           used  to  help  debugging  stack overflow problems.  The additionally emitted code causes only little
           overhead and  hence  can  also  be  used  in  production-like  systems  without  greater  performance
           degradation.   The  given  values  have to be exact powers of 2 and stack-size has to be greater than
           stack-guard without exceeding 64k.  In order to be efficient the extra code makes the assumption that
           the stack starts at an address aligned to the value given by stack-size.  The stack-guard option  can
           only be used in conjunction with stack-size.

       -mhotpatch=pre-halfwords,post-halfwords
           If  the hotpatch option is enabled, a "hot-patching" function prologue is generated for all functions
           in the compilation unit.  The funtion label is prepended  with  the  given  number  of  two-byte  NOP
           instructions  (pre-halfwords,  maximum  1000000).   After  the  label,  2  * post-halfwords bytes are
           appended, using the largest NOP like instructions the architecture allows (maximum 1000000).

           If both arguments are zero, hotpatching is disabled.

           This option can be overridden for individual functions with the "hotpatch" attribute.

       Score Options

       These options are defined for Score implementations:

       -meb
           Compile code for big-endian mode.  This is the default.

       -mel
           Compile code for little-endian mode.

       -mnhwloop
           Disable generation of "bcnz" instructions.

       -muls
           Enable generation of unaligned load and store instructions.

       -mmac
           Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.

       -mscore5
           Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.

       -mscore5u
           Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.

       -mscore7
           Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.

       -mscore7d
           Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.

       SH Options

       These -m options are defined for the SH implementations:

       -m1 Generate code for the SH1.

       -m2 Generate code for the SH2.

       -m2e
           Generate code for the SH2e.

       -m2a-nofpu
           Generate code for the SH2a without FPU, or for a SH2a-FPU in such a way that the floating-point  unit
           is not used.

       -m2a-single-only
           Generate  code for the SH2a-FPU, in such a way that no double-precision floating-point operations are
           used.

       -m2a-single
           Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the  floating-point  unit  is  in  single-precision  mode  by
           default.

       -m2a
           Generate  code  for  the  SH2a-FPU  assuming  the  floating-point unit is in double-precision mode by
           default.

       -m3 Generate code for the SH3.

       -m3e
           Generate code for the SH3e.

       -m4-nofpu
           Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.

       -m4-single-only
           Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only supports single-precision arithmetic.

       -m4-single
           Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in single-precision mode by default.

       -m4 Generate code for the SH4.

       -m4-100
           Generate code for SH4-100.

       -m4-100-nofpu
           Generate code for SH4-100 in such a way that the floating-point unit is not used.

       -m4-100-single
           Generate code for SH4-100 assuming the floating-point unit is in single-precision mode by default.

       -m4-100-single-only
           Generate code for SH4-100 in such a way that no double-precision floating-point operations are used.

       -m4-200
           Generate code for SH4-200.

       -m4-200-nofpu
           Generate code for SH4-200 without in such a way that the floating-point unit is not used.

       -m4-200-single
           Generate code for SH4-200 assuming the floating-point unit is in single-precision mode by default.

       -m4-200-single-only
           Generate code for SH4-200 in such a way that no double-precision floating-point operations are used.

       -m4-300
           Generate code for SH4-300.

       -m4-300-nofpu
           Generate code for SH4-300 without in such a way that the floating-point unit is not used.

       -m4-300-single
           Generate code for SH4-300 in such a way that no double-precision floating-point operations are used.

       -m4-300-single-only
           Generate code for SH4-300 in such a way that no double-precision floating-point operations are used.

       -m4-340
           Generate code for SH4-340 (no MMU, no FPU).

       -m4-500
           Generate code for SH4-500 (no FPU).  Passes -isa=sh4-nofpu to the assembler.

       -m4a-nofpu
           Generate code for the SH4al-dsp, or for a SH4a in such a way that  the  floating-point  unit  is  not
           used.

       -m4a-single-only
           Generate  code  for  the  SH4a,  in such a way that no double-precision floating-point operations are
           used.

       -m4a-single
           Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in single-precision mode by default.

       -m4a
           Generate code for the SH4a.

       -m4al
           Same as -m4a-nofpu, except that it implicitly passes -dsp to the assembler.  GCC doesn't generate any
           DSP instructions at the moment.

       -m5-32media
           Generate 32-bit code for SHmedia.

       -m5-32media-nofpu
           Generate 32-bit code for SHmedia in such a way that the floating-point unit is not used.

       -m5-64media
           Generate 64-bit code for SHmedia.

       -m5-64media-nofpu
           Generate 64-bit code for SHmedia in such a way that the floating-point unit is not used.

       -m5-compact
           Generate code for SHcompact.

       -m5-compact-nofpu
           Generate code for SHcompact in such a way that the floating-point unit is not used.

       -mb Compile code for the processor in big-endian mode.

       -ml Compile code for the processor in little-endian mode.

       -mdalign
           Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries.  Note that this changes the calling conventions,  and  thus  some
           functions from the standard C library do not work unless you recompile it first with -mdalign.

       -mrelax
           Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the linker option -relax.

       -mbigtable
           Use 32-bit offsets in "switch" tables.  The default is to use 16-bit offsets.

       -mbitops
           Enable the use of bit manipulation instructions on SH2A.

       -mfmovd
           Enable the use of the instruction "fmovd".  Check -mdalign for alignment constraints.

       -mrenesas
           Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.

       -mno-renesas
           Comply  with  the  calling conventions defined for GCC before the Renesas conventions were available.
           This option is the default for all targets of the SH toolchain.

       -mnomacsave
           Mark the "MAC" register as call-clobbered, even if -mrenesas is given.

       -mieee
       -mno-ieee
           Control the IEEE compliance of floating-point comparisons, which affects the handling of cases  where
           the   result   of  a  comparison  is  unordered.   By  default  -mieee  is  implicitly  enabled.   If
           -ffinite-math-only is enabled -mno-ieee is implicitly set, which  results  in  faster  floating-point
           greater-equal  and  less-equal  comparisons.   The  implcit  settings can be overridden by specifying
           either -mieee or -mno-ieee.

       -minline-ic_invalidate
           Inline code to invalidate instruction cache entries after setting  up  nested  function  trampolines.
           This  option  has  no effect if -musermode is in effect and the selected code generation option (e.g.
           -m4) does not allow the use of the "icbi" instruction.  If the selected code generation  option  does
           not  allow  the  use  of  the  "icbi"  instruction, and -musermode is not in effect, the inlined code
           manipulates the instruction cache address array directly with an associative write.   This  not  only
           requires privileged mode at run time, but it also fails if the cache line had been mapped via the TLB
           and has become unmapped.

       -misize
           Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.

       -mpadstruct
           This option is deprecated.  It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes, which is incompatible with the
           SH ABI.

       -matomic-model=model
           Sets the model of atomic operations and additional parameters as a comma separated list.  For details
           on  the  atomic  built-in  functions  see __atomic Builtins.  The following models and parameters are
           supported:

           none
               Disable compiler generated atomic sequences and emit library calls for atomic  operations.   This
               is the default if the target is not "sh*-*-linux*".

           soft-gusa
               Generate  GNU/Linux  compatible gUSA software atomic sequences for the atomic built-in functions.
               The generated atomic sequences require additional support from the  interrupt/exception  handling
               code  of  the system and are only suitable for SH3* and SH4* single-core systems.  This option is
               enabled by default when the target is "sh*-*-linux*" and SH3* or SH4*.  When the target is  SH4A,
               this  option will also partially utilize the hardware atomic instructions "movli.l" and "movco.l"
               to create more efficient code, unless strict is specified.

           soft-tcb
               Generate software atomic sequences that use a variable in the thread control block.   This  is  a
               variation  of  the gUSA sequences which can also be used on SH1* and SH2* targets.  The generated
               atomic sequences require additional support from the interrupt/exception  handling  code  of  the
               system  and  are  only  suitable for single-core systems.  When using this model, the gbr-offset=
               parameter has to be specified as well.

           soft-imask
               Generate software atomic sequences that temporarily disable interrupts  by  setting  "SR.IMASK  =
               1111".   This  model works only when the program runs in privileged mode and is only suitable for
               single-core systems.  Additional support from the interrupt/exception handling code of the system
               is not required.  This model is enabled by default when the target is "sh*-*-linux*" and SH1*  or
               SH2*.

           hard-llcs
               Generate  hardware atomic sequences using the "movli.l" and "movco.l" instructions only.  This is
               only available on SH4A and is suitable for multi-core systems.  Since the  hardware  instructions
               support  only  32  bit  atomic  variables access to 8 or 16 bit variables is emulated with 32 bit
               accesses.  Code compiled with this option will also be  compatible  with  other  software  atomic
               model  interrupt/exception  handling  systems  if executed on an SH4A system.  Additional support
               from the interrupt/exception handling code of the system is not required for this model.

           gbr-offset=
               This parameter specifies the offset in  bytes  of  the  variable  in  the  thread  control  block
               structure  that should be used by the generated atomic sequences when the soft-tcb model has been
               selected.  For other models this parameter is ignored.  The specified value must  be  an  integer
               multiple of four and in the range 0-1020.

           strict
               This  parameter  prevents  mixed  usage  of  multiple  atomic  models,  even though they would be
               compatible, and will make the compiler generate atomic sequences of the specified model only.

       -mtas
           Generate the "tas.b" opcode for "__atomic_test_and_set".  Notice that  depending  on  the  particular
           hardware  and  software  configuration  this can degrade overall performance due to the operand cache
           line flushes that are implied by the "tas.b" instruction.  On multi-core SH4A processors the  "tas.b"
           instruction  must  be  used  with  caution  since  it can result in data corruption for certain cache
           configurations.

       -mprefergot
           When generating position-independent code, emit function calls using the Global Offset Table  instead
           of the Procedure Linkage Table.

       -musermode
       -mno-usermode
           Don't allow (allow) the compiler generating privileged mode code.  Specifying -musermode also implies
           -mno-inline-ic_invalidate if the inlined code would not work in user mode.  -musermode is the default
           when  the  target  is  "sh*-*-linux*".  If the target is SH1* or SH2* -musermode has no effect, since
           there is no user mode.

       -multcost=number
           Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.

       -mdiv=strategy
           Set the division strategy to be used for integer division operations.  For SHmedia  strategy  can  be
           one of:

           fp  Performs  the  operation  in  floating point.  This has a very high latency, but needs only a few
               instructions, so it might be a good choice if your code  has  enough  easily-exploitable  ILP  to
               allow  the compiler to schedule the floating-point instructions together with other instructions.
               Division by zero causes a floating-point exception.

           inv Uses integer operations to calculate the inverse of the divisor, and then multiplies the dividend
               with the inverse.  This strategy allows CSE and hoisting of the inverse calculation.  Division by
               zero calculates an unspecified result, but does not trap.

           inv:minlat
               A variant of inv where, if no CSE or hoisting opportunities have been found,  or  if  the  entire
               operation  has  been  hoisted  to  the same place, the last stages of the inverse calculation are
               intertwined with the final multiply to reduce the overall latency, at the expense of using a  few
               more instructions, and thus offering fewer scheduling opportunities with other code.

           call
               Calls  a  library function that usually implements the inv:minlat strategy.  This gives high code
               density for "m5-*media-nofpu" compilations.

           call2
               Uses a different entry point of the same library function, where it assumes that a pointer  to  a
               lookup  table  has  already  been set up, which exposes the pointer load to CSE and code hoisting
               optimizations.

           inv:call
           inv:call2
           inv:fp
               Use the inv algorithm for initial code generation, but if the code stays unoptimized,  revert  to
               the  call, call2, or fp strategies, respectively.  Note that the potentially-trapping side effect
               of division by zero is carried by a separate instruction, so it is possible that all the  integer
               instructions  are  hoisted  out,  but  the  marker  for  the  side  effect  stays where it is.  A
               recombination to floating-point operations or a call is not possible in that case.

           inv20u
           inv20l
               Variants of the inv:minlat strategy.  In the case that the inverse calculation is  not  separated
               from  the  multiply, they speed up division where the dividend fits into 20 bits (plus sign where
               applicable) by inserting a test to skip a number of operations in this case; this test slows down
               the case of larger dividends.  inv20u assumes the case of a such a small dividend to be unlikely,
               and inv20l assumes it to be likely.

           For targets other than SHmedia strategy can be one of:

           call-div1
               Calls a library function that uses the single-step division instruction  "div1"  to  perform  the
               operation.   Division  by  zero  calculates an unspecified result and does not trap.  This is the
               default except for SH4, SH2A and SHcompact.

           call-fp
               Calls a library function  that  performs  the  operation  in  double  precision  floating  point.
               Division  by zero causes a floating-point exception.  This is the default for SHcompact with FPU.
               Specifying this for targets that do not have a double precision FPU will default to "call-div1".

           call-table
               Calls a library function that uses a lookup table for small divisors and the  "div1"  instruction
               with case distinction for larger divisors.  Division by zero calculates an unspecified result and
               does  not  trap.   This  is  the  default  for SH4.  Specifying this for targets that do not have
               dynamic shift instructions will default to "call-div1".

           When a division strategy has not been specified the default strategy will be selected  based  on  the
           current  target.   For SH2A the default strategy is to use the "divs" and "divu" instructions instead
           of library function calls.

       -maccumulate-outgoing-args
           Reserve space once for outgoing arguments in the function prologue  rather  than  around  each  call.
           Generally beneficial for performance and size.  Also needed for unwinding to avoid changing the stack
           frame around conditional code.

       -mdivsi3_libfunc=name
           Set  the name of the library function used for 32-bit signed division to name.  This only affects the
           name used in the call and inv:call division strategies, and the compiler still expects the same  sets
           of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option were not present.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register  allocator  can  not  use.   This is useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is
           specified as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified  separated
           by a comma.

       -mindexed-addressing
           Enable  the  use  of  the  indexed addressing mode for SHmedia32/SHcompact.  This is only safe if the
           hardware and/or OS implement 32-bit wrap-around semantics  for  the  indexed  addressing  mode.   The
           architecture  allows  the implementation of processors with 64-bit MMU, which the OS could use to get
           32-bit addressing, but since no current hardware implementation supports this or  any  other  way  to
           make   the   indexed   addressing   mode   safe   to   use   in   the  32-bit  ABI,  the  default  is
           -mno-indexed-addressing.

       -mgettrcost=number
           Set the cost assumed for the "gettr" instruction to number.  The default is 2  if  -mpt-fixed  is  in
           effect, 100 otherwise.

       -mpt-fixed
           Assume  "pt*" instructions won't trap.  This generally generates better-scheduled code, but is unsafe
           on current hardware.  The current architecture definition says that "ptabs" and "ptrel" trap when the
           target anded with 3 is 3.  This has the unintentional effect of making it unsafe  to  schedule  these
           instructions  before a branch, or hoist them out of a loop.  For example, "__do_global_ctors", a part
           of libgcc that runs constructors at program startup, calls functions in a list which is delimited  by
           -1.   With the -mpt-fixed option, the "ptabs" is done before testing against -1.  That means that all
           the constructors run a bit more quickly, but when the loop comes to the end of the list, the  program
           crashes because "ptabs" loads -1 into a target register.

           Since this option is unsafe for any hardware implementing the current architecture specification, the
           default  is  -mno-pt-fixed.  Unless specified explicitly with -mgettrcost, -mno-pt-fixed also implies
           -mgettrcost=100; this deters register allocation from using target  registers  for  storing  ordinary
           integers.

       -minvalid-symbols
           Assume  symbols  might  be  invalid.   Ordinary function symbols generated by the compiler are always
           valid to load with "movi"/"shori"/"ptabs" or "movi"/"shori"/"ptrel", but with assembler and/or linker
           tricks it is possible to generate symbols that cause "ptabs" or "ptrel" to trap.  This option is only
           meaningful when -mno-pt-fixed is in effect.  It prevents cross-basic-block  CSE,  hoisting  and  most
           scheduling of symbol loads.  The default is -mno-invalid-symbols.

       -mbranch-cost=num
           Assume num to be the cost for a branch instruction.  Higher numbers make the compiler try to generate
           more branch-free code if possible.  If not specified the value is selected depending on the processor
           type that is being compiled for.

       -mzdcbranch
       -mno-zdcbranch
           Assume (do not assume) that zero displacement conditional branch instructions "bt" and "bf" are fast.
           If -mzdcbranch is specified, the compiler will try to prefer zero displacement branch code sequences.
           This  is  enabled by default when generating code for SH4 and SH4A.  It can be explicitly disabled by
           specifying -mno-zdcbranch.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Generate code that uses (does not use)  the  floating-point  multiply  and  accumulate  instructions.
           These  instructions  are  generated  by  default  if  hardware  floating point is used.  The machine-
           dependent -mfused-madd option is now mapped to the machine-independent -ffp-contract=fast option, and
           -mno-fused-madd is mapped to -ffp-contract=off.

       -mfsca
       -mno-fsca
           Allow or disallow the compiler to emit the "fsca" instruction for  sine  and  cosine  approximations.
           The option "-mfsca" must be used in combination with "-funsafe-math-optimizations".  It is enabled by
           default  when  generating  code  for SH4A.  Using "-mno-fsca" disables sine and cosine approximations
           even if "-funsafe-math-optimizations" is in effect.

       -mfsrra
       -mno-fsrra
           Allow or  disallow  the  compiler  to  emit  the  "fsrra"  instruction  for  reciprocal  square  root
           approximations.   The option "-mfsrra" must be used in combination with "-funsafe-math-optimizations"
           and  "-ffinite-math-only".   It  is  enabled  by  default  when  generating  code  for  SH4A.   Using
           "-mno-fsrra" disables reciprocal square root approximations even if "-funsafe-math-optimizations" and
           "-ffinite-math-only" are in effect.

       -mpretend-cmove
           Prefer  zero-displacement  conditional  branches for conditional move instruction patterns.  This can
           result in faster code on the SH4 processor.

       Solaris 2 Options

       These -m options are supported on Solaris 2:

       -mclear-hwcap
           -mclear-hwcap tells the compiler to  remove  the  hardware  capabilities  generated  by  the  Solaris
           assembler.   This is only necessary when object files use ISA extensions not supported by the current
           machine, but check at runtime whether or not to use them.

       -mimpure-text
           -mimpure-text, used in addition to -shared, tells the compiler to not pass -z text to the linker when
           linking a shared object.  Using this option, you can  link  position-dependent  code  into  a  shared
           object.

           -mimpure-text  suppresses  the  "relocations  remain  against  allocatable but non-writable sections"
           linker error message.  However, the necessary  relocations  trigger  copy-on-write,  and  the  shared
           object  is  not actually shared across processes.  Instead of using -mimpure-text, you should compile
           all source code with -fpic or -fPIC.

       These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris 2:

       -pthreads
           Add support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library.  This option sets flags for both  the
           preprocessor  and  linker.  This option does not affect the thread safety of object code produced  by
           the compiler or that of libraries supplied with it.

       -pthread
           This is a synonym for -pthreads.

       SPARC Options

       These -m options are supported on the SPARC:

       -mno-app-regs
       -mapp-regs
           Specify -mapp-regs to generate output using the global registers 2 through 4, which  the  SPARC  SVR4
           ABI  reserves for applications.  Like the global register 1, each global register 2 through 4 is then
           treated as an allocable register that is clobbered by function calls.  This is the default.

           To be fully SVR4 ABI-compliant at the cost of some  performance  loss,  specify  -mno-app-regs.   You
           should compile libraries and system software with this option.

       -mflat
       -mno-flat
           With  -mflat,  the  compiler  does not generate save/restore instructions and uses a "flat" or single
           register window model.  This model is compatible with the regular register window model.   The  local
           registers and the input registers (0--5) are still treated as "call-saved" registers and are saved on
           the stack as needed.

           With  -mno-flat  (the  default),  the  compiler  generates save/restore instructions (except for leaf
           functions).  This is the normal operating mode.

       -mfpu
       -mhard-float
           Generate output containing floating-point instructions.  This is the default.

       -mno-fpu
       -msoft-float
           Generate output containing library calls for floating point.  Warning: the  requisite  libraries  are
           not  available  for all SPARC targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
           used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your own arrangements  to
           provide  suitable  library  functions  for  cross-compilation.  The embedded targets sparc-*-aout and
           sparclite-*-* do provide software floating-point support.

           -msoft-float changes the calling convention in the output file; therefore, it is only useful  if  you
           compile  all of a program with this option.  In particular, you need to compile libgcc.a, the library
           that comes with GCC, with -msoft-float in order for this to work.

       -mhard-quad-float
           Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating-point instructions.

       -msoft-quad-float
           Generate output containing library calls for quad-word  (long  double)  floating-point  instructions.
           The functions called are those specified in the SPARC ABI.  This is the default.

           As  of  this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have hardware support for the quad-word
           floating-point instructions.  They all invoke a trap handler for one of these instructions, and  then
           the  trap handler emulates the effect of the instruction.  Because of the trap handler overhead, this
           is much slower than calling the ABI library routines.   Thus  the  -msoft-quad-float  option  is  the
           default.

       -mno-unaligned-doubles
       -munaligned-doubles
           Assume that doubles have 8-byte alignment.  This is the default.

           With  -munaligned-doubles,  GCC assumes that doubles have 8-byte alignment only if they are contained
           in another type, or if they have an  absolute  address.   Otherwise,  it  assumes  they  have  4-byte
           alignment.   Specifying  this  option  avoids some rare compatibility problems with code generated by
           other compilers.  It is not the default because it results in  a  performance  loss,  especially  for
           floating-point code.

       -muser-mode
       -mno-user-mode
           Do  not  generate  code  that  can only run in supervisor mode.  This is relevant only for the "casa"
           instruction emitted for the LEON3 processor.  The default is -mno-user-mode.

       -mno-faster-structs
       -mfaster-structs
           With -mfaster-structs, the compiler assumes that  structures  should  have  8-byte  alignment.   This
           enables the use of pairs of "ldd" and "std" instructions for copies in structure assignment, in place
           of  twice  as many "ld" and "st" pairs.  However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates
           the SPARC ABI.  Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where  the  developer  acknowledges  that
           their resulting code is not directly in line with the rules of the ABI.

       -mcpu=cpu_type
           Set  the  instruction  set,  register  set,  and  instruction  scheduling parameters for machine type
           cpu_type.  Supported values for cpu_type are v7, cypress, v8, supersparc,  hypersparc,  leon,  leon3,
           leon3v7, sparclite, f930, f934, sparclite86x, sparclet, tsc701, v9, ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara,
           niagara2, niagara3 and niagara4.

           Native  Solaris  and  GNU/Linux  toolchains  also  support  the  value native, which selects the best
           architecture option for the host processor.  -mcpu=native has no effect if GCC does not recognize the
           processor.

           Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select an architecture and not  an
           implementation.  These are v7, v8, sparclite, sparclet, v9.

           Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported implementations.

           v7  cypress, leon3v7

           v8  supersparc, hypersparc, leon, leon3

           sparclite
               f930, f934, sparclite86x

           sparclet
               tsc701

           v9  ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4

           By  default  (unless  configured  otherwise),  GCC  generates  code  for  the V7 variant of the SPARC
           architecture.  With -mcpu=cypress, the compiler additionally optimizes it  for  the  Cypress  CY7C602
           chip,  as  used  in  the SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series.  This is also appropriate for the older
           SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.

           With -mcpu=v8, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC architecture.  The only  difference
           from  V7  code  is that the compiler emits the integer multiply and integer divide instructions which
           exist in SPARC-V8 but not in SPARC-V7.  With -mcpu=supersparc, the compiler additionally optimizes it
           for the SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and 2000 series.

           With -mcpu=sparclite, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant of the SPARC  architecture.   This
           adds the integer multiply, integer divide step and scan ("ffs") instructions which exist in SPARClite
           but not in SPARC-V7.  With -mcpu=f930, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the Fujitsu MB86930
           chip,  which  is  the  original  SPARClite,  with no FPU.  With -mcpu=f934, the compiler additionally
           optimizes it for the Fujitsu MB86934 chip, which is the more recent SPARClite with FPU.

           With -mcpu=sparclet, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of  the  SPARC  architecture.   This
           adds  the  integer  multiply,  multiply/accumulate, integer divide step and scan ("ffs") instructions
           which exist in SPARClet but not in SPARC-V7.  With -mcpu=tsc701, the compiler additionally  optimizes
           it for the TEMIC SPARClet chip.

           With  -mcpu=v9,  GCC  generates  code for the V9 variant of the SPARC architecture.  This adds 64-bit
           integer and floating-point move instructions, 3 additional floating-point  condition  code  registers
           and conditional move instructions.  With -mcpu=ultrasparc, the compiler additionally optimizes it for
           the  Sun  UltraSPARC  I/II/IIi chips.  With -mcpu=ultrasparc3, the compiler additionally optimizes it
           for  the  Sun  UltraSPARC  III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+  chips.   With  -mcpu=niagara,   the   compiler
           additionally   optimizes  it  for  Sun  UltraSPARC  T1  chips.   With  -mcpu=niagara2,  the  compiler
           additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T2 chips. With -mcpu=niagara3, the compiler additionally
           optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T3 chips.  With -mcpu=niagara4, the compiler  additionally  optimizes
           it for Sun UltraSPARC T4 chips.

       -mtune=cpu_type
           Set  the  instruction scheduling parameters for machine type cpu_type, but do not set the instruction
           set or register set that the option -mcpu=cpu_type does.

           The same values for -mcpu=cpu_type can be used for -mtune=cpu_type, but the only  useful  values  are
           those  that select a particular CPU implementation.  Those are cypress, supersparc, hypersparc, leon,
           leon3, leon3v7,  f930,  f934,  sparclite86x,  tsc701,  ultrasparc,  ultrasparc3,  niagara,  niagara2,
           niagara3 and niagara4.  With native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains, native can also be used.

       -mv8plus
       -mno-v8plus
           With  -mv8plus, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI.  The difference from the V8 ABI is that the
           global and out registers are considered 64 bits wide.  This is  enabled  by  default  on  Solaris  in
           32-bit mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.

       -mvis
       -mno-vis
           With  -mvis,  GCC  generates  code  that  takes  advantage  of  the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set
           extensions.  The default is -mno-vis.

       -mvis2
       -mno-vis2
           With -mvis2, GCC generates code that  takes  advantage  of  version  2.0  of  the  UltraSPARC  Visual
           Instruction  Set  extensions.   The  default  is  -mvis2  when  targeting  a  cpu  that supports such
           instructions, such as UltraSPARC-III and later.  Setting -mvis2 also sets -mvis.

       -mvis3
       -mno-vis3
           With -mvis3, GCC generates code that  takes  advantage  of  version  3.0  of  the  UltraSPARC  Visual
           Instruction  Set  extensions.   The  default  is  -mvis3  when  targeting  a  cpu  that supports such
           instructions, such as niagara-3 and later.  Setting -mvis3 also sets -mvis2 and -mvis.

       -mcbcond
       -mno-cbcond
           With -mcbcond, GCC generates code that takes advantage of compare-and-branch instructions, as defined
           in the Sparc Architecture 2011.  The default is -mcbcond when targeting  a  cpu  that  supports  such
           instructions, such as niagara-4 and later.

       -mpopc
       -mno-popc
           With  -mpopc, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC population count instruction.
           The default is -mpopc when targeting a cpu that supports such instructions,  such  as  Niagara-2  and
           later.

       -mfmaf
       -mno-fmaf
           With  -mfmaf,  GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC Fused Multiply-Add Floating-
           point extensions.  The default is -mfmaf when targeting a cpu that supports such  instructions,  such
           as Niagara-3 and later.

       -mfix-at697f
           Enable  the  documented  workaround  for  the  single  erratum  of  the Atmel AT697F processor (which
           corresponds to erratum #13 of the AT697E processor).

       -mfix-ut699
           Enable the documented workarounds for the floating-point errata and the data cache nullify errata  of
           the UT699 processor.

       These -m options are supported in addition to the above on SPARC-V9 processors in 64-bit environments:

       -m32
       -m64
           Generate  code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer
           to 32 bits.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.

       -mcmodel=which
           Set the code model to one of

           medlow
               The Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs must be  linked  in  the  low  32  bits  of
               memory.  Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.

           medmid
               The  Medium/Middle  code  model:  64-bit addresses, programs must be linked in the low 44 bits of
               memory, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in size and the  data  segment  must  be
               located within 2GB of the text segment.

           medany
               The  Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs may be linked anywhere in memory, the
               text and data segments must be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located  within
               2GB of the text segment.

           embmedany
               The Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems: 64-bit addresses, the text and data segments
               must  be  less than 2GB in size, both starting anywhere in memory (determined at link time).  The
               global register %g4 points to the base of the data segment.  Programs are statically  linked  and
               PIC is not supported.

       -mmemory-model=mem-model
           Set the memory model in force on the processor to one of

           default
               The default memory model for the processor and operating system.

           rmo Relaxed Memory Order

           pso Partial Store Order

           tso Total Store Order

           sc  Sequential Consistency

           These memory models are formally defined in Appendix D of the Sparc V9 architecture manual, as set in
           the processor's "PSTATE.MM" field.

       -mstack-bias
       -mno-stack-bias
           With  -mstack-bias,  GCC  assumes that the stack pointer, and frame pointer if present, are offset by
           -2047 which must be added back when making stack frame references.  This is  the  default  in  64-bit
           mode.  Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.

       SPU Options

       These -m options are supported on the SPU:

       -mwarn-reloc
       -merror-reloc
           The  loader  for  SPU  does  not  handle dynamic relocations.  By default, GCC gives an error when it
           generates code that requires a dynamic relocation.  -mno-error-reloc disables the error, -mwarn-reloc
           generates a warning instead.

       -msafe-dma
       -munsafe-dma
           Instructions that initiate or test completion of DMA must not be reordered with respect to loads  and
           stores  of  the memory that is being accessed.  With -munsafe-dma you must use the "volatile" keyword
           to protect memory accesses, but that can lead to inefficient code in places where the memory is known
           to not change.  Rather than mark the memory as volatile, you can use -msafe-dma to tell the  compiler
           to treat the DMA instructions as potentially affecting all memory.

       -mbranch-hints
           By  default,  GCC  generates  a  branch hint instruction to avoid pipeline stalls for always-taken or
           probably-taken branches.  A hint is not generated closer than 8 instructions away  from  its  branch.
           There  is little reason to disable them, except for debugging purposes, or to make an object a little
           bit smaller.

       -msmall-mem
       -mlarge-mem
           By default, GCC generates code  assuming  that  addresses  are  never  larger  than  18  bits.   With
           -mlarge-mem code is generated that assumes a full 32-bit address.

       -mstdmain
           By  default, GCC links against startup code that assumes the SPU-style main function interface (which
           has an unconventional parameter list).  With -mstdmain, GCC links your program against  startup  code
           that assumes a C99-style interface to "main", including a local copy of "argv" strings.

       -mfixed-range=register-range
           Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.  A fixed register is one that the
           register  allocator  cannot  use.   This  is  useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is
           specified as two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be specified  separated
           by a comma.

       -mea32
       -mea64
           Compile  code  assuming  that pointers to the PPU address space accessed via the "__ea" named address
           space qualifier are either 32 or 64 bits wide.  The default is 32 bits.  As this is  an  ABI-changing
           option, all object code in an executable must be compiled with the same setting.

       -maddress-space-conversion
       -mno-address-space-conversion
           Allow/disallow  treating  the  "__ea"  address  space as superset of the generic address space.  This
           enables explicit type casts between "__ea" and generic pointer as well  as  implicit  conversions  of
           generic pointers to "__ea" pointers.  The default is to allow address space pointer conversions.

       -mcache-size=cache-size
           This  option  controls  the  version of libgcc that the compiler links to an executable and selects a
           software-managed cache for accessing variables in the "__ea" address space with  a  particular  cache
           size.  Possible options for cache-size are 8, 16, 32, 64 and 128.  The default cache size is 64KB.

       -matomic-updates
       -mno-atomic-updates
           This  option  controls  the  version  of  libgcc that the compiler links to an executable and selects
           whether atomic updates to the software-managed cache of PPU-side variables  are  used.   If  you  use
           atomic  updates,  changes  to  a  PPU  variable  from  SPU  code using the "__ea" named address space
           qualifier do not interfere with changes to other PPU variables residing in the same cache  line  from
           PPU code.  If you do not use atomic updates, such interference may occur; however, writing back cache
           lines is more efficient.  The default behavior is to use atomic updates.

       -mdual-nops
       -mdual-nops=n
           By  default,  GCC  inserts nops to increase dual issue when it expects it to increase performance.  n
           can be a value from 0 to 10.  A smaller n inserts fewer nops.  10 is the default, 0 is  the  same  as
           -mno-dual-nops.  Disabled with -Os.

       -mhint-max-nops=n
           Maximum  number  of  nops to insert for a branch hint.  A branch hint must be at least 8 instructions
           away from the branch it is affecting.  GCC inserts up to n nops to enforce this,  otherwise  it  does
           not generate the branch hint.

       -mhint-max-distance=n
           The  encoding  of  the  branch  hint instruction limits the hint to be within 256 instructions of the
           branch it is affecting.  By default, GCC makes sure it is within 125.

       -msafe-hints
           Work around a hardware bug that causes the SPU to stall indefinitely.  By default,  GCC  inserts  the
           "hbrp" instruction to make sure this stall won't happen.

       Options for System V

       These  additional  options  are available on System V Release 4 for compatibility with other compilers on
       those systems:

       -G  Create a shared object.  It is recommended that -symbolic or -shared be used instead.

       -Qy Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a ".ident"  assembler  directive  in  the
           output.

       -Qn Refrain from adding ".ident" directives to the output file (this is the default).

       -YP,dirs
           Search the directories dirs, and no others, for libraries specified with -l.

       -Ym,dir
           Look in the directory dir to find the M4 preprocessor.  The assembler uses this option.

       TILE-Gx Options

       These -m options are supported on the TILE-Gx:

       -mcmodel=small
           Generate  code  for  the  small  model.   The  distance for direct calls is limited to 500M in either
           direction.  PC-relative addresses are 32 bits.  Absolute addresses support the full address range.

       -mcmodel=large
           Generate code for the large model.  There is no limitation on call distance,  pc-relative  addresses,
           or absolute addresses.

       -mcpu=name
           Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported type is tilegx.

       -m32
       -m64
           Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit environment sets int, long, and pointer
           to 32 bits.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.

       -mbig-endian
       -mlittle-endian
           Generate code in big/little endian mode, respectively.

       TILEPro Options

       These -m options are supported on the TILEPro:

       -mcpu=name
           Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported type is tilepro.

       -m32
           Generate  code  for  a 32-bit environment, which sets int, long, and pointer to 32 bits.  This is the
           only supported behavior so the flag is essentially ignored.

       V850 Options

       These -m options are defined for V850 implementations:

       -mlong-calls
       -mno-long-calls
           Treat all calls as being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be far away, the  compiler  always
           loads the function's address into a register, and calls indirect through the pointer.

       -mno-ep
       -mep
           Do  not  optimize  (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index pointer 4 or more times to copy
           pointer into the "ep" register, and use the shorter "sld" and "sst" instructions.  The -mep option is
           on by default if you optimize.

       -mno-prolog-function
       -mprolog-function
           Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers at the prologue and epilogue  of
           a  function.   The  external  functions are slower, but use less code space if more than one function
           saves the same number of registers.  The -mprolog-function option is on by default if you optimize.

       -mspace
           Try to make the  code  as  small  as  possible.   At  present,  this  just  turns  on  the  -mep  and
           -mprolog-function options.

       -mtda=n
           Put  static  or  global variables whose size is n bytes or less into the tiny data area that register
           "ep" points to.  The tiny data area  can  hold  up  to  256  bytes  in  total  (128  bytes  for  byte
           references).

       -msda=n
           Put  static  or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into the small data area that register
           "gp" points to.  The small data area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.

       -mzda=n
           Put static or global variables whose size is n bytes or less into the first 32 kilobytes of memory.

       -mv850
           Specify that the target processor is the V850.

       -mv850e3v5
           Specify that the target processor is the V850E3V5.  The preprocessor constant __v850e3v5__ is defined
           if this option is used.

       -mv850e2v4
           Specify that the target processor is the V850E3V5.  This is an alias for the -mv850e3v5 option.

       -mv850e2v3
           Specify that the target processor is the V850E2V3.  The preprocessor constant __v850e2v3__ is defined
           if this option is used.

       -mv850e2
           Specify that the target processor is the V850E2.  The preprocessor constant __v850e2__ is defined  if
           this option is used.

       -mv850e1
           Specify that the target processor is the V850E1.  The preprocessor constants __v850e1__ and __v850e__
           are defined if this option is used.

       -mv850es
           Specify that the target processor is the V850ES.  This is an alias for the -mv850e1 option.

       -mv850e
           Specify  that  the  target processor is the V850E.  The preprocessor constant __v850e__ is defined if
           this option is used.

           If neither -mv850 nor -mv850e nor -mv850e1 nor -mv850e2 nor -mv850e2v3  nor  -mv850e3v5  are  defined
           then  a  default  target  processor  is  chosen  and  the relevant __v850*__ preprocessor constant is
           defined.

           The preprocessor constants __v850 and __v851__ are always  defined,  regardless  of  which  processor
           variant is the target.

       -mdisable-callt
       -mno-disable-callt
           This  option suppresses generation of the "CALLT" instruction for the v850e, v850e1, v850e2, v850e2v3
           and v850e3v5 flavors of the v850 architecture.

           This option is enabled by default when the RH850 ABI is in use (see  -mrh850-abi),  and  disabled  by
           default  when  the  GCC  ABI  is  in  use.   If  "CALLT"  instructions are being generated then the C
           preprocessor symbol "__V850_CALLT__" will be defined.

       -mrelax
       -mno-relax
           Pass on (or do not pass on) the -mrelax command line option to the assembler.

       -mlong-jumps
       -mno-long-jumps
           Disable (or re-enable) the generation of PC-relative jump instructions.

       -msoft-float
       -mhard-float
           Disable (or re-enable) the generation of hardware floating point instructions.  This option  is  only
           significant  when  the  target  architecture  is  V850E2V3  or  higher.   If  hardware floating point
           instructions are being generated then  the  C  preprocessor  symbol  "__FPU_OK__"  will  be  defined,
           otherwise the symbol "__NO_FPU__" will be defined.

       -mloop
           Enables  the use of the e3v5 LOOP instruction.  The use of this instruction is not enabled by default
           when the e3v5 architecture is selected because its use is still experimental.

       -mrh850-abi
       -mghs
           Enables support for the RH850 version of the V850 ABI.  This is the default.  With  this  version  of
           the ABI the following rules apply:

           •   Integer sized structures and unions are returned via a memory pointer rather than a register.

           •   Large structures and unions (more than 8 bytes in size) are passed by value.

           •   Functions are aligned to 16-bit boundaries.

           •   The -m8byte-align command line option is supported.

           •   The  -mdisable-callt  command  line option is enabled by default.  The -mno-disable-callt command
               line option is not supported.

           When this version of the ABI is enabled the C preprocessor symbol "__V850_RH850_ABI__" is defined.

       -mgcc-abi
           Enables support for the old GCC version of the V850 ABI.  With this version of the ABI the  following
           rules apply:

           •   Integer sized structures and unions are returned in register "r10".

           •   Large structures and unions (more than 8 bytes in size) are passed by reference.

           •   Functions are aligned to 32-bit boundaries, unless optimizing for size.

           •   The -m8byte-align command line option is not supported.

           •   The -mdisable-callt command line option is supported but not enabled by default.

           When this version of the ABI is enabled the C preprocessor symbol "__V850_GCC_ABI__" is defined.

       -m8byte-align
       -mno-8byte-align
           Enables  support for "doubles" and "long long" types to be aligned on 8-byte boundaries.  The default
           is to restrict the alignment of all objects to at most 4-bytes.  When -m8byte-align is in effect  the
           C preprocessor symbol "__V850_8BYTE_ALIGN__" will be defined.

       -mbig-switch
           Generate  code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if the assembler/linker complain
           about out of range branches within a switch table.

       -mapp-regs
           This option causes r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by the compiler.  This setting  is  the
           default.

       -mno-app-regs
           This option causes r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.

       VAX Options

       These -m options are defined for the VAX:

       -munix
           Do  not  output  certain  jump  instructions ("aobleq" and so on) that the Unix assembler for the VAX
           cannot handle across long ranges.

       -mgnu
           Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that the GNU assembler is being used.

       -mg Output code for G-format floating-point numbers instead of D-format.

       VMS Options

       These -m options are defined for the VMS implementations:

       -mvms-return-codes
           Return VMS condition codes from "main". The default is to return POSIX-style condition  (e.g.  error)
           codes.

       -mdebug-main=prefix
           Flag the first routine whose name starts with prefix as the main routine for the debugger.

       -mmalloc64
           Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.

       -mpointer-size=size
           Set  the  default size of pointers. Possible options for size are 32 or short for 32 bit pointers, 64
           or long for 64 bit pointers, and no for supporting only 32 bit pointers.  The later  option  disables
           "pragma pointer_size".

       VxWorks Options

       The options in this section are defined for all VxWorks targets.  Options specific to the target hardware
       are listed with the other options for that target.

       -mrtp
           GCC  can generate code for both VxWorks kernels and real time processes (RTPs).  This option switches
           from the former to the latter.  It also defines the preprocessor macro "__RTP__".

       -non-static
           Link an RTP executable against shared libraries rather than static libraries.   The  options  -static
           and -shared can also be used for RTPs; -static is the default.

       -Bstatic
       -Bdynamic
           These options are passed down to the linker.  They are defined for compatibility with Diab.

       -Xbind-lazy
           Enable  lazy  binding  of function calls.  This option is equivalent to -Wl,-z,now and is defined for
           compatibility with Diab.

       -Xbind-now
           Disable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is the default and is defined for  compatibility
           with Diab.

       x86-64 Options

       These are listed under

       Xstormy16 Options

       These options are defined for Xstormy16:

       -msim
           Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.

       Xtensa Options

       These options are supported for Xtensa targets:

       -mconst16
       -mno-const16
           Enable  or  disable  use  of  "CONST16"  instructions  for  loading  constant  values.  The "CONST16"
           instruction is currently not a standard option from Tensilica.  When enabled, "CONST16"  instructions
           are  always  used  in  place of the standard "L32R" instructions.  The use of "CONST16" is enabled by
           default only if the "L32R" instruction is not available.

       -mfused-madd
       -mno-fused-madd
           Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract instructions in the  floating-point
           option.   This  has  no  effect  if  the  floating-point option is not also enabled.  Disabling fused
           multiply/add and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate instructions  for
           the  multiply  and  add/subtract  operations.   This may be desirable in some cases where strict IEEE
           754-compliant results are required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions  do  not  round  the
           intermediate result, thereby producing results with more bits of precision than specified by the IEEE
           standard.  Disabling fused multiply add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is
           not sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract operations.

       -mserialize-volatile
       -mno-serialize-volatile
           When  this  option is enabled, GCC inserts "MEMW" instructions before "volatile" memory references to
           guarantee sequential consistency.  The default is -mserialize-volatile.  Use  -mno-serialize-volatile
           to omit the "MEMW" instructions.

       -mforce-no-pic
           For targets, like GNU/Linux, where all user-mode Xtensa code must be position-independent code (PIC),
           this option disables PIC for compiling kernel code.

       -mtext-section-literals
       -mno-text-section-literals
           Control  the  treatment  of  literal  pools.  The default is -mno-text-section-literals, which places
           literals in a separate section in the output file.  This allows the literal pool to be  placed  in  a
           data  RAM/ROM,  and  it also allows the linker to combine literal pools from separate object files to
           remove redundant literals and improve code size.   With  -mtext-section-literals,  the  literals  are
           interspersed  in  the  text  section  in order to keep them as close as possible to their references.
           This may be necessary for large assembly files.

       -mtarget-align
       -mno-target-align
           When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the  assembler  to  automatically  align  instructions  to
           reduce branch penalties at the expense of some code density.  The assembler attempts to widen density
           instructions  to align branch targets and the instructions following call instructions.  If there are
           not enough preceding safe density instructions to align a target,  no  widening  is  performed.   The
           default  is  -mtarget-align.   These options do not affect the treatment of auto-aligned instructions
           like "LOOP", which the assembler always  aligns,  either  by  widening  density  instructions  or  by
           inserting NOP instructions.

       -mlongcalls
       -mno-longcalls
           When  this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate direct calls to indirect calls
           unless it can determine that the target of a direct  call  is  in  the  range  allowed  by  the  call
           instruction.   This  translation  typically  occurs  for  calls  to  functions in other source files.
           Specifically, the assembler translates a direct "CALL" instruction  into  an  "L32R"  followed  by  a
           "CALLX"  instruction.   The  default is -mno-longcalls.  This option should be used in programs where
           the call target can potentially be out of range.  This option is implemented in  the  assembler,  not
           the  compiler,  so  the assembly code generated by GCC still shows direct call instructions---look at
           the disassembled object code to see the  actual  instructions.   Note  that  the  assembler  uses  an
           indirect call for every cross-file call, not just those that really are out of range.

       zSeries Options

       These are listed under

   Options for Code Generation Conventions
       These machine-independent options control the interface conventions used in code generation.

       Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of -ffoo is -fno-foo.  In the table
       below,  only  one of the forms is listed---the one that is not the default.  You can figure out the other
       form by either removing no- or adding it.

       -fbounds-check
           For front ends that support it, generate additional code to check that indices used to access  arrays
           are  within the declared range.  This is currently only supported by the Java and Fortran front ends,
           where this option defaults to true and false respectively.

       -fstack-reuse=reuse-level
           This option controls stack space reuse for user declared local/auto variables and compiler  generated
           temporaries.   reuse_level  can  be  all,  named_vars, or none. all enables stack reuse for all local
           variables and temporaries, named_vars enables the reuse only for user defined  local  variables  with
           names,  and none disables stack reuse completely. The default value is all. The option is needed when
           the program extends the lifetime of a scoped local variable or a compiler generated temporary  beyond
           the end point defined by the language.  When a lifetime of a variable ends, and if the variable lives
           in memory, the optimizing compiler has the freedom to reuse its stack space with other temporaries or
           scoped  local  variables  whose  live  range  does  not  overlap with it. Legacy code extending local
           lifetime will likely to break with the stack reuse optimization.

           For example,

                      int *p;
                      {
                        int local1;

                        p = &local1;
                        local1 = 10;
                        ....
                      }
                      {
                         int local2;
                         local2 = 20;
                         ...
                      }

                      if (*p == 10)  // out of scope use of local1
                        {

                        }

           Another example:

                      struct A
                      {
                          A(int k) : i(k), j(k) { }
                          int i;
                          int j;
                      };

                      A *ap;

                      void foo(const A& ar)
                      {
                         ap = &ar;
                      }

                      void bar()
                      {
                         foo(A(10)); // temp object's lifetime ends when foo returns

                         {
                           A a(20);
                           ....
                         }
                         ap->i+= 10;  // ap references out of scope temp whose space
                                      // is reused with a. What is the value of ap->i?
                      }

           The lifetime of a compiler generated temporary is well defined by the C++ standard. When  a  lifetime
           of a temporary ends, and if the temporary lives in memory, the optimizing compiler has the freedom to
           reuse  its  stack  space  with  other temporaries or scoped local variables whose live range does not
           overlap with it. However some of the legacy code relies on the behavior of older compilers  in  which
           temporaries'  stack  space is not reused, the aggressive stack reuse can lead to runtime errors. This
           option is used to control the temporary stack reuse optimization.

       -ftrapv
           This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction, multiplication operations.

       -fwrapv
           This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic overflow of addition, subtraction
           and multiplication wraps  around  using  twos-complement  representation.   This  flag  enables  some
           optimizations  and  disables  others.   This  option is enabled by default for the Java front end, as
           required by the Java language specification.

       -fexceptions
           Enable exception handling.  Generates extra code needed to propagate exceptions.  For  some  targets,
           this  implies GCC generates frame unwind information for all functions, which can produce significant
           data size overhead, although it does not affect execution.  If you do not specify  this  option,  GCC
           enables  it  by default for languages like C++ that normally require exception handling, and disables
           it for languages like C that do not normally require it.  However, you may need to enable this option
           when compiling C code that needs to interoperate properly with exception  handlers  written  in  C++.
           You  may  also  wish  to  disable  this option if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't use
           exception handling.

       -fnon-call-exceptions
           Generate code that allows trapping  instructions  to  throw  exceptions.   Note  that  this  requires
           platform-specific  runtime support that does not exist everywhere.  Moreover, it only allows trapping
           instructions to throw exceptions, i.e. memory references or floating-point instructions.  It does not
           allow exceptions to be thrown from arbitrary signal handlers such as "SIGALRM".

       -fdelete-dead-exceptions
           Consider that instructions that may throw exceptions but don't otherwise contribute to the  execution
           of  the  program  can be optimized away.  This option is enabled by default for the Ada front end, as
           permitted by the Ada language specification.  Optimization passes that cause dead  exceptions  to  be
           removed are enabled independently at different optimization levels.

       -funwind-tables
           Similar  to  -fexceptions,  except that it just generates any needed static data, but does not affect
           the generated code in any other way.  You normally do not need to  enable  this  option;  instead,  a
           language processor that needs this handling enables it on your behalf.

       -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
           Generate  unwind table in DWARF 2 format, if supported by target machine.  The table is exact at each
           instruction boundary, so it can be used  for  stack  unwinding  from  asynchronous  events  (such  as
           debugger or garbage collector).

       -fno-gnu-unique
           On  systems  with  recent  GNU  assembler  and  C library, the C++ compiler uses the "STB_GNU_UNIQUE"
           binding to make sure that definitions of template static data members and static local  variables  in
           inline functions are unique even in the presence of "RTLD_LOCAL"; this is necessary to avoid problems
           with  a  library  used by two different "RTLD_LOCAL" plugins depending on a definition in one of them
           and therefore disagreeing with the other one about the  binding  of  the  symbol.   But  this  causes
           "dlclose"  to  be  ignored for affected DSOs; if your program relies on reinitialization of a DSO via
           "dlclose" and "dlopen", you can use -fno-gnu-unique.

       -fpcc-struct-return
           Return "short" "struct" and "union" values in memory like longer  ones,  rather  than  in  registers.
           This convention is less efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between GCC-
           compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly the Portable C Compiler (pcc).

           The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends on the target configuration macros.

           Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match that of some integer type.

           Warning:  code  compiled  with  the  -fpcc-struct-return  switch  is  not binary compatible with code
           compiled with the -freg-struct-return switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application  binary
           interface.

       -freg-struct-return
           Return  "struct"  and  "union"  values  in registers when possible.  This is more efficient for small
           structures than -fpcc-struct-return.

           If you specify  neither  -fpcc-struct-return  nor  -freg-struct-return,  GCC  defaults  to  whichever
           convention  is  standard  for  the  target.   If  there  is  no  standard convention, GCC defaults to
           -fpcc-struct-return, except on targets where GCC is the principal compiler.  In those cases,  we  can
           choose the standard, and we chose the more efficient register return alternative.

           Warning:  code  compiled  with  the  -freg-struct-return  switch  is  not binary compatible with code
           compiled with the -fpcc-struct-return switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application  binary
           interface.

       -fshort-enums
           Allocate  to an "enum" type only as many bytes as it needs for the declared range of possible values.
           Specifically, the "enum" type is equivalent to the smallest integer type that has enough room.

           Warning: the -fshort-enums switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with code
           generated without that switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.

       -fshort-double
           Use the same size for "double" as for "float".

           Warning: the -fshort-double switch causes GCC to generate code that is  not  binary  compatible  with
           code generated without that switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.

       -fshort-wchar
           Override  the  underlying  type  for  wchar_t to be short unsigned int instead of the default for the
           target.  This option is useful for building programs to run under WINE.

           Warning: the -fshort-wchar switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with code
           generated without that switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.

       -fno-common
           In C code, controls  the  placement  of  uninitialized  global  variables.   Unix  C  compilers  have
           traditionally  permitted  multiple  definitions  of  such variables in different compilation units by
           placing the variables in a common block.  This is the behavior specified  by  -fcommon,  and  is  the
           default  for  GCC on most targets.  On the other hand, this behavior is not required by ISO C, and on
           some targets may carry a speed or code size penalty on variable references.  The  -fno-common  option
           specifies  that  the  compiler should place uninitialized global variables in the data section of the
           object file, rather than generating them as common blocks.  This has the  effect  that  if  the  same
           variable  is declared (without "extern") in two different compilations, you get a multiple-definition
           error when you link them.  In this case, you must compile  with  -fcommon  instead.   Compiling  with
           -fno-common  is  useful on targets for which it provides better performance, or if you wish to verify
           that the program will work on other systems that always  treat  uninitialized  variable  declarations
           this way.

       -fno-ident
           Ignore the #ident directive.

       -finhibit-size-directive
           Don't output a ".size" assembler directive, or anything else that would cause trouble if the function
           is  split in the middle, and the two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory.  This option
           is used when compiling crtstuff.c; you should not need to use it for anything else.

       -fverbose-asm
           Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code  to  make  it  more  readable.   This
           option  is  generally  only  of  use  to  those who actually need to read the generated assembly code
           (perhaps while debugging the compiler itself).

           -fno-verbose-asm, the default, causes the  extra  information  to  be  omitted  and  is  useful  when
           comparing two assembler files.

       -frecord-gcc-switches
           This  switch  causes the command line used to invoke the compiler to be recorded into the object file
           that is being created.  This switch is only implemented on some targets and the exact format  of  the
           recording  is  target  and  binary  file format dependent, but it usually takes the form of a section
           containing ASCII text.  This switch is related to the -fverbose-asm  switch,  but  that  switch  only
           records  information  in  the assembler output file as comments, so it never reaches the object file.
           See also -grecord-gcc-switches for another way of storing compiler options into the object file.

       -fpic
           Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared library, if supported  for  the
           target  machine.  Such code accesses all constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT).  The
           dynamic loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic loader is  not  part  of
           GCC;  it  is  part  of  the  operating  system).  If the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a
           machine-specific maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating  that  -fpic  does
           not work; in that case, recompile with -fPIC instead.  (These maximums are 8k on the SPARC and 32k on
           the m68k and RS/6000.  The 386 has no such limit.)

           Position-independent  code  requires  special  support, and therefore works only on certain machines.
           For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V but not for the Sun 386i.   Code  generated  for  the  IBM
           RS/6000 is always position-independent.

           When this flag is set, the macros "__pic__" and "__PIC__" are defined to 1.

       -fPIC
           If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code, suitable for dynamic linking and
           avoiding  any  limit  on  the size of the global offset table.  This option makes a difference on the
           m68k, PowerPC and SPARC.

           Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works only on certain machines.

           When this flag is set, the macros "__pic__" and "__PIC__" are defined to 2.

       -fpie
       -fPIE
           These options are similar to -fpic and -fPIC, but generated position independent  code  can  be  only
           linked into executables.  Usually these options are used when -pie GCC option is used during linking.

           -fpie  and  -fPIE  both  define  the macros "__pie__" and "__PIE__".  The macros have the value 1 for
           -fpie and 2 for -fPIE.

       -fno-jump-tables
           Do not use jump tables for switch statements even where it would be more efficient  than  other  code
           generation  strategies.   This  option is of use in conjunction with -fpic or -fPIC for building code
           that forms part of a dynamic linker and cannot reference the  address  of  a  jump  table.   On  some
           targets, jump tables do not require a GOT and this option is not needed.

       -ffixed-reg
           Treat  the  register  named  reg as a fixed register; generated code should never refer to it (except
           perhaps as a stack pointer, frame pointer or in some other fixed role).

           reg must be the name of a register.  The register names accepted are machine-specific and are defined
           in the "REGISTER_NAMES" macro in the machine description macro file.

           This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a three-way choice.

       -fcall-used-reg
           Treat the register named reg as an allocable register that is clobbered by function calls.  It may be
           allocated for temporaries or variables that do not live across a call.  Functions compiled  this  way
           do not save and restore the register reg.

           It  is an error to use this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.  Use of this flag for other
           registers that have fixed pervasive roles  in  the  machine's  execution  model  produces  disastrous
           results.

           This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a three-way choice.

       -fcall-saved-reg
           Treat  the  register named reg as an allocable register saved by functions.  It may be allocated even
           for temporaries or variables that live across a call.  Functions compiled this way save  and  restore
           the register reg if they use it.

           It  is an error to use this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.  Use of this flag for other
           registers that have fixed pervasive roles  in  the  machine's  execution  model  produces  disastrous
           results.

           A  different  sort  of  disaster  results  from the use of this flag for a register in which function
           values may be returned.

           This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a three-way choice.

       -fpack-struct[=n]
           Without a value specified, pack all structure members  together  without  holes.   When  a  value  is
           specified  (which  must  be  a  small  power of two), pack structure members according to this value,
           representing the maximum alignment (that is, objects with default alignment requirements larger  than
           this are output potentially unaligned at the next fitting location.

           Warning: the -fpack-struct switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible with code
           generated  without  that switch.  Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.  Use it to conform to a
           non-default application binary interface.

       -finstrument-functions
           Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions.  Just after function entry  and  just
           before  function  exit,  the following profiling functions are called with the address of the current
           function and its call site.  (On some platforms, "__builtin_return_address" does not work beyond  the
           current  function,  so  the  call  site  information  may not be available to the profiling functions
           otherwise.)

                   void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
                                                  void *call_site);
                   void __cyg_profile_func_exit  (void *this_fn,
                                                  void *call_site);

           The first argument is the address of the start of the  current  function,  which  may  be  looked  up
           exactly in the symbol table.

           This  instrumentation  is  also done for functions expanded inline in other functions.  The profiling
           calls indicate where, conceptually, the inline function is  entered  and  exited.   This  means  that
           addressable  versions  of  such  functions  must  be  available.   If all your uses of a function are
           expanded inline, this may mean an additional expansion of code size.  If you  use  extern  inline  in
           your  C  code, an addressable version of such functions must be provided.  (This is normally the case
           anyway, but if you get lucky and the optimizer always expands the functions inline,  you  might  have
           gotten away without providing static copies.)

           A function may be given the attribute "no_instrument_function", in which case this instrumentation is
           not  done.   This  can  be used, for example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
           interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling  functions  cannot  safely  be  called
           (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling routines generate output or allocate memory).

       -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=file,file,...
           Set  the  list  of  functions  that  are  excluded  from  instrumentation  (see  the  description  of
           "-finstrument-functions").  If the file that contains a function definition matches with one of file,
           then that function is not instrumented.  The match is done on substrings: if the file parameter is  a
           substring of the file name, it is considered to be a match.

           For example:

                   -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=/bits/stl,include/sys

           excludes any inline function defined in files whose pathnames contain "/bits/stl" or "include/sys".

           If,  for  some  reason,  you  want  to  include  letter  ','  in  one of sym, write ','. For example,
           "-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=',,tmp'" (note the single quote surrounding the option).

       -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=sym,sym,...
           This is similar to "-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list", but  this  option  sets  the  list  of
           function  names  to  be  excluded from instrumentation.  The function name to be matched is its user-
           visible name, such as "vector<int> blah(const vector<int> &)", not the internal mangled  name  (e.g.,
           "_Z4blahRSt6vectorIiSaIiEE").   The  match is done on substrings: if the sym parameter is a substring
           of the function name, it is considered to be a match.  For C99  and  C++  extended  identifiers,  the
           function name must be given in UTF-8, not using universal character names.

       -fstack-check
           Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the stack.  You should specify this
           flag  if you are running in an environment with multiple threads, but you only rarely need to specify
           it in a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is  automatically  detected  on  nearly  all
           systems if there is only one stack.

           Note  that  this  switch  does  not  actually  cause checking to be done; the operating system or the
           language runtime must do that.  The switch causes generation of code to  ensure  that  they  see  the
           stack being extended.

           You  can  additionally  specify a string parameter: "no" means no checking, "generic" means force the
           use of old-style checking, "specific" means use the best checking method and is  equivalent  to  bare
           -fstack-check.

           Old-style  checking  is  a generic mechanism that requires no specific target support in the compiler
           but comes with the following drawbacks:

           1.  Modified allocation strategy for large objects: they are always allocated  dynamically  if  their
               size exceeds a fixed threshold.

           2.  Fixed  limit  on  the  size  of  the static frame of functions: when it is topped by a particular
               function, stack checking is not reliable and a warning is issued by the compiler.

           3.  Inefficiency: because of both the modified allocation strategy and  the  generic  implementation,
               code performance is hampered.

           Note  that  old-style  stack checking is also the fallback method for "specific" if no target support
           has been added in the compiler.

       -fstack-limit-register=reg
       -fstack-limit-symbol=sym
       -fno-stack-limit
           Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value, either the  value  of  a
           register  or the address of a symbol.  If a larger stack is required, a signal is raised at run time.
           For most targets, the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so it is  possible  to
           catch the signal without taking special precautions.

           For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address 0x80000000 and grows downwards, you can use the
           flags -fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit and -Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000 to enforce a stack
           limit of 128KB.  Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.

       -fsplit-stack
           Generate  code  to  automatically  split  the stack before it overflows.  The resulting program has a
           discontiguous stack which can only overflow if the program is unable to  allocate  any  more  memory.
           This  is most useful when running threaded programs, as it is no longer necessary to calculate a good
           stack size to use for each thread.  This is currently only implemented for the i386 and  x86_64  back
           ends running GNU/Linux.

           When  code  compiled  with  -fsplit-stack calls code compiled without -fsplit-stack, there may not be
           much stack space available for the latter code to run.  If  compiling  all  code,  including  library
           code,  with  -fsplit-stack  is not an option, then the linker can fix up these calls so that the code
           compiled without -fsplit-stack always has a large stack.  Support for this is implemented in the gold
           linker in GNU binutils release 2.21 and later.

       -fleading-underscore
           This option and its counterpart, -fno-leading-underscore, forcibly  change  the  way  C  symbols  are
           represented in the object file.  One use is to help link with legacy assembly code.

           Warning:  the  -fleading-underscore  switch causes GCC to generate code that is not binary compatible
           with code generated without that switch.  Use it to  conform  to  a  non-default  application  binary
           interface.  Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.

       -ftls-model=model
           Alter   the   thread-local  storage  model  to  be  used.   The  model  argument  should  be  one  of
           "global-dynamic", "local-dynamic", "initial-exec" or "local-exec".  Note that the choice  is  subject
           to  optimization:  the compiler may use a more efficient model for symbols not visible outside of the
           translation unit, or if -fpic is not given on the command line.

           The default without -fpic is "initial-exec"; with -fpic the default is "global-dynamic".

       -fvisibility=default|internal|hidden|protected
           Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified option---all  symbols  are  marked  with
           this  unless  overridden  within the code.  Using this feature can very substantially improve linking
           and load times of shared object libraries, produce more  optimized  code,  provide  near-perfect  API
           export  and  prevent  symbol  clashes.   It  is  strongly recommended that you use this in any shared
           objects you distribute.

           Despite the nomenclature, "default" always means public; i.e., available to be  linked  against  from
           outside  the shared object.  "protected" and "internal" are pretty useless in real-world usage so the
           only other commonly used option  is  "hidden".   The  default  if  -fvisibility  isn't  specified  is
           "default",  i.e.,  make  every  symbol public---this causes the same behavior as previous versions of
           GCC.

           A good explanation of the benefits offered by ensuring ELF symbols have  the  correct  visibility  is
           given   by   "How   To   Write   Shared   Libraries"  by  Ulrich  Drepper  (which  can  be  found  at
           <http://people.redhat.com/~drepper/>)---however a superior solution made possible by this  option  to
           marking  things  hidden  when  the  default  is  public is to make the default hidden and mark things
           public.  This is the norm with DLLs  on  Windows  and  with  -fvisibility=hidden  and  "__attribute__
           ((visibility("default")))" instead of "__declspec(dllexport)" you get almost identical semantics with
           identical syntax.  This is a great boon to those working with cross-platform projects.

           For  those  adding  visibility  support to existing code, you may find #pragma GCC visibility of use.
           This works by you enclosing the declarations you wish  to  set  visibility  for  with  (for  example)
           #pragma  GCC  visibility  push(hidden)  and  #pragma  GCC  visibility  pop.  Bear in mind that symbol
           visibility should be viewed as part of the API interface contract and thus all new code should always
           specify visibility when it is not the default; i.e., declarations only for use within the  local  DSO
           should  always  be marked explicitly as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection overheads---making this
           abundantly clear also aids readability and self-documentation of the code.  Note that due to ISO  C++
           specification  requirements,  "operator  new"  and  "operator  delete"  must  always  be  of  default
           visibility.

           Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular system headers and  headers  from  any
           other  library  you  use, may not be expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default.
           You may need to explicitly say  #pragma  GCC  visibility  push(default)  before  including  any  such
           headers.

           extern  declarations  are  not  affected  by  -fvisibility,  so  a lot of code can be recompiled with
           -fvisibility=hidden with no modifications.  However, this means that calls to "extern" functions with
           no explicit visibility use the PLT, so it is  more  effective  to  use  "__attribute  ((visibility))"
           and/or "#pragma GCC visibility" to tell the compiler which "extern" declarations should be treated as
           hidden.

           Note  that  -fvisibility  does  affect  C++ vague linkage entities. This means that, for instance, an
           exception class that is be thrown between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default  visibility  so
           that the type_info nodes are unified between the DSOs.

           An    overview    of   these   techniques,   their   benefits   and   how   to   use   them   is   at
           <http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/Visibility>.

       -fstrict-volatile-bitfields
           This option should be used if accesses to volatile bit-fields (or other  structure  fields,  although
           the  compiler  usually  honors  those  types  anyway)  should use a single access of the width of the
           field's type, aligned to a natural alignment if possible.  For example,  targets  with  memory-mapped
           peripheral  registers  might  require  all  such  accesses to be 16 bits wide; with this flag you can
           declare all peripheral bit-fields as "unsigned short" (assuming short is 16 bits on these targets) to
           force GCC to use 16-bit accesses instead of, perhaps, a more efficient 32-bit access.

           If this option is disabled, the compiler uses  the  most  efficient  instruction.   In  the  previous
           example, that might be a 32-bit load instruction, even though that accesses bytes that do not contain
           any portion of the bit-field, or memory-mapped registers unrelated to the one being updated.

           In  some  cases,  such  as when the "packed" attribute is applied to a structure field, it may not be
           possible to access the field with a single read or write that is correctly  aligned  for  the  target
           machine.   In  this  case  GCC  falls back to generating multiple accesses rather than code that will
           fault or truncate the result at run time.

           Note:  Due to restrictions of the C/C++11 memory model, write accesses are not allowed to  touch  non
           bit-field  members.   It is therefore recommended to define all bits of the field's type as bit-field
           members.

           The default value of this option is determined by the application binary  interface  for  the  target
           processor.

       -fsync-libcalls
           This option controls whether any out-of-line instance of the "__sync" family of functions may be used
           to implement the C++11 "__atomic" family of functions.

           The  default  value  of  this  option  is  enabled,  thus  the  only  useful  form  of  the option is
           -fno-sync-libcalls.  This option is used in the implementation of the libatomic runtime library.

ENVIRONMENT

       This section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC operates.  Some of them work  by
       specifying  directories  or  prefixes to use when searching for various kinds of files.  Some are used to
       specify other aspects of the compilation environment.

       Note that you can also specify places to search using  options  such  as  -B,  -I  and  -L.   These  take
       precedence  over  places  specified using environment variables, which in turn take precedence over those
       specified by the configuration of GCC.

       LANG
       LC_CTYPE
       LC_MESSAGES
       LC_ALL
           These environment variables control the way that GCC uses localization information which  allows  GCC
           to  work  with  different  national  conventions.   GCC  inspects  the locale categories LC_CTYPE and
           LC_MESSAGES if it has been configured to do so.  These locale categories can  be  set  to  any  value
           supported  by  your  installation.   A typical value is en_GB.UTF-8 for English in the United Kingdom
           encoded in UTF-8.

           The LC_CTYPE environment variable specifies character classification.  GCC uses it to  determine  the
           character  boundaries in a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote and
           escape characters that are otherwise interpreted as a string end or escape.

           The LC_MESSAGES environment variable specifies the language to use in diagnostic messages.

           If the LC_ALL environment variable is set, it  overrides  the  value  of  LC_CTYPE  and  LC_MESSAGES;
           otherwise,  LC_CTYPE  and LC_MESSAGES default to the value of the LANG environment variable.  If none
           of these variables are set, GCC defaults to traditional C English behavior.

       TMPDIR
           If TMPDIR is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary files.  GCC uses temporary files to
           hold the output of one stage of compilation which is to be used as  input  to  the  next  stage:  for
           example, the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler proper.

       GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
           Setting  GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG  is  nearly  equivalent to passing -fcompare-debug to the compiler driver.
           See the documentation of this option for more details.

       GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
           If GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the names of the subprograms  executed  by
           the  compiler.  No slash is added when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you
           can specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.

           If GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is not set, GCC attempts to figure out an appropriate prefix to use based  on  the
           pathname it is invoked with.

           If  GCC  cannot  find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it tries looking in the usual places
           for the subprogram.

           The default value of GCC_EXEC_PREFIX is prefix/lib/gcc/ where prefix is the prefix to  the  installed
           compiler. In many cases prefix is the value of "prefix" when you ran the configure script.

           Other prefixes specified with -B take precedence over this prefix.

           This prefix is also used for finding files such as crt0.o that are used for linking.

           In  addition,  the  prefix  is used in an unusual way in finding the directories to search for header
           files.  For each of the standard directories whose name normally begins with /usr/local/lib/gcc (more
           precisely, with the value of GCC_INCLUDE_DIR), GCC tries replacing that beginning with the  specified
           prefix  to  produce an alternate directory name.  Thus, with -Bfoo/, GCC searches foo/bar just before
           it searches the standard directory /usr/local/lib/bar.  If  a  standard  directory  begins  with  the
           configured  prefix  then  the  value of prefix is replaced by GCC_EXEC_PREFIX when looking for header
           files.

       COMPILER_PATH
           The value of COMPILER_PATH is a colon-separated list of directories, much like PATH.  GCC  tries  the
           directories  thus  specified  when  searching for subprograms, if it can't find the subprograms using
           GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.

       LIBRARY_PATH
           The value of LIBRARY_PATH is a colon-separated list of directories, much like PATH.  When  configured
           as  a  native  compiler,  GCC  tries the directories thus specified when searching for special linker
           files, if it can't find them using GCC_EXEC_PREFIX.  Linking using GCC also  uses  these  directories
           when  searching  for  ordinary  libraries  for  the -l option (but directories specified with -L come
           first).

       LANG
           This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler.  One way in which this  information
           is  used  is  to  determine the character set to be used when character literals, string literals and
           comments are parsed in C and C++.  When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters, the
           following values for LANG are recognized:

           C-JIS
               Recognize JIS characters.

           C-SJIS
               Recognize SJIS characters.

           C-EUCJP
               Recognize EUCJP characters.

           If LANG is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the compiler uses "mblen" and "mbtowc" as
           defined by the default locale to recognize and translate multibyte characters.

       Some additional environment variables affect the behavior of the preprocessor.

       CPATH
       C_INCLUDE_PATH
       CPLUS_INCLUDE_PATH
       OBJC_INCLUDE_PATH
           Each variable's value is a list of directories separated by a special character, much like  PATH,  in
           which  to  look  for  header files.  The special character, "PATH_SEPARATOR", is target-dependent and
           determined at GCC build time.  For Microsoft Windows-based targets it is a semicolon, and for  almost
           all other targets it is a colon.

           CPATH  specifies  a  list  of directories to be searched as if specified with -I, but after any paths
           given with -I options on the command line.  This environment variable is  used  regardless  of  which
           language is being preprocessed.

           The  remaining environment variables apply only when preprocessing the particular language indicated.
           Each specifies a list of directories to be searched as if specified  with  -isystem,  but  after  any
           paths given with -isystem options on the command line.

           In  all  these  variables,  an  empty  element  instructs  the compiler to search its current working
           directory.  Empty elements can appear at the beginning or end of a path.  For instance, if the  value
           of CPATH is ":/special/include", that has the same effect as -I. -I/special/include.

       DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT
           If  this  variable  is set, its value specifies how to output dependencies for Make based on the non-
           system header files processed by the compiler.  System header files are  ignored  in  the  dependency
           output.

           The value of DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT can be just a file name, in which case the Make rules are written to
           that  file,  guessing the target name from the source file name.  Or the value can have the form file
           target, in which case the rules are written to file file using target as the target name.

           In other words, this environment variable is equivalent to combining the options -MM and -MF, with an
           optional -MT switch too.

       SUNPRO_DEPENDENCIES
           This variable is the same as DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT (see above), except that system header files are not
           ignored, so it implies -M rather than -MM.  However,  the  dependence  on  the  main  input  file  is
           omitted.

BUGS

       For instructions on reporting bugs, see <file:///usr/share/doc/gcc-4.9/README.Bugs>.

FOOTNOTES

       1.  On  some  systems,  gcc  -shared needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work.  On
           multi-libbed systems, gcc -shared must select the correct support libraries to link against.  Failing
           to supply the correct flags may lead to subtle defects.  Supplying them in cases where they  are  not
           necessary is innocuous.

SEE ALSO

       gpl(7),  gfdl(7),  fsf-funding(7),  cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1) and the
       Info entries for gcc, cpp, as, ld, binutils and gdb.

AUTHOR

       See the Info entry for gcc, or <http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html>, for contributors to
       GCC.

COPYRIGHT

       Copyright (c) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.

       Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms  of  the  GNU  Free
       Documentation  License,  Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with
       the Invariant Sections being "GNU General Public License" and "Funding Free  Software",  the  Front-Cover
       texts  being (a) (see below), and with the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below).  A copy of the license
       is included in the gfdl(7) man page.

       (a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:

            A GNU Manual

       (b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:

            You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
            software.  Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
            funds for GNU development.

gcc-4.9                                            2016-04-13                                             GCC(1)